HomeMy WebLinkAboutExecuted Contract.pdf SPECIFICATIONS
JUVENILE JUSTICE CAMPUS GROUNDWATER
MONITORING WELL REPLACEMENTS
3333 E. AMERICAN AVENUE
FRESNO, CA
BUDGET / ACCOUNT: 8935 / 7431
co
Department o Public Works and Planning
O� �O P f g
FRES
CONTRACT NUMBER 23-06-C
TABLE OF CONTENTS
COVER SHEET
COUNTY ADOPTION AND ACKNOWLEDGMENT
Engineer's Signature
Consultant's Signature
NOTICE TO BIDDERS
SPECIAL PROVISIONS
PROJECT DETAILS / DRAWINGS
Location Map
Well Drillers Dummy Permit
CVRWQCB Workplan
Self-Dealing Transactions Disclosure Form
Revised Standard Specifications Dated 09-02-16
BID BOOK
Bidder's Declaration
Bid Form
Abbreviations Used
Signature Page
Noncollusion Declaration
Public Contract Code
Subcontractor List
Certifications
Guaranty
AGREEMENT
PLANS
Contract Number 23-06-C
COUNTY ADOPTION AND ACKNOWLEDGEMENT
PROJECT: JUVENILE JUSTICE CAMPUS GROUNDWATER MONITORING WELL
REPLACEMENTS
CONTRACT NUMBER: 23-06-C
Sal Quintero, Chairman 3rd District
Nathan Magsig, Vice Chairman 5th District
Brian Pacheco 1st District
Steve Brandau 2nd District
Ernest Buddy Mendes 4th District
Paul Nerland, County Administrative i er
Steven E. White, Direc or Date
Department of Public Works and Planning
�y FESS/p Date Signed:
af
CONo. C76724 r
Exp.12/31/24
TF C�VI L
OF CALF
Supervising Engineer:
FRESNO COUNTY Sebastian Artal, PE C76724
Department of Public Works and Planning
m/a 2220 Tulare Street, Suite 720
Fresno, CA 93721-2106
COUNTY ADOPTION AND ACKNOWLEDGEMENT
PROJECT: JUVENILE JUSTICE CAMPUS GROUNDWATER MONITORING WELL
REPLACEMENTS
CONTRACT NUMBER: 23-06-C
Date Signed: 8/8/2023
QROFESS/o49
w No. 61926 z
Exp. 09/30/2023
CIV I -
qTF OF CALIFO�
Professional Engineer:
Stephen Plauson, No. 61926
Kleinfelder
2882 Prospect Park Drive, Suite 200
Rancho Cordova, CA 95670
BOARD OF SUPERVISORS COUNTY OF FRESNO STATE OF CALIFORNIA
NOTICE TO BIDDERS
Sealed proposals will be received at:
https://www.bidexpress.com/businesses/36473/home
and at the Fresno County Department of Public Works and Planning (Department), Office of
the Design Engineer, Seventh Floor, Fresno County Plaza Building, 2220 Tulare Street,
Fresno, CA 93721 until
2:00 P.M., (1400 hours and 00 seconds)
Thursday, September 7, 2023
If you have any questions about bid submission, please contact us at
Des ignServicesCa)fresnocountyca.gov or calling (559) 600-4241.
Promptly following the closing of the bidding all timely submitted bids will be publicly opened
and viewable via a livestream (the link for which will be posted at
http://www.fresnocountyca.gov/planholders) for construction in accordance with the project
specifications therefor, to which special reference is made as follows:
JUVENILE JUSTICE CAMPUS GROUNDWATER MONITORING WELL
REPLACEMENTS
3333 E. AMERICAN AVENUE
FRESNO, CA
CONTRACT NUMBER 23-06-C
The work to be done consists, in general, of installing three new groundwater monitoring
wells, including submersible pumps, to monitor first encountered groundwater quality to
comply with Waste Discharge Requirements Order No. R5-2007-0150, issued by the Central
Valley Regional Water Quality Control Board. The existing seven monitoring wells, installed
in 2007 and shortly after, will remain in place and existing pumps in these wells will be
removed and salvaged.
A pre-bid conference will be held at 10:00 a.m., on Thursday, August 24, 2023. A discussion
of the project will be held and the project sites will be open for examination. Contractors
should meet at 3333 E. American Avenue, Fresno California 93725. Attendance at the pre-
bid is not mandatory; however, the scheduled pre-bid will be the only opportunity for
prospective bidders to visit the site in the presence of County staff, and requests for individual
site visits with County staff will not be granted.
Bidders may fill out a Request to be Added to Planholders list:
https://www.fresnocountyca.gov/Departments/Public-Works-and-Planning/Construction-
Bidding-Opportunities/Request-to-Be-Added-to-the-Planholders-List-Form
Requesters will then be listed as a planholder for the project on the website and receive
notifications and addenda issued for the project.
Prospective bidders may also select the project on www.BidExpress.com. Those that
demonstrate interest in the project will be added to the planholders list, and receive
notifications and addenda issued for the project.
Planholder and exchange/publication names may be obtained from the Fresno County
website at http://www.fresnocountyca.gov/planholders.
Electronic copies, in ".pdf"file format, of the official project plans and specifications, bid books
and proposal sheets, and such additional supplemental project information as may be
provided, are available to view, download, and print at
http://www.fresnocountyca.gov/planholders.
If a bidder is unable to submit a bid via Bid Express, Bid Books, which contain bid proposal
sheets necessary to submit a bid, may be obtained within the Specifications documents
posted on the Fresno County website.
Electronic bids shall be submitted via the Bid Express website. Hardcopy bids shall be
submitted in a sealed envelope addressed to the Department and labeled with the name of
the bidder, the name of the project and the statement "Do Not Open Until The Time Of Bid
Opening."
Bid security in the amount of ten (10) percent of the amount of the bid, and in the form of a
bid bond issued by an admitted surety insurer licensed by the California Department of
Insurance, cash, cashier's check or certified check shall accompany the bid. You must either
attach an electronic bid bond or provide an original bid bond (or other form of bid security
authorized by Public Contract Code Section 20129(a)), prior to the bid opening. Bid security
shall be made in favor of the County of Fresno.
Hardcopy bid bonds shall be submitted in a sealed envelope addressed to the Department
and labeled with the name of the bidder, the name of the project and the statement "Do Not
Open Until The Time Of Bid Opening — BID BOND"
A Summary of Bids and a list of subcontractors for the apparent low bidder will be posted at
the above listed website, generally within 24 hours of the Bid Opening.
All questions regarding this project shall be in writing and shall be received by the Department
of Public Works and Planning, Design Division, no later than 2:00 P.M. on the seventh (7th)
calendar day before bid opening. Any questions received after this deadline will not receive
a response unless the Department of Public Works and Planning elects to issue an
addendum to revise the bid opening date. In the event that the bid opening date is revised,
Contract Number 23-06-C Notice to Bidders - 2
the deadline for questions will be extended to no later than 2:00 P.M. on the seventh (7th)
calendar day before the revised bid opening date. Questions shall be submitted on the
"Request for Clarification Form" provided on our website:
https://www.fresnocountyca.gov/Departments/Public-Works-and-Planning/Construction-
Bidding-Opportunities/23-06-C-Juvenile-Justice-Campus-Groundwater-Monitoring-Wells-
Replacement/Request-for-Clarification-Form
Any changes to, or clarification of, the project plans and specifications shall be in the form of
a written addendum issued to planholders of record. Questions that prompt a change or
clarification shall be included in the addendum with the subsequent answer.
Any oral explanation or interpretations given to this project are not binding.
No contract will be awarded to a contractor who has not been licensed in accordance with
the provisions of the Contractors State License Law, California Business and Professions
Code, Division 3, Chapter 9, as amended, or whose bid is not on the proposal form included
in the contract document. A valid California Contractor's License, Class C-57 (Well Drilling),
is required for this project.
Pursuant to Section 1773 of the Labor Code, the general prevailing wage rates in the county,
or counties, in which the work is to be done have been determined by the Director of the
California Department of Industrial Relations. These wages are set forth in the General
Prevailing Wage Rates for this project, available at County of Fresno, Department of Public
Works and Planning, 2220 Tulare Street, Sixth Floor, Fresno CA 93721-2104 and available
from the California Department of Industrial Relations' Internet web site at
http://www.dir.ca.gov/DLSR/PWD. Future effective general prevailing wage rates, which
have been predetermined and are on file with the California Department of Industrial
Relations are referenced but not printed in the general prevailing wage rates.
This project is subject to compliance monitoring and enforcement by the Department of
Industrial Relations.
No contractor or subcontractor may be listed on a bid proposal for a public works project
unless registered with the Department of Industrial Relations pursuant to Labor Code section
1725.5 [with limited exceptions from this requirement for bid purposes only under Labor Code
section 1771.1(a)].
No contractor or subcontractor may be awarded a contract for public work on a public works
project unless registered with the Department of Industrial Relations pursuant to Labor Code
section 1725.5.
This contract is subject to state contract nondiscrimination and compliance requirements
pursuant to Government Code, Section 12990.
Bids are required for the entire work described herein. Bids will be compared on the basis
of the cumulative sum of the bid amounts listed for the individual line items.
The successful bidder shall furnish a faithful performance bond in the amount of 100 percent
of the contract amount and a payment bond in the amount of 100 percent of the contract
amount. Each bond specified in this Notice (bid bond, faithful performance bond and payment
Contract Number 23-06-C Notice to Bidders - 3
bond) shall meet the requirements of all applicable statutes, including but not limited to those
specified in Public Contract Code section 20129 and Civil Code section 3248.
Each bond specified in this Notice shall be issued by a surety company designated as an
admitted surety insurer in good standing with and authorized to transact business in this state
by the California Department of Insurance, and acceptable to the County of Fresno. Bidders
are cautioned that representations made by surety companies will be verified with the
California Department of Insurance. Additionally, the County of Fresno, in its discretion, when
determining the sufficiency of a proposed surety company, may require the surety company
to provide additional information supported by documentation. The County generally
requires such information and documentation whenever the proposed surety company has
either a Best's Key Rating Guide of less than A and a financial size designation of less than
VIII. Provided, however, that the County expressly reserves its right to require all information
and documentation to which the County is legally entitled from any proposed surety
company.
The Board of Supervisors reserves the right to reject any or all bids.
Board of Supervisors, County of Fresno
Paul Nerland, County Administrative Officer
Bernice E. Seidel, Clerk of the Board
Issue Date: August 8, 2023
Contract Number 23-06-C Notice to Bidders - 4
Special Provisions
Contract Number 23-06-C
DIVISION I GENERAL PROVISIONS
1 GENERAL
1-1.01 GENERAL
Add to the beginning of Section 1:
The work is done in accordance with the 2015 Standard Specifications, 2015 Standard Plans and the
following special provisions.
Where these special provisions indicate to replace, add to, delete, delete from, or otherwise modify a
"section," or a portion thereof, the section or portion thereof to which such modification is to be applied is
the section or portion thereof with the corresponding numbering in the 2015 Standard Specifications.
Except to the extent that they may conflict with these special provisions, revised standard specifications
apply if included in the project details section of the book entitled "Specifications."
Revised standard plans apply if listed on the "List of Revised Standard Plans," if any, in these special
provisions; or if shown or referenced on the project plans or in the project details section of the book
entitled "Specifications."
In case of conflict between the Standard Specifications and these special provisions, the special
provisions shall take precedence over and be used in lieu of such conflicting portions.
In case of conflict between applicable revised standard specifications and these special provisions, the
special provisions shall take precedence over and be used in lieu of such conflicting portions.
Add to the end of section 1-1.01:
Add to the 1st table of section 1-1.06:
SJVAPCD San Joaquin Valley air pollution control district
AQMD air quality management district
CISS cast-in-steel shell
CSL crosshole sonic logging
GGL gamma-gamma logging
METS Caltrans Material Engineering and Testing Services
Add to section 1-1.06:
Abbreviations in the Bid Items and Applicable Sections are also used in the Bid Item List- Proposal 2.
Replace Section 1-1.07 with:
1-1.07 DEFINITIONS
1-1.07A General
Interpret terms as defined in the Contract documents.
1-1.07B Glossary
abandon: Render unserviceable in place.
acts of God: Acts of God as defined in Pub Cont Code § 7105.
activity: Task, event, or other project element on a schedule that contributes to completing the project.
An activity has a description, start date, finish date, duration, and one or more logic ties.
adjust: Raise or lower a facility to match a new grade line.
aerially deposited lead: Lead primarily from vehicle emissions deposited within unpaved areas or
formerly unpaved areas.
Authorized Facility Audit List: Caltrans-developed list of facilities. For the Authorized Facility Audit List,
go the METS website.
authorized laboratory: Independent testing laboratory (1) not employed or compensated by any
subcontractor or subcontractor's affiliate providing other services for the Contract and (2) authorized
by the Department.
Authorized Material List: Caltrans-developed list of authorized materials. For the Authorized Material
List go to the METS website.
Authorized Material Source List: Caltrans-developed list of authorized source materials. For the
Authorized Material Source List go to the METS website.
base: Layer of specified material of planned thickness placed immediately below the pavement or
surfacing.
basement material: Material in an excavation or embankment under the lowest layer to be placed.
bid item: Work unit for which the Bidder provides a price.
Bid Item List: List of bid items, units of measure, and the associated quantities. The verified Bid Item List
is the Bid Item List with verified prices. The Contract Proposal (Proposal 2)of Low Bidder at the
Department's website is the verified Bid Item List. After contract award, interpret a reference to the
Bid Item List as a reference to the verified Bid Item List.
borrow: Fill acquired from an excavation source outside the described cut area.
1. local borrow: Material obtained by widening cuts or excavating from sources outside the planned or
authorized cross section on the job site. The location of the local borrow is described or designated
by the Engineer.
2. imported borrow: Borrow that is not local borrow.
bridge: Structure that:
1. Has a bridge number
2. Carries a (1) utility, (2) railroad, or(3)vehicle, pedestrian, or other traffic over, under, or around
obstructions or waterways
building-construction contract: Contract that has Building Construction on the cover of the Notice to
Bidders and Special Provisions.
California Test: Caltrans-developed test for determining work quality. For California Tests, go to the
METS website.
Caltrans: State of California Department of Transportation
certificate of compliance: Certificate stating the material complies with the Contract.
Certified Industrial Hygienist: Industrial hygienist certified in comprehensive practice by the American
Board of Industrial Hygiene.
change order work: Work described in a Change Order, including extra work and work described in the
Contract as change order work.
closure: Closure of a traffic lane or lanes, including shoulder, ramp, or connector lanes, within a single
traffic control system.
commercial quality: Quality meeting the best general practices.
commercial source: Established business operating as a material source for the general public.
Contract: Written and executed contract between the Department and the Contractor.
Contract acceptance: Director's written acceptance of a completed Contract.
Contract time: Number of original working days as adjusted by any time adjustment.
Contractor: Person or business or its legal representative entering into a Contract with the Department
for performance of the work.
controlling activity: Construction activity that will extend the scheduled completion date if delayed.
County: The County of Fresno
critical path: Longest continuous chain of activities for the project that has the least amount of total float
of all chains. In general, a delay on the critical path extends the scheduled completion date.
critical path method: Network-based planning technique using activity durations and relationships
between activities to calculate a schedule for the entire project.
culvert: Structure other than a bridge that provides an opening under a roadway.
data date: Day after the date through which a schedule is current. Everything occurring earlier than the
data date is as-built and everything on or after the data date is planned.
day: 24 consecutive hours running from midnight to midnight; calendar day.
1. business day: Day on the calendar except a Saturday and a holiday.
2. working day: Time measure unit for work progress. A working day is any 24-consecutive-hour period
except:
2.1. Saturday and a holiday.
2.2. Day during which you cannot perform work on the controlling activity for at least 50 percent of
the scheduled work shift with at least 50 percent of the scheduled labor and equipment due to
any of the following:
2.2.1. Adverse weather-related conditions.
2.2.2. Traffic maintenance under the Contract.
2.2.3. Suspension of a controlling activity that you and the Engineer agree benefits both
parties.
2.2.4. Unanticipated event not caused by either party, such as:
2.2.4.1. Act of God
2.2.4.2. Act of a public enemy.
2.2.4.3. Epidemic.
2.2.4.4. Fire.
2.2.4.5. Flood.
2.2.4.6. Governor-declared state of emergency.
2.2.4.7. Landslide.
2.2.4.8. Quarantine restriction.
2.2.5. Issue involving a third party, including:
2.2.5.1. Industry or area-wide labor strike.
2.2.5.2. Material shortage.
2.2.5.3. Freight embargo.
2.2.5.4. Jurisdictional requirement of a law enforcement agency.
2.2.5.5. Workforce labor dispute of a utility or nonhighway facility owner resulting in
a nonhighway facility rearrangement not described and not solely for the
Contractor's convenience. Rearrangement of a nonhighway facility includes
installation, relocation, alteration, or removal of the facility.
2.3. Day during a concurrent delay.
3. original working days:
3.1. Working days to complete the work shown on the Notice to Bidders for a non-cost-plus-time-
based bid
3.2. Working days bid to complete the work for a cost-plus-time-based bid
Where working days is specified without the modifier original in the context of the number of working
days to complete the work, interpret the number as the number of original working days as adjusted
by any time adjustment.
deduction: Money permanently taken from a progress payment or the final payment. Deductions are
cumulative and are not retentions under Pub Cont Code § 7107.
delay: Event that extends the completion of an activity.
1. excusable delay: Delay caused by the Department and not reasonably foreseeable when the work
began, such as:
1.1. Change in the work
1.2. Department action that is not part of the Contract
1.3. Presence of an underground utility main not described in the Contract or in a location
substantially different from that specified
1.4. Described facility rearrangement not rearranged as described, by the utility owner by the date
specified, unless the rearrangement is solely for the Contractor's convenience
1.5. Department's failure to obtain timely access to the right-of-way
1.6. Department's failure to review a submittal or provide notification in the time specified
2. critical delay: Excusable delay that extends the scheduled completion date
3. concurrent delay: Occurrence of at least 2 of the following events in the same period of time, either
partially or entirely:
3.1. Critical delay
3.2. Delay to a controlling activity caused by you
3.3. Non—working day
Department: The Fresno County Board of Supervisors and its authorized representatives.
District Office: County of Fresno Department of Public Works and Planning
detour: Temporary route for traffic around a closed road part. A passageway through a job site is not a
detour.
Director: Department's Chairman
disadvantaged business enterprise: Disadvantaged business enterprise as defined in 49 CFR 26.5.
dispose of: Remove from the job site.
divided highway: Highway with separated traveled ways for traffic, generally in opposite directions.
Engineer: The County's Director of Public Works and Planning, acting through their authorized
designees.
early completion time: Difference in time between an early scheduled completion date and the work
completion date.
environmentally sensitive area: Area within or near construction limits where access is prohibited or
limited to protect environmental resources.
estimated cost: Estimated cost of the project as shown on the Notice to Bidders.
extra work: Any work, desired or performed, but not included in the original Contract.
federal-aid contract: Contract that has a federal-aid project number on the cover of the Specifications.
final pay item: Bid item whose quantity shown on the Bid Item List is the quantity paid.
finished grade: Final surface of the completed facility. If the work under the Contract includes stage
construction, the relation between the finished grade and the work under the Contract is shown.
fixed cost: Labor, material, or equipment cost directly incurred by the Contractor as a result of performing
or supplying a particular bid item that remains constant regardless of the item's quantity.
float: Difference between the earliest and latest allowable start or finish times for an activity.
1. Department-owned float: Time saved on the critical path by actions of the Department. It is the last
activity shown on the schedule before the scheduled completion date.
force account work: Work ordered on a construction project without an existing agreement on its cost,
and performed with the understanding that the contractor will bill the owner according to the cost of
labor, materials, and equipment, plus a certain percentage for overhead and profit.
grading plane: Basement material surface on which the lowest layer of subbase, base, pavement,
surfacing, or other specified layer is placed.
highway: Whole right-of-way or area reserved for use in constructing the roadway and its appurtenances.
holiday: Holiday shown in the following table:
Holidays
Holiday Date observed
Every Sunday Every Sunda
New Year's Day January 1st
Birthday of Martin Luther King, Jr. 3rd Monday in January
Presidents' Day 3rd Monday in February
Cesar Chavez Day March 31 st
Memorial Day Last Monday in May
Independence Day July 4th
Labor Day 1st Monday in September
Veterans Day November 11th
Thanksgiving Day 4th Thursday in November
Day after Thanksgiving Day Day after Thanksgiving Da
Christmas Day December 25th
If January 1st, March 31st, July 4th, November 11th, or December 25th fall on a Sunday, the Monday
following is a holiday. If January 1st, March 31st, July 4th, November 11th, or December 25th fall on a
Saturday, the preceding Friday is a holiday.
hours of darkness: Hours of darkness as defined in Veh Code § 280.
idle equipment: Equipment:
1. On the job site at the start of a delay
2. Idled because of the delay
3. Not operated during the delay
informal-bid contract: Contract that has Informal Bid Authorized by Pub Cont Code § 10122 on the
cover of the Notice to Bidders and Special Provisions.
job site: Area within the defined boundaries of a project.
Labor Surcharge and Equipment Rental Rates: Caltrans publication that lists labor surcharge and
equipment rental rates.
landscaping: Practice of a landscaping contractor under 16 CA Code of Regs § 832.27.
material: Any product or substance specified for use in the construction of a project.
material shortage:
1. Shortage of raw or produced material that is area-wide and caused by an unusual market condition
except if any of the following occurs:
1.1. Shortage relates to a produced, nonstandard material
1.2. Supplier's and the Contractor's priority for filling an order differs
1.3. Event outside the United States for a material produced outside the United States
2. Unavailability of water that delays a controlling activity
material source facility audit: Self-audit and a Caltrans audit evaluating a facility's capability to
consistently produce materials that comply with Caltrans standards.
median: Portion of a divided highway separating the traveled ways including inside shoulders.
milestone: Event activity that has zero duration and is typically used to represent the start or end of a
certain stage of the project.
mobilization: Preparatory work that must be performed or costs incurred before starting work on the
various items on the job site (Pub Cont Code § 10104).
modify: Add to or subtract from an appurtenant part.
narrative report: Document submitted with each schedule that discusses topics related to project
progress and scheduling.
near critical path: Chain of activities with total float exceeding that of the critical path but having not
more than 10 working days of total float.
obliterate: Place an earth cover over or root, plow, pulverize, or scarify.
Office engineer: The Director of Public Works and Planning for the County of Fresno
pavement: Uppermost layer of material placed on a traveled way or shoulder.
plans: Standard plans, revised standard plans, and project plans.
1. standard plans: Drawings standard to Department construction projects. These plans are in a
book titled Standard Plans.
2. revised standard plans: New or revised standard plans. These plans are listed in the List of
Revised Standard Plans in a book titled Specifications.
3. project plans: Drawings specific to the project, including authorized shop drawings. These plans
also include a section titled Project Details of a book titled Specifications.
plant establishment period: Number of days shown on the Notice to Bidders for plant establishment.
quality characteristic: Characteristic of a material that is measured to determine conformance with a
given requirement.
quality control plan: Contractor's plan to ensure QC.
reconstruct: Remove and disassemble and construct again at an existing or new location.
relocate: Remove and install or place in a new location.
remove: Remove and dispose of.
reset: Remove and install or place laterally at the same station location.
roadbed: Roadway portion extending from the curb line to curb line or the shoulder line to shoulder line.
A divided highway has 2 roadbeds.
roadside: Area between the outside shoulder edge and the right-of-way limits.
roadway: Portion of the highway within the outside lines of curbs, sidewalks, slopes, ditches, channels,
or waterways. A roadway includes the structures and features necessary for safety, protection of
facilities, and drainage.
salvage: Remove, clean, and haul to a specified location.
schedule:
1. baseline schedule: Initial schedule showing the original work plan starting on the date of Contract
approval. This schedule shows no completed work to date and no negative float or negative lag to
any activity.
2. revised schedule: Schedule that incorporates a proposed or past change to logic or activity
durations.
3. updated schedule: Current schedule developed from the accepted baseline and any subsequent
accepted updated or revised schedules through regular monthly review to incorporate actual past
progress.
scheduled completion date: Planned work completion date shown on the current schedule.
shoulder: Roadway portion contiguous with the traveled way for accommodation of a stopped vehicle,
emergency use, and lateral support of base and surface courses.
small tool: Tool or piece of equipment not listed in Labor Surcharge and Equipment Rental Rates that
has a replacement value of$500 or less.
specifications: Standard specifications, revised standard specifications, and special provisions.
1. standard specifications: Specifications standard to Department construction projects. These
specifications are in a book titled Standard Specifications.
2. revised standard specifications: New or revised standard specifications. These specifications
are in a section titled Revised Standard Specifications of a book titled Specifications.
3. special provisions: Specifications specific to the project. These specifications are in a section
titled Special Provisions of a book titled Specifications.
State: State of California, including its agencies, departments or divisions whose conduct or action is
related to the work.
Structure Design: Offices of Structure Design of the Department of Transportation.
subbase: Layer of material between a base and the basement material.
subgrade: Roadbed portion on which pavement, surfacing, base, subbase, or a layer of any other
material is placed.
submittal:
1. action submittal: Written and graphic information and samples that require the Department's
response.
2. informational submittal: Written information that does not require the Department's response.
substantial defects: Defects plainly seen as damaged, displaced, or missing parts or improper
functioning of materials, parts, equipment, or systems.
substructure: Bridge parts below the bridge seats, pier tops, and haunches for rigid-framed bridges or
spring lines for arched bridges; includes abutment backwalls, abutment parapets, and wingwalls.
superstructure: Bridge parts except the substructure.
supplemental project information: Information relevant to the project, specified as supplemental project
information, and made available to bidders.
surfacing: Uppermost layer of material placed on a traveled way or shoulders; pavement.
time impact analysis: Analysis using a CPM schedule developed specifically to demonstrate the effect a
proposed or past change or delay has on the current scheduled completion date.
time-scaled network diagram: Graphic depiction of a CPM schedule comprised of activity bars with
relationships for each activity represented by arrows. The tail of each arrow connects to the activity
bar for the predecessor and points to the successor.
total bid: Sum of the item totals as verified by the Department; original Contract price.
total float: Amount of time that an activity or chain of activities can be delayed before extending the
scheduled completion date.
traffic: Pedestrians, bicyclists, ridden or herded animals, vehicles, streetcars, and other conveyances
either singularly or together while using any highway for purposes of travel.
traffic lane: Portion of traveled way used for the movement of a single line of vehicles.
traveled way: Portion of the roadway for the movement of vehicles, exclusive of the shoulders, berms,
sidewalks, and parking lanes.
tunnel: Tunnel as defined in 8 CA Code of Regs § 8405 et seq.
unauthorized work: Work performed beyond the lines and grades described in the Contract or
established by the Engineer or extra work performed without Department authorization.
unsuitable material: Material encountered below the natural ground surface in embankment areas or
below the grading plane in excavation areas that the Engineer determines to be in any of the
following conditions:
1. Of such unstable nature that it cannot be compacted to the specified density using ordinary methods
at optimum moisture content.
2. Too wet to be properly compacted and cannot be dried before incorporating it into the work.
Excessive moisture alone is not sufficient cause for determining that the material is unsuitable.
3. Inappropriate for the planned use.
withhold: Money temporarily or permanently taken from a progress payment.
work: Resources and activities required for Contract acceptance, including labor, materials, equipment,
and the created product.
work plan: Detailed formulation of a program of action.
work zone: Area of a highway with construction, maintenance, or utility work activities.
1-1.08 DISTRICTS
Replace Section 1.08 with:
Not Used
Add to the end of Section 1-1.09
This project is not in a freeze-thaw area.
Replace Section 1-1.10 with:
1-1.10 PAVEMENT CLIMATE REGIONS
To help account for the effects of various climatic conditions on pavement performance, the State has
been divided into 9 climate regions. The project's pavement climate region is Inland Valley.
Replace Section 1-1.11 with:
1-1.11 WEBSITES, ADDRESSES, AND TELEPHONE NUMBERS
Websites, Addresses, and Telephone Numbers
Reference or
agency or
department unit Website Address Telephone no.
Authorized https://dot.ca.gov/program
Material Lists s/engineering=
Authorized services/authorized-
Material Source materials-lists
Lists
CA Unified
Certification https:Hdot.ca.gov/program
Program's list of s/civil-rights/dbe-search
certified DBEs
California https://dot.ca.gov/program
MUTCD s/safety- -- --
ro rams/camutcd
Data Materials Engineering and Testing
Interchange for Services Department of
Materials https://dime.dot.ca.gov/ Transportation (916)227- 5238
Engineering 5900 Folsom Blvd
Sacramento CA 95819-4612
https://www.fresnocountyc 2220 Tulare Street
Department a.gov/Departments/Public- Design Division—Seventh Floor (559) 600-9908
Works-and-Planning Fresno, CA 93721
Department of
Conservation, http://www.conservation.c
Office of Mine a.gov/dmr/
Reclamation
Department of
General Office of Small Business and DVBE
Services, Office https://www.dgs.ca.gov/O Services Department of General (800) 559-5529
of Small BAS Services 707 3rd St West (916) 375-4940
Business and Sacramento CA 95605-2811
DVBE Services
Department of 455 Golden Gate Ave
Industrial http://www.dir.ca.gov San Francisco CA 94102 --
Relations
Design 2220 Tulare Street Tel: (559) 600-
Services - https://www.fresnocountyc Design Division—Seventh Floor 4241
Contract a.gov/Departments/Public- Fresno, CA 93721 Fax:(559)455-
Administration, Works-and- 4609 Email:
Planholders, Planning/Construction- DesignServices(a)-
Bid Results Bidding-Opportunities fresnocountyca.q
ov
Division of Major Construction Payment and
Accounting, Information Unit
Office of https://dot.ca.gov/program Office of External Accounts Payable
External s/accounting Division of Accounting (916) 227-9013
Accounts Department of Transportation
Payable P.O. Box 168043
Sacramento, CA 95816-8043
Division of http://www.dot.ca.gov/hq/c
Construction onstruc/
Geotechnical Services
Geotechnical https://dot.ca.gov/program Department of Transportation (916) 227-7000
Services s/engineering-services 5900 Folsom Blvd
Sacramento, CA 95819-4612
Materials Engineering and Testing
https://dot.ca.gov/program Services
METS s/engineering-services Department of Transportation (916) 227-7000
5900 Folsom Blvd
Sacramento, CA 95819-4612
https://dot.ca.gov/program
MPQP s/construction/material- -- --
lant- ual ity-prog ram
Director of Public Works & Planning
Office Engineer __ Fresno County cn (559) 600-4078
2220 Tulare St, 8 Floor
Fresno, CA 93721
MSC 9-4/41
Offices of Documents Unit Offices of Structure
Structure Design (916) 227-0716
Design, Department of Transportation
Documents Unit 1801 30th St
Sacramento, CA 95816-7006
Publication Unit
Publication Department of Transportation
Distribution Unit 1900 Royal Oaks Dr
Sacramento, CA 95815-3800
Replace Section 1-1.12 with:
1-1.12 MISCELLANY
Make checks and bonds payable to the County of Fresno.
Replace Section 2 with:
2 BIDDING
2-1.01 GENERAL
Section 2 includes specifications related to bid eligibility and the bidding process.
2-1.02 BID INELIGIBILITY
A firm that has provided architectural or engineering services to the Department for this contract before
bid submittal for this contract is prohibited from any of the following:
1. Submitting a bid
2. Subcontracting for a part of the work
3. Supplying materials
2-1.03 CONTRACTOR REGISTRATION
No contractor or subcontractor may be listed on a bid proposal for a public works project unless
registered with the Department of Industrial Relations pursuant to Labor Code section 1725.5 [with limited
exceptions from this requirement for bid purposes only under Labor Code section 1771.1(a)].
2-1.04-2-1.05 RESERVED
2-1.06 BID DOCUMENTS
2-1.06A General
The Bid book includes bid forms and certifications and may be requested from Design Services and are
available online at http://www.BidExpress.com.
The Specifications includes the Notice to Bidders, revised standard specifications, project details, and
special provisions.
The Specifications, project plans, and any addenda to these documents may be accessed at Design
Services.
The Standard Specifications and Standard Plans may be purchased at the Publication Distribution Unit or
accessed online at https://www.fresnocountyca.aov/files/sharedassets/county/vision-files/files/58025-
2015-standard-specifications.pdf.
2-1.06B Supplemental Project Information
The Department makes the following supplemental project information available:
Supplemental Project Information
Where Available Description
Included in Project Details Well Drillers Dummy Permit
• CVRWQCB Work Ian
Included with the project plans None
Available on Design Services webpage None
If as-built drawings are available they may not show existing dimensions and conditions. Where new
construction dimensions are dependent on existing bridge dimensions, verify the field dimensions and
adjust the dimensions of the work to fit the existing conditions.
2-1.06C-2-1.06D Reserved
2-1.07 JOB SITE AND DOCUMENT EXAMINATION
Examine the job site and bid documents. Notify the Department of apparent errors and patent ambiguities
in the plans, specifications, and Bid Item List. Failure to do so may result in rejection of a bid or rescission
of an award.
Bid submission is your acknowledgment that you have examined the job site and bid documents and are
satisfied with:
1. General and local conditions to be encountered
2. Character, quality, and scope of work to be performed
3. Quantities of materials to be furnished
4. Character, quality, and quantity of surface and subsurface materials or obstacles
5. Requirements of the contract
2-1.08 RESERVED
2-1.09 BID ITEM LIST
Submit a bid based on the bid item quantities the Department shows on Bid Item List.
2-1.10 SUBCONTRACTOR LIST
On the Subcontractor List form, list each subcontractor to perform work in an amount in excess of 1/2 of 1
percent of the total bid or$10,000, whichever is greater(Pub Cont Code §4100 et seq.).
For each subcontractor listed, the Subcontractor List form must show:
1. Business name and the location of its place of business.
2. California contractor license number for a non-federal-aid contract.
3. Public works contractor registration number.
4. Portion of work it will perform. Show the portion of the work by:
4.1. Bid item numbers for the subcontracted work
4.2. Percentage of the subcontracted work for each bid item listed
4.3. Description of the subcontracted work if the percentage of the bid item listed is less than 100
percent
2-1.13-2-1.30 RESERVED
Replace section 2-1.31 with:
2-1.31 RESERVED
2-1.32 RESERVED
2-1.33 BID DOCUMENT COMPLETION AND SUBMITTAL
2-1.33A General
Complete forms in the Bid book.
Submit an electronic bid online at http://www.BidExpress.com (Section 2-1.33D)or submit a hardcopy bid:
1. Under sealed cover
2. Marked as a bid
3. Identifying the contract number and the bid opening date
Certain bid forms must be submitted with the bid and properly executed.
Certain other forms and information must be submitted either with the bid or within the prescribed period
after bid opening as specified elsewhere in these special provisions.
Failure to submit the forms and information as specified results in a nonresponsive bid.
If an agent other than the authorized corporation officer or a partnership member signs the bid, file a
Power of Attorney with the Department either before opening bids or with the bid. Otherwise, the bid may
be nonresponsive.
2-1.33B Bid Item List and Bid Comparison
Submit a bid based on the bid item quantities the Department shows on Proposal 2. Bids will be
evaluated and the low bidder determined as indicated in the Notice to Bidders.
Do not submit an unbalanced bid. An unbalanced is a bid is one in which one or more bid items is/are
considered by the Department to have been bid at an amount that is unreasonably high or unreasonably
low. A bid may be considered to be non-responsive and may be rejected if it is considered by the
Department to be unbalanced.
2-1.33C Bid Document Completion
Proposal items are identified by title and by the word "Proposal"followed by the number assigned to the
proposal item in question. Proposal items are included in the Bid Book.
2-1.33C(1) Proposal 1 - Proposal to the Board of Supervisors of Fresno County
2-1.33C(2) Proposal 2 - Bid Item List
One or more sheet(s) or list(s) upon which the bidder completes the bid.
Fill out completely including a unit price and total for each unit price-based item and a total for each lump
sum item.
Do not make any additions such as "plus tax", "plus freight", or conditions such as "less 2% if paid by
15th".
Use ink or typewriter for paper bids.
2-1.33C(3) Proposal 3 - Evaluation of Bid Item List
Describes how inconsistences and irregularities are evaluated and corrected when Design Services
reviews the Bid Item List.
2-1.33C(4) Proposal 4 - Bid Security and Signature
Submit one of the following forms of bidder's security equal to at least 10 percent of the bid:
• Cash
• Cashier's check
• Certified check
• Signed bidder's bond by an admitted surety insurer
Indicate type of bid security provided.
• Cash—Acceptable but not recommended. Cash is deposited in a clearing account and is
returned to bidders by County warrant. This process may take several weeks.
• Cashier's or Certified Checks. This type of security is held until the bid is no longer under
consideration. If submitted by a potential awardee, they will be returned when the contract is fully
executed by the bidder and bonds and insurance have been approved.
• Bid Bonds - Must be signed by the bidder and by the attorney-in-fact for the bonding company.
Provide notarized signature of attorney-in-fact accompanied by bonding company's affidavit
authorizing attorney-in-fact to execute bonds. An unsigned bid bond will be cause for rejection.
Provide contractor's license information.
State business name and if business is a:
• Corporation - list officers
• Partnership - list partners
• Joint Venture- list members; if members are corporations or partnerships, list their officers or
partners.
• Individual - list Owner's name and firm name style
Signature of Bidder-the following lists types of companies and corresponding authorized signers.
• Corporation - by an officer
• Partnership - by a partner
• Joint Venture- by a member
• Individual - by the Owner
If signature is by a Branch Manager, Estimator, Agent, etc., the bid must be accompanied by a power of
attorney authorizing the individual to sign the bid in question or to sign bids more generally, otherwise the
bid may be rejected.
Business Address- Firm's Street Address
Mailing Address- P.O. Box or Street Address
Complete, sign, and return with bid.
2-1.33C(5) Proposal 5 - Noncollusion Declaration
Must be completed, signed, and returned with bid.
2-1.33C(6) Proposal 6 - Public Contract Code Section 10285.1 Statement
Select"has" or"has not" in accordance with instructions on form, return with completed for with bid. Note
that signing the bid constitutes signing this statement.
2-1.33C(7) Proposal 7 - Public Contract Code Section 10162 Questionnaire And Public Contract
Code 10232 Statement
Select: "yes" or"no" accordance with instructions on form, include explanation if"yes" is selected. Return
completed form with bid. Note that signing the bid constitutes signing this questionnaire and statement.
2-1.33C(8) Proposal 8(a)through Proposal 8(c) -Subcontractors
Sheet(s)or spaces where bidders list subcontractors. List each subcontractor to perform work in an
amount in excess of 1/2 of 1 percent of the total bid (Pub Cont Code §4100 et seq.).
The Subcontractor List submitted with the bid must show the name, location of business, work portions to
be performed, and the contractor's license number for each subcontractor listed.
• Use subcontractor's business name style as registered with the License Board.
• Specify the city in which the subcontractor's business is located and the state if other than
California.
• Description of the work to be performed by the subcontractor. Indicate with bid item numbers
from the bid item list and/or work descriptions similar to those on bid item list.
• List license number and Department of Industrial Relations registration number for each
subcontractor.
Upon request from Design Services, provide the following additional information within 24 hours of bid
opening if not included on the Subcontractor List submitted with the bid:
• Complete physical address for each subcontractor listed.
• Percentage of the total bid or dollar amount associated with each subcontractor listed.
2-1.33C(16) Proposal 16 - Opt out of payment adjustments for price index fluctuations
You may opt out of the payment adjustments for price index fluctuations specified in section 9-1.07. To
opt out, submit a completed Opt Out of Payment Adjustments for Price Index Fluctuations form with your
bid.
2-1.33C(17) Proposal 17 - Guaranty
Does not need to be signed with the bid. Part of the contract which must be signed by the contractor
when contract is executed.
2-1.33D Electronic Bid Document Completion
Electronic versions of the bid book documents are available online at http://www.BidExpress.com, and
may be submitted through that website.
You must either attach an electronic bid bond or provide an original bid bond (or other form of bid security
authorized by Public Contract Code Section 20129(a)), prior to the bid opening.
Bidders submitting online may use one of the accepted electronic sureties (SurePath or Surety 2000)to
submit their bid bond; or may submit cash, cashier's check, certified check, or a bidder bond to Design
Services at 2220 Tulare St., Seventh Floor, Fresno, CA 93721. Those submitting bid bonds directly to
Design Services must submit their bid bond:
1. Under sealed cover
2. Marked as a bid-bond
3. Identifying the contract number and the bid opening date on the cover
2-1.34 BIDDER'S SECURITY
Submit one of the following forms of bidder's security equal to at least 10 percent of the bid:
1. Cash
2. Cashier's check
3. Certified check
4. Signed bidder's bond by an admitted surety insurer
Submit cash, cashier's check, certified check, or bidder's bond with your bid.
2-1.35-2-1.39 RESERVED
2-1.40 BID WITHDRAWAL
1. An authorized agent may withdraw a bid before the bid opening date and time by submitting a written
bid withdrawal request at the location where the bid was submitted. Withdrawing a bid does not
prevent you from submitting a new bid. An authorized agent is an individual authorized to submit a
bid.
2. After the bid opening time, you cannot withdraw a bid.
2-1.41-2-1.42 RESERVED
2-1.43 BID OPENING
The Department publicly opens and reads bids at the time and place shown on the Notice to Bidders.
2-1.44-2-1.45 RESERVED
2-1.46 DEPARTMENT'S DECISION ON BID
The Department's decision on the bid amount is final.
The Department may reject:
1. All bids
2. A nonresponsive bid
2-1.47 BID RELIEF
The Department may grant bid relief under Pub Cont Code § 5100 et seq. Submit any request for bid
relief to Design Services.
2-1.48 RESERVED
2-1.49 SUBMITTAL FAILURE HISTORY
The Department considers a bidder's past failure to submit documents required after bid opening in
determining a bidder's responsibility.
2-1.51 DISCLOSURE OF SELF-DEALING TRANSACTIONS
This provision is only applicable if the contractor is operating as a corporation (a for-profit or non-profit
corporation) or if during the term of this agreement, the contractor changes its status to operate as a
corporation.
Members of the contractor's Board of Directors shall disclose any self-dealing transactions that they are a
party to while contractor is providing goods or performing services under this agreement. A self-dealing
transaction shall mean a transaction to which the contractor is a party and in which one or more of its
directors has a material financial interest. Members of the Board of Directors shall disclose any self-
dealing transactions that they are a party to by completing and signing a Self-Dealing Transaction
Disclosure Form which is included in Project Details of these special provisions.
In the event that the Contractor(to whom the project is awarded) is operating as a corporation or
incorporates during the course of the construction contract, and any member of its board of directors is
engaged or intends to become engaged in self-dealing transaction(s), each member of its board of
directors who is engaged or intends to become engaged in a self-dealing transaction or transactions must
complete and submit to the County a completed Self-Dealing Transaction Disclosure Form (in Project
Details)for each such transaction prior to engaging therein or immediately thereafter.
3 CONTRACT AWARD AND EXECUTION
Replace Section 3 with:
3-1.01 GENERAL
Section 3 includes specifications related to contract award and execution.
3-1.02 CONSIDERATION OF BIDS
3-1.02A General
Bids will be compared on the basis listed in the Notice to Bidders.
3-1.02B Tied Bids
The Department breaks a tied bid with a coin toss:
3-1.03 CONTRACTOR REGISTRATION
No contractor or subcontractor may be awarded a contract for public work on a public works project
(awarded on or after April 1, 2015) unless registered with the Department of Industrial Relations pursuant
to Labor Code section 1725.5.
3-1.04 CONTRACT AWARD
3-1.04A BID PROTEST PROCEDURES
Any bid protest must be submitted in writing and delivered by the Bidder by either of the following means:
(1)via e-mail to DesignServices(a�-fresnocountyca.gov; or(2)via certified mail, return receipt requested to
the following address: Design Division, Department of Public Works and Planning, 2220 Tulare Street,
Sixth Floor, Fresno, CA 93721.
The bid protest must be received no later than 5:00 p.m. of the seventh (71') calendar day following
the deadline for submittal of the specific bid document(s) placed at issue by the protest. Any
Bidder filing a protest is encouraged to submit the bid protest via e-mail, because the deadline is based on
the Department's receipt of the bid protest. A bid protest accordingly may be rejected as untimely if it is
not received by the deadline, regardless of the date on which it was postmarked. The Bidder's compliance
with the following additional procedures also is mandatory:
a. The initial protest document shall contain a complete statement of the grounds for the protest,
including a detailed statement of the factual basis and any supporting legal authority.
b. The protest shall identify and address the specific portion of the document(s)forming the basis for
the protest.
c. The protest shall include the name, address and telephone number of the person representing
the protesting party.
d. The Department will provide a copy of the initial protest document and any attached
documentation to all other Bidders or proposers who appear to have a reasonable prospect of
receiving an award depending upon the outcome of the protest.
e. The Board of Supervisors will issue a decision on the protest. If the Board of Supervisors
determines that a protest is frivolous, the party originating the protest may be determined to be
irresponsible and that party may be determined to be ineligible for future contract awards.
f. The procedure and time limits set forth herein are mandatory and are the Bidder's sole and
exclusive remedy in the event of a bid protest. Failure by the Bidder to comply with these
procedures shall constitute a waiver of any right to further pursue the bid protest, including the
subsequent filing of a Government Code Claim or legal proceedings.
3-1.04B AWARD PERIOD
If the Department awards the contract, the award is made to the lowest responsible bidder within 54
calendar days after bid opening.
The Department may extend the specified award period if the Bidder agrees.
You may request to extend the award period by faxing a request to Design Services before 4:00 p.m. on
or before the last day of the award period. If you do not make this request, after the specified award
period:
1. Your bid becomes invalid
2. You are not eligible for the award of the contract
3-1.05 CONTRACT BONDS (PUB CONT CODE §§ 10221 AND 10222)
The successful bidder must furnish 2 bonds conforming to the requirements in the Agreement of these
special provisions.
3-1.06 CONTRACTOR LICENSE
For a federal-aid contract, the Contractor must be properly licensed as a contractor from contract award
through Contract acceptance (Pub Cont Code § 10164).
For a non-federal-aid contract:
1. Contractor must be properly licensed as a contractor from bid opening through Contract acceptance
(Bus & Prof Code § 7028.15)
2. Joint venture bidders must obtain a joint venture license before contract award (Bus & Prof Code §
7029.1)
3-1.07 INSURANCE POLICIES
The successful bidder must submit copies of its insurance policies conforming to the requirements in the
Agreement of these special provisions.
3-1.08—3-1.10 RESERVED
3-1.11 PAYEE DATA RECORD
Complete and deliver to the Engineer a Payee Data Record form when requested by the Engineer.
3-1.12 RESERVED
3-1.14-3-1.17 RESERVED
3-1.18 CONTRACT EXECUTION
The successful bidder must sign the Agreement.
Deliver to Design Services:
1. Signed Agreement including the attached form FHWA-1273
2. Contract bonds
3. Documents identified in section 3-1.07
4. For a federal-aid contract, Local Agency Bidder-DBE Information form
Design Services must receive these documents before the 10th business day after the bidder receives
the contract.
The bidder's security may be forfeited for failure to execute the contract within the time specified (Pub
Cont Code §§ 10181, 10182, and 10183).
3-1.19 BIDDERS' SECURITIES
The Department keeps the securities of the 1st, 2nd, and 3rd low bidders until the contract has been
executed. The other bidders' securities, other than bidders' bonds, are returned upon determination of the
1st, 2nd, and 3rd low bidders, and their bidders' bonds are of no further effect (Pub Cont Code § 10184).
4 SCOPE OF WORK
Replace Section 4-1.02 with:
4-1.02 INTENT
The Contract intent is to provide for work completion using the best general practices.
Nothing in the specifications, special provisions, Standard Specifications, or in any other Contract
document voids the Contractor's public safety responsibilities.
Replace Section 4-1.07C with:
4-1.07C Reserved
Replace Section 4-1.13 with:
4-1.13 CLEANUP
Before final inspection, leave the job site neat and presentable and dispose of:
1. Rubbish
2. Excess materials
3. Falsework
4. Temporary structures
5. Equipment
Remove warning, regulatory, and guide signs when directed by the Engineer.
5 CONTROL OF WORK
Delete the 91" Paragraph of Section 5-1.01
Add the following before the last sentence in Section 5-1.02
Caltrans Standard Plans, City of Fresno Standard Drawings, and any other other-agency Standard
Drawings included in the "Project Details" section of the book entitled "Specifications" have the same
ranking as Standard Plans."
All other drawings in the "Project Details" section of the book entitled "Specifications" have the same
ranking as Project Plans.
Tables and other documents in the "Project Details" section of the book entitled "Specifications" have the
same ranking as Special Provisions. If a portion of a document in the Project Details section conflicts with
the Special Provisions, the Special Provisions shall prevail.
Replace Section 5-1.09 with:
5-1.09 RESERVED
Replace Section 5-1.12 with:
5-1.12 ASSIGNMENT
No third-party agreement relieves you or your surety of the responsibility to complete the work. Do not
sell, transfer, or otherwise dispose of any Contract part without prior written consent from the Department.
If you assign the right to receive Contract payments, the Engineer accepts the assignment upon the
Engineer's receipt of a notice. Assigned payments remain subject to deductions and withholds described
in the Contract. The Department may use withheld payments for work completion whether payments are
assigned or not.
A pending or disapproved request for assignment does not relieve you of the responsibility to commence
and pursue work timely and in strict accordance with contract documents.
Replace Section 5-1.13C with:
5-1.13C RESERVED
Replace Section 5-1.13D with:
5-1.13D RESERVED
Add the following paragraph to the end of section 5-1.16 with:
Submit Daily Log records to the Engineer weekly for the entire course of work unless the Engineer
requests another interval.
Replace Section 5-1.20B(4) with:
5-1.20B(4) Contractor—Property Owner Agreement
Before procuring material from or disposing or stockpiling of material on non-highway property:
1. Provide proof that the property where materials are to be stockpiled or equipment parked/stored
is appropriately zoned and/or permitted for the use proposed by the Contractor.
2. Obtain written authorization from each and every owner of the property where materials are to be
stockpiled or equipment parked/stored.
3. Provide proof that the signor(s) of the authorization are the owners of the property.
4. Provide an executed release from the property owner(s) absolving the Department from any and
all responsibility in connection with the stockpiling of materials or parking/storage of equipment on
said property.
5. Obtain written permission from the Engineer to stockpile materials or park/store equipment at the
location designated in said authorization.
Before Contract acceptance, submit a document signed by the owner of the material source or disposal
site stating that the Contractor has complied with the Contractor-owner agreement.
Failure by the Contractor to provide written authorization shall result in the withholding of all funds due to
the Contractor until said authorization is received by the County.
Replace Section 5-1.20C with:
5-1.20C Railroad Relations
If the Contract includes an agreement with a railroad company, the Department makes the provisions of
the agreement available in Project Details in the document titled "Railroad Relations and Insurance
Requirements." Comply with the requirements in the document.
Replace Section 5-1.23A with:
5-1.23A General
Section 5-1.23 includes specifications for action and informational submittals.
Any submittal not specified as an informational submittal is an action submittal.
Submit action and informational submittals to the Engineer. Unless otherwise specified in these
Specifications, submittals shall be provided via email in .pdf format.
Each submittal must have a cover sheet that must include:
1. Contract number
2. Project Name
3. Date
4. Submittals (and resubmittals if applicable) must be numbered sequentially
5. Structure number if applicable
6. Contractor
7. Person responsible for submitting the submittal
8. Signature of Contractor's representative sending submittal
9. Section number and/or item submittal is referencing
10. Pages of submittal, excluding cover sheet
The Department rejects a submittal if it has any error or omission.
If the last day for submitting a document falls on a Saturday or holiday, it may be submitted on the next
business day with the same effect as if it had been submitted on the day specified.
Documents must be submitted in the English language.
Convert documents to US customary units.
Replace Section 5-1.26 with:
5-1.26 CONSTRUCTION SURVEYS
The Engineer places stakes and/or marks as the Engineer determines to be necessary to establish the
lines and grades required for the work.
Submit your request for Engineer-furnished stakes:
1 Once staking area is ready for stakes
2. On a Request for Construction Stakes form
After your submittal, the Engineer starts staking within 2 working days.
Preserve stakes and marks placed by the Engineer. If the stakes or marks are destroyed, the Engineer
replaces them at the Engineer's earliest convenience and deducts the cost.
Replace Section 5-1.27E with:
5-1.27E CHANGE ORDER BILLS
Maintain separate records for change order work costs.
5-1.32 AREAS FOR USE
Occupy the highway only for purposes necessary to perform the work.
Defend, indemnify, and hold the Department harmless to the same extent as under section 7-1.05.
The Department does not allow temporary residences within the County right-of-way.
6 CONTROL OF MATERIALS
Replace section 6-1.05 with:
6-1.05 SPECIFIC BRAND OR TRADE NAME AND SUBSTITUTION
Unless substitution is expressly precluded in the special provisions, a reference to a specific brand or
trade name establishes a quality standard and is not intended to limit competition. Unless the Department
has made a public interest finding expressly authorizing sole source procurement of a particular item, you
may use a product that is equal to or better than the specified brand or trade name if authorized.
Submit a substitution request with a time period that:
1. Follows Contract award
2. Allows 30 days for review
3. Causes no delay
Include substantiating data with the substitution request that proves that substitution:
1. Causes no delay
2. Is of equal or better quality and suitability
If the special provisions disallow substitution of a particular item, provide the specified item and do not
propose substitution.
7 LEGAL RELATIONS AND RESPONSIBILITY TO THE PUBLIC
Replace the 2"1 Paragraph of Section 7-1.02K(2)with:
The general prevailing wage rates and any applicable changes to these wage rates are available:
1. From Design Services
2. From the Department of Industrial Relations'Web site
Replace section 7-1.02K(3)with:
Keep accurate payroll records.
Submit a copy of your certified payroll records, weekly, including those of subcontractors. Include:
1. Each employee's:
1.1. Full name
1.2. Address
1.3. Social security number
1.4. Work classification
1.5. Straight time and overtime hours worked each day and week
1.6. Actual wages paid for each day to each:
1.6.1. Journeyman
1.6.2. Apprentice
1.6.3. Worker
1.6.4. Other employee you employ for the work
1.7. Pay rate
1.8. Itemized deductions made
1.9. Check number issued
1.10. Fringe Benefits
2. Apprentices and the apprentice-to-journeyman ratio
Each certified payroll record must include a Statement of Compliance form signed under penalty of
perjury that declares:
1. Information contained in the payroll record is true, correct, and complete
2. Employer has complied with the requirements of sections 1771, 1811, and 1815 for any work
performed by his or her employees on the public works project
3. Wage rates paid are at least those required by the Contract
Submitted certified payrolls for hauling and delivering ready-mixed concrete must be accompanied by a
written time record. The time record must include:
1. Truck driver's full name and address
2. Name and address of the factory or batching plant
3. Time the concrete was loaded at the factory or batching plant
4. Time the truck returned to the factory or batching plant
5. Truck driver's signature certifying under penalty of perjury that the information contained in this written
time record is true and correct
Make certified payroll records available for inspection at all reasonable hours at your main office on the
following basis:
1. Upon the employee's request or upon request of the employee's authorized representative, make
available for inspection a certified copy of the employee's payroll record.
2. Refer the public's requests for certified payroll records to the Department. Upon the public's request,
the Department makes available for inspection or furnishes copies of your certified payroll records.
Do not give the public access to the records at your main office.
Make all payroll records available for inspection and copying or furnish a copy upon request of a
representative of the:
1. Department
2. Division of Labor Standards Enforcement of the Department of Industrial Relations
3. Division of Apprenticeship Standards of the Department of Industrial Relations
Furnish the Department the location of the records. Include the street address, city, and county. Furnish
the Department a notification of a location and address change within 5 business days of the change.
Comply with a request for the records within 10 days after you receive a written request. If you do not
comply within this period, the Department withholds from progress payments a $100 penalty for each day
or part of a day for each worker until you comply. You are not assessed this penalty for a subcontractor's
failure to comply with Labor Code § 1776.
The Department withholds from progress payments for delinquent or inadequate records (Labor Code §
1771.5). If you have not submitted an adequate record by the month's 15th day for the period ending on
or before the 1 st of that month, the Department withholds up to 10 percent of the monthly progress
estimate, exclusive of mobilization. The Department does not withhold more than $10,000 or less than
$1,000.
7-1.02K(4)i Apprenticeship Requirements for non-Federal Projects
A. Pursuant to Sections 1770-1780 of the Labor Code of the State of California, the Director of
the Department of Industrial Relations has determined the general prevailing rate of wages in
the locality for each craft or type of worker needed to execute the work. Said wage rates
pursuant to Section 1773.2 of the Labor Code are on file with the Clerk to the Fresno County
Board of Supervisors, and will be made available to any interested person on request. A
copy of this wage scale may also be obtained at the following Web Site: www.dir.ca.gov/dlsr.
B. Pursuant to Section 1775 of the Labor Code of the State of California, nothing in this Article
shall prevent the employment of properly registered apprentices upon public works. Every
such apprentice shall be paid the standard wage paid to apprentices under the regulations of
the craft or trade at which he/she is employed, and shall be employed only at the work of the
craft or trade to which he/she is registered.
C. Only apprentices, as defined in Section 3077, who are in training under apprenticeship
standards and written apprentice agreements under Chapter 4 (commencing at Section
3070), Division 3, of the Labor Code, are eligible to be employed on public works. The
employment and training of each apprentice shall be in accordance with the provisions of the
apprenticeship standards and apprentice agreements under which he/she is training.
Replace Section 7-1.02M(2)with:
7-1.02M(2) Fire Prevention
Cooperate with local fire prevention authorities in eliminating hazardous fire conditions.
Obtain the phone numbers of the nearest fire suppression agency, California Department of Forestry and
Fire Protection (Cal Fire) unit headquarters, United States Forest Service (USFS) ranger district office,
and U.S. Department of Interior(USDI) BLM field office. Submit these phone numbers to the Engineer
before the start of job site activities.
Immediately report to the nearest fire suppression agency fires occurring within the project limits.
Prevent project personnel from setting open fires that are not part of the work.
Prevent the escape of and extinguish fires caused directly or indirectly by job site activities
Except for motor trucks, truck tractors, buses, and passenger vehicles, equip all hydrocarbon-fueled
engines, both stationary and mobile including motorcycles, with spark arresters that meet USFS
standards as specified in the Forest Service Spark Arrester Guide. Maintain the spark arresters in good
operating condition. Spark arresters are not required by Cal Fire, the BLM, or the USFS on equipment
powered by properly maintained exhaust-driven turbo-charged engines or equipped with scrubbers with
properly maintained water levels. The Forest Service Spark Arrester Guide is available at the district
offices.
Each toilet must have a metal ashtray at least 6 inches in diameter by 8 inches deep half-filled with sand
and within easy reach of anyone using the facility.
Locate flammable materials at least 50 feet away from equipment service, parking, and gas and oil
storage areas. Each small mobile or stationary engine site must be cleared of flammable material for a
radius of at least 15 feet from the engine.
Each area to be cleared and grubbed must be cleared and kept clear of flammable material such as dry
grass, weeds, brush, downed trees, oily rags and waste, paper, cartons, and plastic waste. Before
clearing and grubbing, clear a fire break at the outer limits of the areas to be cleared and grubbed. Other
fire breaks may be ordered and are change order work.
Furnish the following fire tools:
1. 1 shovel and 1 fully charged fire extinguisher UL rated at 4 B:C or more on each truck, personnel
vehicle, tractor, grader, or other heavy equipment.
Cal Fire, USFS, and BLM have established the following adjective class ratings for 5 levels of fire danger
for use in public information releases and fire protection signing: low, moderate, high, very high, extreme.
Obtain the fire danger rating daily for the project area from the nearest Cal Fire unit headquarters, USFS
ranger district office, or BLM field office.
Arrangements have been made with Cal Fire, USFS, and BLM to notify the Department when the fire
danger rating is very high or extreme. This information will be furnished to the Engineer who will notify
you for dissemination and action in the area affected. If a discrepancy between this notice and the fire
danger rating obtained from the nearest office of either Cal Fire or USFS exists, you must conduct
operations according to the higher of the two fire danger ratings.
If the fire danger rating reaches extreme, take the precautions specified for a very high fire danger rating
except smoking is not allowed in an area immediately surrounded by a firebreak and work of a nature that
could start a fire requires that properly equipped fire guards be assigned to such operation for the
duration of the work.
The Engineer may suspend work wholly or in part due to hazardous fire conditions. The days during this
suspension are non—working days.
If field and weather conditions become such that the determination of the fire danger rating is suspended,
section 7-1.02M(2)will not be enforced for the period of the suspension of the determination of the fire
danger rating. The Engineer will notify you of the dates of the suspension and resumption of the
determination of the fire danger rating.
Add between the 9th and 10th paragraphs of section 7-1.03:
07-15-16
If a height differential of more than 0.04 foot is created by construction activities at a joint transverse to
the direction of traffic on the traveled way or a shoulder subject to public traffic, construct a temporary
taper at the joint with a slope complying with the requirements shown in the following table:
Temporary Tapers
Height differential Sloe horizontal:vertical
foot Taper use of 14 da s or less Taper use of more than 14 days___
Greater than 0.08 100:1 or flatter 200:1 or flatter
0.04-0.08 70:1 or flatter 70:1 or flatter
For a taper on existing asphalt concrete or concrete pavement, construct the taper with minor HMA under
section 39-2.07.
Grind existing surfaces to accommodate a minimum taper thickness of 0.10 foot under either of the
following conditions:
1. HMA material such as rubberized HMA, polymer-modified bonded wearing course, or open-graded
friction course is unsuitable for raking to a maximum 0.02 foot thickness at the edge
2. Taper will be in place for more than 14 days
For a taper on a bridge deck or approach slab, construct the taper with polyester concrete under section
60-3.04B.
The completed surface of the taper must be uniform and must not vary more than 0.02 foot from the lower
edge of a 12-foot straightedge when placed on its surface parallel and perpendicular to traffic.
If authorized, you may use alternative materials or methods to construct the required taper.
Replace Section 7-1.04 with:
7-1.04 PUBLIC SAFETY
7-1.04A GENERAL
You are responsible to provide for public safety.
Do not construct a temporary facility that interferes with the safe passage of traffic.
Control dust resulting from the work, inside and outside the right-of-way.
Move workers, equipment, and materials without endangering traffic.
Whenever your activities create a condition hazardous to the public, furnish, erect and maintain those
fences, temporary railing, barricades, lights, signs, and other devices and take any other necessary
protective measures to prevent damage or injury to the public.
Any fences, temporary railing, barricades, lights, signs, or other devices furnished, erected and
maintained by you are in addition to those for which payment is provided elsewhere in the specifications.
Provide flaggers whenever necessary to ensure that the public is given safe guidance through the work
zone. At locations where traffic is being routed through construction under one-way controls, move your
equipment in compliance with the one-way controls unless otherwise ordered.
Use of signs, lights, flags, or other protective devices must comply with the California MUTCD and any
directions of the Engineer. Signs, lights, flags or other protective devices must not obscure the visibility of,
nor conflict in intent, meaning, and function of either existing signs, lights and traffic control devices, or
any construction area signs.
Keep existing traffic signals and highway lighting in operation. Other forces within the Department will
perform routine maintenance of these facilities during the work.
Cover signs that direct traffic to a closed area.
Install temporary illumination in a manner which the illumination and the illumination equipment does not
interfere with public safety. The installation of general roadway illumination does not relieve you from
furnishing and maintaining any protective devices.
Equipment must enter and leave the highway via existing ramps and crossovers and must move in the
direction of traffic. All movements of workmen and construction equipment on or across lanes open to
traffic must be performed in a manner that do not endanger the public. Your vehicles or other mobile
equipment leaving an open traffic lane to enter the construction area must slow down gradually in
advance of the location of the turnoff to give the traffic following an opportunity to slow down. When
leaving a work area and entering a roadway carrying traffic, your vehicles and equipment must yield to
traffic.
Immediately remove hauling spillage from a roadway lane or shoulder open to traffic. When hauling on
roadways, trim loads and remove material from shelf areas to minimize spillage.
Notify the Engineer not less than 5 days before the anticipated start of an activity that will change the
vertical or horizontal clearance available to traffic, including shoulders.
Do not store vehicles, material, or equipment in a way that:
1. Creates a hazard to the public
2. Obstructs traffic control devices
Do not install or place temporary facilities used to perform the work which interfere with the free and safe
passage of traffic.
Temporary facilities that could be a hazard to public safety if improperly designed must comply with
design requirements described in the Contract for those facilities or, if none are described, with standard
design criteria or codes appropriate for the facility involved. Submit shop drawings and design
calculations for the temporary facilities and show the standard design criteria or codes used. Shop
drawings and supplemental calculations must be sealed and signed by an engineer who is registered as
a civil engineer in the State.
If you appear to be neglectful or negligent in furnishing warning devices and taking protective measures,
the Engineer may direct your attention to the existence of a hazard. You must furnish and install the
necessary warning devices. If the Engineer points out the inadequacy of warning devices and protective
measures, that action on the part of the Engineer does not relieve you from your responsibility for public
safety or abrogate your obligation to furnish and pay for these devices and measures.
Install Type K temporary railing or other authorized protective systems under any of the following
conditions:
1. Excavations: Where the near edge of the excavation is within 15 feet from the edge of an open traffic
lane
2. Temporarily unprotected permanent obstacles: When the work includes the installation of a fixed
obstacle together with a protective system, such as a sign structure together with protective railing,
and you elect to install the obstacle before installing the protective system; or you, for your
convenience and as authorized, remove a portion of an existing protective railing at an obstacle and
do not replace such railing completely the same day
3. Storage areas: When material or equipment is stored within 15 feet of the edge of an open traffic lane
and the storage is not otherwise prohibited by the Contract
4. Height differentials: When construction operations create a height differential greater than 0.15 feet
within 15 feet of the edge of traffic lane
Installation of Type K temporary railing is not required if an excavation within 15 feet from the edge of an
open traffic lane is protected by any of the following:
1. Steel plate or concrete covers of adequate thickness to prevent accidental entry by traffic or the
public
2. Side slope where the downhill slope is 4:1 (horizontal: vertical)or less unless a naturally occurring
condition
3. Barrier or railing
Offset the approach end of Type K temporary railing a minimum of 15 feet from the edge of an open
traffic lane. Install the temporary railing on a skew toward the edge of the traffic lane of not more than 1
foot transversely to 10 feet longitudinally with respect to the edge of the traffic lane. If the 15-foot
minimum offset cannot be achieved, the temporary railing must be installed on the 10 to 1 skew to obtain
the maximum available offset between the approach end of the railing and the edge of the traffic lane,
and an array of temporary crash cushion modules must be installed at the approach end of the temporary
railing.
Secure Type K temporary railing in place before starting work for which the temporary railing is required.
Where 2 or more lanes in the same direction are adjacent to the area where the work is being performed,
including shoulders, the adjacent lane must be closed under any of the following conditions:
1. Work is off the traveled way but within 6 feet of the edge of the traveled way, and the approach speed
is greater than 45 miles per hour
2. Work is off the traveled way but within 3 feet of the edge of the traveled way, and the approach speed
is less than 45 miles per hour
Closure of the adjacent traffic lane is not required when performing any of the following:
1. Working behind a barrier
2. Paving, grinding, or grooving
3. Installing, maintaining, or removing traffic control devices except Type K temporary railing
Do not reduce an open traffic lane width to less than 10 feet. When traffic cones or delineators are used
for temporary edge delineation, the side of the base of the cones or delineators nearest to traffic is
considered the edge of the traveled way.
If a traffic lane is closed with channelizers for excavation work, move the devices to the adjacent edge of
the traveled way when not excavating. Space the devices as specified for the lane closure.
Do not move or temporarily suspend anything over a traffic lane open to the public unless the public is
protected.
7-1.04B WORK ZONE SAFETY AND MOBILITY
7-1.04B(1) POLICY
In order to ensure safe and efficient flow of traffic through work zones, the County of Fresno, via its
General Plan, Transportation and Circulation Element, Policy TRA-1, has adopted the use of AASHTO
Standards as supplemented by Caltrans and County Department of Public Works and Planning
Standards.
7-1.04B(2)TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT PLAN
Perform traffic management shall be in accordance with Section 12, "TEMPORARY TRAFFIC
CONTROL," of these special provisions.
7-1.04B(3)TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN
Prepare traffic control plan(s) in accordance with Section 12, "TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL," of
these special provisions.
7-1.04B(4)PUBLIC INFORMATION
Provide notice to public agencies and others to the extent required, if any, elsewhere in these special
provisions. The Engineer provides other noticing not identified to be performed by the Contractor.
Replace Section 7-1.06 with:
7-1.06 INSURANCE
7-1.06A General
Nothing in the Contract is intended to establish a standard of care owed to any member of the public or to
extend to the public the status of a third-party beneficiary for any of these insurance specifications.
7-1.0613 Casualty Insurance
Obtain and maintain insurance on all of your operations with companies acceptable to the Department as
follows:
1. Keep all insurance in full force and effect from the start of the work through Contract acceptance.
2. All insurance must be with an insurance company with a rating from A.M. Best Financial Strength
Rating of A or better and a Financial Size Category of VIII or better.
3. Maintain completed operations coverage with a carrier acceptable to the State through the expiration
of the patent deficiency in construction statute of repose set forth in Civ Pro Code § 337.1.
7-1.06C Workers' Compensation and Employer's Liability Insurance
Under Labor Code § 1860, secure the payment of worker's compensation under Labor Code § 3700.
Submit to the Department the following certification before performing the work(Labor Code § 1861):
1 am aware of the provisions of Section 3700 of the Labor Code which require every employer to be
insured against liability for workers' compensation or to undertake self-insurance in accordance with
the provisions of that code, and I will comply with such provisions before commencing the
performance of the work of this contract.
Contract signing constitutes certification submittal.
Provide Employer's Liability Insurance in amounts not less than:
1. $1,000,000 for each accident for bodily injury by accident
2. $1,000,000 policy limit for bodily injury by disease
3. $1,000,000 for each employee for bodily injury by disease
If there is an exposure of injury to your employees under the U.S. Longshoremen's and Harbor Workers'
Compensation Act, the Jones Act, or under laws, regulations, or statutes applicable to maritime
employees, coverage must be included for such injuries or claims.
7-1.06D Liability Insurance
7-1.06D(1) General
Carry General Liability and Umbrella or Excess Liability Insurance covering all operations by or on behalf
of you providing insurance for bodily injury liability and property damage liability for the following limits
and including coverage for:
1. Premises, operations and mobile equipment
2. Products and completed operations
3. Broad form property damage (including completed operations)
4. Explosion, collapse, and underground hazards
5. Personal injury
6. Contractual liability
7-1.061)(2) Liability Limits/Additional Insureds
Refer to the Agreement of these special provisions
Additional insured coverage must be provided by a policy provision or by an endorsement providing
coverage at least as broad as Additional Insured(Form B) endorsement form CG 2010, as published by
the Insurance Services Office (ISO), or other form designated by the Department.
7-1.061)(3) Contractor's Insurance Policy is Primary
The policy must stipulate that the insurance afforded the additional insureds applies as primary insurance.
Any other insurance or self-insurance maintained by the State is excess only and must not be called upon
to contribute with this insurance.
7-1.06E Automobile Liability Insurance
Comply with requirements in the Agreement of these special provisions
7-1.06F Policy Forms, Endorsements, and Certificates
Provide your General Liability Insurance under Commercial General Liability policy form no. CG0001 as
published by the Insurance Services Office (ISO)or under a policy form at least as broad as policy form
no. CG0001.
7-1.06G NOT USED
7-1.06H Enforcement
The Department may assure your compliance with your insurance obligations. Ten days before an
insurance policy lapses or is canceled during the Contract period you must submit to the Department
evidence of renewal or replacement of the policy.
If you fail to maintain any required insurance coverage, the Department may maintain this coverage and
withhold or charge the expense to you or terminate your control of the work.
You are not relieved of your duties and responsibilities to indemnify, defend, and hold harmless the State,
its officers, agents, and employees by the Department's acceptance of insurance policies and certificates.
Minimum insurance coverage amounts do not relieve you for liability in excess of such coverage, nor do
they preclude the State from taking other actions available to it, including the withholding of funds under
this Contract.
7-1.061 Self-Insurance
Comply with the Agreement of these special provisions
Replace Section 7-1.07 with:
7-1.07 LEGAL ACTIONS AGAINST THE DEPARTMENT
7-1.07A General
If legal action is brought against the Department over compliance with a State or federal law, rule, or
regulation applicable to highway work, then:
1. If the Department in complying with a court order prohibits you from performing work, the resulting
delay is a suspension related to your performance, unless the Department terminates the Contract.
2. If a court order other than an order to show cause or the final judgment in the action prohibits the
Department from requiring you to perform work, the Department may delete the prohibited work or
terminate the Contract.
7-1.07C Claims
This section applies to non-seal coat projects which involve asphalt concrete paving. Pay for claims for
personal property damage caused by your work. Claims are limited to:
1. 10 percent of the total bid
Within 30 days of the last working day placement of hot mix asphalt, do the following:
1. Process and resolve all claims reported or submitted to you by the public as follows:
1.1. Within 3 business days of receipt of a claim, submit to the Department a copy of the claim, a
written analysis of the claim, and a statement indicating whether or not you will pay the claim. If
you reject a claim, provide the reasons for rejection in writing.
1.2. If the claimant becomes dissatisfied with your handling of the claim, immediately refer the
claimant to the local district claims office for assistance in resolving the claim.
2. Submit to the Department evidence of your paid claims.
All claims presented to the Department, (Govt Code § 900 et seq.)are processed and resolved by the
Department as follows:
1. The claims are processed as formal government claims subject to all laws and policies and are
resolved as the Department determines including referring the claim to you for handling.
2. If the Department approves settlement of a claim or is ordered to pay pursuant to a court order, the
claim is paid from funds withheld from you.
3. Within 3 business days of the Department's determination that you are responsible for resolving the
claim, the Department sends a copy of the claim to you for resolution or notifies you of the
Department's decision to resolve the claim.
The Department withholds an amount not to exceed 5 percent of the total bid to resolve all claims. The
amount is held no longer than 60 days following the last working day so that the Department has ample
time to resolve any pending claims. After 60 days, any remaining amount withheld is returned to you.
If no withheld funds remain or have been returned, the Department may pay any claims and seek
reimbursement from you through an offset or any other legal means. Any reimbursement or offset to be
recovered from you, including all other paid claims, is limited to 10 percent of the total bid.
Section 7-1.07C does not limit your obligation to defend and indemnify the Department.
Add between the 1st and 2nd paragraphs of section 7-1.11A:
Comply with 46 CFR 381.7(a)—(b).
8 PROSECUTION AND PROGRESS
Replace Section 8 with:
8-1.01 GENERAL
Section 8 includes specifications related to prosecuting the Contract and work progress.
8-1.01A Work Hours
Perform all work on working days during daytime except drilling operations which may proceed 24 hours
per day.
You may request approval to work on a holiday or on a non-working day. If, pursuant to such request, the
Engineer authorizes you to work on a holiday or on a non-working day, you pay the actual cost incurred
by the Department to perform all inspection, surveying, testing, and all other project-related work by the
Department on such holiday or non-working day. Such payment will be deducted from monies due or
which may become due to the Contractor.
Plan work so that all construction operations performed each day, including cleanup of the project site,
establishment of appropriate traffic control and any other work necessary for the safety of the public shall
be completed within the daytime hours.
Do not perform work during nighttime unless approved by the Engineer
Request approval to work during nighttime in writing and include the appropriate traffic control plan(s) and
work plan(s)which clearly identify all provisions for illuminating all portions of the work site, including any
flagging operations.
If you fail to complete work during the daytime hours, the Engineer may stop all work upon the onset of
nighttime and order you to perform any and all work the Engineer deems necessary to ensure the safety
of the public during the nighttime hours.
You are not entitled to any additional compensation or extension of the contract time as a result of the
Engineer stopping the work due to the onset of nighttime.
8-1.02 SCHEDULE
8-1.02A General
Upon completion of all work, the Department returns the withholds associated with section 8-1.02 and
makes a payment adjustment for work not performed in the same manner as work-character changes.
8-1.0213 Level 1 Critical Path Method Schedule
8-1.0213(1) General
No pay item is provided for Level 1 Critical Path Project Schedule. Payment is considered to be included
in the various items of work.
Before or at the preconstruction conference, submit a CPM baseline schedule.
For each schedule, submit:
1. Plotted original, time-scaled network diagram on a sheet at least 8-1/2 by 11 inches with a title block
and timeline
2. A electronic copy in PDF (Adobe Acrobat compatible)format via email to the Engineer.
8-1.02B(2) Schedule Format
On each schedule, show:
1. Planned and actual start and completion dates of each work activity, including applicable:
1.1. Submittal development
1.2. Submittal review and acceptance
1.3. Material procurement
1.4. Contract milestones and constraints
1.5. Equipment and plant setup
1.6. Interfaces with outside entities
1.7. Erection and removal of falsework and shoring
1.8. Test periods
1.9. Major traffic stage change
1.10. Final cleanup
2. Order that you propose to prosecute the work
3. Logical links between the time-scaled work activities
4. All controlling activities
5. Legible description of each activity
6. At least 1 predecessor and 1 successor to each activity except for project start and project end
milestones
7. Duration of at least 1 working day for each activity
8. Start milestone date as the Contract approval date
8-1.02B(3) Updated Schedule
Submit a monthly updated schedule that includes the status of work completed to date and the work yet
to be performed as planned.
You may include changes to updated schedules that do not alter a critical path or extend the scheduled
completion date compared to the current schedule. Changes may include:
1. Adding or deleting activities
2. Changing activity constraints
3. Changing durations
4. Changing logic
If any proposed change in planned work would alter the critical path or extend the scheduled completion
date, submit a revised schedule within 15 days of the proposed change.
8-1.02C-8-1.02F Reserved
8-1.03 PRECONSTRUCTION CONFERENCE
Attend a preconstruction conference with key personnel, including your assigned representative, at a time
and location determined by the Engineer. Submit documents as required before the preconstruction
conference.
Be prepared to discuss the topics and documents shown in the following table:
Topic Document
Potential claim and dispute Potential claim forms
resolution
Contractor's representation Assignment of Contractor's representative
DBE Final utilization reports
Equipment E ui ment list
Labor compliance and equal Job site posters and benefit and payroll reports
employment opportunity
Material inspection Notice of Materials to be Used form
Materials on hand Request for Payment for Materials on Hand form
Measurements Partnering --
Quality control QC plans
Safety Injury and Illness Prevention Program and job site posters
Schedule Baseline schedule and Weekly Statement of Working Days form
Subcontracting Subcontracting Request form
Surveying Survey Request form
Traffic control Traffic contingency Ian and traffic control plans
Utility work Weight limitations --
Water pollution control SWPPP or WPCP
Work restrictions PLACs
Action submittals --
8-1.04 START OF JOB SITE ACTIVITIES
8-1.04A General
Provide signed contracts, bonds, and evidence of insurance timely as required.
This section, 8-1.04, "Start of Job Activities," does not modify remedies available to the Department
should you fail to provide signed contracts bonds and insurance timely.
Submit a notice 72 hours before starting job site activities. If the project has more than 1 location of work,
submit a separate notice for each location.
You may start job site activities before receiving notice of Contract approval if you:
1. Deliver the signed Contract, bonds, and evidence of insurance to the Department
2. Submit 72-hour notice
3. Are authorized by the Department to start
4. Perform work at your own risk
5. Perform work under the Contract
If the Contract is approved, work already performed that complies with the Contract is authorized.
If the Contract is not approved, leave the job site in a neat condition. If a facility has been changed,
restore it to its former condition or an equivalent condition. The Department does not pay for the
restoration.
8-1.04B Standard Start
Be prepared to begin work at the project site no later than the 20th business day after award of the
Contract by the Department.
The Engineer may issue a notice to proceed as soon as the Contracts, including bonds and insurance
certificates, have been approved.
Start work on the day shown in the notice to proceed, unless an early start has been approved.
The Engineer may issue a notice of commencement of contract time if you fail to provide Contracts,
including bonds and insurance certificates or other required documents timely.
A notice of commencement of contract time does not authorize you to start work on the project site, but
contract time begins to elapse on the date shown in the notice of commencement of contract time.
Complete work before the expiration of
ONE HUNDRED (100)WORKING DAYS
from the date shown in said Notice to Proceed, or in the Notice of Commencement of Contract Time,
whichever comes first.
Complete all work, including corrective work and punch list work, prior to the expiration of the allotted
working days. Working days continue to accrue until corrective work and punch list work is completed
and accepted.
Pay to the County of Fresno the sum of
THREE THOUSAND TWO HUNDRED DOLLARS ($3,200)
per day for each and every calendar day's delay in finishing the work, including corrective work and punch
list work, in excess of the total number of working days prescribed above.
Replace Section 8-1.04C with:
8-1.04C Long Lead Time Equipment Start
Section 8-1.04B, Standard Start, does not apply to this project
This project includes two, non-concurrent phases.
The first order of work (submittals) involves potholing, submittals and equipment procurement.
The second order of work involves physical construction upon the project site.
8-1.04C(1) First Order of Work, Submittals
Be prepared to begin the first order of work no later than the 20th business day after award of the
Contract by the Department.
The Engineer may issue a notice to proceed with the first order of work as soon as the Contracts,
including bonds and insurance certificates, have been approved.
Start the first order of work on the day shown in the notice to proceed, unless an early start has been
approved.
Potholing at the project site shall be completed within the first ten working days of the first order of work.
No submittals will receive final approval until field verification of the final pole location has been approved
by the Engineer. Compensation for potholing shall be considered to be included in the various items of
work.
The Engineer may issue a notice of commencement of contract time for the first order of work if you fail to
provide Contracts, including bonds and insurance certificates or other required documents timely.
The Engineer shall have a maximum of ten (10)working days in which to review and approve or reject
each submittal from the Contractor. In the event that the Engineer rejects any of the Contractor's initial
submittals, the Engineer shall have a maximum of ten (10)working days in which to review and approve
or reject each re-submittal from the Contractor. The ten (10)working day time period for the Engineer's
review shall commence on the day upon which the Engineer receives the submittal or re-submittal in
question.
In the event that the Engineer's review of a submittal or re-submittal requires in excess of ten (10)
working days, the Engineer shall extend the number of working days allowed for the completion of the
first order of work by one working day for each working day of delay in the Engineer's completion of the
review.
The first order of work is complete when you:
• have completed potholing at the project site
• have received approval for all submittals required for the project.
• have furnished a statement from the vendors that the orders for required equipment and
materials has been received and accepted by said vendor
• have furnished a statement from vendors which indicates that the anticipated delivery date for the
equipment and materials ordered is in conformance with contract requirements.
• Receive a written statement that the first order of work is complete.
Complete the first order of work before the expiration of
THIRTY(30)WORKING DAYS
from the date shown in said Notice to Proceed, or in the Notice of Commencement of Contract Time,
whichever was issued first.
8-1.04C(2) Second Order of Work
The Engineer, in their sole discretion, may issue the Notice to Proceed —Second Order of Work
immediately upon delivery to the Contractor of the materials and equipment necessary to construct the
project. Alternatively, the Engineer may defer issuance of the Notice to Proceed —Second Order of Work
to the extent the Engineer, in their sole discretion, deems appropriate.
Begin work at the site on the date shown on the Notice to Proceed—Second Order of Work. Do not
begin site work prior to the date shown on the Notice to Proceed —Second Order of Work. The date
shown on the Notice to Proceed —Second Order of Work will be the first working day charged against the
allotted number of working days for the second order of work.
Complete the second order of work before the expiration of
SEVENTY (70)WORKING DAYS
from the date shown in said Notice to Proceed—Second Order of Work.
Complete all work, including corrective work and punch list work, prior to the expiration of the allotted
working days. Working days continue to accrue until corrective work and punch list work is completed
and accepted.
8-1.05 TIME
Contract time starts on the day specified in the notice to proceed or in the notice of commencement of
contract time as described in section 8-1.04 or on the day you start job site activities, whichever occurs
first.
Complete the work within the Contract time.
Meet each specified interim work completion date.
The Engineer issues a Weekly Statement of Working Days by the end of the following week.
The Weekly Statement of Working Days shows:
1. Working days and non—working days during the reporting week
2. Time adjustments
3. Work completion date computations, including working days remaining
4. Controlling activities
8-1.06 SUSPENSIONS
The Engineer may suspend work wholly or in part due to conditions unsuitable for work progress. Provide
for public safety and a smooth and unobstructed passageway through the work zone during the
suspension as specified in sections 7-1.03 and 7-1.04. Providing the passageway is force account work.
The Department makes a time adjustment for the suspension due to a critical delay.
The Engineer may suspend work wholly or in part due to your failure to (1)fulfill the Engineer's orders, (2)
fulfill a Contract part, or(3) perform weather-dependent work when conditions are favorable so that
weather-related unsuitable conditions are avoided or do not occur. The Department may provide for a
smooth and unobstructed passageway through the work during the suspension and deduct the cost from
payments. The Department does not make a time adjustment for the suspension.
Upon the Engineer's order of suspension, suspend work immediately. Resume work when ordered.
8-1.07 DELAYS
8-1.07A General
To request a delay-related time or payment adjustment, submit an RFI.
8-1.07B Time Adjustments
The Department may make a time adjustment for a critical delay. The Engineer uses information from the
schedule to evaluate requests for time adjustments.
To request an adjustment, submit a revised schedule showing the delay's effect on the controlling activity.
If the delay has:
1. Occurred, submit records of the dates and what work was performed during the delayed activity
2. Not occurred, submit the expected dates or duration of the delayed activity
Update the schedule to the last working day before the start of the delay if ordered.
8-1.07C Payment Adjustments
The Department may make a payment adjustment for an excusable delay that affects your costs.
Only losses for idle equipment, idle workers, and moving or transporting equipment are eligible for delay-
related payment adjustments.
The Engineer determines payment for idle time of equipment in the same manner as determinations are
made for equipment used in the performance of force account work under section 9-1.04 with the
following exceptions:
1. Delay factor in the Labor Surcharge and Equipment Rental Rates applies to each equipment rental
rate.
2. Daily number of payable hours equals the normal working hours during the delay, not to exceed 8
hours per day.
3. Delay days exclude non—working days.
4. Markups are not added.
The Engineer determines payment adjustment for the idle workers under section 9-1.04B, but does not
add markups.
The Engineer includes costs due to necessary extra moving or transporting of equipment.
The Department does not make a payment adjustment for overhead incurred during non—working days of
additional construction seasons experienced because of delay.
8-1.08-8-1.09 RESERVED
8-1.10 LIQUIDATED DAMAGES
8-1.10A General
The Department specifies liquidated damages (Pub Cont Code § 10226). Liquidated damages, if any,
accrue starting on the 1 st day after the expiration of the working days through the day of Contract
acceptance except as specified in sections 8-1.10B and 8-1.10C.
The Department withholds liquidated damages before the accrual date if the anticipated liquidated
damages may exceed the value of the remaining work.
Liquidated damages are specified in section 8-1.04.
8-1.10B Failure to Complete Work Parts within Specified Times
The Department may deduct specified damages from payments for each day needed to complete a work
part in excess of the time specified for completing the work part.
Damages for untimely completion of work parts may not be equal to the daily amount specified as
liquidated damages for the project as a whole, but the Department does not simultaneously assess
damages for untimely completion of work parts and for the whole work.
Damages accrue starting the 1st day after a work part exceeds the specified time through the day the
specified work part is complete.
8-1.10C Failure to Complete Work Parts by Specified Dates
The Department may deduct specified damages from payments for each day needed to complete a work
part in excess of the specified completion date for the work part.
Damages for untimely completion of a work part may not be equal to the daily amount specified as
liquidated damages for the project as a whole, but the Department does not simultaneously assess
damages for untimely completion of a work part and the whole work.
Damages accrue starting the 1 st day after an unmet completion date through the day the work part is
complete.
8-1.10D RESERVED
8-1.11-8-1.12 RESERVED
8-1.13 CONTRACTOR'S CONTROL TERMINATION
The Department may terminate your control of the work for failure to do any of the following (Pub Cont
Code § 10253):
1. Supply an adequate workforce
2. Supply material as described
3. Pay subcontractors (Pub Cont Code §10262)
4. Prosecute the work as described in the Contract
The Department may also terminate your control for failure to maintain insurance coverage.
For a federal-aid project, the Department may terminate your control of the work for failure to include
"Required Contract Provisions, Federal-Aid Construction Contracts" in subcontracts.
The Department gives notice to you and your surety at least 5 business days before terminating control.
The notice describes the failures and the time allowed to remedy the failures. If failures are not remedied
within the time provided, the Department takes control of the work.
The Department may complete the work if the Department terminates the Contractor's control or you
abandon the project(Pub Cont Code § 10255). The Department determines the unpaid balance under
Pub Cont Code § 10258 and the Contract.
At any time before final payment of all claims, the Department may convert a Contractor's control
termination to a Contract termination.
8-1.14 CONTRACT TERMINATION
8-1.14A General
The Director may terminate the Contract if it serves the State's best interest. The Department issues you
a written notice, implements the termination, and pays you.
8-1.14B Relief from Responsibility for Work
Upon receiving a termination notice:
1. Stop work
2. Notify subcontractors and suppliers of the Contract termination and stop Contract-related work
3. Perform the Engineer-ordered work to secure the job site for termination
4. Remove equipment
5. Subject to the Engineer's authorization, settle termination-related claims and liabilities involving
subcontractors and suppliers; assign to the Department the rights, titles, or interests held by you with
respect to these parties
8-1.14C Responsibility for Materials
Upon receiving a termination notice, protect unused material until.-
1. You submit an inventory of materials already produced, purchased, or ordered but not yet used;
include the location of the material.
2. The Engineer identifies materials that will be retained by the Department. Submit bills of sales or
other records of material title.
3. The Engineer confirms that unused materials paid by progress payment and materials furnished by
the State have been delivered and stored as ordered.
4. The titles are transferred for materials purchased by the Department.
Dispose of materials that will not be retained by the Department.
8-1.14D Contract Acceptance after Termination
The Engineer recommends Contract acceptance after determining the completion of:
1. Work ordered to be completed before termination
2. Other work ordered to secure the project before termination
3. Material delivery and title transfer
The Department pays you under section 9-1.17.
8-1.14E Payment Adjustment for Termination
If the Department issues a termination notice, the Engineer determines the payment for termination based
on the following:
1. Direct cost for the work:
1.1. Including:
1.1.1. Mobilization.
1.1.2. Demobilization.
1.1.3. Securing the job site for termination.
1.1.4. Losses from the sale of materials.
1.2. Not including:
1.2.1. Cost of materials you keep.
1.2.2. Profit realized from the sale of materials.
1.2.3. Cost of material damaged by:
1.2.3.1. Act of God.
1.2.3.2. Act of a public enemy.
1.2.3.3. Fire.
1.2.3.4. Flood.
1.2.3.5. Governor-declared state of emergency.
1.2.3.6. Landslide.
1.2.3.7. Tsunami.
1.2.4. Other credits.
2. Cost of remedial work, as estimated by the Engineer, is not reimbursed.
3. Allowance for profit not to exceed 4 percent of the cost of the work. Prove a likelihood of having made
a profit had the Contract not been terminated.
4. Material handling costs for material returned to the vendor or disposed of as ordered.
5. Costs in determining the payment adjustment due to the termination, excluding attorney fees and
litigation costs.
Termination of the Contract does not relieve the surety of its obligation for any just claims arising out of
the work performed.
8-1.15-8-1.16 RESERVED
9 PAYMENT
Add Section 9-1.01A:
9-1.01A COMPENSATION
The bid items shown in the bid item list represent full compensation for performing all work. Full
compensation for any work for which there is no bid item shall be considered to be included in the various
items of work.
Replace Section 9-1.03 with:
9-1.03 PAYMENT SCOPE
The Department pays you for furnishing the resources and activities required to complete the work. The
Department's payment is full compensation for furnishing the resources and activities, including:
1. Risk, loss, damage repair, or cost of whatever character arising from or relating to the work and
performance of the work
2. PLACs and taxes
3. Any royalties and costs arising from patents, trademarks, and copyrights involved in the work
The Department does not pay for your loss, damage, repair, or extra costs of whatever character arising
from or relating to the work that is a direct or indirect result of your choice of construction methods,
materials, equipment, or manpower, unless specifically mandated by the Contract.
Payment is:
1. Full compensation for all work involved in each bid item shown on the Bid Item List by the unit of
measure shown for that bid item
2. For the price bid for each bid item shown on the Bid Item List or as changed by change order with a
specified price adjustment
Full compensation for work specified in divisions I, II, and X is included in the payment for the bid items
unless:
1. Bid item for the work is shown on the Bid Item List
2. Work is specified as change order work
Work paid for under one bid item is not paid for under any other bid item.
Payment for a bid item includes payment for work in sections referenced by the section set forth by that
bid item.
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in these special provisions, full compensation for
performing all work as shown, as specified, and as directed by the Engineer is considered to be
included in the various bid items, and no additional payment will be made, except pursuant to a
contract change order to perform work not shown and/or specified.
If one or more bid item(s) is/are not included, perform the work as shown and as specified and
payment therefor is considered to be included in the various items of work.
If an alternative is described in the Contract, the Department pays based on the bid items for the details
and specifications not described as an alternative unless the bid item is described as an alternative, in
which case, the Department pays based on the details and specifications for that alternative.
The Department pays for change order work based on one or a combination of the following:
1. Bid item prices
2. Force account
3. Agreed price
4. Specialist billing
If the Engineer chooses to pay for change order work based on an agreed price, but you and the
Engineer cannot agree on the price, the Department pays by force account.
If a portion of extra work is covered by bid items, the Department pays for this work as changed quantities
in those items. The Department pays for the remaining portion of the extra work by force account or
agreed price.
If the amount of a deduction or withhold exceeds final payment, the Department invoices you for the
difference, to be paid upon receipt.
Pay your subcontractors within 10 days of receipt of each progress payment under Pub Cont Code §§
10262 and 10262.5.
Replace Section 9-1.07 with:
9-1.07 PAYMENT ADJUSTMENTS FOR PRICE INDEX FLUCTUATIONS DOES NOT APPLY TO THIS
PROJECT
Replace Section 9-1.16F with:
9-1.16F Retentions
The Department, once in each month, shall cause an estimate in writing to be made by the Engineer.
The estimate shall include the total amount of work done and acceptable materials furnished, provided
the acceptable materials are listed as eligible for partial payment as materials in the special provisions
and are furnished and delivered by the Contractor on the ground and not used or are furnished and
stored for use on the contract, if the storage is within the State of California and the Contractor furnishes
evidence satisfactory to the Engineer that the materials are stored subject to or under the control of the
Department, to the time of the estimate, and the value thereof. The estimate shall also include any
amounts payable for mobilization. Daily extra work reports furnished by the Contractor less than 5
calendar days, not including Saturdays, Sundays and legal holidays, before the preparation of the
monthly progress estimate shall not be eligible for payment until the following month's estimate.
The amount of any material to be considered in making an estimate will in no case exceed the amount
thereof which has been reported by the Contractor to the Engineer on State-furnished forms properly
filled out and executed, including accompanying documentation as therein required, less the amount of
the material incorporated in the work to the time of the estimate. Only materials to be incorporated in the
work will be considered. The estimated value of the material established by the Engineer will in no case
exceed the contract price for the item of work for which the material is furnished.
The Department shall retain 5 percent of the estimated value of the work done and 5 percent of the value
of materials so estimated to have been furnished and delivered and unused or furnished and stored as
aforesaid as part security for the fulfillment of the contract by the Contractor. The Department will not
hold retention for mobilization or demobilization.
The Department shall pay monthly to the Contractor, while carrying on the work, the balance not retained,
as aforesaid, after deducting therefrom all previous payments and all sums to be kept or retained under
the provisions of the contract. No monthly estimate or payment shall be required to be made when, in the
judgment of the Engineer, the work is not proceeding in accordance with the provisions of the contract.
No monthly estimate or payment shall be construed to be an acceptance of any defective work or
improper materials.
Attention is directed to the prohibitions and penalties pertaining to unlicensed contractors as provided in
Business and Professions Code Sections 7028.15(a) and 7031.
Add Section 9-1.23:
9-1.23 RESOLUTION OF CONTRACT CLAIMS
Public works contract claims of three hundred seventy-five thousand dollars ($375,000)or less which arise
between a Contractor and a local public agency shall be resolved in accordance with the provisions of
California Public Contract Code Sections 20104-20104.6, inclusive. In addition, California Public Contract
Code Section 9204 requires that the procedure established therein shall apply to all claims (as therein
defined)filed by a contractor in connection with a public works project. Accordingly, this contract expressly
incorporates all of the terms and conditions of those statutory provisions, which are as follows:
California Public Contract Code Section 9204
(a) The Legislature finds and declares that it is in the best interests of the state and its citizens to ensure
that all construction business performed on a public works project in the state that is complete and not in
dispute is paid in full and in a timely manner.
(b) Notwithstanding any other law, including, but not limited to, Article 7.1 (commencing with Section
10240) of Chapter 1 of Part 2, Chapter 10 (commencing with Section 19100)of Part 2, and Article 1.5
(commencing with Section 20104) of Chapter 1 of Part 3, this section shall apply to any claim by a
contractor in connection with a public works project.
(c) For purposes of this section:
(1) "Claim" means a separate demand by a contractor sent by registered mail or certified mail
with return receipt requested, for one or more of the following:
(A)A time extension, including, without limitation, for relief from damages or penalties for
delay assessed by a public entity under a contract for a public works project.
(B) Payment by the public entity of money or damages arising from work done by, or on
behalf of, the contractor pursuant to the contract for a public works project and payment
for which is not otherwise expressly provided or to which the claimant is not otherwise
entitled.
(C) Payment of an amount that is disputed by the public entity.
(2) "Contractor" means any type of contractor within the meaning of Chapter 9 (commencing with
Section 7000)of Division 3 of the Business and Professions Code who has entered into a direct
contract with a public entity for a public works project.
(3)(A) "Public entity" means, without limitation, except as provided in subparagraph (B), a state
agency, department, office, division, bureau, board, or commission, the California State
University, the University of California, a city, including a charter city, county, including a charter
county, city and county, including a charter city and county, district, special district, public
authority, political subdivision, public corporation, or nonprofit transit corporation wholly owned
by a public agency and formed to carry out the purposes of the public agency.
(B) "Public entity" shall not include the following:
(i)The Department of Water Resources as to any project under the jurisdiction of
that department.
(ii)The Department of Transportation as to any project under the jurisdiction of
that department.
(iii) The Department of Parks and Recreation as to any project under the
jurisdiction of that department.
(iv) The Department of Corrections and Rehabilitation with respect to any
project under its jurisdiction pursuant to Chapter 11 (commencing with Section
7000) of Title 7 of Part 3 of the Penal Code.
(v) The Military Department as to any project under the jurisdiction of that
department.
(vi) The Department of General Services as to all other projects.
(vii) The High-Speed Rail Authority.
(4) "Public works project' means the erection, construction, alteration, repair, or improvement of
any public structure, building, road, or other public improvement of any kind.
(5) "Subcontractor" means any type of contractor within the meaning of Chapter 9 (commencing
with Section 7000) of Division 3 of the Business and Professions Code who either is in direct
contract with a contractor or is a lower tier subcontractor.
(d) (1) (A) Upon receipt of a claim pursuant to this section, the public entity to which the claim applies
shall conduct a reasonable review of the claim and, within a period not to exceed 45 days, shall provide
the claimant a written statement identifying what portion of the claim is disputed and what portion is
undisputed. Upon receipt of a claim, a public entity and a contractor may, by mutual agreement, extend
the time period provided in this subdivision.
(B)The claimant shall furnish reasonable documentation to support the claim.
(C) If the public entity needs approval from its governing body to provide the claimant a
written statement identifying the disputed portion and the undisputed portion of the claim,
and the governing body does not meet within the 45 days or within the mutually agreed to
extension of time following receipt of a claim sent by registered mail or certified mail,
return receipt requested, the public entity shall have up to three days following the next
duly publicly noticed meeting of the governing body after the 45-day period, or extension,
expires to provide the claimant a written statement identifying the disputed portion and
the undisputed portion.
(D)Any payment due on an undisputed portion of the claim shall be processed and made
within 60 days after the public entity issues its written statement. If the public entity fails to
issue a written statement, paragraph (3)shall apply.
(2) (A) If the claimant disputes the public entity's written response, or if the public entity fails to
respond to a claim issued pursuant to this section within the time prescribed, the claimant may
demand in writing an informal conference to meet and confer for settlement of the issues in
dispute. Upon receipt of a demand in writing sent by registered mail or certified mail, return receipt
requested, the public entity shall schedule a meet and confer conference within 30 days for
settlement of the dispute.
(B)Within 10 business days following the conclusion of the meet and confer conference, if
the claim or any portion of the claim remains in dispute, the public entity shall provide the
claimant a written statement identifying the portion of the claim that remains in dispute
and the portion that is undisputed. Any payment due on an undisputed portion of the claim
shall be processed and made within 60 days after the public entity issues its written
statement. Any disputed portion of the claim, as identified by the contractor in writing,
shall be submitted to nonbinding mediation, with the public entity and the claimant sharing
the associated costs equally. The public entity and claimant shall mutually agree to a
mediator within 10 business days after the disputed portion of the claim has been
identified in writing. If the parties cannot agree upon a mediator, each party shall select a
mediator and those mediators shall select a qualified neutral third party to mediate with
regard to the disputed portion of the claim. Each party shall bear the fees and costs
charged by its respective mediator in connection with the selection of the neutral
mediator. If mediation is unsuccessful, the parts of the claim remaining in dispute shall be
subject to applicable procedures outside this section.
(C) For purposes of this section, mediation includes any nonbinding process, including,
but not limited to, neutral evaluation or a dispute review board, in which an independent
third party or board assists the parties in dispute resolution through negotiation or by
issuance of an evaluation. Any mediation utilized shall conform to the timeframes in this
section.
(D) Unless otherwise agreed to by the public entity and the contractor in writing, the
mediation conducted pursuant to this section shall excuse any further obligation under
Section 20104.4 to mediate after litigation has been commenced.
(E)This section does not preclude a public entity from requiring arbitration of disputes
under private arbitration or the Public Works Contract Arbitration Program, if mediation
under this section does not resolve the parties' dispute.
(3) Failure by the public entity to respond to a claim from a contractor within the time periods
described in this subdivision or to otherwise meet the time requirements of this section shall result
in the claim being deemed rejected in its entirety. A claim that is denied by reason of the public
entity's failure to have responded to a claim, or its failure to otherwise meet the time requirements
of this section, shall not constitute an adverse finding with regard to the merits of the claim or the
responsibility or qualifications of the claimant.
(4)Amounts not paid in a timely manner as required by this section shall bear interest at 7 percent
per annum.
(5) If a subcontractor or a lower tier subcontractor lacks legal standing to assert a claim against a
public entity because privity of contract does not exist, the contractor may present to the public
entity a claim on behalf of a subcontractor or lower tier subcontractor. A subcontractor may
request in writing, either on his or her own behalf or on behalf of a lower tier subcontractor, that
the contractor present a claim for work which was performed by the subcontractor or by a lower
tier subcontractor on behalf of the subcontractor. The subcontractor requesting that the claim be
presented to the public entity shall furnish reasonable documentation to support the claim. Within
45 days of receipt of this written request, the contractor shall notify the subcontractor in writing as
to whether the contractor presented the claim to the public entity and, if the original contractor did
not present the claim, provide the subcontractor with a statement of the reasons for not having
done so.
(e) The text of this section or a summary of it shall be set forth in the plans or specifications for any
public works project that may give rise to a claim under this section.
(f) A waiver of the rights granted by this section is void and contrary to public policy, provided, however,
that(1) upon receipt of a claim, the parties may mutually agree to waive, in writing, mediation and proceed
directly to the commencement of a civil action or binding arbitration, as applicable; and (2) a public entity
may prescribe reasonable change order, claim, and dispute resolution procedures and requirements in
addition to the provisions of this section, so long as the contractual provisions do not conflict with or
otherwise impair the timeframes and procedures set forth in this section.
(g) This section applies to contracts entered into on or after January 1, 2017.
(h) Nothing in this section shall impose liability upon a public entity that makes loans or grants available
through a competitive application process, for the failure of an awardee to meet its contractual obligations.
(i) This section shall remain in effect only until January 1, 2027, and as of that date is repealed, unless a
later enacted statute, that is enacted before January 1, 2027, deletes or extends that date.
California Public Contract Code Sections 20104—20104.6
Section 20104
(a)(1) This article applies to all public works claims of three hundred seventy-five thousand
dollars ($375,000)or less which arise between a contractor and a local agency.
(2) This article shall not apply to any claims resulting from a contract between a contractor and a
public agency when the public agency has elected to resolve any disputes pursuant to Article 7.1
(commencing with Section 10240)of Chapter 1 of Part 2.
(b)(1) "Public work" means "public works contract"as defined in Section 1101 but does not include
any work or improvement contracted for by the state or the Regents of the University of California.
(2) "Claim" means a separate demand by the contractor for(A)a time extension, (B) payment of
money or damages arising from work done by, or on behalf of, the contractor pursuant to the
contract for a public work and payment of which is not otherwise expressly provided for or the
claimant is not otherwise entitled to, or(C)an amount the payment of which is disputed by the
local agency.
(c) The provisions of this article or a summary thereof shall be set forth in the plans or specifications for
any work which may give rise to a claim under this article.
(d) This article applies only to contracts entered into on or after January 1, 1991.
Section 20104.2
For any claim subject to this article, the following requirements apply:
(a) The claim shall be in writing and include the documents necessary to substantiate the claim. Claims
must be filed on or before the date of final payment. Nothing in this subdivision is intended to extend the
time limit or supersede notice requirements otherwise provided by contract for the filing of claims.
(b) (1) For claims of less than fifty thousand dollars ($50,000), the local agency shall respond in writing to
any written claim within 45 days of receipt of the claim, or may request, in writing, within 30 days of receipt
of the claim, any additional documentation supporting the claim or relating to defenses to the claim the
local agency may have against the claimant.
(2) If additional information is thereafter required, it shall be requested and provided pursuant to
this subdivision, upon mutual agreement of the local agency and the claimant.
(3) The local agency's written response to the claim, as further documented, shall be submitted to
the claimant within 15 days after receipt of the further documentation or within a period of time no
greater than that taken by the claimant in producing the additional information, whichever is
greater.
(c) (1) For claims of over fifty thousand dollars ($50,000)and less than or equal to three hundred
seventy-five thousand dollars ($375,000), the local agency shall respond in writing to all written claims
within 60 days of receipt of the claim, or may request, in writing, within 30 days of receipt of the claim, any
additional documentation supporting the claim or relating to defenses to the claim the local agency may
have against the claimant.
(2) If additional information is thereafter required, it shall be requested and provided pursuant to
this subdivision, upon mutual agreement of the local agency and the claimant.
(3) The local agency's written response to the claim, as further documented, shall be submitted to
the claimant within 30 days after receipt of the further documentation, or within a period of time no
greater than that taken by the claimant in producing the additional information or requested
documentation, whichever is greater.
(d) If the claimant disputes the local agency's written response, or the local agency fails to respond within
the time prescribed, the claimant may so notify the local agency, in writing, either within 15 days of receipt
of the local agency's response or within 15 days of the local agency's failure to respond within the time
prescribed, respectively, and demand an informal conference to meet and confer for settlement of the
issues in dispute. Upon a demand, the local agency shall schedule a meet and confer conference within
30 days for settlement of the dispute.
(e) Following the meet and confer conference, if the claim or any portion remains in dispute, the claimant
may file a claim as provided in Chapter 1 (commencing with Section 900)and Chapter 2 (commencing
with Section 910) of Part 3 of Division 3.6 of Title 1 of the Government Code. For purposes of those
provisions, the running of the period of time within which a claim must be filed shall be tolled from the time
the claimant submits his or her written claim pursuant to subdivision (a) until the time that claim is denied
as a result of the meet and confer process, including any period of time utilized by the meet and confer
process.
(f) This article does not apply to tort claims and nothing in this article is intended nor shall be construed
to change the time periods for filing tort claims or actions specified by Chapter 1 (commencing with
Section 900) and Chapter 2 (commencing with Section 910) of Part 3 of Division 3.6 of Title 1 of the
Government Code.
Section 20104.4
The following procedures are established for all civil actions filed to resolve claims subject to this article:
(a) Within 60 days, but no earlier than 30 days, following the filing or responsive pleadings, the court shall
submit the matter to nonbinding mediation unless waived by mutual stipulation of both parties. The
mediation process shall provide for the selection within 15 days by both parties of a disinterested third
person as mediator, shall be commenced within 30 days of the submittal, and shall be concluded within
15 days from the commencement of the mediation unless a time requirement is extended upon a good
cause showing to the court or by stipulation of both parties. If the parties fail to select a mediator within the
15-day period, any party may petition the court to appoint the mediator.
(b) (1) If the matter remains in dispute, the case shall be submitted to judicial arbitration pursuant to
Chapter 2.5 (commencing with Section 1141.10) of Title 3 of Part 3 of the Code of Civil Procedure,
notwithstanding Section 1141.11 of that code. The Civil Discovery Act (Title 4 (commencing with Section
2016.010) of Part 4 of the Code of Civil Procedure)shall apply to any proceeding brought under this
subdivision consistent with the rules pertaining to judicial arbitration.
(2) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, upon stipulation of the parties, arbitrators
appointed for purposes of this article shall be experienced in construction law, and, upon
stipulation of the parties, mediators and arbitrators shall be paid necessary and reasonable hourly
rates of pay not to exceed their customary rate, and such fees and expenses shall be paid equally
by the parties, except in the case of arbitration where the arbitrator, for good cause, determines a
different division. In no event shall these fees or expenses be paid by state or county funds.
(3) In addition to Chapter 2.5 (commencing with Section 1141.10)of Title 3 of Part 3 of the Code
of Civil Procedure, any party who after receiving an arbitration award requests a trial de novo but
does not obtain a more favorable judgment shall, in addition to payment of costs and fees under
that chapter, pay the attorney's fees of the other party arising out of the trial de novo.
(c) The court may, upon request by any party, order any witnesses to participate in the mediation or
arbitration process.
Section 20104.6
(a) No local agency shall fail to pay money as to any portion of a claim which is undisputed except as
otherwise provided in the contract.
(b) In any suit filed under Section 20104.4, the local agency shall pay interest at the legal rate on any
arbitration award or judgment. The interest shall begin to accrue on the date the suit is filed in a court of
law.
Add Section 9-1.25:
9-1.25 SUPPLEMENTAL WORK
The Supplemental Work bid item is provided to compensate the Contractor for new and unforeseen work
necessary to construct the project as designed and intended. Supplemental Work is not for design
changes. Supplemental Work will be classed as extra work in accordance with the provisions of Section
4-1.05, "Changes and Extra Work," of the Standard Specifications. The dollar amount for supplemental
work shown in the Proposal is an estimate only, and shall be included in each bidder's proposal.
Supplemental work shall be performed only upon direct written authorization from the Engineer and daily
extra work reports shall be submitted to and approved by the Engineer. The contractor shall maintain
separate records for extra work performed in accordance with the provisions of Section 5-1.27," Records,"
of the Standard Specifications and these special provisions.
Payment will be based on the total amount of authorized Supplemental Work actually performed. The
provisions in Section 9-1.06, "Changed Quantity Pay Adjustments"of the Standard Specifications shall
not apply to the item "Supplemental Work."
DIVISION II GENERAL CONSTRUCTION
10 GENERAL
Add to the end of Section 10-1.02C(2):
Protect any irrigation component to be relocated before performing any other construction activity in the
area.
Replace Reserved in Section 10-1.02C(3)with:
Transplant any plant to be transplanted before performing any other construction activity in the area.
12 TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL
Replace section 12-1.04 with:
12-1.04 FLAGGING COSTS
You pay the cost of furnishing all flaggers, including transporting flaggers and furnishing stands and
towers for flaggers to provide for the passage of traffic through the work as specified in sections 7-1.03
and 7-1.04.
Replace Section 12-3.01 C with:
12-3.01 C Construction
If channelizing devices are used on the project, perform all layout work necessary to place channelizing
devices:
1. On the proper alignment
2. Uniformly at the location and spacing described
3. Straight on a tangent alignment
4. On a true arc in a curved alignment
If temporary traffic control devices are damaged, displaced, or stop operating or functioning as described
from any cause during the progress of the work, immediately repair, repaint, or replace the components
and restore them to their original locations and positions.
If ordered, furnish and place additional temporary traffic control devices. This work is not change order
work if:
1. Required to conform with your traffic control plan
2. Required to conform with the MUTCD
3. Necessary for public safety or convenience as determined by the Engineer
4. Required to perform staged construction shown on the plans
Replace Section 12-3.03C with:
12-3.03C Construction
If plastic traffic drums are used on project, use 1 type of plastic traffic drum on the project.
Use the same type and brand of retroreflective sheeting for all plastic traffic drums used on the project.
Do not use sandbags or comparable ballast.
Moving plastic traffic drums from location to location if ordered after initial placement is not change order
work if:
1. Required to conform with your traffic control plan
2. Required to conform with the MUTCD
3. Necessary for public safety or convenience as determined by the Engineer
4. Required to perform staged construction shown on the plans
Replace Section 12-3.10C with:
12-3.10C Construction
If barricades are used on the project, place each barricade such that the stripes slope downward in the
direction road users are to pass.
Place each sand-filled bag near the ground level on the lower parts of the frame or stays to serve as
ballast for the barricades. Do not place ballast on top of barricades or over any retroreflective barricade
rail face that is facing traffic.
Do not remove barricades that are shown to be left in place at the time of work completion.
Moving a barricade from location to location is change order work if ordered after initial placement of the
barricade unless.
1. Required to conform with your traffic control plan
2. Required to conform with the MUTCD
3. Necessary for public safety or convenience as determined by the Engineer
4. Required to perform staged construction shown on the plans
Replace Section 12-3.20C(1)with:
12-3.20C1 General
If Type K temporary rail is used on the project, before placing Type K temporary railing on the job site,
paint the exposed surfaces of the railing with white paint complying with the specifications for acrylic
emulsion paint for exterior masonry.
Place Type K temporary railing on a firm, stable foundation. Grade the foundation to provide a uniform
bearing surface throughout the entire length of the railing.
Structure excavation and backfill must comply with section 19-3 except compaction of earth fill placed
behind Type K temporary railing in a curved layout is not required.
Place and maintain the abutting ends of PC concrete units in alignment without substantial offset from
each other.
The drilling of holes and bonding of threaded rods or dowels must comply with the specifications for
drilling and bonding dowels in section 51-1.
Install a reflector on the top or face of the rail of each rail unit placed within 10 feet of a traffic lane. Apply
adhesive for mounting the reflector under the reflector manufacturer's instructions.
Install a Type P marker panel at each end of railing placed adjacent to a 2-lane, two-way highway and at
the end facing traffic for railing installed adjacent to a one-way roadbed. If the railing is placed on a skew,
install the marker at the end of the skew nearest the traveled way. Type P marker panels must comply
with section 82 except you must furnish the marker panels.
After removing Type K temporary railing:
1. Restore the area to its previous condition or construct it to its planned condition if temporary
excavation or embankment was used to accommodate the railing.
2. Remove all threaded rods or dowels to a depth of at least 1 inch below the surface of the concrete.
Fill the resulting holes with mortar under section 51-1 except cure the mortar by the water method or
by the curing compound method using curing compound no. 6.
If the Engineer orders a lateral move of Type K temporary railing and repositioning is not shown, the
lateral move is change order work unless:
1. Required to conform with your traffic control plan
2. Required to conform with the MUTCD
3. Necessary for public safety or convenience as determined by the Engineer
4. Required to perform staged construction shown on the plans
Replace Section 12-3.22C with:
12-3.22C Construction
If crash cushion modules are used on the project, use the same type of crash cushion module for a single
grouping or array.
Temporary crash cushion arrays must not encroach on the traveled way.
Secure the sand-filled modules in place before starting an activity requiring a temporary crash cushion.
Maintain sand-filled temporary crash cushions in place at each location, including times when work is not
actively in progress. You may remove the crash cushions during the work shift for access to the work if
the exposed fixed obstacle is 15 feet or more from the nearest lane carrying traffic. Reset the crash
cushion before the end of the work shift.
Immediately repair sand-filled temporary crash cushion modules damaged due to your activities. Remove
and replace any module damaged beyond repair. Repair and replacement of temporary crash cushion
modules damaged by traffic are change order work.
You may place sand-filled temporary crash cushion modules on movable pallets or frames complying with
the dimensions shown. The pallets or frames must provide a full-bearing base beneath the modules. Do
not move the modules and supporting pallets or frames by sliding or skidding along the pavement or
bridge deck.
Attach a Type R or Type P marker panel to the front of the temporary crash cushion if the closest point of
the crash cushion array is within 12 feet of the traveled way. Firmly fasten the marker panel to the crash
cushion with commercial quality hardware or by other authorized methods. Attach the Type R marker
panel such that the top of the panel is 1 inch below the module lid.Attach the Type P marker panel such
that the bottom of the panel rests upon the pallet or roadway surface if pallets are not used.
A lateral move of a temporary crash cushion module is change order work if ordered and the repositioning
is not shown, unless required for staged construction.
Remove sand-filled temporary crash cushion modules, including sand, pallets or frames, and marker
panels, at Contract acceptance. Do not install sand-filled temporary crash cushion modules in the
permanent work.
Replace section 12-3.31 C with:
12-3.31 C Construction
If portable flashing beacons are used on the project, remove portable flashing beacons from the traveled
way at the end of each night's work. You may store the flashing beacon at selected central locations
within the highway where designated by the Engineer.
Moving portable flashing beacons from location to location if ordered after initial placement is change
order work unless:
1. Required to conform with your traffic control plan
2. Required to conform with the MUTCD
3. Necessary for public safety or convenience as determined by the Engineer
4. Required to perform staged construction shown on the plans
Replace Section 12-3.35B(6)with:
12-3.35B(6) User Interface
If the project includes an AWIS, the system must have a user interface to control the AWIS PCMS
communications. The interface must be (1)software compatible with a Windows environment or(2) a web
service accessed by a web browser.
Provide any software on a CD or other Engineer-authorized data-storage device.
The user interface must, at a minimum, provide the user with a list of AWIS PCMSs in the field, location
information for each AWIS PCMS, and a real-time on-board display of the message in the field. Control
options must, at a minimum, provide the user the ability to change the on-board messages and flash rate.
Replace Section 12-4 with:
12-4 MAINTAINING TRAFFIC
12-4.01 GENERAL
12-4.01A General
Section 12-4.01 includes general specifications for maintaining traffic through construction work zones.
If local authorities regulate traffic, notify them at least 5 business days before the start of job site activities.
Cooperate with the local authorities to handle traffic through the work zone and to make arrangements to
keep the work zone clear of parked vehicles.
12-4.01 B Materials
Not Used
12-4.01 C CONSTRUCTION
Furnishing and operating pilot cars is not change order work.
12-4.01 D Payment
Not Used
12-4.02 TRAFFIC CONTROL SYSTEMS
12-4.02A General
12-4.02A(1) Summary
Section 12-4.02 includes specifications for providing a traffic control system to close traffic lanes,
shoulders, and roadways.
A traffic control system for a closure includes the temporary traffic control devices described as part of the
traffic control system. Temporary traffic control devices must comply with section 12-3.
12-4.02A(2) Definitions
designated holidays: Designated holidays are shown as "holidays" in Section 1-1.07B.
12-4.02A(3) Submittals
12-4.02A(3)(a) General
The Contractor shall prepare and submit to the County Construction Engineer for approval, a traffic
control system plan indicating the means and methods he will employ to institute and maintain traffic
control for all phases of the work within the project. The traffic control system plan shall be submitted to
the County Construction Engineer as early as possible, preferably five (5)working days prior to pre-
construction meeting. The Engineer will require five (5)working days to review the initial submittal of the
traffic control system plan and an additional five (5)working days for each successive review.
No work at the project site whatsoever, including preparatory work such as the installation of
construction project funding signs, shall commence until the traffic control system plan has been
approved in writing by the Engineer. In the event that the traffic control system plan is not
submitted timely, the Engineer may issue a notice of commencement of contract time prior to
approval of the traffic control system plan, and working days will begin to accrue against the
allotted contract time.
Late submittal of the traffic control plan or revisions thereafter required, due to the inadequacy of the plan,
shall not be accepted as justification for the delay in the start of the working days for the project.
It shall be the Contractor's responsibility to provide, install, maintain, and remove any and all detour
signage and traffic control devices and to obtain all permits, including permits from Caltrans, as may be
necessary to establish detours as part of the contractor's traffic control plan.
Traffic will not be allowed to be limited to one direction when construction activities are not actively in
progress. Providing, installing, maintaining, and removing all traffic control, including portable changeable
message signs if required, obtaining and complying with all permits, and providing all traffic control
operations shall be the responsibility of the contractor, and no additional compensation will be allowed
therefor.
12-4.02A(3)(b) Closure Schedules
One-way traffic shall be controlled through the project in accordance with the California Manual MUTCD
and Caltrans Standard Plans T-11 and T-13 entitled "Traffic Control System for Lane Closure on Multilane
Conventional Highways" and "Traffic Control System for Lane Closure on Two Lane Conventional
Highways," and these special provisions. Night closure will not be permitted.
When traffic is under one way control on unpaved areas, the cones shown along the centerline on the
plan need not be placed.
Every Monday by noon, submit a closure schedule request for planned closures for the next week.
The next week is defined as Sunday at noon through the following Sunday at noon.
Submit a closure schedule request 5 days before the anticipated start of any job site activity that reduces:
1. Horizontal clearances of traveled ways, including shoulders, to 2 lanes or fewer due to activities such
as temporary barrier placement and paving
2. Vertical clearances of traveled ways, including shoulders, due to activities such as pavement
overlays, overhead sign installation, or falsework girder erection
Submit closure schedule changes, including additional closures, by noon at least 3 business days before
a planned closure.
Cancel closure requests at least 48 hours before the start time of the closure.
The Department notifies you of unauthorized closures or closures that require coordination with other
parties as a condition for authorization.
12-4.02A(3)(c) Contingency Plans for Closures
Submit a contingency plan for an activity that could affect a closure if a contingency plan is specified in
the special provisions or if a contingency plan is requested.
If a contingency plan is requested, submit the contingency plan within 1 business day of the request.
The contingency plan must identify the activities, equipment, processes, and materials that may cause a
delay in the opening of a closure to traffic. The plan must include:
1. List of additional or alternate equipment, materials, or workers necessary to ensure continuing
activities and on-time opening of closures if a problem occurs. If the additional or alternate equipment,
materials, or workers are not on the job site, specify their location, the method for mobilizing these
items, and the required time to complete mobilization.
2. General time-scaled logic diagram displaying the major activities and sequence of the planned
activities. For each activity, identify the critical event that will activate the contingency plan.
Submit revisions to a contingency plan at least 3 business days before starting the activity requiring the
contingency plan. Allow 2 business days for review.
12-4.02A(4) Quality Assurance
Reserved
12-4.02B Materials
Not Used
12-4.02C Construction
12-4.02C(1) General
Traffic will be controlled by flagmen by eyesight, radio (walkie talkie)or baton. In the event these
methods do not work satisfactorily, as determined by the Engineer, a pilot car will be required.
The Engineer may require a pilot car to be used during earthwork operations in preparation of the grading
plane or other operations when the Contractor's operations cover an area beyond the line of sight, or
beyond the range of radios or when the baton method does not function satisfactorily.
Work that interferes with traffic is limited to the hours when closures are allowed.
12-4.02C(3) Closure Requirements and Charts
12-4.02C(3)(a) General
Where 2 or more lanes in the same direction, including the shoulders, are adjacent to the area where the
work is being performed, close the adjacent lane under any of the following conditions:
1. Work is off the traveled way but within 6 feet of the edge of the traveled way, and the approach
speed is greater than 45 mph
2. Work is off the traveled way but within 3 feet of the edge of the traveled way, and the approach
speed is less than 45 mph
Closure of the adjacent traffic lane is not required during any of the following activities:
1. Work behind a barrier
2. Paving, grinding, or grooving
3. Installation, maintenance, or removal of traffic control devices except for temporary railing
12-4.02C(3)(b) - 12-4.02C(3)(n)
Reserved
12-4.02C(3)(o) Closure of Conventional County Roads
The type and location of signs, lights, flags, flagmen, and other traffic control and safety devices shall be
in accordance with the current edition of the California Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices
(MUTCD) issued by the State of California, Department of Transportation (Caltrans).
Allow public traffic to pass through construction at all times unless otherwise specified herein.
Provide access to properties abutting the project site at all times.
When directed by the Engineer, traffic shall be routed through the work under one-way control.
Under one-way reversing traffic control operations, public traffic may be stopped in one direction for periods
not to exceed 10 minutes.
Lane closure is defined as the closure of a traffic lane or lanes within a single traffic control system.
No work that would require a lane closure shall be performed.
The full width of the traveled way shall be open for use by public traffic when construction operations are
not actively in progress.
Keep driveways and access roads accessible at all times.
Maintain vehicular access to the channel bank access roads at all times.
Personal vehicles of the Contractor's employees shall not be parked on the traveled way or shoulders
including sections closed to public traffic.
When work vehicles or equipment are parked on the shoulder within 6 feet of a traffic lane, the shoulder
area shall be closed as shown on standard plan T-10.
12-4.02C(3)(o)-12-4.02C(3)(s) Reserved
12-4.02C(4)-12.4.02C(6) Reserved
12-4.02C(7) Traffic Control System Requirements
12-4.02C(7)(a) General
Control traffic using stationary closures.
If components of the traffic control system are displaced or cease to operate or function as specified,
immediately repair them to their original condition or replace them and place them back in their original
locations.
Vehicles equipped with attenuators must comply with section 12-3.23.
Each vehicle used to place, maintain, and remove components of a traffic control system on a multilane
highway must have a Type II flashing arrow sign that must operate whenever the vehicle is used for
placing, maintaining, or removing the components. For a stationary closure, vehicles with a Type II
flashing arrow sign not involved in placing, maintaining, or removing the components must display only
the caution display mode. If a flashing arrow sign is required for a closure, activate the sign before the
closure is in place.
12-4.02C(7)(b) Stationary Closures
Except for channelizing devices placed along open trenches or excavations adjacent to the traveled way,
remove the components of the traffic control system for a stationary closure from the traveled way and
shoulders at the end of each work period. You may store the components at authorized locations within
the limits of the highway.
If a traffic lane is closed with channelizing devices for excavation work, move the devices to the adjacent
edge of the traveled way when not excavating. Space the devices as shown for the lane closure.
12-4.02C(7)(c) Moving Closures
For a moving closure, use a PCMS that complies with section 12-3.32 except the sign must be truck
mounted. The full operational height to the bottom of the sign may be less than 7 feet above the ground
but must be as high as practicable.
If you use a flashing arrow sign in a moving closure, the sign must be truck mounted. Operate the flashing
arrow sign in the caution display mode if it is being used on a 2-lane, two-way highway.
12-4.02C(8) Traffic Control System Signs
12-4.02C(8)(a) General
Traffic control system signs must comply with section 12-3.11.
12-4.02C(8)(b) Connector and Ramp Closure Signs
Inform motorists of a temporary closing of a (1) connector or a (2)freeway or expressway entrance or exit
ramp using:
1. SC6-3(CA) (Ramp Closed)sign for closures of 1 day or less
2. SC6-4(CA) (Ramp Closed)sign for closures of more than 1 day
SC6-3(CA) and SC6-4(CA) signs must be stationary mounted at the locations shown and must remain in
place and visible to motorists during the connector or ramp closure.
Notify the Engineer at least 2 business days before installing the sign and install the sign from 7 to 15
days before the closure.
12-4.02C(10)-12-4.02C(11) Reserved
12-4.02C(12) Failure to Provide Traffic Control.
If you do not provide the traffic control and it becomes necessary for the Engineer to notify you of your
duties according to the Standard Specifications and these special provisions, you will pay$200 per 15-
minute period or portion thereof to the County for all the time required to acquire the traffic control,
including pilot car.
Such payment shall commence at the time notice of the improper traffic control condition is given to you
or your authorized representative by the Engineer and shall terminate when the condition is corrected.
Such payment will be deducted from your payment.
In addition, when it is necessary for the Engineer to perform the work, you will pay the actual cost for the
performance thereof. Such amount will be deducted from the your payment. This will be in addition to
any penalties imposed in these special provisions.
The provisions in this section will not relieve you from your responsibility to provide such additional
devices or take such measures as may be necessary to comply with the provisions in Section 7-1.04,
"Public Safety," of the Standard Specifications.
12-4.02D Payment
The Department pays for change order work for a traffic control system by force account for increased
traffic control and uses a force account analysis for decreased traffic control.
Traffic control system for lane closure is paid for as traffic control system. Flagging costs are paid for as
specified in section 12-1.04.
The requirements in section 4-1.05 for payment adjustment do not apply to traffic control system.
Adjustments in compensation for traffic control system will be made for an increase or decrease in traffic
control work if ordered and will be made on the basis of the cost of the necessary increased or decreased
traffic control. The adjustment will be made on a force account basis for increased work and estimated on
the same basis in the case of decreased work.
A traffic control system required by change order work is paid for as a part of the change order work.
Full compensation for furnishing and operating the pilot car, (including driver, radios, and any other
equipment and labor required) shall be considered as included in the contract lump sum price paid for
traffic control system and no further payment will be made.
12-4.03 FALSEWORK OPENINGS
Reserved
12-4.04 PEDESTRIAN FACILITIES
12-4.04A General
Section 12-4.04 includes specifications for providing temporary pedestrian facilities.
Temporary pedestrian facilities must comply with section 16-2.02.
12-4.04B Materials
Not Used
12-4.04C Construction
If pedestrian traffic is allowed to pass through work areas, provide a temporary pedestrian facility through
the construction areas within the highway. Include a protective overhead covering as necessary to ensure
protection from falling objects and drippings from overhead structures.
If an activity requires a closure of a walkway, provide another walkway nearby, off of the traveled way.
Where pedestrian openings through falsework are required, provide a temporary pedestrian facility with a
protective overhead covering during all bridge construction activities.
12-4.04D Payment
Not Used
13 WATER POLLUTION CONTROL
Replace 13-1.01A with:
13-1.01A Summary
Section 13-1 includes general specifications for preventing, controlling, and abating water pollution within
waters of the State.
Information on forms, reports, and other documents is in the following Caltrans manuals:
1. Field Guide to Construction Site Dewatering
2. Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan (SWPPP) and Water Pollution Control Program (WPCP)
Preparation Manual
3. Construction Site Best Management Practices (BMPs) Manual
4. Construction Site Monitoring Program Guidance Manual
You may view these manuals at the Stormwater and Water Pollution Control Information link at the
Caltrans Division of Construction website or purchase them at the Caltrans Publication Distribution Unit.
A WPCP and a SWPPP must comply with the Caltrans Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan (SWPPP)
and Water Pollution Control Program (WPCP) Preparation Manual and must be prepared using the latest
template posted on the Construction stormwater website.
Replace Section 13-1.01 D(2)with
13-1.01 D(2) Regulatory Requirements
Comply with the discharge requirements in the NPDES General Permit for Storm Water Discharges
Associated with Construction and Land Disturbance Activities; Order No. 2009-000 9-DWQ, CAS000002
(Construction General Permit)and any amendments thereto issued by the SWRCB. The Construction
General Permit may be found at:
http://www.waterboards.ca.gov/water i ssues/prog rams/stormwater/constpe rm its.shtmI
Discharges from manufacturing facilities, such as batch plants and crushing plants, must comply with the
discharge requirements in the NPDES General Permit for Storm Water Discharges Associated with
Industrial Activities; Order No. 2014-0057-DWQ, CAS000001 (Industrial General Permit), issued by the
SWRCB. For the Industrial General Permit, go to the SWRCB website.
For a batch plant and crushing plant outside a job site or within a job site that serves one or more
contracts, obtain coverage under the Industrial General Permit before operating a batch plant to
manufacture concrete, HMA, or other material or a crushing plant to produce rock or aggregate.
This Project disturbs less than 1 acre of soil.
Replace Section 13-1.01 D(4)(b)with:
13-1.01 D(4)(b) Qualifications
The WPC manager must:
1. Comply with the requirements provided in the Construction General Permit for:
1.1. QSP if the project requires a WPCP
1.2. QSD if the project requires a SWPPP
2. Complete the stormwater management training described at the Stormwater and Water Pollution
Control Information link at the Caltrans Division of Construction website
Replace Section 13-2.04:
13-2.04 PAYMENT
The Department pays for prepare water pollution control program as follows:
1. Total of 50 percent of the item total upon authorization of the WPCP
2. Total of 90 percent of the item total upon work completion
3. Total of 100 percent of the item total upon Contract acceptance
Add to section 13-3.01A:
Replace Section 13-3.01C(2)(b)(iv)with:
13-3.01C(2)(b)(iv) Sampling and Analysis Plan
If a sampling and analysis plan is required, submit a sampling and analysis plan that complies with the
Caltrans Construction Site Monitoring Program Guidance Manual.
The sampling and analysis plan must describe:
1. Sampling equipment and sample containers.
2. Preparation of samples.
3. Collection and holding times.
4. Field measurement methods.
5. Analytical methods.
6. Quality assurance and quality control.
7. Sample preservation and labeling.
8. Collection documentation, including the names of personnel collecting samples and their training.
9. Shipment of samples.
10. Chain of custody.
11. Data management and reporting.
12. Precautions from the construction site health and safety plan, including procedures for collecting
samples during precipitation. List the conditions under which you are not required to collect samples,
such as:
12.1. Dangerous weather
12.2. Flooding or electrical storms
12.3. Times outside of normal working hours
13. Procedures for collecting and analyzing at least 3 samples for each day of each qualifying rain event
for a risk level 2 or risk level 3 project.
14. Procedures for collecting effluent samples at all locations where the stormwater is discharged off the
job site.
The sampling and analysis plan must identify the State-certified laboratory that will perform the analyses.
For a list of State-certified laboratories, go to the SWRCB's website.
Submit a revised plan if discharges or sampling locations change because of changed work activities or
knowledge of site conditions.
Replace Section 13-4.03G with:
13-4.03G Dewatering
Dewatering consists of discharging accumulated stormwater, groundwater, or surface water from
excavations or temporary containment facilities.
If dewatering is required, perform dewatering work as specified for the work items involved, such as a
temporary ATS or dewatering and discharge.
If dewatering and discharging activities are not specified for a work item and you perform dewatering
activities:
1. Conduct dewatering activities under the Caltrans Field Guide for Construction Site Dewatering.
2. Ensure any dewatering discharge does not cause erosion, scour, or sedimentary deposits that could
impact natural bedding materials.
3. Discharge the water within the project limits. Dispose of the water if it cannot be discharged within
project limits due to site constraints or contamination.
4. Do not discharge stormwater or non-stormwater that has an odor, discoloration other than sediment,
an oily sheen, or foam on the surface. Immediately notify the Engineer upon discovering any such
condition.
Replace Section 13-5.04 with:
13-5.04 PAYMENT
The payment quantity for temporary soil stabilization bid items paid for by the area is the area measured
parallel with the ground surface not including the additional quantity used for overlaps.
If there is no bid item for temporary soil stabilization measures, payment therefor is considered to be
included in the bid item for prepare water pollution control program or in the bid item for prepare
stormwater pollution prevention plan, as applicable.
Replace Section 13-6.04 with:
13-6.04 PAYMENT
The payment quantity for temporary sediment control bid items paid for by the length is the length
measured along the centerline of the installed material.
The payment quantity, if any, for temporary fiber roll does not include the additional quantity used for
overlaps.
The Department does not pay for the relocation of temporary drainage inlet protection during work
progress.
If there are no bid items for installing or maintaining temporary sediment control measures, payment
therefor is considered to be included in the bid item for prepare water pollution control program or in the
bid item for prepare stormwater pollution prevention plan, as applicable.
Replace Section 13-7.03D with:
13-7.03D Payment
The Department does not pay for the relocation of temporary construction entrances or roadways during
work progress.
If there are no bid items for installing or maintaining temporary construction entrances or roadways,
payment therefor is considered to be included in the bid item for prepare water pollution control program
or in the bid item for prepare stormwater pollution prevention plan, as applicable.
14 ENVIRONMENTAL STEWARDSHIP
Add after the 3rd paragraph of section 14-10.01:
Food scraps, paper wrappers, food containers, cans, bottles and all food related trash and litter must be
removed from the project site at the end of each working day.
Replace the 7th paragraph of section 14-10.01 with:
Furnish and use closed-lid trash containers in the job-site yard, field trailers, and locations where workers
gather for lunch and breaks.
Replace Section 14-11.14A:
Section 14-11.14 is applicable to all projects. Wood removed from guardrail, signs, or structures is
considered treated wood waste.
Section 14-11.14 includes specifications for handling, storing, transporting, and disposing of treated wood
waste. Manage treated wood waste under 22 CA Code of Regs Div 4.5 Ch 34.
If there is no bid item for Treated Wood Waste, payment for training, handling, storing, transporting, and
disposing of treated wood waste therefor is considered to be included in the bid item for the removal of
other items.
Add Section 14-12.04:
14-12.04 RELATIONS WITH SAN JOAQUIN VALLEY AIR POLLUTION CONTROL DISTRICT
(SJVAPCD)
You are responsible for compliance with all applicable SJVAPCD regulations and requirements. This
section is provided for your information, and nothing herein or elsewhere within these special provisions
shall be construed as limiting your responsibility for complying with all applicable rules and regulations.
In accordance with SJVAPCD Regulation VIII — Fugitive PM10 Prohibitions: Rule 8021, implementation of
an SJVAPCD-approved dust control plan is not required prior to commencement of any dust generating
activities. You must file Construction Notification with SJVAPCD 48 hours prior to starting work.
Pursuant to section 6.4 of District Rule 8021 —Construction, Demolition, Excavation, Extraction, and
Other Earthmoving Activities, the owner or operator of a construction project of at least 1.0 acre in size
shall provide written notification to the District at least 48 hours prior to his/her intent to commence any
earthmoving activities. Use the first two pages of this form to submit a written Construction
Notification. There are no fees for filing a construction notification.
It is your responsibility to be fully informed of the requirements of all rules, regulations, plans and
conditions that may govern your operations and to conduct the work accordingly.
Replace Section 14-12.05-14.12.08 With:
14-12.05-14.12.08 RESERVED
DELETE DIVISION III THROUGH DIVISION VIII AND REPLACE WITH
THE FOLLOWING:
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Section Description Paqe
DIVISION 01 - GENERAL REQUIREMENTS
01 0005 Specifications......................................................................................... 2
01 11 00 Description of Work and Schedule Constraints ..................................... 4
01 11 05 Design Engineer's Status During Construction...................................... 6
01 11 10 Coordination of Work............................................................................. 8
01 2000 Measurement and Payment................................................................... 9
01 2200 Explanation of Bid Items........................................................................ 11
01 2613 Requests for Information ....................................................................... 16
ADMINISTRATIVE REQUIREMENTS
01 31 19 Project Meetings.................................................................................... 19
01 33 00 Submittals.............................................................................................. 21
01 35 00 Material Submittal Procedures............................................................... 26
QUALITY REQUIREMENTS
01 42 13 Definitions and Abbreviations. ............................................................... 33
01 43 00 Quality Control and Testing ................................................................... 38
TEMPORARY FACILITIES AND CONTROLS
01 50 00 Temporary Facilities .............................................................................. 40
01 57 50 Construction Stakes, Lines and Grades................................................ 42
EXECUTION AND CLOSEOUT REQUIREMENTS
01 77 00 Contract Closeout.................................................................................. 43
DIVISION 02 to 32 (NOT USED)
DIVISION 33 — UTILITIES
33 24 13 Monitoring Well Construction, Development & Deconstruction ............. 45
33 24 32 Submersible Pumps............................................................................... 55
Contract Number 23-06-C 1
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 00 05
SPECIFICATIONS
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 SUMMARY
A. Furnish hardcopy Plans and Specifications to be kept on site.
1. Hardcopy of Contract Plans and Specifications must be accessible to Engineer and
Owner
B. Information mentioned in Specifications and not indicated on Plans or indicated on Plans
and not mentioned in Specifications shall be of like effect as if indicated or mentioned
in both.
C. Do not take advantage of errors, discrepancies or omissions which may exist in Plans and
Specifications. Immediately call them to attention of Owner.
D. Change Orders, supplemental agreements, and approved revisions to Plans and
Specifications will take precedence over documents listed above. Detailed Plans will
have precedence over general Plans.
E. Whenever conflicts appear in Contract Documents, resolve by order of precedence.
1.02 REFERENCES
A. For a definition of Reference Documents and State Standard Specifications refer to Section
01 42 13 "Definitions and Abbreviations".
B. Throughout the Specification sections, references are made to various widely published,
standard and commercial specifications, manuals, or codes of technical societies,
organizations, or associations. These specifications are intended to amplify descriptions of
materials, equipment, and construction systems. The following Reference Documents are
the most widely used, and are cited or referred to in each of the following sections of these
Specifications:
1. American Society of Testing Materials (ASTM)
2. American National Standards Institute (ANSI)
3. American Standards Associations (ASA)
4. American Concrete Institute (ACI)
5. Federal Specifications, as applicable.
6. California Building Code
7. California Plumbing Code
8. National Electric Code
9. Construction Safety Orders of the Division of Industrial Relations latest edition.
C. Refer to latest published revision of cited Reference Documents as of the date of invitation
for bids and to such portions of it that relate and apply directly to material or installation
called for on this job.
D. Whenever references are made to above-mentioned Reference Documents or testing
methods in governing Building Codes, requirements of those Reference Documents shall
Contract Number 23-06-C 2
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
govern, insofar as they are not in contravention with maxima or minima prescribed by
documents designated in Building Code.
1.03 DEFINITIONS
A. For definitions of Specifications categorized as General Requirements and Technical
Specifications refer to Section 01 42 13 "Definitions and Abbreviations".
1.04 QUALITY ASSURANCE
A. Occupational Safety and Health Act:
1. Applicable standards of the American National Standards Institute and the National
Fire Protection Association that have been adopted are hereby made a part of these
Specifications as a whole and as mentioned in various sections.
2. Report errors, ambiguities, or inconsistencies of these standards with either local
codes, Specifications, or Drawings to attention of Owner.
B. Compliance with Laws and Codes:
1. Conform to and abide by local city, county, state and federal laws, rules, regulations,
including industrial safety laws. Laws shall be considered as essential parts of these
Specifications and, in absence of definite requirements herein, provisions of such rules
and regulations shall be observed by Contractor. If Drawings and/or Specifications are
at variance therewith, Contractor must notify Engineer promptly. Contractor will bear
costs arising from work performed contrary to such laws, ordinances, rules, and
regulations.
2. Where these Specifications, call for or describe materials workmanship or construction
of a better quality, higher standard, or larger size than is required by said rules and
regulations, the provisions of these Specifications shall take precedence over said
rules and regulations. Contractor shall furnish, without extra charge, additional labor, or
materials, or both, when required for compliance with these rules and regulations.
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 3
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 11 00
DESCRIPTION OF WORK AND SCHEDULE CONSTRAINTS
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 WORK INCLUDED
A. The Work consists of furnishing labor, materials, and equipment necessary to drill and
construct three (3) groundwater monitoring wells and inspecting one (1) existing
groundwater monitoring well at the Fresno County Juvenile Justice Center.
B. The Work shall include but not be limited to:
1. Drilling
2. Logging boreholes
3. Constructing monitor wells
4. Constructing wellheads
5. Incidentals to complete work described in Plans and Specifications.
C. Primary components:
1. Drill each borehole in turn to total depth, collect sonic core samples.
2. Construct each well in turn: Install Casing, Filter Pack and Annular Seal.
3. Bail, surge, and install development pump in each well in turn; perform pump
development at Design Engineers direction.
4. Construct Wellheads Facilities.
D. The inspection Work of the existing well shall include but not be limited to:
1. Demo existing well concrete vault
2. Inspect existing casing per plan
3. Repair or destroy well as directed by Engineer.
1.02 SITE LOCATION
A. Fresno County
B. Address: 3333 E. American Ave, Fresno, California.
1.03 BEGINNING OF WORK
A. Begin work as stated in Section 8-1.04A Start of Job Site Activities.
1.04 TIME OF COMPLETION
A. Bring work to substantial completion as stated in Section 8-1.04A.
1.05 TIME CONSTRAINTS
A. Supervise, inspect, and direct Work competently and apply such skills and expertise as
may be necessary to perform Work in accordance with Contract Documents.
Contract Number 23-06-C 4
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
B. Contractor will be solely responsible for specific means, methods, techniques, sequence, or
procedure of construction required to complete the Work as specified by Contract
Documents.
C. Contractor will be responsible to see that completed Work complies accurately with
Contract Documents.
1.06 ORDER OF WORK
A. This Work must adhere to the replacement order of an approved Work Plan by the Central
Valley Regional Water Quality Control Board.
B. Work sequence:
1. Drilling and development of new groundwater monitoring wells indicated in Plans.
2. Inspection of well MW-21-1
3. New wells installation, well destruction must be approved by Design Engineer prior to
start of drilling.
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 5
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 11 05
DESIGN ENGINEER'S STATUS DURING CONSTRUCTION
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 VISITS TO SITE
A. Design Engineer will make visits to Work Site at intervals appropriate to various stages of
construction as Design Engineer deems necessary to observe as an experienced and
qualified design professional the progress that has been made and quality of various
aspects of Contractor's executed Work. Based on information obtained during such visits
and observations, Design Engineer, will determine, in general, if the Work is proceeding in
accordance with Contract Documents.
B. Design Engineer's visits and observations are subject to limitations on Design Engineer's
authority and responsibility set forth in Section 1.5, below. Particularly, but without
limitation, during or because of Design Engineer's visits or observations of Contractor's
Work. Design Engineer will not supervise, direct, control, or have authority over or be
responsible for Contractor's means, methods, techniques, sequences, or procedures of
construction, or safety precautions and programs incident thereto, or for failure of
Contractor to comply with Laws and Regulations applicable to performance of the Work.
C. Review of the Work by Design Engineer will not relieve Contractor of obligation to fulfill
conditions of Contract.
D. No oral or telephonic agreement or conversation with officer, agent or employee of Owner
or Design Engineer, or with Design Engineer, either before or after execution of Contract,
shall affect or modify terms or obligations contained in Contract Documents.
1.02 AUTHORIZED VARIATIONS IN WORK
A. Design Engineer may authorize minor variations in the Work from requirements of Contract
Documents which do not involve an adjustment in Contract Price or Contract Times and are
compatible with the design concept of the completed Work as a functioning whole as
indicated by Contract Documents.
1.03 REJECTING DEFECTIVE WORK
A. Design Engineer will have authority to reject Work which Design Engineer believes to be
defective, or that Design Engineer believes will not produce a completed Work that
conforms to Contract Documents or that will prejudice integrity of the design concept of the
completed Work as a functioning whole as indicated by Contract Documents. Design
Engineer will also have authority to require special inspection or testing of the Work,
whether the Work is fabricated, installed, or completed. Neither this authority nor Design
Engineer's good faith judgment to reject or not reject work shall be subject Design Engineer
to liability or cause of action by Contractor, or other suppliers or persons performing work
on the Contract.
1.04 LIMITATIONS ON DESIGN ENGINEER'S AUTHORITY AND RESPONSIBILITIES
A. Design Engineer will not supervise, direct, control, or have authority over or be responsible
for Contractor's means, methods, techniques, sequences, or procedures of construction, or
safety precautions and programs incident thereto, or for failure of Contractor to comply with
Contract Number 23-06-C 6
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
Laws and Regulations applicable to performance of the Work. Design Engineer will not be
responsible for Contractor's failure to perform the Work in accordance with Contract
Documents.
B. Design Engineer will not be responsible for acts or omissions of Contractor, Supplier, or of
other individual or entity performing Work.
C. Design Engineer's review of final Application for Payment and accompanying
documentation and maintenance and operating instructions, schedules, guarantees, bonds,
certificates of inspection, tests and approvals, and other documentation required to be
delivered will only be to determine generally that their content complies with requirements
of, and in the case of certificates of inspections, tests, and approvals that results certified
indicate compliance with Contract Documents.
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 7
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 11 10
COORDINATION OF WORK
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 RESPONSIBILITY OF CONTRACTOR
A. If any part of the Work depends on execution or results upon the work of others, Contractor
must inspect and promptly report to Design Engineer apparent discrepancies or defects in
such work of others that render it unsuitable for such execution and results.
B. Failure of Contractor to so inspect and report shall constitute an acceptance of the work of
others as fit and proper except as to defects which may develop in the work of others after
execution of the Work by Contractor.
1.02 WORK INVOLVED WITH EXISTING SYSTEM
A. Operate with other Contractors or forces which may be working at Fresno County Juvenile
Justice Center.
B. Contractor will initially remove pumps, tubing, and pump caps of existing groundwater
monitoring wells.
C. Existing pumps will be cleaned, tested and salvaged for Owner.
D. Existing materials and equipment removed not designated to be salvaged for Owner in
execution of the Work shall become property of Contractor and shall be removed from, and
disposed of, off site by Contractor in an acceptable and lawful manner.
1.03 COORDINATION OF WORK
A. Maintain overall coordination for execution of the Work. Based on Construction Schedule
prepared in accordance with these Specifications, Contractor must be responsible for
parties maintaining these schedules and for coordinating required modifications.
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 8
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 20 00
MEASUREMENT OF PAYMENT
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 MEASUREMENT
A. Unless otherwise specified in Contract Documents, quantities of work shall be determined
from measurements or dimensions in a horizontal or vertical plane. Measurements shall be
made in accordance with United States Standard Measures and shall be measured based
on "in-place" quantities.
B. After the Work has been completed, Owner or Owners representative will make field
measurements of unit price items to determine quantities of distinct items as a basis for
payment.
C. On unit price items, Contractor will be paid for actual amount of work performed in
accordance with Contract Documents, as computed from field measurements.
D. Work or quantities not listed in description of bid items are considered incidental to other
construction and will not be measured. Compensation for such incidental work is included in
the distinct items of work bid.
1.02 PARTIAL PAYMENT
A. Attention is directed to Section 9-1.16 of the State Standard Specifications which, except as
modified herein, shall apply in its entirety.
1. Local agency will withhold not less than 5 percent of Contract price until final
completion and acceptance of the Work.
2. Partial payments for materials on hand shall not exceed one hundred percent (100%)
of the value of material delivered on site, safely stored in a secured fenced area
subject to, or under control of, Owner and local agency, and unused.
3. Submit copies of invoices of materials to support values.
4. Materials stored must be installed within 60 calendar days of delivery for payment
eligibility.
B. Payment will not relieve Contractor from its obligations under the Contract; nor will such
payment be construed as acceptance of the Work.
C. Payment shall not be construed as transfer of ownership of equipment or materials to
Owner.
D. Responsibility of ownership will remain with Contractor who will be obligated to protect fully
or partially completed work or structure for which payment has been made; or replace
materials or equipment to be provided under the Contract which may be damaged, lost,
stolen or otherwise degraded prior to acceptance of the Work, except as provided in
Section 7-1.15 of the State Standard Specifications.
Contract Number 23-06-C 9
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
1.03 FINAL PAYMENT
A. File Notice of Completion in normal course of business following the first regular meeting of
Fresno County Board which occurs far enough after Final Completion to allow for agenizing
Fresno County Board approval of the Notice.
B. Upon completion of the Work, final contract prices, revised by change order, if necessary,
shall reflect true quantities used at stated unit price thereof as contained in Contractor's
Proposal hereto attached. Make payments on account as set forth in these Specifications.
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 10
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 22 00
EXPLANATION OF BID ITEMS
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 SUMMARY
A. Contract payment for specified items of work as set forth in Bid Schedule must be full
compensation for furnishing labor, materials, methods or processes, implements, tools,
equipment, and incidentals and for doing work involved as required by provisions of
Contract Documents for a complete in place and operational system.
B. Unless otherwise specified in Specifications, quantities of work will be determined per each,
or from measurements or dimensions in the horizontal and vertical plane. Materials shall be
measured based on "in place" quantities and paid for using units listed in the bid schedule.
C. Except as noted, Owner may make field measurements of unit price items to determine
quantities of distinct items as a basis for payment. On unit price items, Contractor will be
paid for actual amount of work performed in accordance with Contract Documents, as
computed from field measurements.
D. Work or quantities not listed in description of bid items are considered incidental to other
construction and will not be separately measured or paid for. Compensation for such work
and/or material shall be included in prices paid for other items of work.
1.02 BID SUMMARY
Bid Item 1 — Mobilization, Bonds, Insurance and Permits
A. Payment for this item shall include full compensation for labor, materials, tools, equipment,
and incidentals making up cost of mobilization, move-in, move-out, necessary bonds,
insurance, permits, licenses, and fees required during performance of the Work as
specified. This item also includes demobilization, including removal of equipment, supplies,
personnel, and incidentals from the Work at end of construction, and completion and
submittal of DWR Well Completion Reports. This bid item will be paid for by Lump Sum for
the entire project.
Bid Item 2 —Worker Protection
A. Payment for this item shall be considered full compensation for items included in Section 7-
1.02K (6) of the State Standard Specifications including but not limited to labor, materials,
tools, equipment and incidentals for providing for worker protection from caving ground in
excavations and other hazards, including temporary fencing, that may occur during
construction, in accordance with Plans and specifications. This bid item will be paid for by
Lump Sum, prorated, based on percentage of contract work completed.
Bid Item 3—Traffic Control
A. Contract lump sum price paid traffic control includes full compensation for furnishing labor,
materials, tools, equipment, and incidentals and for doing work involved in implementing
necessary traffic control measures as specified in the State Standard Specifications and
these special provisions, and as ordered by Engineer.
Contract Number 23-06-C 11
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
Bid Item 4—Job Site Management
A. Contract lump sum price paid for job site management includes full compensation for
furnishing labor, materials, tools, equipment, and incidentals and for doing work involved in
spill prevention and control, material management, waste management, non- stormwater
management, and dewatering and identifying, sampling, testing, handling, and disposing of
hazardous waste resulting from your activities, as specified in the State Standard
Specifications and these special provisions, and as ordered by Engineer.
Bid Item 5—Water Pollution Control
A. Contract lump sum price paid for water pollution control includes full compensation for
furnishing labor, materials, tools, equipment, and incidentals and for doing work involved in
preparing, implementing, maintaining, inspecting, and removing water pollution control
practices in accordance with approved WPCP as specified in the State Standard
Specifications and these special provisions, and as directed by Engineer.
Bid Item 6 — Miscellaneous Facilities, Operations, and USA
A. This bid item includes provisions for protection of workers from hazards that may occur
during construction, and Underground Service Alert (USA) notification for monitoring well
drilling and construction. This bid item also includes work indicated and described in
Contract documents, but not included in other bid items, including, but not limited to site
safety, protection of existing facilities, sieve analysis, cleaning/salvaging existing pumps
and site cleanup. This bid item will be paid for by Lump Sum for the entire project.
Bid Item 7— Drill 10-inch Diameter Borehole
A. This bid item is a unit price bid for drilling borehole, and shall be per lineal foot completed,
and shall be full compensation for furnishing labor, equipment, and materials to complete
the installation as described herein, including collection and proper disposal of drill cutting
samples, and no additional compensation will be made, therefore. Quantities may be
increased, decreased, or deleted entirely by Owner, with no change in unit price.
Bid Item 8— Furnish and Install 4-inch (nominal) Diameter Blank Casing
A. This bid item is a unit price bid for furnishing and installing 4-inch diameter(nominal) schedule
80 PVC blank casing and shall be per lineal foot complete in place, and shall be full
compensation for furnishing labor, equipment and materials to complete installation as
described herein, and no additional compensation will be made therefor. This task will also
include furnishing and installing end caps, fittings and sample port assembly as indicated on
plans. Quantities may be increased, decreased, or deleted entirely by Owner, with no change
in unit price.
Contract Number 23-06-C 12
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
Bid Item 9— Furnish and Install 4-inch (nominal) Diameter Perforated Casing
A. This bid item is a unit price bid for furnishing and installing 4-inch diameter (nominal)
schedule 80 PVC perforated casing, 0.020 milled slot, and shall be per lineal foot complete
in place, and shall be full compensation for furnishing labor, equipment and materials to
complete installation as described herein, including centralizers, and no additional
compensation will be made, therefore. Quantities may be increased, decreased, or deleted
entirely by Owner, with no change in unit price.
Bid Items 10 — Furnish and Install Filter Pack
A. This bid item is a unit price bid for furnishing and installing filter pack as specified, and shall
be per lineal foot complete in place, and shall be full compensation for furnishing labor,
equipment, and other materials to complete installation as described herein, and no
additional compensation will be made, therefore. Quantities may be increased, decreased,
or deleted entirely by Owner, with no change in unit price.
Bid Item 11 — Construct Bentonite Seal
A. This bid item is a unit price bid for constructing a bentonite seal and shall be per lineal foot
complete in place and shall be full compensation for furnishing labor, equipment and
materials to complete installation as described herein, and no additional compensation will
be made, therefore. Quantities may be increased, decreased, or deleted entirely by Owner,
with no change in unit price.
Bid Item 12 — Construct Cement Grout Seal
A. This bid item is a unit price bid for constructing a cement grout seal and shall be per lineal
foot complete in place and shall be full compensation for furnishing labor, equipment, and
materials to complete installation as described herein, and no additional compensation will
be made, therefore. Quantities may be increased, decreased, or deleted entirely by Owner,
with no change in unit price.
Bid Item 13 —Well Development by Bailing, Surging, and Pumping
A. This bid item is a unit bid for well development by bailing, surging, and pumping and shall
be reimbursed per hour completed and shall be full compensation for furnishing labor,
equipment and materials to complete work as described herein, including proper disposal of
water, and no additional compensation will be made, therefore. Quantities may be
increased, decreased, or deleted entirely by Owner, with no change in unit price.
Bid Item 14 — Construct Wellhead Facilities
A. This bid item includes constructing wellhead facilities, including, but not limited to traffic
rated vault boxes set in concrete, site grading around wellhead, and shall be full
compensation for furnishing labor, equipment and materials to complete work as described
herein, and no additional compensation will be made, therefore. This bid item will be paid
for by each wellhead facility being constructed.
Contract Number 23-06-C 13
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
Bid Items 15 —Video Survey Well Casing
A. This bid item is a unit price bid item and includes video surveillance of each new well and
casing, and shall be full compensation for furnishing labor, equipment and other materials to
complete the video survey, and provide digital documentation as described herein. Quantities
may be increased, decreased, or deleted entirely by Owner, with no change in unit price.
Bid Items 16 — Furnish and Install Submersible Well Pump
A. This bid item is a unit price bid for furnishing and installing Submersible Well Pumps as
specified, and shall be full compensation for furnishing labor, equipment, and other
materials to complete installation as described herein including fittings and no additional
compensation will be made, therefore. Quantities may be increased, decreased, or deleted
entirely by Owner, with no change in unit price.
Bid Item 17 — Furnish and Install 3/4" (nominal)Access Tube
A. This bid item is a unit price bid for furnishing and installing 3/4" Schedule 80 PVC Access
Tube and shall be per lineal foot complete in place, and shall be full compensation for
furnishing labor, equipment and materials to complete installation as described herein,
including fittings, and no additional compensation will be made, therefore. Quantities may
be increased, decreased, or deleted entirely by Owner, with no change in unit price.
Bid Item 18 — Furnish and Install 1 1/4-inch (nominal) Drop Pipe
A. This bid item is a unit price bid for furnishing and installing 1 1/4" Schedule 80 PVC Access
Tube, and shall be per lineal foot complete in place, and shall be full compensation for
furnishing labor, equipment and materials to complete installation as described herein,
including fittings, and no additional compensation will be made, therefore. Quantities may
be increased, decreased, or deleted entirely by Owner, with no change in unit price.
Bid Item 19 —Well MW-2U Inspection
This bid item is a unit price bid item and includes inspection and demolition of the existing
MW-2U wellhead facilities, including, but not limited to demolition of the traffic rated valve
box and concrete foundation, video surveillance of the well casing and appurtenant
equipment. This bid item shall be paid by lump sum and no addition compensation will be
made, therefore.
Bid Item 20 —Well MW-2U Wellhead Facilities
This bid item is a unit price bid item and includes construction of new wellhead facilities for
Well MW-2U and shall be full compensation for furnishing all labor, equipment and
materials to construct the new vault box and concrete foundation with bollards, inspection
and testing of the existing submersible pump. This bid item will be paid for by Lump Sum.
The quantity shown in the Proposal shall be included in each Bidder's proposal. This item
may be deleted entirely by Owner, if the Engineer determines that it is unnecessary. If the
item is deleted, no compensation will be made therefor. No costs shall be incurred
pertaining to this item unless directed by the Engineer. This item is excluded from the
adjustment of changed quantities as specified in Standard Specifications Section 9-1.06
Changed Quantity Payment Adjustments.
Contract Number 23-06-C 14
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
Bid Item 21 —Well MW-2U Decommissioning
This bid item is a unit price bid item and all labor, equipment and materials to
decommission Well MW-2U. This bid item shall be full compensation for furnishing labor,
equipment and materials to complete work as described herein, and no additional
compensation will be made, therefore. This bid item will be paid for by Lump Sum.
This item may be deleted entirely by Owner, if the Engineer determines that it is
unnecessary. If the item is deleted, no compensation will be made therefor. No costs shall
be incurred pertaining to this item unless directed by the Engineer. This item is excluded
from the adjustment of changed quantities as specified in Standard Specifications Section
9-1.06 Changed Quantity Payment Adjustments
Bid Item 22- PMW-2 Fence Removal and Replacement
A. This bid item includes demolishing two 8-ft sections of existing chain link fence and
replacing in kind and shall be full compensation for furnishing labor, equipment and
materials to complete work as described herein, and no additional compensation will be
made, therefore. This bid item will be paid for by lump sum.
Bid Item 23 — Supplemental Work
A. The Supplemental Work bid item is provided to compensate the Contractor for new and
unforeseen work necessary to construct the project as designed and intended.
Supplemental Work is not for design changes. Supplemental Work will be classed as extra
work in accordance with the provisions of Section 4-1.05, "Changes and Extra Work," of the
Standard Specifications. The dollar amount for supplemental work shown in the Proposal is
an estimate only, and shall be included in each bidder's proposal.
Supplemental work shall be performed only upon direct written authorization from the
Engineer and daily extra work reports shall be submitted to and approved by the Engineer.
The contractor shall maintain separate records for extra work performed in accordance with
the provisions of Section 5-1.27," Records," of the Standard Specifications and these
special provisions.
Payment will be based on the total amount of authorized Supplemental Work actually
performed. The provisions in Section 9-1.06, "Changed Quantity Pay Adjustments" of the
Standard Specifications shall not apply to the item "Supplemental Work."
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 15
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 26 13
REQUESTS FOR INFORMATION
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 SUMMARY
A. This Section includes administrative and procedural requirements for handling and
processing Requests for Information (RFI).
B. Requests for Information are intended for requesting clarification and information of
Contract Documents due to apparent inconsistencies, errors, or omissions in Contract
Documents, and due to unanticipated existing conditions.
C. An RFI which fails to comply with requirements of this section will be returned to Contractor
for correction without benefit of Design Engineer's response.
D. No extension of Contract Time will be granted due to Contractor's failure to transmit an RFI
to Design Engineer sufficiently in advance of Work to permit processing.
E. Owner reserves right to assess Contractor for costs of Design Engineer's response to an
RFI which Owner deems as being frivolous or unnecessary.
F. RFI form is provided at end of this section.
1.02 PROCEDURE
A. RFI's must use provided RFI form noted above and must indicate which drawings, details,
and specifications need clarification.
B. RFI must be explicit in what information is required.
C. Each submitted RFI must only address a single subject or issue; and shall be numbered in
sequence of submittal.
D. RFI's shall be submitted to Engineer at least 10 calendar days before a response is
needed.
E. Engineer will log each received RFI along with date of receipt and name of individual
submitting.
F. Design Engineer will provide written responses to RFI's within 5 working days.
1.03 RFI FORM
A. See next page.
Contract Number 23-06-C 16
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Center Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
RFI Transmittal
Submittal No.
Date:
PART 2 - FRESNO COUNTY JUVENILE JUSTICE CENTER
Fresno, California
To: From:
Co.. Co..
Issue Date:
Due Date:
WE ARE SENDING:
El Attached ❑ Enclosed ❑ Under Separate Cover Via:
THE FOLLOWING ITEMS:
Ll Submittals ❑ Product/Data ❑ Samples ❑ Plans ❑ Shop Drawings ❑ Copies
❑ Specifications ❑ Contract ❑ Other:
TRANSMITTED AS CHECKED BELOW:
For Approval ❑ For Review and Comment ❑ For Your Use ❑ Per Your Request
❑ Other:
Copies Spec Section Description of Product/Data Subcontractor/Supplier
REMARKS:
RESPONSE:
Contract Number 23-06-C 17
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 18
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 31 19
PROJECT MEETINGS
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 PRECONSTRUCTION CONFERENCE
A. Upon approval of Contract or at an earlier time if mutually agreeable, Engineer will arrange
a preconstruction conference to be attended by Contractor, Engineer, and representatives
of utilities, Owner and others involved in execution of the Work.
B. The purpose of this conference is to establish a working understanding between parties and
to discuss Construction Schedule, Critical Path Method format required, shop drawing
submittals and processing, applications for payment and their processing, and such other
subjects as may be pertinent for execution of the Work.
1.02 PROGRESS MEETINGS
A. Engineer will arrange and conduct progress meetings.
B. Conduct weekly, unless designated otherwise and be attended by Engineer, Contractor,
Contractor's superintendent, utilities, and others, which are active in execution of the Work.
C. The purpose of these meetings is to expedite work, address schedule, resolve conflicts,
and in general, coordinate and expedite execution of Work.
D. Agenda of progress meetings shall include review of:
1. Progress and schedule
2. Payment Requests
3. Construction Schedule update
4. Record documents
1.03 PROGRESS AND SCHEDULE REVIEW
A. Review progress of the Work and Construction Schedule to verify:
1. Actual start and finish dates of completed activities since last progress meeting.
2. Durations and progress of activities not completed.
3. Reason, time, and cost data for Change Order work that is to be incorporated into
Construction Schedule or payment request form.
4. Payment due to Contractor based on percentage complete of items in submitted
payment request.
5. Reasons for, and duration of, required revisions in Construction Schedule.
6. After each monthly update, Submit to the Owner electronically the last accepted
Construction Schedule, revised in accordance with monthly review.
1.04 REVIEW OF PAYMENT REQUEST
A. Contractor payment requests and other data required by Contract Documents completed
prior to progress meeting.
B. Engineer will process Contractor's payment request after satisfactory review of schedule
update.
Contract Number 23-06-C 19
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 20
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 33 00
SUBMITTALS
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 SUMMARY
A. Work described in this section includes general requirements and procedures related to
preparation and transmission of submittals to include Shop Drawings, Samples, Manuals,
and Record Drawings:
1.02 REFERENCES
A. Related Documents:
1. General Conditions
2. Individual equipment specifications
1.03 GENERAL
A. Before submitting a Shop Drawing or Sample:
1. Review and coordinate Shop Drawing or Sample with other Shop Drawings and
Samples and with requirements of the Work and Contract Documents.
2. Determine and verify field measurements, quantities, dimensions, specified
performance and design criteria, installation requirements, materials, catalog numbers,
and similar information with respect thereto.
3. Determine and verify suitability of materials and equipment offered with respect to
indicated application, fabrication, shipping, handling, storage, assembly, and
installation pertaining to performance of the Work.
4. Determine and verify information relative to Contractor's responsibilities for means,
methods, techniques, sequences, and procedures of construction, and safety
precautions and programs incident thereto.
B. Submit each submittal document under separate cover or transmittal. Transmittal must
include the following identification data, as applicable:
1. Contract number
2. Project name and location
3. Submittal number and revision
4. Product identification
5. Applicable contract drawing number, specification section, and paragraph number.
6. Stamp Space: Blank space of approximately 2-1/2 inches high by 4 inches wide
adjacent to identification data to receive Design Engineer's status stamp.
7. Contractor's certification statement as described below.
C. To each submittal affix the following signed Certification Statement.
1. "Certification Statement: By this submittal, we hereby represent that we have
determined and verified field measurements, field construction criteria, materials,
dimensions, catalog numbers and pertinent data and we have checked and
coordinated each item with other applicable approved drawings and Contract
requirements."
Contract Number 23-06-C 21
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
D. With each submittal, provide specific written notice of variations that Shop Drawing or
Sample may have from requirements of Contract Documents. This notice must be set forth
in a written communication separate from Shop Drawings or Sample submittal; and, in
addition, in case of Shop Drawings by a specific notation made on each Shop Drawing
submitted to Design Engineer for review and approval of each such variation.
E. Furnish neat, legible, and sufficiently explicit detail to enable proper review for Contract
compliance.
F. Contractor assumes risks of error and omission.
G. Work performed before approval, or not conforming to approved submittals, shall be at
Contractor's risk.
H. Submittal requirements contained in this specification are in addition to specific submittal
requirements contained in individual equipment specification sections.
I. Submit Submittals electronically.
1.04 REVIEW PROCESS
A. Submit Submittals in sufficient time to allow Design Engineer not less than 10 working days
for examining Shop Drawings and Samples. Design Engineer will provide review of Shop
Drawings and Samples in accordance with Schedule of Submittals acceptable to Design
Engineer. Design Engineer's review will be only to determine if items covered by submittals
will, after installation or incorporation in the Work, conform to information given in Contract
Documents and be compatible with design concept of completed Work as a functioning
whole as indicated by Contract Documents.
B. Design Engineer's review will not extend to means, methods, techniques, sequences, or
procedures of construction or to safety precautions or programs incidental thereto.
C. Design Engineer's review of a separate item as such will not indicate approval of assembly
in which the item functions.
D. Design Engineer's review of a Shop Drawing or Sample does not relieve Contractor from
responsibility for variation from requirements of Contract Documents unless Contractor has
given Design Engineer specific written notice of variations that Shop Drawing or Sample
may have from Contract Documents and Design Engineer has given written approval of
each such variation by specific written notation thereof incorporated in or accompanying
Shop Drawing or Sample. Design Engineer will document such approved variation from
requirements of Contract Documents in a Field Order.
E. Design Engineer's review of a Shop Drawing or Sample, or of a variation from requirements
of Contract Documents, does not change Contract Times or Contract Price, unless such
changes are included in a Change Order.
Contract Number 23-06-C 22
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
F. Submittals will be returned, marked with one of the following classifications:
1. NO EXCEPTIONS TAKEN: Accepted subject to its compatibility with further submittals
and additional partial submittals for portions of the work not covered in this submittal.
Does not constitute approval or deletion of specified or required items not indicated in
partial submittal.
2. MAKE CORRECTIONS NOTED: Same as 1, except that minor corrections as noted
will be made by Contractor. No re- submittal required.
3. REVISE AND RESUBMIT: Rejected because of major inconsistencies or errors which
will be resolved or corrected by Contractor prior to subsequent review by Design
Engineer. Re-submittal required.
4. SUBMIT SPECIFIED ITEM: Minor item in submittal missing or incomplete. Submit
data, specifications, drawings covering specified item only. Submittal will be referenced
to main submittal under review.
5. REJECTED: Submitted material does not conform to Plans and Specifications in major
respect, i.e.: wrong item, wrong size, model, capacity, or material. Re-submittal
required.
PART 2 - PRODUCTS
2.01 SHOP DRAWINGS
A. Unless otherwise noted in individual specification sections, submit electronically.
B. Mark catalog and specification sheets to indicate specific model number and configuration
to be used. Cross out items and sections not applicable to Work.
C. Show complete and detailed fabrication; assembly and installation details; wiring and
control diagrams; catalog data; pamphlets; descriptive literature; and performance and test
data.
D. Include calculations or other information sufficient to show comprehensive description of
structure, equipment, or system provided and its intended manner of use.
E. Include Manufacturer's installation recommendations.
2.02 SAMPLES
A. Unless otherwise noted in individual specification sections, submit three (3) samples of
each item.
B. Provide representative samples of material proposed for use in the Work and of sufficient
size to demonstrate design, color, texture, and finish.
C. Permanently attach to each sample
1. Contract Number
2. Project name and location
3. Product identification
4. Applicable contract drawing and specification section number.
5. Subcontractor's, vendor is and/or manufacturer's name, address, and telephone
number.
Contract Number 23-06-C 23
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
D. Certain samples may be tested for specific requirements by Owner and/or Design Engineer
prior to approval. Failure of sample to pass tests will be sufficient cause for refusal to
consider further samples of same brand and make.
E. Rejected samples will be returned upon request, and resubmittals will consist of new
samples.
2.03 RECORD DRAWINGS
A. Maintain one record copy of Contract Documents at site in good order and annotated to
show revisions made during construction. Keep annotations current during construction and
allow inspection.
B. Always make record drawings available during life of Contract.
2.04 DRAWINGS:
A. Contract Drawings: Annotate or redraft, to show revisions, substitutions, variations,
omissions, and discrepancies made or discovered during construction concerning location
and depth of utilities, piping, ductbanks, conduits, utility access holes, pumps, valves,
vaults, and other equipment.
B. Make revisions and show on drawing views with actual dimensions established to
permanent points.
C. Working/Layout Drawings: When required as submittals, record actual layouts of conduit
runs between distinct items of electrical equipment for power, control, and instrumentation;
wire sizes, numbers, and functions; configuration of conduits; piping layouts; and duct
layouts.
D. At completion of Contract and before final payment is made, furnish Engineer one set of
approved record drawings reflecting revisions herein described.
2.05 OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE MANUALS
A. Furnish Operation and Maintenance Manuals for distinct types of equipment and systems,
as required by Contract Documents. Provide Operation and Maintenance Manuals for
mechanical and electrical equipment. Unless otherwise indicated, furnish separate manual
for each piece of equipment and system. If manual contains other items or equipment,
indicate where specified items are located in manual. Include in manual complete
information necessary to operate, maintain, and repair specific equipment and system
furnished under this Contract, and include the following specific requirements.
B. Contents:
1. Table of Contents and Index.
2. Brief description of equipment/system and principal components.
3. Starting and stopping procedures, both normal and emergency.
4. Installation, maintenance, and overhaul instructions including detailed assembly
drawings with parts list and numbers, and recommended spare parts list with
recommended quantity, manufacturer's price, supplier's address, and telephone
number.
Contract Number 23-06-C 24
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
5. Recommended schedule for servicing, including technical data sheets that indicate
weights and types of oil, grease, or other lubricants recommended for use and their
application procedures.
6. One copy of each component wiring diagram and system wiring diagram showing wire
size and identification.
7. One reviewed and stamped copy of each submittal with changes made during
construction properly noted, including test certificates, characteristic curves, factory,
and field test results.
8. For electrical systems, include dimensioned installation drawings, single line diagrams,
control diagrams, wiring and connection diagrams, list of material for contactors, relays
and controls, outline drawings showing relays, meters, controls, and indication
equipment mounted on equipment or inside cubicles, control and protective
schematics, and recommended relay settings.
C. Material:
1. Covers: Oil, moisture, and wear resistant 9 inches by 11-1/2 inches size.
2. Pages: 60-pound paper 8-1/2 inches by 11 inches size with minimum of 2 punched
holes 8-1/2 inches apart reinforced with plastic, cloth, or metal.
3. Fasteners: Metal screw post or Acco metal strap type.
4. Diagrams and Illustrations: Attach foldouts.
D. Copies:
1. Submit preliminary copies of manuals for review and approval no later than date of
shipment of equipment. Do not begin Installation until manuals are accepted by Design
Engineer. Include in preliminary copies of items required under"Contents" above.
Copies will be marked and returned to Contractor.
2. Deliver up to 3 copies as required by Owner.
PART 3 - EXECUTION (NOT USED)
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 25
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 35 00
MATERIAL SUBMITTAL PROCEDURES
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 SUMMARY
A. Materials furnished and used must be new, unless otherwise specified in Contract
Documents.
B. Materials required to complete the work under this contract must be furnished by
Contractor, unless otherwise stated.
C. It will be the duty of Contractor to call Engineer's attention to apparent errors or omissions
and request instruction before proceeding with Work.
D. Engineer may, by appropriate instructions, correct said apparent errors and omissions,
which instructions will be as binding upon Contractor as though contained in original
Contract Documents.
1.02 DEFINITIONS
A. Substitutions: Requests for changes in products, materials, equipment, and methods of
construction required by Contract Documents proposed by Contractor.
B. Revisions: Changes to Contract Documents requested by Design Engineer.
C. Options: Specified options of products and construction methods included in Contract
Documents.
1.03 TRADE NAMES AND ALTERNATIVES
A. Wherever an article, or class of materials, is specified by trade name or by name of
particular patentee, manufacturer or dealer, or by reference to catalog of such manufacturer
or dealer, it shall be taken as intending to mean and specify article or material described or
other equal thereto in quality, finish and durability, and equally as serviceable for the
purpose for which it is or they are intended. The intent of the Plans and Specifications is to
specify highest grade standard equipment, and it is not the intent of these Plans and
Specifications to exclude or omit manufacturer products, if such products are equal in every
practical respect to those mentioned herein, as determined by Design Engineer.
1.04 SAMPLES
A. At the option of the Design Engineer, the source of supply of materials for the Work may be
subject to tests and inspection before the delivery is started and before such materials are
used in the Work.
B. Samples representative of the character and quality of materials must be submitted.
Samples must be of sufficient quantities or amounts for testing or examination.
C. Tests of materials furnished by Contractor must be made in accordance with the commonly
recognized standards of national technical organizations, and such special methods and
tests as are prescribed in Contract Documents.
Contract Number 23-06-C 26
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
D. Furnish samples of materials as requested by the Design Engineer, without charge. No
material will be used until the Design Engineer has had the opportunity to test or examine
such materials. Samples will be secured and tested whenever necessary to determine the
quality of the material. Samples and test specimens prepared at the jobsite, such as
concrete test cylinders, may be taken or prepared by the Design Engineer, in the presence
and with the assistance of Contractor.
1.05 SUBMITTALS
A. Submit material submittals in accordance with State Standard Specifications Section 5-1.23
and Section 01 33 00 "Submittals".
1.06 INSPECTION OF MATERIALS BY CONTRACTOR
A. Inspect materials as delivered and promptly return defective materials without waiting for
their rejection by the Engineer/Design Engineer.
1.07 CERTIFICATES OF COMPLIANCE
A. A Certificate of Compliance may be required for certain materials and equipment that
become final products of the completed Work.
B. Furnish Certificates of Compliance prior to the use of materials for which these
Specifications require that such a certificate be furnished.
C. When authorized in these Specifications, the Engineer may permit the use of certain
materials or assemblies prior to sampling and testing if accompanied by a Certificate of
Compliance.
D. The Certificate shall be signed by the manufacturer of the material or the manufacturer of
assembled materials and state that the materials involved comply in respects with the
requirements of the Specifications.
E. Furnish a Certificate of Compliance with each lot of material delivered to the Work and the
lot clearly identified in the certificate.
F. Materials used based on a Certificate of Compliance may be sampled and tested at any
time. Certificates of Compliance will not relieve Contractor of responsibility for incorporating
material in the Work which conforms to the requirements of the Plans and Specifications
and material not conforming to such requirements will be subject to rejection whether in
place or not.
G. Owner reserves the right to refuse to permit the use of material based on a Certificate of
Compliance.
H. The form of the Certificate of Compliance and its disposition shall be as directed by the
Design Engineer.
Contract Number 23-06-C 27
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
I. Manufacturer Testing:
1. At the option of the Design Engineer, materials, and equipment to be supplied under
this Contract will be tested and inspected either at their place of origin or at the site of
the Work.
2. Provide Design Engineer written notification well in advance of actual readiness of
materials and equipment to be tested and inspected at point of origin.
3. Satisfactory tests and inspections at the point of origin will not be construed as a final
acceptance of the materials and equipment nor shall such tests and inspections
preclude retesting or re-inspection at the site of the Work.
4. Materials and equipment which will require testing and inspection at the place of origin
must not be shipped prior to such testing and inspection.
1.08 MANUFACTURERS' RECOMMENDATIONS
A. Equipment specified and used in the Work must be installed in accordance with the
approved manufacturer's current written recommendations.
B. Equipment, material, etc., shall be of the manufacturer's latest system or line.
1.09 SUBSTITUTIONS
A. Conditions: Contractor's substitutions will be considered when one or more conditions are
satisfied, as determined by the Design Engineer. Contractor's submittal and Design
Engineer's acceptance of Shop Drawings, Product Data or Samples that relate to
construction activities not complying with Contract Documents does not constitute an
acceptable or valid request for substitution, nor does it constitute approval.
B. Extensive revisions to Contract Documents are not required.
C. Proposed changes are in keeping with the general intent of Contract Documents.
D. Request is timely, fully documented and properly submitted.
E. Request is related to an "or equal" clause or similar language in Contract Documents.
F. The specified product or method of construction cannot be provided within Contract Time.
The request will not be considered if the product or method cannot be provided because of
failure to pursue the Work promptly or coordinate activities properly.
G. The specified product or method of construction cannot receive necessary approval by
governing authority, and the requested substitution can.
H. Substantial advantage is offered the Owner, in terms of cost, time, energy conservation or
other considerations of merit, after deducting offsetting responsibilities the Owner may be
required to bear.
I. Additional responsibilities for the Owner may include additional compensation to the Design
Engineer for redesign and evaluation services, increased cost of other construction by the
Owner or separate Contractors, and similar considerations.
J. Contractor shall provide data in support of proposed substitute or "or-equal" at Contractor's
expense.
Contract Number 23-06-C 28
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
K. Specified product or method of construction cannot be provided in a manner that is
compatible with other materials, and where Contractor certifies that the substitution will
overcome the incompatibility.
L. Specified product or method of construction cannot be coordinated with other materials,
and where Contractor certifies that the proposed substitution can be coordinated.
M. Specified product or method of construction cannot provide a warranty required by Contract
Documents and where Contractor certifies that the proposed substitution provide the
required warranty.
1.10 SUBSTITUTION REQUEST FORM
A. Use Substitution Request Form at the end of this Section.
B. Submit one form electronically for each request.
Contract Number 23-06-C 29
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SUBSTITUTION REQUEST FORM
Page 1 of 2
TO:
PROJECT:
We hereby submit for your consideration the following product instead of the specified item for the above project:
SECTION: PARAGRAPH: SPECIFIED ITEM:
Proposed Substitution:
Attach: 1) Complete technical data, including laboratory tests, if applicable.
2) Complete information on changes to Drawings and/or Specifications which proposed
substitution will require for its proper installation.
Does the substitution affect dimensions on Drawings?
Will the undersigned pay for changes to the project design, including engineering and detailing costs
caused by the requested substitution?
What affect does substitution have on other trades?
Differences between proposed substitution and specified item?
Manufacturer's guarantees of the proposed and specified items are:
Same Different(explain on attached sheet)
Contract Number 23-06-C 30
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SUBSTITUTION REQUEST FORM
Page 2 of 2
The undersigned states that the function, appearance,and quality are equivalent or superior to the specified item.
Submitted By:
Signature
Firm
Address
Date
Telephone
For Use by Design Consultant
Accepted
Accepted as Noted
Not Accepted Received Late
By:
Date:
Remarks:
Contract Number 23-06-C 31
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 32
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 42 13
DEFINITIONS AND ABBREVIATIONS
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 DEFINITIONS AND TERMS
A. If these definitions conflict with the definitions is section 1-1.07, the definitions in section 1-
1.07 shall prevail.
B. Whenever in these Specifications, or in other Contract Documents, the following terms are
used, the intent and meaning shall be interpreted as follows:
1. Board: Board of Directors, Fresno County.
2. Contractor: The word "Contractor" means the person, firm, or corporation to whom the
award is made. Subcontractors as such will not be recognized.
3. Contract Price: The total amount of money for which Contract is awarded.
4. Contract Unit Price: Contractor's original bid for a single unit of an item of work in the
Proposal.
5. Contract Time: The number of calendar days for completion of the Work, including
authorized time extensions. In the event a calendar date is specified for the Work
completion in lieu of a number of calendar days, the Work shall be completed by that
calendar date. Contract Time shall be computed by excluding the first and including the
last day; and if the last day be Sunday or a legal holiday, which shall be excluded.
6. Day: Each day indicated on the calendar. Used interchangeably with calendar days.
7. Design Engineer: Consultant Engineer, Consultant Geologist, Design Engineer of
Record and/or designee
8. Equipment: (Construction) -Machinery and equipment, together with the necessary
supplies for upkeep and maintenance, and tools and apparatus necessary for the
proper construction and acceptable completion of work. (Installed) M material or
articles used in equipping a facility as furnishings or apparatus to fulfill a functional
design.
9. General Conditions: As specified in Section 00 72 00 "General Conditions".
10. General Requirements: Specifications contained in Division 1.
11. Notice: Notices allowed or required to be given by the Owner may be given by Design
Engineer.
12. Owner: Fresno County and/or Designee including Engineer.
13. Person: Individuals, associations, partnerships, corporations, trusts, joint ventures, or
other legal entity.
14. Plans: Drawings, profiles, cross-sections, working drawings and supplemental
drawings, or reproduction thereof, approved by the Design Engineer, which show the
location, character, dimensions, or details of the work.
15. Proposal: The offer of a Bidder when submitted on the Proposal form; properly signed
and guaranteed.
16. Reference Documents: Bulletins, Rules, Methods of Analysis or Test, Codes,
Standards, and Specifications of public or private agencies, Engineer Societies, or
Industrial Associations. Reference shall be to the latest edition thereof, including
Amendments, which are in effect and published at the time the Request for Bids is
issued, unless a specific edition is identified, in which case reference shall be to such
specific edition. Reference Documents are intended to amplify the descriptions of
materials, equipment, and construction systems and are to be considered a part of
Contract Documents as far as the various sections thereof are referred to. Examples of
Contract Number 23-06-C 33
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
Reference Documents are Federal Specifications, State Standard Specifications, and
those of American Society of Testing Materials (ASTM), American National Standards
Institute (ANSI), American Standards Associations (ASA), and American Concrete
Institute (ACI).
17. Salvage: The protection storage, and/or removal of specified existing equipment, parts,
or materials during the work for retention and later use by the Owner.
18. Sanitary Sewer: Conduits and appurtenances intended for the reception and transfer of
sewage.
19. Specifications: Specifications defined in this section and addendums thereof. They are
divided into three categories:
a. Contract and Bidding Requirements
b. Special Provisions: General Provisions and General Construction (Division I and II,
State Standard Specifications)
c. Technical Specifications: General Requirements (Division 1), (Division 33), and
Reference Documents
20. State: The State of California.
21. State Standard Plans: State of California, Business and Transportation Agency,
Department of Transportation, Caltrans, Standard Plans, latest revision.
22. State Standard Specifications: Standard Specifications for the Work are those entitled
"State Standard Specifications, State of California, Business and Transportation
Agency, Department of Transportation," 2015 edition, referred to as the "State
Standard Specifications". These Specifications are to be considered a part of the
Contract Documents as far as they are not superseded by other provisions contained
in Divisions 0 through 2 and 33 of these Specifications.
23. Storm Sewer: Conduit and appurtenances intended for the reception and transfer of
storm water.
24. Street: Public Road, highway, parkway, freeway, alley, walk or right-of-way.
25. Surety: Individuals, firms or corporations bound with and for Contractor for the
acceptable performance, execution, and completion of the Work, and for the
satisfaction of obligations incurred.
26. Utility: Tracks, overhead of underground wires, pipelines, conduits, ducts or structures,
sewers of storm drains owned, operated, or maintained in or across a public right-of-
way or private easement.
27. Water Main: Conduit and appurtenances intended for the distribution of water.
28. Working Day: Weekdays (Monday through Friday), not a designated national holiday,
during which weather allows Contractor to work four or more hours consecutively,
starting no later than 10:00 AM.
1.02 REFERENCED STANDARDS
A. The standards referred to, except as modified, shall have full force and effect as though
printed in this Specification, and shall be the latest edition or revision thereof in effect on the
bid opening date, unless a particular edition or issue is indicated. Copies of these standards
are not available from the Owner. The Engineer will furnish, upon request, information as to
how copies may be obtained.
Contract Number 23-06-C 34
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
1.03 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS
A. Abbreviations and terms, or pronouns in place of them, shall be interpreted as follows:
1. AA Aluminum Association
2. AABC Associated Air Balance Council
3. AAMA Architectural Aluminum Manufacturers Association
4. AASHTO American Association of State Highway and Transportation Officials
5. ABMA American Boiler Manufacturers Association
6. ACI American Concrete Institute
7. ACPA American Concrete Pipe Association
8. ADC Air Diffusion Council
9. AEIC Association of Edison Illuminating Companies
10. AFBMA Antifriction Bearing Manufacturers Association
11. AGA American Gas Association
12. AGMA American Gear Manufacturers Association
13. AHA American Hardboard Association
14. Al Asphalt Institute
15. AIA American Institute of Architects
16. AISC American Institute of Steel Construction
17. AISI American Iron and Steel Institute
18. AITC American Institute of Timber Construction
19. AMCA Air Moving and Conditioning Association
20. ANSI American National Standards Institute
21. APA American Plywood Association
22. API American Petroleum Institute
23. APWA American Public Works Association
24. ARI American Refrigeration Institute
25. ASA (now U.S.A.S.I., USA Standards Institute) Association & its Standard
Specifications
26. ASAHC American Society of Architectural Hardware Consultants
27. ASCE American Society of Civil Engineers
28. ASHRAE American Society of Heating, Refrigerating, and Air-Conditioning
Engineers ASME American Society of Mechanical Engineers
29. ASSE American Society of Sanitary Engineers
30. ASTM American Society for Testing and Materials
31. AWG American Wire Gage
32. AWI Architectural Woodwork Institute
33. AWPA American Wood-Preservers' Association
34. AWS American Welding Society
35. AWWA American Water Works Association
36. BHMA Builders Hardware Manufacturers Association
37. BIA Brick Institute of America (formerly SCPI)
38. CAL/OSHA California Occupational Safety and Health Administration
39. CALTRANS California Department of Transportation
40. CBC California Building Code
41. CCR California Codes of Regulations
42. CDA Copper Development Association
43. CEC California Electrical Code
44. CEQA California Environmental Quality Act
45. CFR Code of Federal Regulations
Contract Number 23-06-C 35
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
46. CISPI Cast Iron Soil Pipe Institute
47. CMAA Crane Manufacturers Association of America
48. CMC California Mechanical Code
49. CPC California Plumbing Code
50. CRA California Redwood Association
51. CRSI Concrete Reinforcing Steel Institute
52. CS Commercial Standard (U.S. Department of Commerce)
53. DHI Door and Hardware Institute
54. DIPRA Ductile Iron Pipe Research Association
55. EEI Edison Electric Institute
56. EJCDC Engineers' Joint Contract Documents Committee
57. EP Edge of pavement
58. EPA Environmental Protection Agency
59. FED SPEC Federal Specification
60. FCI Fluid Controls Institute
61. FGMA Flat Glass Marketing Association
62. FIA Factory Insurance Association
63. FM Factory Mutual
64. FSA Fluid Sealing Association
65. FTI Facing Tile Institute
66. HEI Heat Exchange Institute
67. HMI Hoist Manufacturers Institute
68. HPMA Hardwood Plywood Manufacturers Association
69. HTI Hand Tools Institute
70. ICBO International Conference of Building Officials
71. I-B-R Institute of Boiler and Radiator Manufacturers
72. IEEE Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers
73. IES Illuminating Engineering Society
74. IFI Industrial Fasteners Institute
75. IPCEA Insulated Power Cable Engineers Association
76. ISA Instrument Society of America
77. JIC Joint International Conference (Hydraulic Institute)
78. MHI Materials Handling Institute
79. MIL Military Specification
80. MMA Monorail Manufacturers Association
81. MSS Manufacturers' Standardization Society
82. NAAMM National Association of Architectural Metals Manufacturers
83. NACE National Association of Corrosion Engineers.
84. MBBPVI National Board of Boiler and Pressure Vessel Inspectors
85. NBHA National Builders Hardware Association
86. NCSPA National Corrugated Steel Pipe Association
87. NEC National Electrical Code
88. NECA National Electrical Contractors Association
89. NEMA National Electrical Manufacturers Association
Contract Number 23-06-C 36
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
90. NEMI National Elevator Manufacturing Industry
91. NFPA National Fire Protection Association
92. NIST National Institute of Standards and Technology
93. NLA National Lime Association
94. NPC National Plumbing Code
95. NPT National Pipe Thread
96. NRCA National Roofing Contractors' Association
97. NRMCA National Ready Mixed Concrete Association
98. NSC National Safety Council
99. NSF National Sanitation Foundation
100.NTMA National Terrazzo and Mosaic Association
101.NWMA National Woodwork Manufacturers Association
102.OSHA Occupational Safety and Health Administration
103.PCA Portland Cement Association
104.PC1 Prestressed Concrete Institute
105.PD1 Plumbing and Drainage Institute
106.PF1 Pipe Fabrication Institute
107.PS Product Standard
108.RT1 Resilient Tile Institute (formerly AVATI)
109.SAE Society of Automotive Engineers
110.SCPRF Structural Clay Products Research Foundation
111.S1 International Systems of Units (Metric)
112.SIGMA Sealed Insulating Glass Manufacturers Association
113.SFPA Southern Forest Products Association
114.SJ1 Steel Joist Institute
115.SMA Screen Manufacturers Association
116.SMACNA Sheet Metal and Air Conditioning Contractors National Association
117.SPFA Steel Plate Fabricators Association
118.SP1 Society of the Plastics Industry
119.SPTA Southern Pressure Treaters Association
120.SS1 Scaffolding and Shoring Institute
121.SSPC Steel Structures Painting Council
122.SSPWC Standard Specifications for Public Works Construction (Greenbook)
123.UL Underwriters' Laboratories
124.UPC Uniform Plumbing Code
125.USBR U.S. Bureau of Reclamation
126.USGS United States Geological Survey
127.WCLA West Coast Lumbermen's Association (Std. Grading and Dressing Rule)
128.WCL1B West Coast Lumber Inspection Bureau
129.WIC Woodwork Institute of California
130.WPCP Water Pollution Control Plan
131.WR1 Wire Reinforcement Institute, Inc.
132.WWPA Western Wood Products Association
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 37
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 43 00
QUALITY CONTROL AND TESTING
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 NOTICE OF DEFECTS
A. Prompt notice of defective Work of which Owner or Design Engineer has knowledge will be
given to Contractor.
B. Defective Work may be rejected, corrected, or accepted, at the discretion of the Owner and
Design Engineer.
1.02 ACCESS TO WORK
A. Owner, Engineer, their consultants and other representatives and personnel of Owner,
independent testing laboratories, and governmental agencies with jurisdictional interests
shall have access to the Site and the Work at reasonable times for their observation,
inspecting, and testing. Contractor shall provide them proper and safe conditions for such
access and advise them of Contractor's Site safety procedures and programs so that they
may comply therewith.
1.03 MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENT
A. Materials and equipment will be subject to the requirements of Section 01 35 00 "Materials
Submittal Procedures".
1.04 WORK SITE TESTING
A. Provide Engineer timely notice of readiness of the Work for required inspections, tests, or
approvals and shall cooperate with inspection and testing personnel to facilitate required
inspections or tests.
B. Except for specified material suitability tests, initial routine tests of materials will be at the
expense of the Owner and will be performed by an independent certified laboratory
designated by the Owner. Whenever a specified percent relative compaction test is
required and the material or portion thereof so tested fails to meet or exceed the relative
compaction specified, subsequent retesting will be performed at the expense of Contractor.
C. Material suitability tests will be at the expense of Contractor. Testing will be by an
independent certified laboratory approved by the Design Engineer.
1.05 TEST STANDARDS
A. Sampling, specimen preparation, and testing of materials must be in accordance with the
standards of nationally recognized technical organizations.
B. The physical characteristics of materials not particularly specified must conform to the latest
standards published by the ASTM, where applicable.
Contract Number 23-06-C 38
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
1.06 UNCOVERING WORK
A. If Work (or the work of others) that is to be inspected, tested, or approved is covered by
Contractor without concurrence of Engineer, it must, if requested by Engineer, be
uncovered for Engineer's observation, and recovered at Contractor's expense.
B. If Engineer considers it necessary or advisable that covered Work be re-observed by
Engineer or inspected or tested by others, Contractor, at Engineer's request, must uncover,
expose, or otherwise make available for observation, inspection, or testing as Engineer may
require, that portion of the Work in question, furnishing necessary labor, material, and
equipment.
C. If it is found that the uncovered Work is defective, Contractor must promptly correct said
defects, including work involved in uncovering and recovering the work, at no cost to the
Owner.
D. If, the uncovered Work is not found to be defective, Contractor will be allowed an increase
in Contract Price or an extension of Contract Times, or both, directly attributable to such
uncovering, exposure, observation, inspection, testing, replacement, and reconstruction.
1.07 CORRECTION OR REMOVAL OF DEFECTIVE OR REJECTED WORK
A. Upon receipt of notice, Contractor must correct defective or rejected Work and replace it
with Work that is not defective, at no cost to the Owner.
1.08 ACCEPTANCE OF DEFECTIVE WORK
A. If, instead of requiring correction or removal and replacement of defective Work, Owner
prefers to accept it, Owner may do so.
B. If acceptance occurs, a Change Order will be issued incorporating the necessary revisions
in Contract Documents with respect to the Work, and Owner shall be entitled to an
appropriate decrease in Contract Price, reflecting the diminished value of Work so
accepted.
C. Engineer will determine the reasonableness of the diminished value of Work so accepted
and Contractor shall pay costs involved in making such determination.
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 39
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 50 00
TEMPORARY FACILITIES
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 GENERAL
A. Provide temporary facilities and utilities required for completion of the Work as well as
safety precautions and programs. No attempt is made to set out in detail Contractor's
means or methods necessary to accomplish the tasks involved.
1.02 TEMPORARY UTILITIES
A. Water
1. Water used for human consumption shall be kept free from contamination and shall
conform to the requirements of the State and local authorities for potable water.
B. Sanitary Facilities
1. Provide suitable and adequate sanitary conveniences for the staff at the site of the
Work. Conveniences must include chemical toilets or water closets and shall be
located at appropriate locations at the site of the Work. Sanitary conveniences must
conform to the regulations of the public authority having jurisdiction over such matters.
At the completion of the Work, such sanitary conveniences must be removed, and the
site left in a sanitary condition.
2. Cooperate with and follow directions of representatives of the Public Health Service
and the State. State and County Public Health Service representatives must have
access to the Work, whether it is in preparation or progress.
1.03 TEMPORARY CONSTRUCTION FACILITIES
A. Construction hoists, shoring, and similar temporary facilities must be of ample size and
capacity to support and move the loads to which they will be subjected. Railings,
enclosures, safety devices, and controls required by law or for adequate protection of life
and property shall be provided.
B. Temporary supports must be designed with an adequate safety factor to assure adequate
load bearing capability.
C. Submit design calculations prepared by a professional registered engineer for staging and
shoring prior to application of loads.
D. Barriers must be placed at each end of excavations and at such places as may be
necessary along excavations to warn pedestrian and vehicular traffic of such excavations
from one hour before sunset each calendar day to one hour after sunrise of the next
calendar day until such excavation is entirely refilled, compacted, and paved.
E. Excavations must be barricaded in such a manner as to prevent person from falling,
walking, or otherwise entering excavation in street, roadway, parking lot, treatment plant, or
other area, public or private.
F. Identify and guard hazardous areas and conditions by visual warning devices and, where
necessary, physical barriers. Devices must at minimum, conform to the requirements of
Cal/OSHA.
Contract Number 23-06-C 40
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
G. At such time or times temporary construction facilities and utilities are no longer required for
the work, notify the Engineer of intent and schedule for removal of the temporary facilities
and utilities, and obtain the Engineer's approval before removing the same.
H. Remove the temporary facilities and utilities from the site as their property and leave the
site in such condition as specified, as directed by the Engineer, and/or as indicated on the
Plans.
1.04 ACCESS ROADS AND STAGING AREA
A. Maintain adequate access to storage areas and other areas to which frequent access is
required.
B. Limit the location of storage of equipment and materials outside of the Work site.
C. Contractor must plan for space that may be required and bear associated costs.
D. Contractor must provide temporary storage required for the protection of equipment and
materials as recommended by manufacturers of such materials.
E. Storage and protection:
1. Materials and equipment must be stored in accordance with supplier's written
instructions, with seals and labels intact and legible. Exposed metal surfaces of valves,
fittings and similar materials shall be coated with accordance with manufacturer's
recommendations to prevent corrosion.
2. Storage must be arranged to provide access for inspection.
3. Periodically inspect to assure materials and equipment are undamaged and are
maintained under required conditions.
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 41
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 57 50
CONSTRUCTION STAKES, LINES AND GRADES
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 LINES AND GRADE
A. The Work must be executed in accordance with the lines and grades indicated in Contract
Documents.
B. Distances and measurements, except elevations and structural dimensions, will be made
on horizontal planes.
1.02 OWNER'S SURVEY SERVICES
A. Construction surveying and staking for construction will be done by the Engineer or
Engineer's representative at the Owner's expense. The Engineer will provide one set of
staking indicating the location of each well prior to Contractor mobilization to each well.
B. Additional detail staking layout will be the responsibility of Contractor.
C. Contractor will be responsible for preserving construction survey stakes, permanent survey
monuments and benchmarks for the duration of their usefulness. If construction survey
stakes, permanent survey monuments or benchmarks are lost or disturbed and need to be
replaced, such replacement shall be made by the Engineer at the expense of Contractor.
D. Notify the Engineer at least 3 working days before survey services are required in
connection with laying out of any portion of the Work.
E. Dig holes necessary for line and grade stakes prior to requesting survey services that
depend on such digging.
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 42
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 01 77 00
CONTRACT CLOSEOUT
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 SUMMARY
A. It is the intent of these Contract Documents that Contractor will deliver a complete and
operable facility capable of performing its intended functions and ready for use.
1.02 CLEANING
A. Keep worksite free and clean of rubbish and debris, and promptly remove from the site, or
from property adjacent to the site of the Work, unused and rejected materials, surplus earth,
concrete, plaster, and debris, excepting select material which may be required for refilling or
grading.
1.03 FINAL SITE CLEAN-UP
A. Upon completion of the Work, and prior to final acceptance, remove from the vicinity of the
Work paint, surplus material, and equipment belonging to Contractor or used under
Contractor's direction during construction.
B. Restore property not designated for alteration by these Contract Documents to original
condition.
1.04 FINAL BUILDING CLEAN-UP
A. On building projects and wherever else applicable, besides general broom cleaning, the
following special cleaning shall be performed at completion of the Work:
1. Putty stains and paint must be removed from glass; glass must be washed and
polished, inside, and outside. Care must be exercised so as not to scratch glass.
2. Marks, stains, fingerprints, and other soil and dirt must be removed from painted,
decorated, or stained work.
3. Waxed woodwork must be cleaned and polished.
4. Hardware must be cleaned and polished of traces; this includes removal of stains,
dust, dirt, paints, and blemishes.
5. Spots, soil, paint, plaster, and concrete must be removed from tile; tile work must be
washed afterwards.
6. Fixtures and equipment must be cleaned, and stains, paint, dirt, and dust must be
removed.
7. Temporary floor protection must be removed; floors must be cleaned, waxed, and
buffed.
8. Dust, cobwebs, and traces of insects and dirt must be removed.
1.05 WASTE DISPOSAL
A. Dispose of surplus materials, waste products, demolition materials, and debris.
B. Transport and dispose of waste materials in accordance with applicable laws and
regulations.
Contract Number 23-06-C 43
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
1.06 RECORD DOCUMENTS
A. Furnish and maintain at the site, available to the Owner and Engineer, one copy of Contract
Documents, Drawings, Shop Drawings, Change Orders, and other modifications in good
order and annotated to show changes made during construction. These Documents shall
be delivered to the Engineer for the Owner upon completion of the Work.
B. Record documents must be reviewed during progress meetings to ascertain that changes
have been recorded.
C. Store Record Documents separate from documents used for construction.
1.07 TOUCH-UP AND REPAIR
A. Touch-up or repair finished surfaces on structures, equipment, fixtures, or installations that
have been damaged prior to final acceptance. Surfaces on which such touch-up or repair
cannot be successfully accomplished must be completely refinished or in the case of
hardware and similar small items, the item shall be replaced. Items shall include, but not be
limited to, the following:
1. Road surfaces
2. Exposed structure surfaces
3. Exposed equipment surfaces
4. Exposed piping surfaces
1.08 EQUIPMENT START-UP
A. After acceptance tests have been completed by Contractor and Owner but prior to final
acceptance, Contractor shall recheck equipment for proper alignment and adjustment,
check oil levels, re-lubricate bearings and wearing points, and in general assure that
equipment is in proper condition for continuous operation.
1.09 OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE (O&M) MANUALS
A. See Section 01 33 00 "Submittals" for Operation and Maintenance Manuals.
1.10 FINAL EQUIPMENT CHECK
A. After testing and before acceptance, equipment will be test run by the Owner for a minimum
of 7 calendar days to ensure proper operation. At the end of the test run each piece of
machinery shall be lubricated and components and couplings checked for proper alignment
and adjustment.
B. Submit written certification that Contract Documents have been reviewed, Work has been
inspected, and that Work is complete in accordance with Contract Documents and ready for
Engineer's inspection.
C. Provide submittals to the Owner required by other governing authorities.
1.11 MANUFACTURER'S CERTIFICATES OF PROPER INSTALLATION
A. Submit manufacturers' certificates of proper installation for items of equipment.
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 44
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 33 24 13
MONITORING WELL CONSTRUCTION, DEVELOPMENT & DECONSTRUCTION
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 WORK INCLUDED
A. The work consists of, in general, constructing three monitoring wells.
B. Upon completion of construction of each monitoring well, develop the well as described in
these Specifications. Contractor will supply equipment and labor for well development.
1.02 DEFINITIONS
A. Geologist: Professional geologist retained by Owner who will monitor construction of the
wells and prepare geologic logs.
B. Driller or Contractor: The person or persons, co-partnership, or corporation, private or
municipal, who have entered a contract with the Owner as party or parties of the second
part, or their legal representative.
1.03 SUBMITTAL REQUIREMENTS
A. Well Information: Prepare and submit at a minimum, the following information for each
monitoring well.
1. Well Completion Report showing the location of the well, casing diameter and wall
thickness, lengths and locations of casing installed, type of perforation and slot size,
perforated interval(s), borehole diameter, gradation of filter pack, location of fine sand,
annular seals, and other pertinent information found on State Well Completion Reports.
2. Development records showing duration and volume of water pumped, and other
pertinent information concerning development by pumping.
3. Manufacturer's or supplier's standard literature and certification that the following
materials for the monitoring well comply with this specification (to be submitted before
well construction):
a. Blank Well Casing
b. Perforated Well Casing
c. Filter Pack
d. Annular Seal Material
B. Drilling plan including drill rig to be used, water disposal method and excavation disposal
method.
C. Discussions on problems, unique circumstances or other issues worthy of discussions that
were encountered during drilling and construction.
D. PDF of the Well Completion Reports must be submitted to the Owner prior to acceptance.
E. An edited well video recording in electronic format (.mp4 or equal) completed for each new
well and one existing well. Files shall be uploaded to an accessible site for the County to
download.
Contract Number 23-06-C 45
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
1.04 STANDARDS AND PERMITS
A. Monitoring wells must be drilled in accordance with the Fresno County Water Well Permit,
the California Water Well Standards, and as described in the Plans and these
Specifications.
B. Obtain and pay for well drilling permits from Fresno County Health Department and report
the results of the drilling to the California Department of Water Resources.
C. Contractor will not be allowed to mobilize or perform drilling until they have provided the
Owner with copies of required permits. Contractor will not be reimbursed for work
performed without the required permits.
D. Contractor must be available and present for a final well inspection by Owner if they so
choose to inspect the constructed wells.
E. Contact Underground Service Alert (USA) to mark the proposed well locations for
underground utilities.
F. Verify that there are no utilities in the vicinity of the areas to be drilled.
G. Mark an area at least 50 feet by 50 feet for USA to mark, or more if the site conditions
require or there is reasonable potential that the well location may later be moved.
Contractor will not be permitted to mobilize for construction until copies of the USA tickets
are provided to the Engineer.
H. Contact Fresno County Health Department at least 48 hours prior to well drilling.
1.05 EXPERIENCE AND LICENSE
A. Contractor must be a licensed C-57 well driller. License must be current and valid in the
State of California.
B. Contractor must have completed at least 4 projects in the last 3 years in drilling
groundwater monitoring wells to a depth of at least 200 feet using sonic-drilling rigs for
groundwater monitoring wells.
C. Submit 3 references for completed drilling work meeting the minimum experience
requirements specified herein, involving the use of sonic-drilling rigs for the drilling of
groundwater monitoring wells to a depth of at least 200 feet.
1. In listing these references, provide the name of the person or entity for whom such
work was performed, the address and telephone number at which that person or entity
can be contacted, and a satisfactorily detailed description of the work performed.
1.06 EQUIPMENT REQUIREMENTS
A. Drilling equipment and soil samples will be thoroughly washed with a solution containing
Liquinox®, or steam- cleaned, rinsed with distilled water, and air-dried immediately prior to
use on site to prevent the introduction of contamination from another source. If equipment
needs to be steam-cleaned on site, it will be cleaned in a designated area prior to reuse.
Contract Number 23-06-C 46
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
1.07 ORDER OF WORK
A. Contact Underground Service Alert (USA) and obtain a valid ticket number listing Fresno
County as the company providing oversight, the drilling contractor, the boring locations, and
other pertinent information. The USA ticket shall be available during field activities
associated with ground disturbance. The ticket must be updated and re-validated.
B. If a staked location is found unsuitable by Contractor, the Engineer/Design Engineer must
visit and verify new well locations before Contractor can re-contact USA or begin drilling.
C. Construction of a monitoring well shall not proceed until Design Engineer/Geologist has
made final recommendation of construction details.
D. Construction of the monitoring wells shall occur as specified in Section 01 11 00
"Description of Work and Schedule Constraints" Part 1.5 of these specifications.
1.08 WORK TO BE PERFORMED BY CONTRACTOR
A. Contact Underground Service Alert (USA) no less than two full working days prior to drilling
to verify that the staked well locations are not within the path of buried utilities.
B. Immediately notify the Engineer and the Utility owner if a utility is disturbed, disrupted, or
damaged. No extra compensation will be made for the repair of services or mains damaged
by Contractor.
C. Contact Fresno County Health Department 48-hours prior to drilling at site.
D. Drilling, casing, gravel packing, sealing, airlifting, and other work incidental to the
monitoring wells will be performed by Contractor. The drilling must be performed using
sonic technology.
E. Prepare and maintain access to the work area as well as provide sufficient room for the
efficient operation of their equipment.
F. For security and safety, Contractor shall provide temporary fencing to enclose the work
area and stored equipment. Contractor will be held as having examined the drilling site and
access roads to acquaint themselves with local conditions, as no allowance will be made
after contract has been awarded for errors or omissions made by Contractor due to site
conditions.
G. Pursue work to completion. Upon completion and development of each monitoring well,
Contractor shall level the drill site, and remove materials incidental to the drilling operations.
H. At the end of each workday, take reasonable measures to clean and level the work site to
limit visual impacts.
I. Furnish equipment, material, supplies, and personnel necessary to perform the work
(including, but not limited to drilling rig, water truck, a crew comprised of experienced
drillers, and helpers).
J. Contractor must pay federal, local, or state taxes assessed or levied on account thereof, in
accordance with the practices acceptable for the nature of work to be performed under this
Contract.
Contract Number 23-06-C 47
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
K. The entire cost of furnishing, transporting, unloading, hauling, handling, sorting, and caring
for equipment, materials, tools, and supplies, and of removing same from the site of the
work as specified, must be included in prices bid in the proposal for the work for which the
materials are required. The drilling must be done with well drilling equipment of proper type
and size and in good working condition so that the work can be performed without
interruption arising from defective or improper equipment. Equipment, materials, tools, and
supplies not a part of the completed monitoring well shall remain the property of Contractor
and must be removed from the site upon completion of the work. Materials to be stored
shall be stored at the drilling site within a fenced enclosure, or other suitable arrangement.
L. Notify the Engineer immediately if quantities will be greater than those in the Bid Schedule.
M. Construct the wells using sonic drilling. Sonic drilling must begin at 5-foot below ground
surface and continue to the total depth of the boring, the bore hole shall be at least 10-inch-
diameter. The drilling soil cuttings shall be spread on the ground in areas within JJC
campus as directed by the Engineer.
1.09 SECURITY
A. Provide means of protecting the boreholes and well casings from the entrance of foreign
objects during the duration of Contract.
1.10 NOTIFICATION
A. Provide notice to the Engineer/Design Engineer of specific operations as follows:
1. At least 5 working days advance notice of start of drilling operations at the well site.
2. At least eight (8) hours advance notice of geophysical logging.
1.11 WELL DESTRUCTION
A. In the event Contractor destroys a hole or well because of loss of tools or other causes
which are their responsibility, or if the well fails to conform to these Specifications and
Contractor is unable to correct the condition at their own expense or negotiate a mutually-
acceptable cost reduction for deviations from Plans and Specifications, it shall be
considered an abandoned hole, and Contractor must immediately start a new monitoring
well at a nearby location designated by the Design Engineer.
1. Contractor may salvage as much undamaged material from the initial well as possible
to be used in the new monitoring well.
2. Contractor must, at their expense, destroy the old hole by filling with neat-cement grout
completely from bottom to five feet below ground surface, remove the top five feet of
casing and well seal, and backfill with clean import fill or select sand in conformance
with regulations of the Fresno County Health Department, the Section 23 of the
California Water Well Standards, and as described in these Specifications. Contractor
shall notify the Fresno County Health Department and arrange for a Health Department
inspector to witness sealing.
1.12 NUISANCE WATER
A. It is anticipated that nuisance water, such as rainfall or surface runoff, may occur within the
construction sites during the period of drilling under this contract. Contractor, by submitting
this bid, will be held to have investigated the risks arising from such water, and to have
made their bid in accordance therewith.
Contract Number 23-06-C 48
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
B. Protect the work from damage by such waters and shall take due measures to prevent
delays in progress of the work caused by such waters.
1.13 RIGHT TO TERMINATE WORK
A. The Engineer reserves the right to terminate the work on each of the monitoring wells at
any time. In such an event, Contractor shall be paid for work completed at that time based
on the unit bid prices.
B. The Engineer reserves the right to select an alternate monitoring well site to replace a
destroyed monitoring well. If an alternate site is chosen by the Engineer, Contractor will be
paid for the work done on the alternate well hole based on the unit bid prices.
PART 2 - PRODUCTS
2.01 VAULT BOX
A. Lid: Cast-Iron 10-inch diameter 3 bolt manhole cover
B. Skirt: HDPE
C. Manufacturer: Hole Products (SKU 7801145), or equal.
2.02 WELL LABELLING
A. Provide permanent tags for new and existing monitoring well vault boxes.
B. Affix stainless steel tag with well information stamped on tag in a position that is legible
from the surface.
2.03 WATERPROOFING
A. Vault box shall have a watertight seal.
2.04 WELL CASING
A. Blank Well Casing —The blank casing shall be 4-inch diameter (nominal) schedule 80 PVC
pipe meeting ASTM D1785 with flush threaded joints, as indicated on drawings.
B. Perforated Well Casing —The perforated casing shall be 4-inch diameter (nominal)
schedule 80 PVC pipe meeting ASTM D1785 with flush threaded joints with machined
horizontal slots (0.020- inch width). The bottom portion of the screen will be capped with a
threaded cap to prevent sand or gravel from filling the slotted interval.
2.05 FILTER PACK
A. The filter pack shall be composed of Monterey#2/12 silica sand or equivalent. Contractor
shall submit Monterey#2/12 silica sand or equivalent information, which must be approved
by Design Engineer prior to delivery to the site.
2.06 CEMENT GROUT
A. Cement grout will be Type II Portland Cement with not more than seven gallons of clean
water per cubic foot of cement.
Contract Number 23-06-C 49
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
2.07 BENTONITE SEAL
A. The bentonite seals will consist of bentonite chips or pellets, which will be hydrated with
clean water. The bentonite used for well construction must be specifically prepared for use
as a sealing material. Bentonite shall be commercially prepared sodium-montmorillonite
clay and be NSF/ANSI Standard 60 certified.
B. Source: Contractor-selected and Design Engineer-approved source.
C. The bentonite shall be high-swelling, sodium bentonite containing no added organic
polymers. The material shall exhibit the following properties:
1. Bentonite Chips
a. %" -1/4" size
b. Plasticity Index: 54 per ASTM D-4318
c. Expansion Index: 289 per ASTM D-4829
d. Bentonite Pellets
2.08 WATER DURING DRILLING
A. Coordinate with County Operator to use water from JJC storage tank.
B. Use of a hydrant is subject to the approval of the County Operator
C. Dispose of surplus fluids in a manner acceptable to the Engineer, according to regulatory
requirements.
D. Provide backup water supply in case of unforeseen circumstances.
2.09 CONCRETE SURFACE SEAL
A. Use Type II Portland Cement that complies with ASTM C150-19a.
B. Water used for concrete: ASTM C1602/C1602M-18.
C. Supplementary cementitious materials used in concrete: ASTM C618-19.
D. Chemical admixtures: ASTM C494/C494M-17 or C1017/C1017M-13e1.
E. Aggregates for concrete: ASTM C33/C33M-18.
F. Coarse Aggregate: 1" x#4 grading.
G. Aggregate: Class 1 N
H. Mixed concrete: ASTM C94/C94M-19a.
I. Concrete shall contain a minimum of 564 pounds of Type II cement per cubic yard of
concrete.
J. Water-Cement (W/C) Ratio of the mix: Maximum 0.52 (35 gallons of water per cubic yard of
concrete).
K. Slump of mixed concrete:
1. ASTM C143/C143M-15a
Contract Number 23-06-C 50
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
2. 4 inches ± 1 inch.
PART 3 - EXECUTION
3.01 HOURS OF OPERATION
A. Drilling operations may proceed at any time of day.
3.02 METHOD OF DRILLING
A. Drill boreholes using the sonic method of drilling.
3.03 BOREHOLE DRILLING
A. Prior to drilling the borehole with a drill rig, Contractor must explore to a depth of at least 5
feet using a hand auger, to help verify that there are no buried utilities in the well location.
B. The sonic drilling method will be used to drill the boreholes to an anticipated depth of
approximately 130 feet. The exact depth to which each hole must be drilled will be
determined by Design Engineer/Geologist based upon first encountered groundwater.
Contractor will be responsible for keeping each hole open to the total depth. The boreholes
must be a minimum of 10-inches in diameter.
C. The Driller must collect continuous samples throughout the entire depth of the borehole for
the Geologist to prepare a lithologic log. Contractor must be cooperative and accommodate
the Geologist's efforts. If Contractor is drilling, and the Geologist is not on-site, then
Contractor must keep soil samples properly labeled for the Geologist.
D. The final design for each monitoring well will be determined by the Design
Engineer/Geologist after the borehole is completed and information interpreted. Blank and
perforated casing will be required as indicated on the Plans or as modified by the Design
Engineer/Geologist after completion of the borehole.
3.04 PLUMBNESS AND ALIGNMENT
A. Drill the well in a manner that will result in a plumb and well-aligned casing, to prevent
undue delays due to lost or jammed tools or abandonment of severely misaligned holes. If
equipment specified cannot be placed in the well after completion due to not being plumb or
properly aligned, the well shall be deemed unacceptable, and will be properly destroyed
and replaced with a suitable well by Contractor at no additional cost to the Owner.
3.05 INSTALLING BLANK AND PERFORATED WELL CASING
A. Casing installation must be by methods that will ensure no damage to blank casing,
perforated casing, or the hole. The casing will be suspended above the bottom of the hole
to ensure that it will not be supported from the bottom.
B. The casing shall have plastic centralizers placed at intervals no greater than 60 ft, and at
the top, middle and bottom of perforated sections.
C. Join casing together with threaded joints.
D. No PVC glue joints are allowed.
Contract Number 23-06-C 51
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
3.06 INSTALLATION OF FILTER PACK
A. The bottom of the well shall consist of#2/12 Monterey silica sand, the filter pack will extend
from the bottom of the borehole to two feet above the top of the well screen. The exact
length of the filter pack will be determined by field conditions at the time of well installation.
The sand used must be approved by the Design Engineer prior to placement and will be
placed using a tremie pipe.
3.07 INSTALLATION OF BENTONITE SEAL
A. The bentonite seal must be installed by placing bentonite chips by gravity. Water will be
added to the bentonite within the borehole and shall be allowed to hydrate for a minimum of
2 hours prior to completing the well installation. Hydrate bentonite once placed in the
borehole.
3.08 INSTALLING CEMENT GROUT SEAL
A. The cement grout seal will be installed by pumping cement grout under pressure through a
tremie line. During the operation, the tremie line will be raised as the annular space is filled
with cement grout but must remain submerged five feet into the cement grout during the
entire operation.
B. The cement grout seal will extend from 0.5' below the ground surface to a depth as
indicated on Plans, or as indicated by the Design Engineer/Geologist after completion of the
borehole.
C. The cement grout seal must be allowed to set for 48 hours prior to further operations.
3.09 DEVELOPMENT BY PUMPING
A. Install temporary pump.
B. Permanent pump will not be used for well testing or well development.
C. Pump development of the well will consist of pumping the well at the maximum possible
rate and periodically stopping the pump, to allow the water to fall down the well. Estimated
time of pumping, surging, and bailing required for the well is 2 hours. Pumping rate will be
measured with an approved totalizing flow meter.
D. Development must continue until the water is clear and sand free, or until the Design
Engineer directs Contractor to stop.
E. Dispose of excess water in an approved manner and that will not cause flooding, erosion,
or other problem on or near the well site.
F. Excess water may be disposed with permission from the Engineer to the Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Center wastewater treatment plant headworks after the following
conditions are met:
1. Approval/acknowledgement with the plant operator has been obtained.
2. Excess water shall be placed into 20-yard roll-off bins for sediment to settle.
3. Excess water shall be mostly free of sand and sediment prior to discharge.
Contract Number 23-06-C 52
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
G. Excess water may be disposed of on private land only with permission from the landowner.
If Contractor cannot obtain permission to dispose the water on-site or on private property,
they will need to haul the water off-site with a water truck.
3.10 CLEANING WELL
A. Upon completion of development, remove excess cuttings and debris from the bottom of
the well.
3.11 WELLHEAD CONSTRUCTION
A. The well casing must be cut to the required height and the wellhead constructed as
indicated on the Plans. The well must be completed using the well seal and plumbing as
indicated on plans and set within a traffic rated vault box. The concrete pad shall provide
positive drainage away from the vault box.
3.12 SITE GRADING AROUND WELLHEAD
A. Site around wellhead must be graded to slope away from the well for a minimum of 10 feet
3.13 SITE CLEANUP
A. At the completion of work and at the end of each workday, Contractor will clean the site of
material used in drilling and constructing the monitoring wells, including the removal, and
spreading of debris and cuttings.
3.14 VIDEO LOG
A. Contractor shall provide equipment and labor to survey the wells. A well inspection camera
consisting of a high-resolution lens (20 megapixels or greater) with zoom capabilities that
provides both axial (downhole) and radial (side view) perspectives shall be used. The side
view camera lens shall also rotate 360 degrees. A centralizing device shall be used to keep
the camera away from the casing sidewall and as close as possible to the center of the
well.
B. A camera with a sufficiently bright light source to clearly illuminate the well casing and
screen in the side view perspective shall be used. The camera shall also have a sufficiently
bright light source in the downhole perspective to clearly illuminate the surrounding
environment for a downhole distance of at least three feet.
C. A downhole view shall be maintained while descending through the well with use of side
scan views as necessary to inspect areas for potential casing or screen damage until the
bottom of the well is reached. A side scan view with slow continuous rotation shall be
maintained while ascending at a rate no greater than 0.1 feet per second through the well
with stops as necessary to inspect areas for potential casing or screen damage until the top
of the well is reached (video to continue above the water level). The Contractor shall
provide two copies of the video log on an electronic storage device (DVD, flash drive,
portable hard drive) within 5 days of completing the video. A written report shall accompany
any video observations documenting findings for each well.
D. The camera inspection system shall include the capability to imprint text onto the video
media to document well name, date, continuous displayed camera depth, and observations
during the video inspection.
Contract Number 23-06-C 53
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
3.15 SITE QUALITY CONTROL
A. If the Design Engineer determines that the hole is lost due to negligence, incompetence, or
malpractice on the part of Contractor or their personnel, or to equipment malfunction, or to
the use of defective or unsuitable equipment, the Design Engineer will immediately notify
Contractor in writing the decision and order the hole abandoned, and Contractor will not be
paid for footage drilled or for other operations performed in the abandoned hole.
B. If a hole does not meet the requirements set forth in these Specifications, it shall be
considered an abandoned hole.
C. If Contractor fails to drill a borehole to the depth ordered by the Design Engineer within the
scope of Contract, the hole shall be declared abandoned.
D. Contractor, at their own expense, will destroy the borehole by filling with sand-cement grout
from bottom to top and in conformance with the specifications of the Owner, the County of
Fresno, the State Standard Specifications, and local and State permits and ordinances for
abandonment of test holes. Contractor will drill a new borehole at an alternative site in the
immediate area approved by the Design Engineer.
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 54
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
SECTION 33 24 32
SUBMERSIBLE PUMPS
PART 1 - GENERAL
1.01 WORK INCLUDED
A. Provide labor, materials, equipment, and incidentals required to furnish and install
submersible pumps inside wells as indicated and as specified.
B. Start-up and testing of pumps with a generator or other temporary power source.
1.02 SUBMITTAL REQUIREMENTS
A. Shop Drawings: Submit per Section 01 35 00 "Material Submittal Procedures":
1. Manufacturer's literature, illustrations, specifications, and engineering data including
dimensions, materials, size, weight, required net positive suction head, flow rate, head,
brake horsepower, motor horsepower, speed, and shut off head.
2. Provide installation drawings and wiring diagrams.
B. Operation and Maintenance Manuals:
1. Submit complete Installation, Operation and Maintenance Manuals, including test
reports, maintenance data and schedules, description of operation, and spare parts
information.
1.03 STANDARDS AND PERMITS
A. Standards referenced in this Section are listed below:
1. American Bearing Manufacturers Association, (ABMA).
2. American National Standards Institute, (ANSI).
3. American Water Works Association, (AWWA).
4. ANSI/Standards of the Hydraulics Institute, (ANSI/HI).
5. Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, (IEEE).
6. National Electrical Code, (NEC).
7. National Electrical Manufacturers Association, (NEMA).
8. National Sanitation Foundation, (NSF).
9. Local and State Building Codes and Ordinances.
1.04 DELIVERY, STORAGE AND HANDLING
A. Packing, Shipping, Handling and Unloading:
1. Deliver materials to Site to ensure uninterrupted progress of Work.
B. Storage and Protection:
1. Store materials to permit easy access for inspection and identification.
2. Keep material off the ground, using pallets, platforms, or other supports.
3. Protect products from corrosion and deterioration during storage.
Contract Number 23-06-C 55
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
C. Acceptance at Site:
1. Inspect boxes, crates, and packages upon delivery to Site.
2. Notify Owner, in writing, of a loss or damage to equipment or components.
3. Replace loss and repair damage to new condition in accordance with manufacturer's
instructions.
PART 2 - PRODUCTS
2.01 GENERAL:
A. Submersible type, suitable for pumping groundwater.
B. The characteristic curve of pump shall rise from minimum head condition to shutoff head
without dips.
C. The complete pumping unit consisting of pump and respective motor shall be suitable for
continuous, stable performance when operating at any point on the characteristic curve
without cavitation or runout and in accordance with vibration criteria specified herein.
D. Pumps shall be specially designed, constructed, and installed for the service specified and
shall comply with Design Criteria as specified herein.
2.02 MANUFACTURERS
A. Grundfos:
1. Product Name: 10SQE05-100 NE
2. Product No.: 97778421
B. Or Equal
2.03 DESIGN CRITERIA
Design Conditions Value
Use: Sample pump
Type: Submersible
Number of Stages: 2
Motor: hp 0.8 0.69kW
Maximum Operating Speed: rpm 10,700
Pump Column Diameter: inches 3.0
Discharge Size: inches 1.25
Liquid Pumped: Ground Water
Liquid Temperature: degrees F 50 - 90
Liquid pH: 6.0 - 9.0
Drive Type: Constant speed
Motor: Volts/Phase/Hertz 100-115/1/60
Contract Number 23-06-C 56
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
2.04 DETAILS OF CONSTRUCTION
A. General:
1. Pumps, appurtenances, and cables shall be designed for continuous operation under
submergence, without leakage, in water to a depth of 150 feet.
2. Each complete pumping unit, including motor, shall be capable of safely operating at
up to 125 percent of full load speed in reverse rotation without sustaining damage.
3. Include Dry-Running Protection
4. Include protection against impeller upthrust.
B. Pump Materials and Construction:
1. Pump: Type 316 stainless steel.
2. Impellers: Composite
3. No moving parts should be constructed from plastic or other brittle materials.
C. Motors:
1. Motor shall be rated as indicated in Design Criteria and as specified herein.
2. Pump and motor shall be designed for continuous operation. Dry-run protection will
shut off pump automatically when water level falls below inlet of pump.
3. Pump motor will also have built-in overvoltage, soft start, undervoltage, and
overtemperature protection.
4. Motors shall be non-overloading for entire pump operating curve and shall have a 1.75
service factor.
D. Power Cable:
1. Pump motor cable shall be designed for submersible duty and shall be indicated by
code or legend permanently applied to cable.
2. Cable and sizing shall conform to National Electrical Code for pump motors and shall
be supplied in sufficient length to extend continuously, without splices, from pump to
generator hookup at mouth of well as indicated on Drawings.
3. Cable Clamps:
a. Clamps used to secure cable to discharge pipe shall be Type 316 stainless steel
with rubber cable protectors.
b. Placement: 4 feet, minimum.
c. Include an extra 6 inches of slack above each cable clamp.
4. Cable Length:
a. Provide as required to allow 4 feet of cable between well seal and generator
receptacle box.
E. Generator Receptacle Box:
1. Provide a male generator receptacle at end of pump cable once it exits well seal.
2. Material: Aluminum or Non-Metal
3. Plug: NEMA 5-15P
4. Current: 15 amps
5. Voltage: 120 v
6. Waterproofing: IP69K or better
2.05 DROP PIPE
A. Provide 1 '/4" Schedule 80 PVC Pipe and fittings with threaded ends as indicated on the
plans.
Contract Number 23-06-C 57
Fresno County
Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements
2.06 ACCESS TUBE
A. Provide %" Schedule 40 PVC Pipe riser and fittings with flush threaded ends as indicated
on the plans.
B. Manufacturer
1. Hole Products: Model 5800245
2. Or Equal
2.07 LABELLING AND NAMEPLATES
A. Each pump and motor shall be furnished with a stainless-steel nameplate securely mounted
to body of equipment. As a minimum, nameplate for pumps shall include:
1. Manufacturer's name and model number
2. Serial number
3. Rated maximum flow capacity.
4. Maximum head
5. Horsepower
6. Speed
7. Voltage
8. Full Load Amperes
9. Frequency
10. Service factor
2.08 SAMPLE PORT
A. Confirm sample port connections with Owner and provide compatible adapters, bushing,
plugs or accessories.
B. Well Discharge Sample Port: 1 '/4" Ball valve and 1/2" king nipple
PART 3 - EXECUTION
3.01 INSTALLING
A. Install in accordance with manufacturer's instructions and recommendations.
B. Suspend Pump inside well using the drop pipe.
3.02 SITE QUALITY CONTROL
A. If Design Engineer determines that the hole is lost due to negligence, incompetence, or
malpractice on part of Contractor or their personnel, or to equipment malfunction, or
3.03 START-UP AND TESTING
A. Adjust required to place system in proper operating condition per Section 01 43 00 "Quality
Control and Testing".
END OF SECTION
Contract Number 23-06-C 58
Project Details
Contract Number 23-06-C
E CENTRAL AV
NLQ
PROJECT SITE (�HUNTINGTON
V N AU
ERe
RA HER
�9 co I
r_UL
C� eKERMAN r DUNLAPDOTA SELMA
FEMALAGAAV '9L LATON PARLIER
COALINGA`HURON
Q SUPERVISOR DISTRICT 4
JUVENILE JUSTICE CAMPUS
> CO
Lu
Q co �2
E AMERI CAN AVco
QQL >
Q
U
W
a N
E JEFFERSON
�L
Q
v
US P85C��
COtj�
DEPARTMENT OF PUBLIC WORKS SCALE: N.T.S. LOCATION MAP
O is56 O AND PLANNING JUVENILE JUSTICE CAMPUS
CO(J
DEPARTMENT OF PUBLIC HEALTH - ENVIRONMENTAL HEALTH DIVISION
P.O. Box 11867 Zip 93775, 1221 Fulton Mall, Fresno, California 93721
O ia56 O Telephone: (559) 600-3357 Fax: (559) 600-7629 Website: www.fcdph.org/water
'k- PERMIT TO CONSTRUCT, DEEPEN, DESTROY, RECONDITION, OR REPAIR A WELL
OFFICE USE ONLY
Application Date Estimated Start Date Well Permit# FA#
T R S Specialist CT
❑ Corcoran Clay Depth Ft
APN - - (see Special Corcoran Clay Annular Seal Requirements on attachment)
(ex###-###-##) ❑ Well Location in Flood Zone. (Extend Casing above known flood
Contractor level; Flood Elevation Certificate required to be submitted to the Fresno
Co.Public Works.Dept.prior to approval of the well electrical permit.)
License# Approved Date Seal Insp. Date
Phone FAX Final Insp. Date Supervisor
Job Address/Location Parcel Size
Owner Name Owner Phone
Owner Address City State t Zip
Type of Work Type of Well Intended Use Well Construction
❑ New Well ❑ Casing Driven ❑ Domestic Private Well Casing Material
❑ Replacement Well ❑ Cable Tool ❑ Domestic Public Well Casing Diameter in
❑ Reconstruction/Deepening ❑ Hardrock ❑Agricultural Well Casing Gauge
❑ Test Hole ❑Auger ❑ Industrial Conductor Casing Material
❑ Destruction ❑ Direct Rotary ❑ Cathodic Conductor Casing Diameter in
❑ Reverse Rotary ❑ Test Hole Conductor Casing Depth Ft
❑ Monitoring Annular Seal Depth Ft
❑ Other Borehole Diameter in
Gravel Pack ❑Yes ❑ No
Well Destruction
Type ❑ Gravel Pack ❑ Open Bottom ❑ Uncased ❑ Other Sealing Material/Seal Placement Method
Well Diameter In Total Depth ` El Neat Cement El Sand Cement El Concrete
Depth to Water Ft
Casing to be Perforated Ft to El Bentonite— Product Name
❑ Casing cut off Ft Below Grade(6ft max allowed) ❑ Pumped ❑ Free Fall (allowed only when the interval to
❑ Oil lubricated pump(Any oil in the well shall be removed and properly be sealed is dry and less than 30 Ft depth)
disposed of prior to destruction)
Setbacks ❑All setbacks exceed 300 Feet ❑ Other Wells Ft
❑ Leach Lines Ft ❑ Septic Tank Ft ❑ Cesspool Ft ❑ Seepage Pits Ft
❑ Sewer Lines Ft ❑ Animal/Fowl Enclosure Ft ❑ Designated Sewage Replacement Area Ft
❑ Flood Control Basins Ft ❑ Waste Water Disposal Ponds Ft ❑ Lakes/Streams Ft
FEE ❑ $605(Domestic/Agricultural/Cathodic/Test Hole PE4650, Public/Industrial PE4652 ) ❑ $407(Well Destruction PE4651)
❑ No Charge(Monitoring Well/Soil Boring PE4653)
PAYMENT METHOD ❑ Cash ❑ Check ❑ Credit Card (Authorization on file with Dept. of Public Health, Env. Health Division)
I hereby certify that the information described herein is correct. I understand that all work is to be done in accordance with the California Well Standards
Ordinance and the conditions of this permit application, including any conditions which are added by the Environmental Health Division upon review of this
application and issuance of the permit. I certify that I have a current C-57 Contractor's License and, if I employ workers,a current certificate of Workers'
Compensation Insurance. I further understand that any permit issued pursuant to this application is subject to such further conditions as may be deemed
necessary to ensure compliance with the Ordinance. Note: This permit is non-transferable and is valid for 180 days.
CONTRACTOR SIGNATURE:
DATE:
OFFICE USE ONLY-ENVISION CLERICAL:
Account# Invoice#
Entered By Date
SPECIAL REQUIREMENTS: Faxed by
coU
DEPARTMENT OF PUBLIC HEALTH - ENVIRONMENTAL HEALTH DIVISION
P.O. Box 11867 Zip 93775, 1221 Fulton Mall, Fresno, California 93721
Telephone: (559) 600-3357 Fax: (559) 600-7629 Website: www.fcdph.org/water
O� 856 O PLOT PLAN TO ACCOMPANY PERMIT TO CONSTRUCT, DEEPEN, DESTROY,
FRESH RECONDITION, OR REPAIR WELL
Note: This permit is non-transferable and is valid for 180 days
Job Address/Location: APN: / / PERMIT#
Indicate distances in feet. Provide the names of streets or roads nearest to the property. Provide dimensions of the
property and all existing or proposed structures. Provide locations of existing or proposed sewage disposal systems,
including expansion or repair areas, within 250 feet of the new well. Provide locations of all other wells within 300 feet of
the new well. Location information shall include all adjacent parcels, if within setbacks.
I
N
KLHINFELOER
Y S,ght Pcople.Right Solutions.
Groundwater Monitoring Well Installation Work Plan
Fresno County Juvenile Justice Center Wastewater Treatment System
3333 E. American Avenue
Fresno, California
MARCH 25, 2022
PUBLIC WORKS AND PLANNING
COUNTY OF FRESNO
KLEINFELDER PROJECT NO: 20223600.001A
20223600.001A/SAC22R137465 Page i of iv March 25, 2022
KLE/NFELOER
Bright People,Right Solutions.
Prepared for:
Mr. Sabastian Artal, P.E.
Public Works and Planning
County of Fresno
GROUNDWATER MONITORING WELL INSTALLATION WORK PLAN
FRESNO COUNTY JUVENILE JUSTICE CENTER WASTEWATER TREATMENT SYSTEM
3333 E. AMERICAN AVENUE
FRESNO, CALIFORNIA
Prepared by:
Stacy Mann
Staff Toxicologist
SSIONAL GF
WILLIA �<
Reviewed by: a� FREDERICK
SCHtiryERER!V cA
9190
(POP •
CALIF
William F. Schmierer, PG
Senior Geologist
KLEINFELDER
2882 Prospect Park Drive, Suite 200
Rancho Cordova, CA 95670
Phone: 916.366.1701
March 25, 2022
Kleinfelder Project No. 20223600.001A
20223600.001 A/SAC22R1 37465 Page ii of iv March 25, 2022
KLE1NFELOER
Y S,ght P11PJ1 Right Solutions.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Section Paqe
1 INTRODUCTION.............................................................................................................1
2 SITE BACKGROUND .....................................................................................................2
2.1 DOCUMENTATION REVIEW ..............................................................................2
2.1.1 Monitoring Well Construction....................................................................3
2.1.2 Groundwater Data....................................................................................4
2.1.3 Groundwater Flow Direction .....................................................................4
3 PROPOSED SCOPE OF WORK.....................................................................................5
3.1 PRE- MONITORING WELL INSTALLATION ACTIVITIES ...................................5
3.1.1 Permitting.................................................................................................5
3.1.2 Health and safety Plan .............................................................................5
3.1.3 Utility Locating..........................................................................................5
3.2 WELL INSTALLATION AND DEVELOPMENT.....................................................6
3.3 MONITORING WELL DESIGN ............................................................................6
3.4 MONITORING WELL DEVELOPMENT...............................................................7
3.5 WELL SURVEY ...................................................................................................7
3.6 WELL ABANDONMENT ......................................................................................7
3.7 MONITORING WELL INSTALLATION REPORT.................................................8
3.8 GROUNDWATER MONITORING AND REPORTING..........................................8
4 SCHEDULE.....................................................................................................................9
5 LIMITATIONS ...............................................................................................................10
6 REFERENCES..............................................................................................................11
FIGURES
1 Site Location Map
2 Well Location Map
3 Proposed Monitoring Well Construction Diagram
20223600.001A/SAC22R137465 Page iii of iv March 25, 2022
KLE/NFELDER
V Bright People-Right Solutions.
ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS
bgs Below Ground Surface
HASP Health and Safety Plan
PPE Personal Protective Equipment
RWQCB Central Valley Regional Water Quality Control Board
USA North Underground Service Alert of Northern California
Work Plan Groundwater Monitoring Well Installation Work Plan
20223600.001 A/SAC22R1 37465 Page iv of iv March 25, 2022
KLE/NFELDER
V Bright People-Right Solutions.
1 INTRODUCTION
Kleinfelder has prepared this Groundwater Monitoring Well Installation Work Plan (Work Plan)for
the County of Fresno (Client) for the Fresno County Juvenile Justice Center Wastewater
Treatment System located at 3333 E. American Avenue in Fresno, California (Site). This Work
Plan has been prepared to address deficiencies in the current monitoring well network and the
installation of new groundwater monitoring wells and the abandonment of existing monitoring
wells. The Site location is presented in Figure 1.
20223600.001 A/SAC22R1 37465 Page 1 of 11 March 25, 2022
KLE1NFELOER
Y &,9ht P11PJ1 Right Solutions.
2 SITE BACKGROUND
The Fresno County Juvenile Justice Center's (JJC) Wastewater Treatment Facility (WWTF) is
regulated under Waste Discharge Requirements (WDR) Order No. R5-2007-0150 (Order) by the
Central Valley Regional Water Quality Control Board (RWQCB). As part of the order, the JJC is
required to monitor the quality of first encountered groundwater beneath the JJC.
Monitoring wells were installed in 2007 to depths ranging from 80 to 100 feet below ground surface
(bgs), with screened intervals ranging from 40 to 90 feet bgs. Over the past several years, the
regional groundwater levels have decreased below the bottom of the current monitoring well
screened intervals, and most of the wells in the network are now reported as dry. Therefore, the
current monitoring well network is not able to assess first encountered groundwater
The County of Fresno recognized that the JJC was out of compliance with the Order and
requested Kleinfelder to perform historical research and provide recommendations to bring the
JJC back into compliance with the Order. The following is a summary of the information obtained
through historical documentation research at the RWQCB; available reports from the County of
Fresno; and site reconnaissance. This research was used to guide recommendations to improve
the monitoring well network
2.1 DOCUMENTATION REVIEW
Kleinfelder visited and reviewed available documents at the RWQCB on November 30, 2021. The
reviewed documents included the following:
• Waste Discharge Requirements for County of Fresno Juvenile Justice Campus
Wastewater Treatment Facility, Fresno County, prepared by California Regional Water
Quality Control Board Central Valley Region, Order No. R5-2007-0150 (RWQCB, 2007a)
• Standard Provisions and Reporting Requirements, Waste Discharge to Land, date 1/2015
through 7/2021 (County of Fresno, 2015 to 2021)
• Review of Monitoring Well Installation Report, Fresno County Juvenile Justice Campus
Wastewater Treatment Facility, Fresno County, dated January 19, 2007 (RWQBC, 2007b)
20223600.001A/SAC22R137465 Page 2 of 11 March 25, 2022
KLE/NFELOER
Y Bright People-Right Solutions.
• Salinity Minimization Plan, Fresno County Juvenile Justice Campus Wastewater
Treatment Plant, Fresno County, dated October 22, 2008. (RWQCB, 2008)
• Updated Salinity Evaluation and Salinity Minimization Plan, prepared by Nolte, dated
November 16, 2009 (Nolte Associates, 2009).
• Provision G.12 Salinity Evaluation, Fresno County, Juvenile Justice Campus WWTF
(WDID 5131 ONC00011, RM 372451), Fresno County, dated January 20, 2010
Other historical information regarding groundwater was obtained from:
• Department of Water Resources (DWR) Water Data Library was queried from online
source to assess the local groundwater levels in wells near the JJC
• Past quarterly monitoring reports (2014 to 2021) provided by Fresno County
2.1.1 Monitoring Well Construction
Research from the available documents and the site reconnaissance indicated that five wells were
initially installed in 2007. The initial five wells were constructed using mud-rotary drilling and
installing 4-inch diameter schedule 80 PVC well casing, using 20 feet of 0.30 machine slotted
screen and a 10-foot blank casing (sump) placed below to screened interval to the bottom of
boring. Two additional shallower wells were installed later, at an unknown date, after some of the
initial wells were found to be screened significantly below first encountered groundwater. The
table below lists the five initial monitoring wells constructed at the JJC. No documentation was
available regarding the construction of the two additional shallower wells (MW-6U and MW-7U).
Table 1 below outlines the initial five wells (CVRWQCB, 2007b).
Table 1. Well Information (2007)
Total Well Depth Screened Depth to Water
Well Designation (feet bgs) Interval (feet Initial Measurement (2007)
bgs) (feet bgs)
MW-1 U 80 40 — 60 50.70
MW-2U 90 60 — 80 48.15
MW-3U 100 70 — 90 49.10
MW-4U 1 100 70 — 90 51.65
MW-5U 1 99 69 — 89 49.99
20223600.001 A/SAC22R1 37465 Page 3 of 11 March 25, 2022
KLE1NFELOER
Y &,9ht P11PJ1 Right Solutions.
2.1.2 Groundwater Data
The most recent Site groundwater monitoring quarterly report (County of Fresno, 2015-2021)
indicated that only two wells, MW-3U and MW-5U, had measurable groundwater at 89 and 88.5
feet bgs, respectively. It was further noted that wells MW-1 U, MW-2U, MW-4U, MW-6U and MW-
7U were dry. Based on these readings, the groundwater level has decreased below the bottom
of the screened intervals of the JJC monitoring wells.
The review of the DWR online source (DWR, 2022)for State Well 15S21 E06B001 M (an Irrigation
well), indicated that the groundwater depth to water from 2010 and 2011 was 77 and 78 feet bgs,
respectively. The well is near the northern portion of the JJC.
2.1.3 Groundwater Flow Direction
The WDR indicated that the groundwater flow is to the west(RWQCB, 2007a). Recent monitoring
reports did not calculate flow direction and gradient due to only two of seven wells having water
in the screened zone. Additionally, depth to water measurements have not been recorded with
sufficient precision to calculate flow direction. Based on Site maps and a field reconnaissance:
MW-5U and MW-6U are located down-gradient of the WWTF; MW-3U, MW-4U, MW-7D are
down-gradient of the application areas; and MW-1 U and MW-2 are located upgradient of the JJC
facility.
20223600.001A/SAC22R137465 Page 4 of 11 March 25, 2022
KLE/NFELDER
V Bright People-Right Solutions.
3 PROPOSED SCOPE OF WORK
This Work Plan has been prepared to address deficiencies in the current monitoring well network
at the Site. Proposed locations for additional well installations are included in Figure 2.
3.1 PRE- MONITORING WELL INSTALLATION ACTIVITIES
3.1.1 Permitting
Permits will be obtained prior to the well installation activities. Well permits will be obtained from
the Fresno County Environmental Health Department. Encroachment permits may need to be
obtained from Fresno County for installing the monitoring wells in the County right-of-way
surrounding the JJC.
3.1.2 Health and safety Plan
A Health and Safety Plan (HASP) specific to the Site will be prepared prior to implementing field
activities to address the health and safety of field staff and provide contingency plans for
emergencies that may arise during the work. The HASP will provide guidelines for personal
protection equipment (PPE) and safety procedures to be used by staff during field operations.
3.1.3 Utility Locating
Underground Service Alert of Northern California (USA North) will be notified after the proposed
monitoring well locations are marked, but a minimum of 48 hours (two business days) prior to
initiating subsurface-intrusive activities, to obtain clearance for public underground utilities.
Since USA North may not enter the JJC facility, a geophysical services provider will be used to
locate and mark detectable subsurface utility lines and other identifiable subsurface features at
and immediately adjacent to the proposed well locations.
20223600.001 A/SAC22R1 37465 Page 5 of 11 March 25, 2022
KLE/NFELDER
V Bright People-Right Solutions.
3.2 WELL INSTALLATION AND DEVELOPMENT
A licensed C-57 water well driller will install three new monitoring wells at the Site to depths of
approximately 130 feet bgs or at least 40 feet below the first encountered groundwater, which is
expected to currently be at approximately 90 feet bgs. The new wells will be constructed at these
approximate locations (Figure 2):
1. Near the existing downgradient MW-5U and MW-6U wells, this will be the downgradient
monitoring well;
2. Southwest of the existing MW-2U well (downgradient of the spray field), this will be a
crossgradient and downgradient monitoring well; and
3. South of the existing upgradient MW-1 U, this will be the upgradient monitoring well.
The wells will be drilled using sonic drilling technologies in order to maintain hole stability and to
enable drilling through groundwater without the use of drilling mud. The wells will be installed
under the direction of a Professional Geologist registered in the state of California.
Soil cuttings and liquid waste generated during installation and development of wells will be
spread on the ground surface near the wells.
3.3 MONITORING WELL DESIGN
An eight-inch diameter borehole will be drilled to 130 feet bgs and lithology will be continuously
logged. The proposed screen zone is from 75 feet bgs to 120 feet bgs. This well design will be
modified in the field based on current groundwater levels encountered in the borehole. The top of
screen will be set 15 feet above current groundwater and the bottom of screen will be set 30 feet
below current groundwater. The monitoring wells will be constructed using new materials of
threaded three-inch diameter, schedule 80, polyvinyl chloride (PVC) casing. The screen will
consist of three-inch diameter schedule 80, PVC 0.020 milled screen with a threaded end cap.
The filter pack will consist of a #2/12 silica sand blend to be installed from the bottom of the well
to approximately two feet above the well screen. A four-foot layer consisting of bentonite chips
will be installed above the filter pack. Water will be added to the bentonite chips to hydrate the
bentonite for a minimum of 30 minutes. The remaining annular space above the bentonite will be
filled to the land surface with neat cement grout mixed to the specifications of 6 gallons clean
20223600.001 A/SAC22R1 37465 Page 6 of 11 March 25, 2022
KLE/NFELDER
Y Bright People-Right Solutions.
water to 94 pounds of cement. All well materials will be installed using a tremie pipe. The wells
will be completed with traffic rated flush-mount vaults. A locking well cap will be placed on each
well. A proposed monitoring well construction diagram is shown in Figure 3.
3.4 MONITORING WELL DEVELOPMENT
A minimum of 72 hours after the monitoring well construction, the wells will be developed by
bailing, surging, and pumping a maximum of ten casing volumes or until the water is relatively
clear and free of sand. The water level and total depth of the wells will be measured before
development begins and after each successive surge/pump task. Field parameters to be
measured include: water level, pumping rate (during pumping development only), total depth,
temperature, pH, and specific conductance. The well development water will be discharged to the
ground near each well site.
3.5 WELL SURVEY
Once the monitoring wells are installed, a California-licensed land surveyor will survey the
horizontal northing and easting locations, elevation of the top of well casing, elevation of the top
of the monument rise, and ground surface for each well. The accuracy of the horizontal
measurements will be ± 0.1 foot, and the accuracy of the vertical measurements will be ± 0.01
foot, from their respective reference data points. The northings and easting will be based on the
North American Datum (NAD) 1983 California State Pane Zone IV coordinate system. The
elevations will be measured based on North American Vertical Datum of 1988 (NAVD88).
3.6 WELL ABANDONMENT
Due to the current monitoring wells being dry, the seven existing monitoring wells (MW-1 U
through MW-7U) will be abandoned in accordance with the County of Fresno and DWR
guidelines. A permit from Fresno County to abandon the wells will be required and attained before
abandonment activities begin. The wells will be abandoned by drilling out the wells to the original
total depths and backfilling with a neat cement mixture to five feet below ground surface or
abandoning the wells in-place by backfilling the monitoring wells from total depth to ground
surface with neat cement grout and removing the top five feet of casing. The RWQCB will be
notified a minimum of one week prior to the scheduled date for abandonment of the wells.
20223600.001 A/SAC22R1 37465 Page 7 of 11 March 25, 2022
KLE/NFELDER
V Bright People-Right Solutions.
3.7 MONITORING WELL INSTALLATION REPORT
The monitoring well installation report will be prepared in accordance with the RWQCB
requirements. The report will include the following:
• A description of the project, present use, and past use (if readily available) of the site
• Description of the geologic and hydrogeologic setting
• Graphical representations (on topographic map) of the site, project area, monitoring well
locations, and groundwater gradient
• A description of the surface and subsurface site conditions encountered during our field
exploration
• Copy of County Well Permit
• Drilling details
• Well construction details
• Well development details
• Well survey details
The report will be submitted to Fresno County and the RWQCB for review and comment.
3.8 GROUNDWATER MONITORING AND REPORTING
The County of Fresno will monitor the new wells according to the groundwater monitoring
guidelines outlined in the MRP No. R5-2007-0150. Sampling frequencies for each constituent of
concern is outlined in the MRP. The discharger shall report the required monitoring data and
information in the form of monthly, quarterly, and annual reports to be submitted to the RWQCB.
All reporting requirements are outlined in the MRP.
20223600.001 A/SAC22R1 37465 Page 8 of 11 March 25, 2022
KLE/NFELDER
V Bright People-Right Solutions.
4 SCHEDULE
Upon receipt of written approval of this Work Plan by the RWQCB, the scheduling for subsurface
utility clearance, well installation and development, and groundwater sampling will be completed
following the County of Fresno contracting process. The anticipated schedule is as follows:
• County to obtain California Environmental Quality Act (CEQA) Notice of Exemption (NOE)
based on approved Workplan [3 months]
• Prepare Plans, Specifications, and Estimates [3 months concurrent with previous task].
• Advertise bid opportunity for monitoring well construction [3 months]
• Monitoring well installation, development, and survey will be completed [6 months].
• Routine WDR groundwater monitoring will commence following the monitoring well
installation.
20223600.001 A/SAC22R1 37465 Page 9 of 11 March 25, 2022
KLE/NFELDER
V Bright People-Right Solutions.
5 LIMITATIONS
This Work Plan was prepared in a manner consistent with that level of care and skill ordinarily
exercised by other members of Kleinfelder's profession practicing in the same locality, under
similar conditions and at the date the services are provided. Kleinfelder's conclusions, opinions,
and recommendations are based on a limited number of observations and data. It is possible that
conditions could vary between or beyond the data evaluated. Kleinfelder makes no other
representation, guarantee, or warranty, express or implied, regarding the services,
communication (oral or written), report, opinion, or instrument of service provided.
This Work Plan may be used only by the Client and the registered design professional in
responsible charge and only for the purposes stated for this specific engagement within a
reasonable time from its issuance, but in no event later than two years from the date of the Work
Plan.
20223600.001 A/SAC22R1 37465 Page 10 of 11 March 25, 2022
KLE/NFELDER
Y &,9ht P11PJ1 Right Solutions.
6 REFERENCES
California Department of Water Resources (DWR). 2022. Groundwater Levels for Well
366634N1197270W001. March 4.
https://wdl.water.ca.gov/WaterDataLibrary/GroundwaterBrowseData.aspx?LocalWelINu
tuber=&Station Id=38213&StateWeIINumber=15S21 E06 BOO 1 M&SelectedCounties=&Site
Code=366634N 1 197270W001&SelectedGWBasins=
California Regional Water Quality Control Board Central Valley Region (RWQCB). 2007a. Order
NO. R5-2007-0150, Waste Discharge Requirements for County of Fresno Juvenile Justice
Campus Wastewater Treatment Facility Fresno County. October 26.
RWQCB. 2007b. Groundwater Monitoring Well Installation Work Plan, Fresno County Juvenile
Justice Campus, Fresno County. November 7.
RWQCB. 2008. Salinity Minimization Plan, Fresno County Juvenile Justice Center Wastewater
Treatment Plant, Fresno County. October 22.
County of Fresno. 2015 to 2021. Standard Provisions and Reporting Requirements, Waste
Discharge to Land, District No: Juvenile Justice Campus.
Nolte Associates, Inc. 2009. County of Fresno Juvenile Justice Campus, Updated Salinity
Evaluation and Salinity Minimization Plan. November.
20223600.001A/SAC22R137465 Page 11 of 11 March 25, 2022
FIGURES
C _
� f
m
L l
Q CALIFORNIA Malaga
v
ti
sa ento� Site
N
N
N
cD Location
an Francisco — — --
LM r
0
Fresno Last/
LU
r
r
O
a osAngeles
CID
�anQieg Y,rdSp "°�
a�d==
SITE LOCATION
x
U
0
U
N
J
N
N
J
O
O
E LINCOLN AVE
O -
N
O
N
N
LL
O
_T
CU
c
_o
U
N
O
a- Explanation
c?
O Approximate Site
Q Boundary
o �
rn c Basemap:USGS The National Map
N Inset:National Geographic World Map
� O
INt 0 1,000 2,000
N
o� Feet
W r Locations are Approximate
LL
PROJECT: 20223600 FIGURE
< DRAWN: FEB 2022 SITE LOCATION MAP
O DRAWN BY: KFH
Z KL E//VFEL DER
a Bright People.Right Solutions. CHECKED BY: WS FRESNO JUVENILE JUSTICE CENTER
3333 EAST AMERICAN AVENUE
0FILE NAME: FRESNO,CALIFORNIA
Figurel.mxd
j�iltt� it � "'• EASTAMERICANAVENUE _
, '° MW-1 U
.., � sty
N
N
O
' Na •+pp0 G 1�'� ' aRp9
E �r • •••MNR \ I•taaa\ .a0
cli
m _.. 1 �•. •. •
-1 two
!i!1
Mgt
MW-4U, V\\\AOAD\CD
F\\.\' • • 4.\.•*� t� ��+, �a �'' '�w • ``
o s `.
MW-7U +•itei - MW-2U
o
MW-3U ,• / r
0
T
Explanation
oMW�-5U PMW-3 � �. — , Proposed Monitoring Well
MW=6U
Existing Monitoring Well
21
m — Existing Water Supply Well
w -- 0 Approximate Site Boundary
LL
0 250 500 ^ PROJECT: 20223600 FIGURE
a
Feet / \ DRAWN: FEB 2022 WELL LOCATION MAP
U Locations are Approximate
KL E/NFEL DER DRAWN BY: KFH w
Aerial imagery:ESRI World Imagery,Maxar Metro 6/6/2021 1
w
Th Bright People. Right Solutions. CHECKED BY: WS
� FRESNO JUVENILE JUSTICE CENTER
< d FILE NAME: 3333 EAST AMERICAN AVENUE
c> www.kleinfelder.com FRESNO,CALIFORNIA
u)
Figure2.mxd
N
0
E
0
Ur
t`0 12-Inch Traffic-Rated Vault Box
C4
N
0 Concrete
Pad Ground Surface
7777:77
Uj
Locking Well Cap
0
8-Inch Diameter Borehole
Neat Cement Annular Seal
3-Inch Diameter Schedule 80
PVC Well Casing
Bentonite Seal
Approximate 4 Feet
Top of Screen 15 Feet Above First
First Encountered Groundwater,
Encountered Groundwater
Approximatly 90'bgs
2/12 Sand Filter Pack
2 Feet Above Screen
Bottom of Screen 25 Feet Below First
Encountered Groundwater
LU
3-Inch Diameter Schedule 80
PVC Well Screen,0.020 Slot
LL
0
Bottom Well Cap
9 The,fr,,b,n ind,d,d an this graphic p,,,nt,b,n he,been compiled than,a variety of
< ,I 7 t, h he,without net,,, Kl,,nfid,,makes ,representations or
wahah,ies,_Press or1 al,as t.—r-y,-plat,,-hh,ek r rights to theuseI
r"'tThis d—nneht —ted far — isO
1.hd ay ph.—nor t
-.--h-,
gned or te—d deagn d..maht Th. a-
m. f the information
O contained an this graph,c representation Is at the ad,n,k at the party using or misusing the
ID af.—h— Not To Scale
M
c PROJECT NO.20223600.001A
FIGURE
N
PROPOSED MONITORING WELL
o DRAWN: 03/04/2022
CONSTRUCTION DIAGRAM
KLE/NFELOHR DRAWN BY: D.Ross
LL CHECKED BY: B.Schmierer FRESNO JUVENILE JUSTICE CENTER
Bright People.Right Solutions
FILE NAME: 3333 EAST AMERICAN AVENUE
< W..k1einfelder.com FRESNO,CALIFORNIA
20223600 3.dwg
SELF-DEALING TRANSACTION DISCLOSURE FORM
(1) Company Board Member Information:
Name: Date:
Job Title:
(2) Company/Agency Name and Address:
(3) Disclosure (Please describe the nature of the self-dealing transaction you are a party to)
(4) Explain why this self-dealing transaction is consistent with the requirements of Corporations
Code 5233 (a)
(5) Authorized Signature
Signature: Date:
SELF-DEALING TRANSACTION DISCLOSURE FORM INSTRUCTIONS
In order to conduct business with the County of Fresno (hereinafter referred to as "County"), members of
a contractor's board of directors (hereinafter referred to as "County Contractor"), must disclose any self-
dealing transactions that they are a party to while providing goods, performing services, or both for the
County. A self-dealing transaction is defined below:
'A self-dealing transaction means a transaction to which the corporation is a party and which one or
more of its directors has a material financial interest"
The definition above will be utilized for purposes of completing the disclosure form.
(1) Enter board member's name, job title (if applicable), and date this disclosure is being made.
(2) Enter the board member's company/agency name and address.
(3) Describe in detail the nature of the self-dealing transaction that is being disclosed to the County.
At a minimum, include a description of the following:
a. The name of the agency/company with which the corporation has the transaction; and
b. The nature of the material financial interest in the Corporation's transaction that the board
member has.
(4) Describe in detail why the self-dealing transaction is appropriate based on applicable provisions
of the Corporations Codes.
(5) Form must be signed by the board member that is involved in the self-dealing transaction
described in Sections (3) and (4).
REVISED STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DATED
09-02-16
ORGANIZATION
Revised standard specifications are under headings that correspond with the main-section headings of
the Standard Specifications.A main-section heading is a heading shown in the table of contents of the
Standard Specifications. A date under a main-section heading is the date of the latest revision to the
section.
Each revision to the Standard Specifications begins with a revision clause that describes or introduces a
revision to the Standard Specifications. For a revision clause that describes a revision, the date on the
right above the clause is the publication date of the revision. For a revision clause that introduces a
revision, the date on the right above a revised term, phrase, clause, paragraph, or section is the
publication date of the revised term, phrase, clause, paragraph, or section. For a multiple-paragraph or
multiple-section revision, the date on the right above a paragraph or section is the publication date of the
paragraphs or sections that follow.
Any paragraph added or deleted by a revision clause does not change the paragraph numbering of the
Standard Specifications for any other reference to a paragraph of the Standard Specifications.
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
DIVISION I GENERAL PROVISIONS
1 GENERAL
07-15-16
Add to the 1st table of section 1-1.06:
07-15-16
APCD air pollution control district
AQMD air quality management district
CISS cast-in-steel shell
CSL crosshole sonic logging
GGL gamma-gamma logging
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
7 LEGAL RELATIONS AND RESPONSIBILITY TO THE PUBLIC
07-15-16
Replace the paragraphs in section 7-1.021(2)with:
05-06-16
Under 2 CA Code of Regs§ 11105:
1. During the performance of this contract,the recipient, contractor, and its subcontractors shall not
deny the contract's benefits to any person on the basis of race, religious creed, color, national origin,
ancestry, physical disability, mental disability, medical condition,genetic information, marital status,
sex, gender, gender identity, gender expression, age, sexual orientation, or military and veteran
status, nor shall they discriminate unlawfully against any employee or applicant for employment
because of race, religious creed, color, national origin, ancestry, physical disability, mental disability,
medical condition, genetic information, marital status, sex, gender, gender identity, gender
Page 1 of 183
expression, age, sexual orientation, or military and veteran status. Contractor shall insure that the
evaluation and treatment of employees and applicants for employment are free of such
discrimination.
2. Contractor shall comply with the provisions of the Fair Employment and Housing Act(Gov. Code, §
12900 et seq.), the regulations promulgated thereunder(Cal. Code Regs., tit. 2, § 11000 et seq.),the
provisions of Article 9.5, Chapter 1, Part 1, Division 3, Title 2 of the Government Code(Gov. Code, §§
11135-11139.5), and the regulations or standards adopted by the awarding state agency to
implement such article.
3. Contractor or recipient shall permit access by representatives of the Department of Fair Employment
and Housing and the awarding state agency upon reasonable notice at any time during the normal
business hours, but in no case less than 24 hours' notice, to such of its books, records, accounts, and
all other sources of information and its facilities as said Department or Agency shall require to
ascertain compliance with this clause.
4. Recipient, contractor and its subcontractors shall give written notice of their obligations under this
clause to labor organizations with which they have a collective bargaining or other agreement.
5. The contractor shall include the nondiscrimination and compliance provisions of this clause in all
subcontracts to perform work under the contract.
Under 2 CA Code of Regs§ 11122:
STANDARD CALIFORNIA NONDISCRIMINATION CONSTRUCTION CONTRACT
SPECIFICATIONS (GOV. CODE SECTION 12990)
These specifications are applicable to all state contractors and subcontractors having a construction
contract or subcontract of$5,000 or more.
1. As used in the specifications:
a. "Act" means the Fair Employment and Housing Act.
b. "Administrator"means Administrator, Office of Compliance Programs, California Department of
Fair Employment and Housing, or any person to whom the Administrator delegates authority;
2. Whenever the contractor or any subcontractor subcontracts a portion of the work, it shall include in
each subcontract of$5,000 or more the nondiscrimination clause in this contract directly or through
incorporation by reference. Any subcontract for work involving a construction trade shall also include
the Standard California Construction Contract Specifications, either directly or through incorporation
by reference.
3. The contractor shall implement the specific nondiscrimination standards provided in paragraphs 6(a)
through (e)of these specifications.
4. Neither the provisions of any collective bargaining agreement, nor the failure by a union with whom
the contractor has a collective bargaining agreement,to refer members of any group protected by the
Act shall excuse the contractor's obligations under these specifications, Government Code section
12990, or the regulations promulgated pursuant thereto.5. In order for the nonworking training hours
of apprentices and trainees to be counted, such apprentices and trainees must be employed by the
contractor during the training period, and the contractor must have made a commitment to employ the
apprentices and trainees at the completion of their training, subject to the availability of employment
opportunities.Trainees must be trained pursuant to training programs approved by the U.S.
Department of Labor or the California Department of Industrial Relations.
5. In order for the nonworking training hours of apprentices and trainees to be counted, such
apprentices and trainees must be employed by the contractor during the training period, and the
contractor must have made a commitment to employ the apprentices and trainees at the completion
of their training, subject to the availability of employment opportunities.Trainees must be trained
pursuant to training programs approved by the U.S. Department of Labor or the California
Department of Industrial Relations.
6. The contractor shall take specific actions to implement its nondiscrimination program.The evaluation
of the contractor's compliance with these specifications shall be based upon its effort to achieve
maximum results from its actions.The contractor must be able to demonstrate fully its efforts under
steps a.through e. below:
a. Ensure and maintain a working environment free of harassment, intimidation, and coercion at
all sites, and at all facilities at which the contractor's employees are assigned to work. The
contractor shall specifically ensure that all foremen, superintendents, and other on-site
Page 2 of 183
supervisory personnel are aware of and carry out the contractor's obligations to maintain such
a working environment.
b. Provide written notification within seven days to the director of the DFEH when the referral
process of the union or unions with which the contractor has a collective bargaining agreement
has impeded the contractor's efforts to meet its obligations.
C. Disseminate the contractor's equal employment opportunity policy by providing notice of the
policy to unions and training, recruitment and outreach programs and requesting their
cooperation in assisting the contractor to meet its obligations; and by posting the company
policy on bulletin boards accessible to all employees at each location where construction work
is performed.
d. Ensure all personnel making management and employment decisions regarding hiring,
assignment, layoff, termination, conditions of work,training, rates of pay or other employment
decisions, including all supervisory personnel, superintendents, general foremen, on-site
foremen, etc., are aware of the contractor's equal employment opportunity policy and
obligations,and discharge their responsibilities accordingly.
e. Ensure that seniority practices,job classifications,work assignments, and other personnel
practices, do not have a discriminatory effect by continually monitoring all personnel and
employment related activities to ensure that the equal employment opportunity policy and the
contractor's obligations under these specifications are being carried out.
7. Contractors are encouraged to participate in voluntary associations that assist in fulfilling their equal
employment opportunity obligations.The efforts of a contractor association,joint contractor-union,
contractor-community, or other similar group of which the contractor is a member and participant,
may be asserted as fulfilling any one or more of its obligations under these specifications provided
that the contractor actively participates in the group, makes every effort to assure that the group has a
positive impact on equal employment opportunity in the industry, ensures that the concrete benefits of
the program are reflected in the contractor's workforce participation, and can provide access to
documentation that demonstrates the effectiveness of actions taken on behalf of the contractor.The
obligation to comply, however, is the contractor's.
8. The contractor is required to provide equal employment opportunity for all persons. Consequently, the
contractor may be in violation of the Fair Employment and Housing Act(Government Code section
12990 et seq.) if a particular group is employed in a substantially disparate manner.
9. The contractor shall not use the nondiscrimination standards to discriminate against any person
because race, religious creed, color, national origin, ancestry, physical disability, mental disability,
medical condition, genetic information, marital status, sex, gender,gender identity, gender
expression, age, sexual orientation, or military and veteran status.
10. The contractor shall not enter into any subcontract with any person or firm decertified from state
contracts pursuant to Government Code section 12990.
11. The contractor shall carry out such sanctions and penalties for violation of these specifications and
the nondiscrimination clause, including suspension, termination and cancellation of existing
subcontracts as may be imposed or ordered pursuant to Government Code section 12990 and its
implementing regulations by the awarding agency.Any contractor who fails to carry out such
sanctions and penalties shall be in violation of these specifications and Government Code section
12990.
12. The contractor shall designate a responsible official to monitor all employment related activity to
ensure that the company equal employment opportunity policy is being carried out, to submit reports
relating to the provisions hereof as may be required by OCP and to keep records. Records shall at
least include for each employee the name, address, telephone numbers,construction trade, union
affiliation if any, employee identification number when assigned,status, (e.g., mechanic, apprentice
trainee, helper, or laborer), dates of changes in status, hours worked per week in the indicated trade,
rate of pay, and locations at which the work was performed. Records shall be maintained in any
easily understandable and retrievable form; however, to the degree that existing records satisfy this
requirement, contractors shall not be required to maintain separate records.
Add to the end of the 2nd sentence in the 1st paragraph of section 7-1.02K(1):
04-22-16
and hauling and delivery of ready-mixed concrete.
Page 3 of 183
Add between the 4th and 5th paragraphs of section 7-1.02K(3):
04-22-16
Submitted certified payrolls for hauling and delivering ready-mixed concrete must be accompanied by a
written time record.The time record must include:
1. Truck driver's full name and address
2. Name and address of the factory or batching plant
3. Time the concrete was loaded at the factory or batching plant
4. Time the truck returned to the factory or batching plant
5. Truck driver's signature certifying under penalty of perjury that the information contained in this written
time record is true and correct
Add between the 9th and 10th paragraphs of section 7-1.03:
07-15-16
If a height differential of more than 0.04 foot is created by construction activities at a joint transverse to
the direction of traffic on the traveled way or a shoulder subject to public traffic, construct a temporary
taper at the joint with a slope complying with the requirements shown in the following table:
Temporary Tapers
Height differential Slope(horizontal:vertical)
(foot) Taper use of 14 days or less Taper use of more than 14 days
Greater than 0.08 100:1 or flatter 200:1 or flatter
0.04-0.08 70:1 or flatter 70:1 or flatter
For a taper on existing asphalt concrete or concrete pavement, construct the taper with minor HMA under
section 39-2.07.
Grind existing surfaces to accommodate a minimum taper thickness of 0.10 foot under either of the
following conditions:
1. HMA material such as rubberized HMA, polymer-modified bonded wearing course, or open-graded
friction course is unsuitable for raking to a maximum 0.02 foot thickness at the edge
2. Taper will be in place for more than 14 days
For a taper on a bridge deck or approach slab, construct the taper with polyester concrete under section
60-3.04B.
The completed surface of the taper must be uniform and must not vary more than 0.02 foot from the lower
edge of a 12-foot straightedge when placed on its surface parallel and perpendicular to traffic.
If authorized, you may use alternative materials or methods to construct the required taper.
Replace§337.15 in the 3rd item in the list in the paragraph of section 7-1.06B with:
05-06-16
§337.1
Add between the 1st and 2nd paragraphs of section 7-1.11A:
02-12-16
Comply with 46 CFR 381.7(a)—(b).
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
Page 4 of 183
8 PROSECUTION AND PROGRESS
07-15-16
Replace the table in the 3rd paragraph of section 8-1.10A with:
07-15-16
Liquidated Damages
Total bid Liquidated damages
From over To per day
$0 $60,000 $1,400
$60,000 $200,000 $2,900
$200,000 $500,000 $3,200
$500,000 $1,000,000 $3,500
$1,000,000 $2,000,000 $4,000
$2,000,000 $5,000,000 $4,800
$5,000,000 $10,000,000 $6,800
$10,000,000 $20,000,000 $10,000
$20,000,000 $50,000,000 $13,500
$50,000,000 $100,000,000 $19,200
$100,000,000 $250,000,000 $25,300
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
9 PAYMENT
01-15-16
Replace may withhold in the 1st paragraph of section 9-1.16E(4)with:
01-15-16
withholds
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
DIVISION II GENERAL CONSTRUCTION
10 GENERAL
04-15-16
Replace section 10-1.0213 with:
04-15-16
10-1.02B Traffic Elements
Before starting the operational test of a traffic management system that directly impacts traffic, the system
must be ready for operation, and all signs, pavement delineation, and pavement markings must be in
place at the system's location.
If maintaining existing traffic management system elements during construction is shown on the Bid Item
List, a list of the systems shown within the project limits and their operational status is included in the
Information Handout. Before starting job site activities, conduct a preconstruction operational status check
of the existing system's elements and each element's communication status with the transportation
management center to which it communicates. If an existing system element is discovered and has not
been identified, the Department adds the element to the list of systems.The pre-and postconstruction
operational status check of the discovered elements is change order work.
If maintaining existing traffic management system elements during construction is not shown on the Bid
Item List and an existing system element is discovered during the work, notify the Engineer.The Engineer
orders a pre-and postconstruction operational status check of the discovered elements.The status check
of the discovered elements is change order work.
Page 5 of 183
Conduct the status check with the Engineer and an electrical representative from the traffic operations
office of the district in which the work is located. The Department provides you a list of the preconstruction
operational status-check results, including:
1. Existing traffic management system elements and their locations within the project limits
2. Fully functioning elements
3. Nonoperational elements
Before Contract acceptance, conduct a postconstruction operational status check of all elements shown
on the list with the Engineer and an electrical representative from the traffic operations office of the district
in which the work is located.
Replace 10-3 of section 10 with:
04-15-16
10-2-10-3 RESERVED
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
12 TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL
07-15-16
Replace section 12-3.32 with:
04-15-16
12-3.32 PORTABLE CHANGEABLE MESSAGE SIGNS
12-3.32A General
12-3.32A(1) Summary
Section 12-3.32A includes specifications for placing portable changeable message signs.
12-3.32A(2) Definitions
Reserved
12-3.32A(3) Submittals
If requested, submit a certificate of compliance for each PCMS.
Submit your cell phone number before starting the first activity that requires a PCMS.
12-3.32A(4) Quality Assurance
Reserved
12-3.32B Materials
Each PCMS must have a message board, controller unit, power supply, and a structural support system.
The unit must be assembled to form a complete self-contained PCMS that can be delivered to the job site
and placed into immediate operation.The sign unit must be capable of operating at an ambient air
temperature from -4 to 158 degrees F and must be unaffected by mobile radio transmissions other than
those required to control the PCMS.
A PCMS must be permanently mounted on a trailer, truck bed, or truck cab under the manufacturer's
instructions.The PCMS must be securely mounted on the support vehicle such that it remains attached
during any impact to the vehicle. If it is mounted on a trailer, the trailer must be capable of being leveled
and plumbed.
A minimum of 3 feet of retroreflective material must be permanently affixed on all 4 sides of the trailer.
The retroreflective material need not be continuous but must be visible on the same plane.
The sign panel must be capable of displaying a 3-line message with at least 7 characters per line. The
characters must be at least 18 inches in height where the useable shoulder area is at least 15 feet wide.
Page 6 of 183
To prevent encroachment onto the traveled way where the useable shoulder area is less than 15 feet
wide, you may use a smaller message panel with at least 12-inch-high characters.
The message displayed on the sign must be visible from a distance of 1,500 feet and legible from a
distance of 750 feet at noon on a cloudless day and during the night by persons with 20/20 vision or
vision corrected to 20/20.
The characters on a sign panel may be 10 inches in height if:
1. PCMS is mounted on a service patrol truck or other incident response vehicle or used for traffic
control operations on a highway facility where the posted speed limit is less than 40 mph
2. Message is legible from a distance of at least 650 feet at noon on a cloudless day and during the
night by persons with 20/20 vision or vision corrected to 20/20
A matrix sign must provide a complete alphanumeric selection.
A PCMS must automatically adjust its brightness under varying light conditions to maintain the legibility of
the message. The sign must be equipped with an automatic-dimming mode that automatically
compensates for the influence of temporary light sources or abnormal lighting conditions.The sign must
have 3 or more manual dimming modes of different intensities.
During the hours of darkness, a matrix sign not using lamps must be either internally or externally
illuminated.
The controller must be an all solid-state unit containing the necessary circuitry for the storage of at least 5
preprogrammed messages.The controller must be installed at a location that allows the operator to
perform all functions from a single position. The controller must have a keyboard entry system that allows
the operator to generate an infinite number of additional messages in addition to the preprogrammed
stored messages. The keyboard must be equipped with a security lockout feature to prevent unauthorized
use of the controller.
The controller must have:
1. Nonvolatile memory that stores keyboard-created messages during periods when the power is not
activated
2. Variable display rate that allows the operator to match the information display to the speed of
approaching traffic
3. Screen upon which messages may be reviewed before being displayed on the sign
The flashing-off time must be adjustable from within the control cabinet.
12-3.32C Construction
Place a PCMS as far from the traveled way as practicable where it is legible to approaching traffic without
encroaching on the traveled way.Where the vertical roadway curvature restricts the sight distance of
approaching traffic, place the sign on or before the crest of the curvature where it is most visible to the
approaching traffic.Where the horizontal roadway curvature restricts the sight distance of approaching
traffic, place the sign at or before the curve where it is most visible to approaching traffic.Where
practicable, place the sign behind guardrail or Type K temporary railing.
Make a taper consisting of 9 traffic cones placed 25 feet apart to delineate the location of a PCMS except
where the sign is placed behind guardrail or Type K temporary railing.
When in full operation, the bottom of a sign must be at least 7 feet above the roadway in areas where
pedestrians are anticipated and 5 feet above the roadway elsewhere, and the top of the sign must be not
more than 14.5 feet above the roadway.
Operate the PCMS under the manufacturer's instructions.
Keep the PCMS clean to provide maximum visibility.
If multiple signs are needed, place each sign on the same side of the road at least 1,000 feet apart on
freeways and expressways and at least 500 feet apart on other types of highways.
Page 7 of 183
If more than one PCMS is simultaneously visible to traffic, only 1 sign may display a sequential message
at any time. Do not use dynamic message displays, such as animation, rapid flashing, dissolving,
exploding, scrolling, horizontal movement, or vertical movement of messages.The message must be
centered within each line of the display.
You may use an additional PCMS if more than 2 phases are needed to display a message.
Display only messages shown or ordered.
Repeat the entire message continuously in not more than 2 phases of at least 3 seconds per phase. The
sum of the display times for both of the phases must be a maximum of 8 seconds. If more than 2 phases
are needed to display a message, use an additional PCMS.
You must be available by cell phone during activities that require a sign. Be prepared to immediately
change the displayed message if ordered. You may operate the sign with a 24-hour timer control or
remote control if authorized.
After the initial placement, move a sign from location to location as ordered.
When a PCMS is not in use, move it to an area at least 15 feet from the edge of the traveled way or
remove it from the job site away from traffic.
12-3.32D Payment
Not Used
Add between the 1st sentence and 2nd sentences in the 1st paragraph of section 12-4.02A(3)(a):
07-15-16
For a project in District 7, submit the request at least 15 days before the proposed closure date.
Replace section 12-4.02C(2)with:
01-15-16
12-4.02C(2) Lane Closure System
12-4.02C(2)(a) General
The Department provides LCS training. Request the LCS training at least 30 days before submitting the
1 st closure request. The Department provides the training within 15 days after your request.
LCS training is web-based or held at a time and location agreed upon by you and the Engineer. For web-
based training,the Engineer provides you the website address to access the training.
With 5 business days after completion of the training, the Department provides LCS accounts and user
IDs to your assigned,trained representatives.
Each representative must maintain a unique password and current user information in the LCS.
04-15-16
The project is not accessible in LCS after Contract acceptance.
01-15-16
12-4.02C(2)(b) Status Updates for Authorized Closures
Update the status of authorized closures using the LCS Mobile web page.
For a stationary closure, use code:
1. 10-97 immediately before you place the 1st advance warning sign
2. 10-98 immediately after you remove all of the advance warning signs
For a moving closure, use code:
1. 10-97 immediately before the actual start time of the closure
2. 10-98 immediately after the actual end time of the closure
Page 8 of 183
Cancel an authorized closure by using code 10-22 within 2 hours after the authorized start time.
If you are unable to access the LCS Mobile web page, immediately notify the Engineer of the closure's
status.
Replace the 1st sentence in the 3rd paragraph of section 12-6.03Awith:
07-15-16
When the Engineer determines the temporary pavement delineation is no longer required for the direction
of traffic, remove the temporary pavement delineation, including any underlying adhesive for temporary
pavement markers,from the final layer of surfacing and from the pavement to remain in place.
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
13 WATER POLLUTION CONTROL
09-02-16
Replace General Industrial Permit in the 2nd item in the list in the paragraph of section 13-1.01 C(3)
with:
05-06-16
Industrial General Permit
Replace the 2nd paragraph of section 13-1.01 D(2)with:
05-06-16
Discharges from manufacturing facilities, such as batch plants and crushing plants, must comply with the
discharge requirements in the NPDES General Permit for Storm Water Discharges Associated with
Industrial Activities; Order No.2014-0057-DWQ, CAS000001 (Industrial General Permit), issued by the
SWRCB. For the Industrial General Permit, go to the SWRCB website.
Replace General Industrial Permit in the 3rd paragraph of section 13-1.01 D(2)with:
05-06-16
Industrial General Permit
Replace the 2nd paragraph of section 13-3.01 D(2)with:
09-02-16
For a project in the Lake Tahoe Hydrologic Unit, discharges of stormwater from the project must comply
with the NPDES General Permit for General Waste Discharge Requirements and National Pollutant
Discharge Elimination System General Permit for Storm Water Discharges Associated with Construction
Activity in the Lake Tahoe Hydrologic Unit, Counties of Alpine, El Dorado, and Placer, (Order No. R6T-
2016-0010 and NPDES No. CAG616002). You may view the General Permit for the Lake Tahoe
Hydrologic Unit at the Construction Storm Water Program page of the SWRCB website.
Replace the 2nd paragraph of section 13-8.01 D(2)with:
09-02-16
For a project within the Lake Tahoe Hydrologic Unit,the design, installation, operation, and monitoring of
the temporary ATS and monitoring of the treated effluent must comply with Attachment E of the NPDES
General Permit for General Waste Discharge Requirements and National Pollutant Discharge Elimination
System General Permit for Storm Water Discharges Associated with Construction Activity in the Lake
Tahoe Hydrologic Unit, Counties of Alpine, El Dorado, and Placer, (Order No. R6T-2016-0010 and
NPDES No. CAG616002). You may view the General Permit for the Lake Tahoe Hydrologic Unit at the
Construction Storm Water Program page of the SWRCB website.
Page 9 of 183
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
16 TEMPORARY FACILITIES
04-15-16
Add between the 1st and 2nd sentences of section 16-2.03A(1):
04-15-16
Constructing a high-visibility fence includes the installation of any signs specified in the special provisions.
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
DIVISION III EARTHWORK AND LANDSCAPE
20 LANDSCAPE
07-15-16
Replace 86 in the 1st paragraph of section 20-2.01C(2)with:
04-15-16
87
Replace the 8th paragraph of section 20-2.01 C(2)with:
07-15-16
Trenches for irrigation supply lines and conduits 3 inches and larger in diameter must be a minimum of 18
inches below the finished grade, measured to the top of the installed pipe.
Replace 86 in the 1st paragraph of section 20-2.01C(3)with:
04-15-16
87
Replace section 20-2.04A(4)with:
04-15-16
Perform conductors test.The test must comply with the specifications in section 87.
Where the conductors are installed by trenching and backfilling, perform the test after a minimum of 6
inches of backfill material has been placed and compacted over the conductors.
Replace the 1st paragraph of section 20-2.04C(4)with:
04-15-16
Splice low voltage control and neutral conductors under section 87, except do not use Method B.
Replace the 3rd paragraph of section 20-2.05B with:
07-15-16
The impeller must be glass reinforced nylon on a tungsten carbide shaft.
Replace 86 in the 2nd paragraph of section 20-2.06C with:
04-15-16
87
Page 10 of 183
Replace section 20-2.07B(5)with:
04-15-16
20-2.07B(5) PVC Pipe Conduit Sleeve
PVC pipe conduit sleeves must be schedule 40 complying with ASTM D1785.
Fittings must be schedule 80.
Replace section 20-2.07C(3)with:
04-15-16
20-2.07C(3) PVC Pipe Conduit Sleeve
Where PVC pipe conduit sleeves 2 inches or less in outside diameter is installed under surfacing, you
may install by directional boring under section 20-2.07C(2)(b).
For sleeves 2 inches or less in diameter,the top of the conduit must be a minimum of 18 inches below
surfacing.
Extend sleeves 6 inches beyond surfacing. Cap ends of conduit until used.
Replace sections 20-2.0913 and 20-2.09C with:
07-15-16
20-2.0913 Materials
20-2.09B(1) General
Swing joints must match the inlet connection size of the riser.
Where shown, a sprinkler assembly must include a check valve.
Threaded nipples for swing joints and risers must be schedule 80, PVC 1120 or PVC 1220 pipe, and
comply with ASTM D1785. Risers for sprinkler assemblies must be UV resistant.
Fittings for sprinkler assemblies must be injection-molded PVC, schedule 40, and comply with ASTM
D2466.
Flexible hose for sprinkler assemblies must be leak-free, non-rigid and comply with ASTM D2287, cell
Type 6564500.The hose must comply with ASTM D2122 and have the thickness shown in the following
table:
Nominal hose diameter Minimum wall thickness
(inch) (inch)
1/2 0.127
3/4 0.154
1 0.179
Solvent cement and fittings for flexible hose must comply with section 20-2.08B(5).
20-2.09B(2) Pop-Up Sprinkler Assemblies
Each pop-up sprinkler assembly must include a body, nozzle, swing joint, pressure reducing device,
fittings, and sprinkler protector where shown.
20-2.09B(3) Riser Sprinkler Assemblies
Each riser sprinkler assembly must include a body, flexible hose, threaded nipple, nozzle, swing joint
(except for a Type V riser), pressure reducing device,fittings, and riser support where shown.
20-2.09B(4) Tree Well Sprinkler Assemblies
Each tree well sprinkler assembly must include a threaded nipple, nozzle, swing joint,fittings, perforated
drainpipe, and drain grate.
Page 11 of 183
The perforated drainpipe must be commercial-grade, rigid PVC pipe with holes spaced not more than 6
inches on center on 1 side of the pipe.
The drain grate must be a commercially-available, 1-piece, injection-molded grate manufactured from
structural foam polyolefins with UV light inhibitors. Drain grate must be black.
Gravel for filling the drainpipe must be graded such that 100 percent passes the 3/4-inch sieve and 100
percent is retained on the 1/2-inch sieve. The gravel must be clean, washed, dry, and free from clay or
organic material.
20-2.09C Construction
Where shown, install a flow shut-off device under the manufacturer's instructions, unless you use
equipment with a preinstalled flow shut-off device.
Where shown, install a pressure reducing device under the manufacturer's instructions, unless you use
equipment with a preinstalled pressure reducing device.
Install pop-up and riser sprinkler assembly:
1. From 6-1/2 to 8 feet from curbs, dikes, and sidewalks
2. At least 10 feet from paved shoulders
3. At least 3 feet from fences and walls
If sprinkler assembly cannot be installed within these limits, the location will be determined by the
Engineer.
Set sprinkler assembly riser on slopes perpendicular to the plane of the slope.
Replace the paragraph of section 20-2.10B(3)with:
07-15-16
Each check valve must be one of the following:
1. Schedule 80 PVC with a factory setting to withstand a minimum 7-foot head on risers
2. Class 200 PVC if used on a nonpressurized plastic irrigation supply line
3. Internal to the sprinkler body with a factory setting to withstand a minimum 7-foot head
Replace the paragraph of section 20-2.10C(3)with:
07-15-16
Install check valves as necessary to prevent low-head drainage.
Replace the paragraphs of section 20-3.01 B(10)with:
07-15-16
Each plant stake for vines must be nominal 1 by 1 inch and 18 inches long.
Each plant stake for trees must be nominal 2 by 2 inches or nominal 2 inches in diameter and long
enough to keep the tree in an upright position.
Replace the paragraph of section 20-3.01 B(11)with:
07-15-16
Each plant tie for vines must be extruded vinyl-based tape, 1 inch wide and at least 8 mils thick.
Each plant tie for trees must be a (1)minimum 3/4-inch-wide, UV-resistant,flexible vinyl tie complying
with ASTM D412 for tensile and elongation strength, or(2)lock-stitch,woven polypropylene with a
minimum 900 lb tensile strength.
Page 12 of 183
Add between the 7th and 8th paragraphs of section 20-3.02C(3)(b):
07-15-16
Spread the vine shoots and tie them with a plant tie to each stake above the crossing point.
Replace the 8th paragraph of section 20-3.02C(3)(b)with:
07-15-16
Tie trees to the stakes with 2 tree ties, 1 tie to each stake. Each tie must form a figure eight by crossing
the tie between the tree and the stake. Install ties at the lowest position that will support the tree in an
upright position. Install the ties such that they provide trunk flexibility but do not allow the trunk to rub
against the stakes.Wrap each end of the tie 1-1/2 turns around the stake and securely tie or nail it to the
stake.
Replace the 1st paragraph of section 20-5.02C(1)with:
07-15-16
Where edging is used to delineate the limits of inert ground cover or wood mulch areas, install the edging
before installing the inert ground cover or wood mulch.
07-15-16
Delete AND MULCHES in the heading of section 20-5.03.
07-15-16
Delete and mulches in the paragraph of section 20-5.03A(1)(a).
Replace the paragraph of section 20-5.03A(3)(a)with:
07-15-16
Before installing inert ground cover, remove plants and weeds to the ground level.
07-15-16
Delete or mulch at each occurrence in sections 20-5.03A(3)(c)and 20-5.03A(3)(d).
Replace section 20-5.03E with:
07-15-16
20-5.03E Reserved
Replace section 20-5.04 with:
07-15-16
20-5.04 WOOD MULCH
20-5.04A General
20-5.04A(1) Summary
Section 20-5.04 includes specifications for placing wood mulch.
20-5.04A(2) Definitions
Reserved
20-5.04A(3) Submittals
Submit a certificate of compliance for wood mulch.
Submit a 2 cu ft mulch sample with the mulch source shown on the bag. Obtain authorization before
delivering the mulch to the job site.
20-5.04A(4) Quality Assurance
Reserved
Page 13 of 183
20-5.04B Materials
20-5.04B(1) General
Mulch must not contain more than 0.1 percent of deleterious materials such as rocks, glass, plastics,
metals, clods, weeds, weed seeds, coarse objects, sticks larger than the specified particle size, salts,
paint, petroleum products, pesticides or chemical residues harmful to plant or animal life.
20-5.04B(2) Tree Bark Mulch
Tree bark mulch must be derived from cedar, Douglas fir, or redwood species.
The mulch must be ground such that at least 95 percent of the material by volume is less than 2 inches
long in any dimension and no more than 30 percent by volume is less than 1 inch long in any dimension.
20-5.04B(3) Wood Chip Mulch
Wood chip mulch must:
1. Be derived from clean wood
2. Not contain leaves or small twigs
3. Contain at least 95 percent by volume of wood chips with a width and thickness from 1/16 to 3/8 inch
and a length from 1/2 to 3 inches
20-5.04B(4) Shredded Bark Mulch
Shredded bark mulch must:
1. Be derived from trees
2. Be a blend of loose, long, thin wood, or bark pieces
3. Contain at least 95 percent by volume of wood strands with a width and thickness from 1/8 to 1-1/2
inches and a length from 2 to 8 inches
20-5.04B(5) Tree Trimming Mulch
Tree trimming mulch must:
1. Be derived from chipped trees and may contain leaves and small twigs
2. Contain at least 95 percent by volume of material less than 3 inches long for any dimension and not
more than 30 percent by volume of material less than 1 inch long for any dimension
20-5.04B(6)-20-5.04B(11) Reserved
20-5.04C Construction
Before placing wood mulch, remove plants and weeds to the ground level.
Maintain the planned flow lines, slope gradients, and contours of the job site. Grade the subgrade to a
smooth and uniform surface.
Place mulch after the plants have been planted.
Place mulch in the plant basin at the rate described. Mulch must not come in contact with the plant crown
and stem.
Place mulch as shown in areas outside of plant basins to a uniform thickness.
Spread mulch from the outside edge of the plant basin to the adjacent edges of shoulders, paving,
retaining walls, dikes, edging, curbs, sidewalks,walls,fences, and existing plantings. If the plant is 12 feet
or more from the adjacent edges of any of these elements, spread the mulch 6 feet beyond the outside
edge of the plant basin.
Do not place mulch within 4 feet of:
1. Flow line of earthen drainage ditches
2. Edge of paved ditches
3. Drainage flow lines
Page 14 of 183
20-5.04D Payment
The payment quantity for wood mulch is the volume measured in the vehicle at the point of delivery.
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
21 EROSION CONTROL
07-15-16
Add between tube and 12 in the 1st paragraph of section 21-2.02Q:
07-15-16
8 or
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
DIVISION IV SUBASES AND BASES
23 GENERAL
07-15-16
Replace the headings and paragraphs in section 23 with:
07-15-16
23-1 GENERAL
23-1.01 GENERAL
23-1.01A Summary
Section 23 includes general specifications for constructing subbases and bases.
23-1.01B Definitions
Reserved
23-1.01C Submittals
Submit a QC plan for the types of subbases or bases where described.
23-1.01 D Quality Assurance
23-1.01D(1) General
23-1.01D(1)(a) General
Take samples under California Test 125.
23-1.01D(1)(b) Test Result Disputes
You and the Engineer must work together to avoid potential conflicts and to resolve disputes regarding
test result discrepancies. Notify the Engineer within 5 business days of receiving the test result if you
dispute the test result.
If you or the Engineer dispute each other's test results, submit your test results and copies of paperwork
including worksheets used to determine the disputed test results.An independent third party performs
referee testing. Before the independent third party participates in a dispute resolution, it must be qualified
under AASHTO Materials Reference Laboratory program and the Department's Independent Assurance
Program. The independent third party must have no prior direct involvement with this Contract. By mutual
agreement,the independent third party is chosen from:
1. Department laboratory in a district or region not in the district or region the project is located
2. Transportation Laboratory
3. Laboratory not currently employed by you or your material producer
If split acceptance samples are not available,the independent third party uses any available material
representing the disputed material for evaluation.
Page 15 of 183
If the independent third party determines the Department's test results are valid, the Engineer deducts the
independent third party testing costs from payments. If the independent third party determines your test
results are valid,the Department pays the independent third party testing costs.
23-1.01 D(2) Quality Control
23-1.01 D(2)(a) General
Provide a QC manager when the quantity of subbase or base is as shown in the following table:
QC Manager Requirements
Subbase or base Requirement
Stabilized soils d >_20,000
Aggregate subbases cu d >_20,000
Aggregate bases cu yd >_20,000
CTB cu d >_ 10,000
Lean concrete base cu d >_2,000
Rapid strength concrete base cu d >_ 1,000
Lean concrete base rapid setting cu d >_ 1,000
Concrete base cu d >_ 1,000
Treated permeable bases cu d >_2,000
Reclaimed pavements sq d >_ 10,000
Provide a testing laboratory to perform quality control tests. Maintain sampling and testing equipment in
proper working condition.
You are not entitled to compensation for the suspension of work resulting from noncompliance with
quality control requirements, including those identified within the QC plan.
23-1.01D(2)(b) Quality Control Plan
The QC plan must describe the organization and procedures used to:
1. Control the production process
2. Determine if a change to the production process is needed
3. Implement a change
The QC plan must include action and suspension limits and details of corrective action to be taken if any
process is outside of those limits. Suspension limits must not exceed specified acceptance criteria.
The QC plan must describe how test results will be submitted including times for sampling and testing for
each quality characteristic.
23-1.01D(2)(c) Qualifications
Testing laboratories and testing equipment must comply with the Department's Independent Assurance
Program.
Personnel performing sampling and testing must be qualified under the Department's Independent
Assurance Program for the sampling and testing performed.
23-1.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
Reserved
23-1.02 MATERIALS
Not Used
23-1.03 CONSTRUCTION
Not Used
23-1.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
Page 16 of 183
23-2-23-7 RESERVED
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
24 STABILIZED SOILS
07-15-16
Add to section 24-1.01 C(1):
07-15-16
Submit a stabilized soil quality control plan.
Add to section 24-1.01 D(1):
07-15-16
Construct test pads for compaction tests by scraping away material to the depth ordered. If a compaction
test fails, corrective action must include the layers of material already placed above the test pad elevation.
Replace section 24-1.01 D(2)with:
07-15-16
24-1.01 D(2) Quality Control
24-1.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
24-1.01D(2)(b) Quality Control Plan
Reserved
24-1.01D(2)(c) Qualifications
Reserved
24-1.01 D(2)(d) Preparing Basement Material
After preparing an area for soil stabilization, verify the surface grades.
24-1.01D(2)(e) Mixing
Except for clods larger than 1 inch, randomly test the adequacy of the mixing with a phenolphthalein pH
indicator solution.
Replace the 1st paragraph of section 24-1.03C with:
07-15-16
The Engineer orders the application rate as pounds of stabilizing agent per square yard of basement
material to be stabilized.
07-15-16
Delete section 24-2.01D(1)(c)
Replace 250 in the 2nd sentence in the 2nd paragraph of section 24-2.01 D(2)(c)with:
07-15-16
500
Page 17 of 183
Add to section 24-2.01 D(2):
07-15-16
24-2.01 D(2)(d) Quality Control Testing
Lime stabilized soil quality control must include testing the quality characteristics at the frequencies
shown in the following table:
QC Testing Frequencies
Quality characteristic Test method Sampling location Minimum frequency
Ground surface temperature -- Each temperature 1 test per 20,000 sq ft,
before adding lime and full depth location minimum 1 per day
ground temperature during
mixing operations
Lime application rate Calibrated Roadway 1 test per 40,000 sq ft,
tray orequal minimum 2 per day
Gradation on mixed material California Roadway 1 per 500 cu yd,
Test 202 minimum 1 per day
Moisture content California Roadway 1 per 500 cu yd on each
Test 226 layer, each day during
mixing and mellowing
periods, minimum 1 per
day
Relative compaction California Roadway 1 per 500 cu yd on each
Test 231 layer, minimum 1 per
day
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
25 AGGREGATE SUBBASES
07-15-16
Replace Reserved in section 25-1.01C with:
07-15-16
Submit an aggregate subbase QC plan.
Replace Reserved in section 25-1.01 D(2)with:
07-15-16
25-1.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
25-1.01 D(2)(b) Quality Control Plan
Reserved
25-1.01D(2)(c) Qualifications
Reserved
25-1.01D(2)(d) Quality Control Testing
AS quality control must include testing the quality characteristics at the frequencies shown in the following
table:
Page 18 of 183
QC Testing Frequencies
Quality Test method Sampling location Minimum frequency
characteristic
R-value California Test Stockpiles, 1 test before beginning work and
301 transportation units, every 2000 cu yd thereafter'
windrows,or
roadways
Aggregate California Test Stockpiles,
gradation 202 transportation units,
windrows,or
roadways 1 per 500 cu yd but at least one per
Sand equivalent California Test Stockpiles, day of placement
217 transportation units,
windrows,or
roadways
Relative California Test Roadway 1 per 500 sq yd on each layer
compaction 231
'Additional R-value frequency testing will not be required when the average of 4 consecutive sand
equivalent tests is 4 or more above the specified operating range value.
Add between the 2nd and 3rd paragraphs of section 25-1.01 D(3):
07-15-16
The Engineer takes aggregate subbase samples for R-value, aggregate gradation, and sand equivalent
from any of the following locations:
1. Windrow
2. Roadway
07-15-16
Delete for each noncompliant test result in the 4th paragraph of section 25-1.01 D(3).
07-15-16
Delete a in the 5th paragraph of section 25-1.01 D(3).
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
26 AGGREGATE BASES
07-15-16
Replace Reserved in section 26-1.01 C with:
07-15-16
Submit an aggregate base QC plan.
Replace Reserved in section 26-1.01D(1)with:
07-15-16
Aggregate samples must not be treated with lime, cement, or chemicals before testing for durability index.
Aggregate from untreated reclaimed processed AC, PCC, LCB, or CTB is not considered treated.
Page 19 of 183
Replace Reserved in section 26-1.01D(2)with:
07-15-16
26-1.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
26-1.01 D(2)(b) Quality Control Plan
Reserved
26-1.01D(2)(c) Qualifications
Reserved
26-1.01 D(2)(d) Quality Control Testing
AB quality control must include testing the quality characteristics at the frequencies shown in the following
table:
QC Testing Frequencies
Quality characteristic Test method Sampling location Minimum frequency
R-value California Test 301 Stockpiles, 1 test before starting work and
transportation units, every 2,000 cu yd thereafter
windrows,or
roadways
Aggregate gradation California Test 202 Stockpiles, 1 per 500 cu yd but at least
transportation units, one per day of placement
windrows,or
roadways
Sand equivalent California Test 217 Stockpiles,
transportation units,
windrows,or
roadways
Durability indexb California Test 229 Stockpiles, 1 per project
transportation units,
windrows,or
roadways
Relative compaction California Test 231 Roadway 1 per 500 sq yd on each layer
aAdditional R-value frequency testing will not be required when the average of 4 consecutive sand
equivalent tests is 29 or greater for Class 2 AB or 25 or greater for Class 3 AB.
bApplies if section 26-1.02 contains an applicable requirement for durability index
Add between requirements, and and in the 1st paragraph of section 26-1.01 D(3):
07-15-16
durability,
Add between the 2nd and 3rd paragraphs of section 26-1.01 D(3):
07-15-16
The Engineer takes aggregate base samples for R-value, aggregate gradation, sand equivalent, and
durability index from any of the following locations:
1. Windrow
2. Roadway
07-15-16
Delete the 3rd paragraph of section 26-1.01 D(3).
Page 20 of 183
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
27 CEMENT TREATED BASES
07-15-16
Add to section 27-1.01 C:
07-15-16
Submit cement treated base QC plan.
Replace the headings and paragraphs in section 27-1.01 D with:
07-15-16
27-1.01 D Quality Assurance
27-1.01D(1) General
After the CTB has been spread on the subgrade and before initial compaction, the cement content of the
completed mixture of CTB must not vary from the specified cement content by more than 0.6 percent of
the weight of the dry aggregate when tested under California Test 338.
For Class A CTB, compaction is tested under California Test 312 or 231.
The relative compaction of CTB must be at least 95 percent. Each layer of CTB may be tested for
compaction, or all layers may be tested together at the option the Engineer. If all layers are tested
together, you are not relieved of the responsibility to achieve the required compaction in each layer
placed.
27-1.01D(1)(a) Aggregate
When tested under California Test 301, aggregate for Class B CTB must have (1) an R-value of at least
60 before mixing with cement and (2)an R-value of at least 80 when aggregate is mixed with an amount
of cement that does not exceed 2.5 percent by weight of the dry aggregate.
Before sand equivalent testing, aggregate samples must not be treated with lime, cement, or chemicals.
If the aggregate gradation test results,the sand equivalent test results, or both comply with contract
compliance requirements but not operating range requirements, you may continue placing CTB for the
remainder of the work day. Do not place additional CTB until you demonstrate to the Engineer that the
CTB to be placed complies with the operating range requirements.
If the aggregate gradation test results, sand equivalent test results, or both do not comply with contract
compliance requirements, remove the CTB or request a payment deduction. If your request is authorized,
$2.50/cu yd is deducted. If CTB is paid for by weight,the Engineer converts tons to cubic yards for the
purpose of reducing payment for noncompliant CTB left in place.An aggregate gradation and a sand
equivalent test represents up to (1)500 cu yd or(2) 1 day's production if less than 500 cu yd.
27-1.01D(1)(b) Road-Mixed Cement Treated Base Moisture Content
Just before initial compaction the moisture content of the completed mixture must be at least the optimum
moisture content less 1 percent. The moisture content is determined under California Test 226 and
optimum moisture content is determined under California Test 312.
27-1.01D(1)(c) Plant-Mixed Cement Treated Base Moisture Content
At the point of delivery to the work,the moisture content of the completed mixture must be at least the
optimum moisture content less 1 percent.The moisture content is determined under California Test 226
and optimum moisture content under California Test 312.
27-1.01 D(2) Quality Control
27-1.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
27-1.01D(2)(b) Quality Control Plan
Reserved
Page 21 of 183
27-1.01 D(2)(c) Qualifications
Reserved
27-1.01 D(2)(d) Quality Control Testing
CTB quality control must include testing the quality characteristics at the frequencies shown in the
following table:
QC Testing Frequencies
Quality characteristic Test method Sampling location Minimum frequency
Aggregate gradation California Test 202 Stockpiles,plant,
modified transportation units, 1 per 500 cu yd but at
windrow, or roadway least one per day of
Sand equivalent California Test 217 Stockpiles,plant, placement
transportation units,
windrow, or roadway
R-value' California Test 301 Stockpiles,plant, 1 test before starting work
transportation units, and every 2000 cu yd
windrows,or roadway thereafterb
Optimum moisture California Test 312 Plant,transportation 1 per day of placement
content units,windrow, or
roadway
Moisture content California Test 226 Roadway 1 per 500 cu yd but at
least one per day of
placement
Cement content California Test 338 Windrows or roadway 1 per 1000 cu yd but at
least one per day of
placement
Relative compaction California Test 312 or Roadway 1 per 2000 sq yd but at
231 least one per day of
placement
Compressive strength° California Test 312 Windrow or roadways 1 per day of placement
R-value is required for Class B CTB only
bAdditional R-value frequency testing will not be required while the average of 4 consecutive sand
equivalent tests is 4 or more above the specified operating range value.
°Compressive strength is required for Class A CTB only when specified
27-1.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
The Department's acceptance testing includes testing the CTB quality characteristics shown in the
following table:
CTB Requirements for Acceptance
Quality characteristic Test method
Aggre ate gradation California Test 202 modified
Sand equivalent California Test 217
R-value' California Test 301
Optimum moisture content California Test 312
Moisture content California Test 226
Cement content California Test 338
Relative compaction California Test 312 or 231
Compressive strength California Test 312
R-value is required for Class B CTB only
bCompressive strength is required for Class A CTB only when specified
The Engineer takes samples for aggregate gradation and sand equivalent from any of the following
locations:
1. Plant
Page 22 of 183
2. Truck
3. Windrow,for road-mixed only
4. Roadbed,for road-mixed only
Add to section 27-1.02:
07-15-16
Water must comply with section 90-1.02D.
Add to section 27-1.03F:
07-15-16
The relative compaction of CTB must be at least 95 percent.
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
28 CONCRETE BASES
07-15-16
Replace the headings and paragraphs in section 28-1.01 D with:
07-15-16
28-1.01 D Quality Assurance
28-1.01D(1) General
Aggregate samples must not be treated with lime, cement, or chemicals before testing for sand
equivalent.
Stop concrete base activities and immediately notify the Engineer whenever:
1. Any QC or QA test result does not comply with the specifications
2. Visual inspection shows a noncompliant concrete base
If concrete base activities are stopped, before resuming activities:
1. Notify the Engineer of the adjustments you will make
2. Remedy or replace the noncompliant concrete base
3. Field qualify or construct a new test strip as specified for the concrete base involved to demonstrate
compliance with the specifications
4. Obtain authorization
28-1.01 D(2) Quality Control
28-1.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
28-1.01 D(2)(b) Quality Control Plan
Reserved
28-1.01D(2)(c) Qualifications
Reserved
28-1.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
Reserved
Add to section 28-2.01 C(1):
07-15-16
Submit a lean concrete base QC plan.
Page 23 of 183
Replace the headings and paragraphs in section 28-2.01 D with:
07-15-16
28-2.01 D Quality Assurance
28-2.01D(1) General
28-2.01D(1)(a) General
The molds for compressive strength testing under ASTM C31 or ASTM C192 must be 6 by 12 inches.
If the aggregate gradation test results, sand equivalent test results or both comply with the contract
compliance requirements but not the operating range requirements, you may continue placing LCB for the
remainder of the work day. Do not place additional LCB until you demonstrate the LCB to be placed
complies with the operating range requirements.
28-2.01D(1)(b) Qualifications
Field qualification tests and calculations must be performed by an ACI certified "Concrete Laboratory
Technician, Grade I.
28-2.01D(1)(c) Aggregate Qualification Testing
Qualify the aggregate for each proposed aggregate source and gradation.The qualification tests include
(1)a sand equivalent and (2)an average 7-day compressive strength under ASTM C39 of 3 cylinders
manufactured under ASTM C192 except cure cylinders in molds without lids after initial curing.
For the compressive strength test,the cement content for each cylinder must be 300 Ib/cu yd.The 7-day
average compressive strength must be at least 610 psi.The cement must be Type II portland cement.
LCB must have from 3 to 4 percent air content during aggregate qualification testing.
28-2.0113(1)(d) Field Qualification Testing
Before placing LCB, you must perform field qualification testing and obtain authorization for each mix
design. Retest and obtain authorization for changes to the authorized mix designs.
Notify the Engineer at least 5 business days before field qualification. Perform the field qualification at the
job site or an authorized location.
Field qualification testing includes tests for compressive strength, air content, and penetration or slump.
For compressive strength field qualification testing:
1. Prepare 12 cylinders under ASTM C31 except final cure cylinders in molds without lids from a single
batch.
2. Perform 3 tests; each test consists of determining the average compressive strength of 2 cylinders at
7 days under ASTM C39. The average compressive strength for each test must be at least 530 psi
If you submitted a notice to produce LCB qualifying for a transverse contraction joint waiver, manufacture
additional specimens and test the LCB for compressive strength at 3 days. Prepare the compressive
strength cylinders under ASTM C31 except final cure cylinders in molds without lids at the same time
using the same material and procedures as the 7-day compressive strength cylinders except do not
submit 6 additional test cylinders.The average 3-day compressive strength for each test must be not
more than 500 psi.
28-2.01D(2) Quality Control
28-2.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
28-2.01 D(2)(b) Quality Control Manager
Reserved
28-2.01D(2)(c) Quality Control Testing
Test the LCB under the test methods and at the locations and frequencies shown in the following table:
Page 24 of 183
LCB Sampling Location and Testing Frequencies
Quality characteristic Test method Sampling location Minimum sampling and
testing frequency
Sandequivalent ASTM D2419 Source
Aggregate gradation ASTM C136
Air content ASTM C231 1 per 500 cubic yards
Penetration ASTM C360 but at least 1 per day of
Slumpa ASTM C143 Job site production
Compressive strength ASTM C39
Test for either penetration or slump
bPrepare cylinders under ASTM C31 except final cure cylinders in molds without lids.
28-2.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
The Department accepts LCB based on compliance with the requirements shown in the following table:
LCB Requirements for Acceptance
Quality characteristic I Test method Requirement
Compressive strength (min, psi at 7 days) I ASTM C39a 530
Cylinders prepared under ASTM C31 except final cure cylinders in molds without lids.
bA compressive strength test represents up to (1) 1,000 cu yd or(2) 1 day's production if
less than 1,000 cu yd.
Replace section 28-2.01D(4)in item 3 of the 5th paragraph in section 28-2.03D with:
07-15-16
section 28-2.01 D(1)(c)
Replace the 1st paragraph in section 28-2.03F with:
07-15-16
After finishing LCB, cure LCB with pigmented curing compound under section 90-1.03B(3)and 40-1.031.
Apply curing compound:
1. In 2 separate applications
2. Before the atmospheric temperature falls below 40 degrees F
3. At a rate of 1 gal/150 sq ft for the first application
4. At a rate of 1 gal/200 sq ft for the second application
Replace Reserved in section 28-3.01C(3)with:
07-15-16
Submit a rapid strength concrete base QC plan.
Replace the headings and paragraphs in section 28-3.01 D with:
07-15-16
28-3.01 D Quality Assurance
28-3.01D(1) General
28-3.01D(1)(a) General
At the preconstruction meeting be prepared to discuss the project specifications and methods of
performing each item of work. Items discussed must include the processes for:
1. Production
2. Transportation
Page 25 of 183
3. Placement
4. QC plan, if specified in the special provisions
5. Contingency plan
6. QC sampling and testing
7. Acceptance criteria
Beams for modulus of rupture testing must be fabricated and tested under California Test 524. The beams
may be fabricated using an internal vibrator under ASTM C31. For each test, 3 beam must be
fabricated and the test results averaged. No single test represents more than that day's production or 130
cu yd, whichever is less.
For early age testing, beams must be cured so the monitored temperatures in the beams and the test
strip are always within 5 degrees F. The internal temperatures of the RSC base and early age beams
must be monitored and recorded at intervals of at least 5 minutes.Thermocouples or thermistors
connected to strip-chart recorders or digital data loggers must be installed to monitor the temperatures.
Temperature recording devices must be accurate to within ±2 degrees F. Until early age testing is
completed, internal temperatures must be measured at 1 inch from the top, 1 inch from the bottom, and
no closer than 3 inches from any edge.
For other age testing, beams must be cured under California Test 524 except beams must be placed into
sand at a time that is the earlier of either from 5 to 10 times the final set time, or 24 hours.
RSC base must have an opening age modulus of rupture of not less than 400 psi and a 7-day modulus of
rupture of not less than 600 psi.
28-3.01D(1)(b) Preconstruction Meeting
Reserved
28-3.01D(1)(c) Test Strip
Reserved
28-3.01D(2) Quality Control
28-3.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
28-3.01D(2)(b) Quality Control Manager
Reserved
28-3.01D(2)(c) Quality Control Testing
Test the rapid strength concrete base under the test methods and at the locations and frequencies shown
in the following table:
Page 26 of 183
Rapid Strength Concrete Base Sampling Location and Testing Frequencies
Quality characteristic Test method Sample Location Minimum testing frequencya
Cleanness value California Test 227 1 per 500 cubic yards but at
Sand equivalent California Test 217 Source least 1 per shift
Aggregate gradation California Test 202
Air content California Test 504 1 per 130 cu yd but at least 1 per
shift
Yield California Test 518 1 per shift
Slump or penetration ASTM C143 or California 1 per 2 hours of placement
Test 533 Job site
Density California Test 518 1 per shift
Aggregate moisture California Test 223 or 1 per shift
meter calibration California Test 226
Modulus of rupture California Test 524 1 per 130 cu yd but at least 1 per
shift
Test at the most frequent interval.
bCheck calibration of the plant moisture meter by comparing moisture meter readings with California Test
223 or California Test 226 test results.
Notify the Engineer at least 2 business days before any sampling and testing. Submit testing results
within 15 minutes of testing completion. Record inspection, sampling, and testing on the forms accepted
with the QC plan and submit them within 48 hours of completion of each day of production and within 24
hours of 7-day modulus of rupture tests.
During the placement of RSC base,fabricate beams and test for the modulus of rupture:
1. At opening age
2. At 7 days after placing the first 30 cu yd
3. At least once every 130 cu yd
4. Within the final truckload
Opening age tests must be performed in the presence of the Engineer.
28-3.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
The Department accepts RSC base based on compliance with the requirements shown in the following
table:
RSC Base Requirements for Acceptance
Quality characteristic I Test method Requirement
Modulus of rupture minpsi at 7 da s California Test 524 600
The Engineer adjust payment for RSC base for the 7-day modulus of rupture as follows:
1. Payment for a base with a modulus of rupture of 600 psi or greater is not adjusted.
2. Payment for a base with a modulus of rupture of less than 600 and greater than or equal to 550 psi is
reduced by 5 percent.
3. Payment for a base with a modulus of rupture of less than 550 and greater than or equal to 500 psi is
reduced by 10 percent.
4. Payment for a base with a modulus of rupture of less than 500 psi is not adjusted and no payment is
made. Remove and replace this base.
Add to section 28-4.01C(1):
07-15-16
Submit a lean concrete base rapid setting QC plan.
Page 27 of 183
Replace the headings and paragraphs in section 28-4.01 D with:
07-15-16
28-4.01 D Quality Assurance
28-4.01D(1) General
28-4.01D(1)(a) General
For compressive strength testing, prepare 6 cylinders under California Test 540. Test cylinders must be 6
by 12 inches.As an alternative to rodding, a vibrator may be used under California Test 524. Test
cylinders under California Test 521 and perform 3 tests with each test consisting of 2 cylinders. The test
result is the average from the 2 cylinders.
28-4.01D(1)(b) Field Qualification
Before placing lean concrete base rapid setting, you must perform field qualification testing and obtain
authorization for each mix design. Retest and obtain authorization for changes to authorized mixed
designs.
Proposed mix designs must be field qualified before you place the base represented by those mix
designs.The technician performing the field test must hold current ACI certification as a Concrete Field
Testing Technician-Grade I.
Notify the Engineer at least 5 days before field qualification. Perform field qualification within the job site
or a location authorized.
Field qualification testing includes compressive strength, air content, and penetration or slump in
compliance with the table titled "Lean Concrete Base Rapid Setting Requirements."
Field qualification must comply with the following:
1. Test for compressive strength at opening age and 7 days of age
2. At opening age, the compressive strength for each test must be at least 180 psi and the average
strength for the 3 tests must be at least 200 psi
3. At 7 days age, the compressive strength for each test must be at least 600 psi and the average
strength for the 3 tests must be at least 725 psi
28-4.01 D(2) Quality Control
28-4.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
28-4.01 D(2)(b) Quality Control Manager
Reserved
28-4.01 D(2)(c) Quality Control Testing
Test the base under the test methods and at the locations and frequencies shown in the following table:
LCB Rapid Setting Sampling Location and Testing Frequencies
Quality characteristic Test method Sampling Minimum sampling and testing
location frequency
Sand equivalent ASTM D2419 1 per 500 cu yd, minimum 1 per day
Aggregate gradation ASTM C136 Source of production
Air content ASTM C231
Penetration ASTM C360 Slumps ASTM C143 Job site 1 per 4 hours of placement work, plus Compressive strength California Test 521 one in the last hour of placement work
aTest either penetration or slump
During placement of lean concrete base rapid setting,fabricate cylinders and test compressive strength
for opening age and 7 days. Opening age tests must be performed in the presence of the Engineer.
Page 28 of 183
28-4.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
The Department accepts LCB rapid setting based on compliance with the requirement shown in the
following table:
LCB Rapid Setting Requirements for Acceptance
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Compressive strength (min, psi at 7 days) California Test 521 725
'Cylinders made under California Test 540
Replace the 2nd and 3rd paragraphs in section 28-4.03A with:
07-15-16
Concrete paving operations with equipment not supported by the base may start before opening age. Do
not open pavement for traffic before opening age of the LCB rapid setting.
Any other paving operations must start after the final set time of the base. The base must have a
compressive strength of at least 450 psi under California Test 521 before:
1. Placing HMA
2. Placing other base material
3. Operating equipment on the base
Replace Reserved in section 28-5.01C with:
07-15-16
Submit a concrete base QC plan.
Replace the headings and paragraphs in section 28-5.01 D(2)with:
07-15-16
28-5.01 D(2) Quality Control
28-5.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
28-5.01 D(2)(b) Quality Control Manager
Reserved
28-5.01D(2)(c) Quality Control Testing
Test the concrete base under the test methods and at the locations and frequencies shown in the
following table:
Page 29 of 183
Concrete Base Sampling Location and Testing Frequencies
Quality characteristic Test method Sample location Minimum testing frequencya
Cleanness value California Test 227 1 per 500 cubic yards but at
Sand equivalent California Test 217 Source least 1 per shift
Aggregate gradation California Test 202
Air content California Test 504 1 per 500 cu yd but at least 1 per
shift
Yield California Test 518 1 per shift
Slump or penetration ASTM C143 or California 1 per 2 hours of placement
Test 533 Job site
Density California Test 518 1 per shift
Aggregate moisture California Test 223 or 1 per shift
meter calibration California Test 226
Modulus of rupture California Test 524 1 per 500 cu yd but at least 1 per
shift
Test at the most frequent interval.
bCheck calibration of the plant moisture meter by comparing moisture meter readings with California Test
223 or California Test 226 test results.
28-5.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
The Department accepts a concrete base based on compliance with the requirements shown in the
following table:
Concrete Base Requirements for Acceptance
Quality characteristic I Test method Requirement
Modulus of rupture min psi at 28 days) California Test 523 570
Acceptance for the modulus of rupture is on a lot basis. The Department provides the molds and
machines for the modulus of rupture acceptance testing. Provide any material and labor the Engineer
may require for the testing.
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
29 TREATED PERMEABLE BASES
07-15-16
Replace the headings and paragraphs in section 29-1.01 with:
07-15-16
29-1.01 GENERAL
29-1.01A Summary
Section 29-1 includes general specifications for constructing treated permeable bases.
29-1.01B Definitions
Reserved
29-1.01C Submittals
Submit a treated permeable base quality control plan.
29-1.01 D Quality Assurance
29-1.01D(1) General
Reserved
Page 30 of 183
29-1.01 D(2) Quality Control
29-1.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
29-1.01 D(2)(b) Quality Control Plan
Reserved
29-1.011)(2)(c) Qualifications
Reserved
29-1.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
Reserved
Replace the headings and paragraphs in section 29-2.01 D with:
07-15-16
29-2.01 D Quality Assurance
29-2.011)(1) General
The Engineer determines the asphalt content of the asphalt mixture under California Test 382. The
bitumen ratio, pounds of asphalt per 100 lb of dry aggregate, must not vary more than 0.5 lb of asphalt
above or below the quantity designated by the Engineer. Samples used to determine the bitumen ratio
are obtained from trucks at the plant or from the mat behind the paver before rolling. If the sample is
taken from the mat behind the paver,the bitumen ratio must not be less than the quantity designated by
the Engineer, less 0.7 lb of asphalt per 100 lb of dry aggregate.
29-2.01 D(2) Quality Control
29-2.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
29-2.01 D(2)(b) Quality Control Testing
ATPB quality control must include testing the quality characteristics at the frequencies shown in the
following table:
QC Testing Frequencies
Quality characteristic Test method Sampling location Minimum frequency
Gradation California Test Stockpiles or plant 1 for every 4 hours of
202 production but at least one
Per day of placement
Cleanness value California Test Stockpiles or plant 1 for every 4 hours of
227 production but at least one
per day
Percentage of crushed California Test Stockpiles or plant 1 test before production and
particles 205 one every 5,000 cu yd
thereafter
Los Angeles rattler loss at California Test Stockpiles or plant 1 test before production and
500 rev 211 one every 5,000 cu yd
thereafter
Film stripping California Test Plant 1 test before production and
302 one every 5000 cu yd
thereafter
Asphalt content of the California Test Plant,transportation 1 for every 4 hours of
asphalt mixture 382 units,windrows, or production but at least one
roadway per day
Page 31 of 183
29-2.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
The Department accepts ATPB based on aggregate gradation, cleanness value, percent of crushed
particles, Los Angeles rattler,film stripping and asphalt content requirements specified in section 29-2.02
and section 29-2.01 D(1).
The Engineer takes samples for aggregate gradation, cleanness value, percent of crushed particles, Los
Angeles rattler, and film stripping from the plant.
The Engineer takes samples for asphalt content of the asphalt mixture from any of the following locations:
1. Plant
2. Truck
3. Windrow
4. Roadbed
Replace the headings and paragraphs in section 29-3.01 with:
07-15-16
29-3.01 GENERAL
29-3.01A Summary
Section 29-3 includes specifications for constructing cement treated permeable bases.
29-3.01 B Definitions
Reserved
29-3.01C Submittals
Reserved
29-3.01 D Quality Assurance
29-3.01D(1) General
Reserved
29-3.01 D(2) Quality Control
29-3.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
29-3.01 D(2)(b) Quality Control Testing
CTPB quality control must include testing the quality characteristics at the frequencies shown in the
following table:
QC Testing Frequencies
Quality characteristic Test method Sampling location Minimum frequency
Gradation California Test Stockpiles or plant 1 for every 4 hours of
202 production but at least one
per daV of placement
Cleanness value California Test Stockpiles or plant 1 for every 4 hours of
227 production but at least one
per day
Los Angeles rattler California Test Stockpiles or plant 1 test before production and
loss at 500 rev 211 one every 5,000 cu yd
thereafter
Soundness California Test Stockpiles or plant 1 test before production and
214 one every 5,000 cu yd
thereafter
Page 32 of 183
29-3.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
The Department accepts CTPB based on aggregate gradation, cleanness value, Los Angeles rattler and
soundness requirements in section 29-3.02.
The Engineer takes samples for aggregate gradation, cleanness value, Los Angeles rattler and
soundness from the plant.
Add to section 29-3.02A:
07-15-16
Water must comply with section 90-1.02D.
Replace 3rd in the 2nd paragraph in section 29-3.03 with:
07-15-16
4th
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
30 RECLAIMED PAVEMENT
07-15-16
Replace section 30-1.01C(2)(c)in the 1st paragraph of section 30-3.01C(2)(c)with:
07-15-16
section 30-1.01 C(3)(c)
Page 33 of 183
Replace the table in section 30-3.02A with:
07-15-16
FDR—Foamed Asphalt Quality Characteristic Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Moisture content before HMA paving California Test 226 < 50% of OMC
Asphalt binder expansion ratio 10
(min, %) Note a
Asphalt binder half-life 12
(seconds,min)
Gradation(%, passing)
Sieve Size:
3 inch California Test 202 100
2 inch 95-100
1-1/2 inch 85-100
Moisture content
Maximum California Test 226 OMC
Minimum OMC-2%
In-place wet density California Test 216 Report only
Ib/cu ft
Relative compaction California Test 231 98
(min, %)
Indirect dry tensile strength (psi)b California Test 371 90%of mix design value
Indirect wet tensile strength (psi)b California Test 371 90%of mix design value
Tensile strength ratio California Test 371 90%of mix design value
(%)
Test at the foaming temperature and percentage of foaming water by dry weight of FDR—foamed
asphalt material designated in the mix design.To test asphalt binder expansion ratio and half-life, use
a pail of known volume and a dipstick calibrated for the pail. From the inspection nozzle on the asphalt
binder spray bar, inject foamed asphalt into the pail without exceeding the pail's capacity.
With the dipstick, immediately measure and record the level of foamed asphalt in the pail. Record the
half-life in seconds from the time the injection of foamed asphalt in the pail is turned off to half the dip
stick reading after peak. Calculate the expansion ratio as the volume of the foamed asphalt upon
injection divided by the volume of the unfoamed asphalt binder.
bFrom material passing the 1-inch sieve, compact 6 specimens under California Test 304, Part 2.
Cure the specimens at 100 °F for 72 hours and allow the specimens to cool to room temperature.
Test 3 specimens for dry tensile strength under California Test 371. Test 3 specimens for wet tensile
strength under California Test 371 after moisture conditioning.
Replace section 30-4.01D(3) in the 2nd paragraph of section 30-4.01D(1)with:
07-15-16
section 30-4.01 D(4)
Replace section 30-4.01D(1)(a) in the table in section 30-4.02Awith:
07-15-16
section 30-4.01 D(2)
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
Page 34 of 183
DIVISION V SURFACINGS AND PAVEMENTS
37 BITUMINOUS SEALS
07-15-16
Replace section 37 with:
07-15-16
37 SEAL COATS
37-1 GENERAL
37-1.01 GENERAL
37-1.01A Summary
Section 37-1 includes general specifications for applying seal coats.
37-1.0113 Definitions
Reserved
37-1.01C Submittals
At least 10 days before the preconstruction meeting submit a list of participants in the preconstruction
meeting. Provide each participant's name, employer,title, and role in the production and placement of the
seal coats.
At least 10 days before starting seal coat activities, submit the names of the authorized laboratories for
quality control testing.
For each delivery of asphalt binder or asphaltic emulsion to the job site, submit a certificate of compliance
and a copy of the specified test results.
For a seal coat that uses crumb rubber modifier, submit a Crumb Rubber Usage Report form monthly and
at the end of project.
37-1.01 D Quality Assurance
37-1.0113(1) General
For aggregate testing, quality control laboratories must be in compliance with the Department's
Independent Assurance Program to be an authorized laboratory. Quality control personnel must be
qualified under the Department's Independent Assurance Program.
For emulsion testing, quality control laboratories must participate in the AASHTO Material's Reference
Laboratory proficiency sample program.
37-1.01D(2) Preconstruction Meeting
Hold a preconstruction meeting within 5 days before start of seal coat work at a mutually agreed time and
place with the Engineer and your:
1. Project superintendent
2. Project foreman
3. Traffic control foreman
Make arrangements for the conference facility. Preconstruction meeting participants must sign an
attendance sheet provided by the Engineer. Be prepared to discuss:
1. Quality control testing
2. Acceptance testing
3. Seal coat placement
4. Proposed application rates for asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder and aggregate.
5. Training on placement methods
6. Checklist of items for proper placement
7. Unique issues specific to the project, including:
7.1. Weather
7.2. Alignment and geometrics
7.3. Traffic control requirements
Page 35 of 183
7.4. Haul distances
7.5. Presence and absence of shaded areas
7.6. Any other local conditions
8. Contingency plan for material deliveries, equipment breakdowns, and traffic handling
9. Who in the field has authority to adjust application rates and how adjustments will be documented
10. Schedule of sweepings
37-1.02 MATERIALS
Not Used
37-1.03 CONSTRUCTION
37-1.03A General
If seal coat activities affect access to public parking, residential property, or commercial property, post
signs at 100-foot intervals on the affected streets. Signs must display No Parking— Tow Away. Signs
must state the dates and hours parking or access will be restricted. Notify residents, businesses, and
local agencies at least 24 hours before starting activities.The notice must:
1. Describe the work to be performed
2. Detail streets and limits of activities
3. Indicate dates and work hours
4. Be authorized
Asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder for seal coats may be reheated if necessary. After loading the
asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder into a truck for transport to the job site, do not heat asphaltic
emulsion above 160 degrees F and asphalt rubber binder above 425 degrees F. During reheating,
circulate or agitate the asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder to prevent localized overheating.
Except for fog seals, apply quick setting Grade 1 asphaltic emulsions at a temperature from 75 to 130
degrees F and apply quick setting Grade 2 asphaltic emulsions at a temperature from 110 to 185 degrees
F.
You determine the application rates for asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder and aggregate and the
Engineer authorizes the application rates.
37-1.0313 Equipment
A self-propelled distributor truck for applying asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder must be equipped with:
1. Pressure-type system with insulated tanks with circulating unit
2. Spray bars:
2.1. With minimum length of 9 feet and full-circulating type
2.2. With full-circulating-type extensions if needed to cover a greater width
2.3. Adjustable to allow positioning at various heights above the surface to be treated
2.4. Operated by levers such that 1 or all valves may be quickly opened or closed in one operation
3. Devices and charts to provide for accurate and rapid determination and control of asphaltic emulsion
or asphalt binder quantities being applied. Include an auxiliary wheel type meter that registers:
3.1. Speed in ft/min
3.2. Trip by count
3.3. Total distance in feet
4. Distribution system:
4.1. Capable of producing a uniform application of asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder in controlled
quantities ranging from 0.02 to 1 gal/sq yd of surface and at a pressure ranging from 25 to 75
psi
4.2. Pumps that spray asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder within 0.02 gal/sq yd of the set rate
4.3. With a hose and nozzle for application of asphaltic emulsion to areas inaccessible to the spray
bar
4.4. With pressure gauges and a thermometer for determining temperatures of the asphaltic
emulsion or asphalt binder
Page 36 of 183
You may use cab-controlled valves for the application of asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder. The valves
controlling the flow from nozzles must act positively to provide a uniform unbroken application of asphaltic
emulsion or asphalt binder.
Maintain distributor and storage tanks at all times to prevent dripping.
37-1.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
37-2 CHIP SEALS
37-2.01 GENERAL
37-2.01A General
37-2.01A(1) Summary
Section 37-2.01 includes general specifications for applying chip seals.
37-2.01A(2) Definitions
Reserved
37-2.01A(3) Submittals
At least 15 days before starting placement of chip seal, submit:
1. Samples for:
1.1. Asphaltic emulsion chip seal,two 1-quart wide mouth plastic containers with screw top lid of
asphaltic emulsion
1.2. Polymer modified asphaltic emulsion chip seal,two 1-quart wide mouth plastic containers with
screw top lid of polymer modified asphaltic emulsion
1.3. Asphalt rubber binder chip seal,two 1-quart cans of base asphalt binder
1.4. Asphalt rubber binder chip seal,five 1-quart cans of asphalt rubber binder
2. Asphaltic emulsion, polymer modified asphaltic emulsion, asphalt binder or asphalt rubber binder data
as follows:
2.1. Supplier and Type/Grade of asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder
2.2. Type of modifier used including polymer or crumb rubber or both
2.3. Percent of crumb rubber, if used as modifier
2.4. Copy of the specified test results for asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder
3. 50 lb of uncoated aggregate
4. Aggregate test results for the following:
4.1. Gradation
4.2. Los Angeles Rattler
4.3. Percent of crushed particles
4.4. Flat and elongated particles
4.5. Film stripping
4.6. Cleanness value
4.7. Durability
5. Vialit test results
Submit quality control test results for the quality characteristics within the reporting times allowance after
sampling shown in the following table:
Quality Control Test Result Reporting
Quality characteristic Maximum reporting time allowance
Los Angeles Rattler loss max % 48 hours
Percent of crushed particles min, % 48 hours
Flat and elongated particles max by weight at 3:1, % 48 hours
Film stripping max, % 48 hours
Durability min 48 hours
Gradation(percentage passing) 24 hours
Cleanness value min 24 hours
Asphaltic emulsion spread rate al/sq d 24 hours
Page 37 of 183
Within 3 days after taking asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder quality control samples, submit the
authorized laboratory's test results.
37-2.01A(4) Quality Assurance
37-2.01A(4)(a) General
Reserved
37-2.01A(4)(b) Quality Control
37-2.01A(4)(b)(i) General
Reserved
37-2.01A(4)(b)(ii) Aggregate
All tests must be performed on uncoated aggregate except for film stripping which must be performed on
precoated aggregate.
For aggregate, the authorized laboratory must perform sampling and testing at the specified frequency
and location for the following quality characteristics:
Aggregate Quality Control Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Minimum Location of
sampling sampling
and testing
frequency
Los Angeles Rattler loss (max, %) California Test 1 st day of See California
At 100 revolutions 211 production Test 125
At 500 revolutions
Percent of crushed particles
Coarse aggregate(min, %)
One-fractured face 1 st day of See California
Two-fractured faces AASHTO T 335 production Test 125
Fine aggregate(min, %)
(Passing No. 4 sieve and retained on No. 8 sieve)
One fractured face
Flat and elongated particles(max by weight at ASTM D4791 1 st day of See California
3:1, % production Test 125
Film stripping (max, %) California Test 1 st day of See California
302 production Test 125
Durability(min) California Test 1 st day of See California
229 production Test 125
Gradation (% passing) California Test 2 per day See California
202 Test 125
Cleanness value(min) California Test 2 per day See California
227 Test 125
37-2.01A(4)(b)(iii) Chip Seals
For a chip seal,the authorized laboratory must perform sampling and testing at the specified frequency
and location for the following quality characteristics:
Chip Seal Quality Control Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Minimum sampling Location of
and testing frequency sampling
Asphaltic emulsion binder spread rate California 1 per day per Pavement surface
al/s d Test339 distributor truck
37-2.01A(4)(c) Department Acceptance
Department Acceptance shall not apply to identified areas where the existing surfacing before application
of chip seal, contains defective areas as determined by the Engineer and Contractor.At least 7 days
Page 38 of 183
before starting placement of the chip seal, the Contractor shall submit a written list of existing defective
areas, identifying the lane direction, lane number, starting and ending highway post mile locations, and
defect type. The Engineer must agree on which of the identified areas are defective.
Defective areas are defined as one of the following:
1. Areas with wheel path rutting in excess of 3/8 inch when measured by placing a straightedge 12 feet
long on the finished surface perpendicular to the center line and measuring the vertical distance
between the finished surface and the lower edge of the straightedge
2. Areas exhibiting flushing
For a chip seal, acceptance is based on visual inspection for the following:
1. Uniform surface texture
2. Raveling, which consists of the separation of the aggregate from the asphaltic emulsion or asphalt
binder
3. Flushing, which consists of the occurrence of a film of asphaltic material on the surface of the chip
seal.
4. Streaking,which consists of alternating longitudinal bands of asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder
without uniform aggregate retention, approximately parallel with the lane line.
Areas of raveling,flushing or streaking that are greater than 0.5 sq ft shall be considered defective and
must be repaired.
Raveling and streaking must be repaired by placing an additional layer of chip seal over the defective
area.
For asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder, acceptance is based on the Department's sampling and testing
for compliance with the requirements for the quality characteristics specified.
For aggregate, acceptance is based on the Department's sampling and testing for compliance with the
requirements shown in the following table:
Chip Seal Aggregate Acceptance Criteria
Quality characteristic Test method Requirements
Los Angeles Rattler loss (max, %)
At 100 revolutions California Test 211 10
At 500 revolutions 40
Percent of crushed particles: AASHTO T 335
Coarse aggregate(min, %)
One-fractured face 95
Two-fractured faces 90
Fine aggregate(min, %)
(Passing No. 4 sieve and retained on No. 8 sieve)
One fractured face 70
Flat and elongated particles (max by weight at 3:1, %) ASTM D4791 10
Film stripping (max, %) California Test 302 25
Durability(min) California Test 229 52
Gradation (% passing by weight) California Test 202 Aggregate Gradation
table shown under
Materials for the chip
seal ty e specified.
Cleanness value min California Test 227 80
If test results for the aggregate gradation do not comply with specifications, you may remove the chip seal
represented by these tests or request that it remain in place with a payment deduction.The deduction is
$1.75 per ton for the aggregate represented by the test results.
Page 39 of 183
If test results for aggregate cleanness value do not comply with the specifications, you may remove the
chip seal represented by these tests or you may request that the chip seal remain in place with a pay
deduction corresponding to the cleanness value shown in the following table:
Chip Seal Cleanness Value Deductions
Cleanness value Deduction
80 or over None
79 $2.00/ton
77-78 $4.00/ton
75-76 $6.00/ton
If the aggregate cleanness value is less than 75, remove the chip seal.
37-2.01 B Materials
37-2.01B(1) General
Reserved
37-2.01B(2) Asphaltic Emulsions and Asphalt Binders
Reserved
37-2.01 B(3) Aggregate
37-2.01 B(3)(a) General
Aggregate must be broken stone, crushed gravel, or both.
Aggregate must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Chip Seal Aggregate Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Requirements
Los Angeles Rattler loss (max, %)
At 100 revolutions California Test 211 10
At 500 revolutions 40
Percent of crushed particles AASHTO T 335
Coarse aggregate(min, %)
One-fractured face 95
Two-fractured faces 90
Fine aggregate(min, %)
(Passing No. 4 sieve and retained on No. 8 sieve)
One fractured face 70
Flat and elongated particles (max by weight at 3:1, %) ASTM D4791 10
Film stripping (max, %) California Test 302 25
Durability(min) California Test 229 52
Gradation (% passing by weight) California Test 202 Aggregate Gradation
table shown under
Materials for the chip
seal type specified.
Cleanness value(min) California Test 227 80
The authorized laboratory must conduct the Vialit test using the proposed asphaltic emulsion or asphalt
binder and aggregate for compliance with the requirements shown in the following table:
Page 40 of 183
Chip Retention Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Chip retention (%) Vialit test method for aggregate in chip seals,
French chip(Modified)a 95
The asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder must be within the field placement temperature
range and application rate during specimen preparation. For asphalt binder cure the specimen
for first 2 hours at 100 'F.
37-2.01 B(3)(b) Precoated Aggregate
Precoating of aggregate must be performed at a central mixing plant. The plant must be authorized under
the Department's MPQP.
When precoating aggregate, do not recombine fine materials collected in dust control systems.
Precoated aggregate must be preheated from 260 to 325 degrees F. Coat with any of the asphalts
specified in the table titled "Performance Graded Asphalt Binder" in section 92.The asphalt must be from
0.5 to 1.0 percent by weight of dry aggregate. You determine the exact asphalt rate for precoating of
aggregate.
Do not stockpile precoated aggregate.
37-2.01 C Construction
37-2.01C(1) General
For chip seals on 2-lane, 2-way roadways, place a W8-7(LOOSE GRAVEL)sign and a W 13-1 (35)plaque
at 2,000-foot maximum intervals along each side of the traveled way where aggregate is spread
on a traffic lane and at public roads or streets entering the chip seal area. Place the 1st W8-7 sign in each
direction where traffic first encounters the loose aggregate, regardless of which lane the aggregate is
spread on. A W13-1 (35) plaque is not required where the posted speed limit is less than 40 mph.
For chip seals on freeways, expressways, and multilane conventional highways, place a W8-7, (LOOSE
GRAVEL)sign and a W 13-1 (35)plaque at 2,000-foot maximum intervals along the outside edge of the
traveled way nearest to the lane worked on, at on ramps, and at public roads or streets entering the chip
seal area. Place the 1 st W8-7 sign where the aggregate starts with respect to the direction of travel on
that lane. A W 13-1 (35) plaque is not required where the posted speed limit is less than 40 mph.
Pilot cars must have cellular or radio contact with other pilot cars and personnel in the work zone. The
maximum speed of the pilot cars convoying or controlling traffic through the traffic control zone must be 15
mph on 2-lane,two-way highways and 25 mph on multilane divided and undivided highways. Pilot cars
must only use traffic lanes open to traffic.
On the days that closures are not allowed, you may use a moving closure to maintain the seal coat
surface.The moving closure is only allowed during daylight hours when traffic will be the least
inconvenienced and delayed.The Engineer determines the hours for the moving closure.
Maintain signs in place at each location until the final sweeping of the chip seal surface for that location is
complete. Signs may be set on temporary portable supports with the W 13-1 sign below the W8-7 sign or
on barricades with the W13-1 sign alternating with the W8-7 sign.
Schedule chip seal activities so that the chip seals are placed on both lanes of the traveled way each
work shift.
If traffic is routed over a surface where a chip seal application is intended, the chip seal must not be
applied to more than half the width of the traveled way at a time, and the remaining width must be kept
free of obstructions and open to traffic until the previously applied width is ready for traffic use.
Wherever maintenance sweeping of the chip seal surface is complete, place permanent traffic stripes and
pavement markings within 10 days.
Page 41 of 183
If you fail to place the permanent traffic stripes and pavement markings within the specified time, the
Department withholds 50 percent of the estimated value of the chip seal work completed that has not
received permanent traffic stripes and pavement markings.
37-2.01C(2) Equipment
Equipment for chip seals must include and comply with the following:
1. Aggregate haul trucks must have:
1.1. Tailgate that discharge aggregate
1.2. Device to lock onto the rear aggregate spreader hitch
1.3. Dump bed that will not push down on the spreader when fully raised
1.4. Dump bed that will not spill aggregate on the roadway when transferred to the spreader hopper
1.5. Tarpaulin to cover precoated aggregate when haul distance exceeds 30 minutes or ambient
temperature is less than 65 degrees F
2. Self-propelled aggregate spreaders must have:
2.1. Aggregate hopper in the rear
2.2. Belt conveyor that carries the aggregate to the front
2.3. Spreading hopper capable of providing a uniform aggregate spread rate over the entire width
of the traffic lane in 1 application.
3. Self-propelled power brooms must:
3.1. Not be steel-tined brooms on emulsion chip seals
3.2. Be capable of removing loose aggregate adjacent to barriers that prevent aggregate from
being swept off the roadway, including curbs, gutters, dikes, berms, and railings
4. Pneumatic or foam filled rubber tired rollers must:
4.1. Be an oscillating type at least 4 feet wide
4.2. Be self-propelled and reversible
4.3. Have tires of equal size, diameter, type, and ply
4.4. Carry at least 3,000 Ibs of load on each wheel
4.5 Have tires with an air pressure of 100±5 psi or be foam filled
37-2.01C(3) Surface Preparation
Before applying chip seals, cover manholes, valve and monument covers, grates, or other exposed
facilities located within the area of application, using a plastic or oil resistant construction paper secured
by tape or adhesive to the facility being covered. Reference the covered facilities with enough control
points to relocate the facilities after the application of the chip seal.
Immediately before applying chip seals, clean the surface to receive a chip seal by removing any
extraneous material affecting adhesion of the chip seal with the existing surface and drying. Use self-
propelled power brooms to clean the existing pavement.
37-2.01C(4) Placement
37-2.01 C(4)(a) General
Schedule the operations so that chip seals are placed on both lanes of the traveled way each work shift.
At the end of the work shift,the end of the chip seals on both lanes must generally match.
37-2.01C(4)(b) Applying Asphaltic Emulsions or Asphalt Binders
Prevent spraying on existing pavement not intended for chip seals or on previously applied chip seals
using a material such as building paper. Remove the material after use.
Align longitudinal joints between chip seal applications with designated traffic lanes.
For asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder, overlap longitudinal joints by not more than 4 inches. You may
overlap longitudinal joints up to 8 inches if authorized.
For areas not accessible to a truck distributor bar apply:
1. Asphaltic emulsions by hand spraying
2. Asphalt binders with a squeegee or other authorized means
Page 42 of 183
You may overlap the asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder applications before the application of aggregate
at longitudinal joints.
Do not apply the asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder unless there is sufficient aggregate at the job site to
cover the asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder.
Discontinue application of asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder early enough to comply with lane closure
requirements.Apply to 1 lane at a time and cover the lane width entirely in 1 operation.
37-2.01C(4)(c) Spreading Aggregates
37-2.01C(4)(c)(i) General
Prevent vehicles from driving on asphaltic emulsion or asphalt binder before spreading aggregate.
Spread aggregate within 10 percent of your determined rate.
Spread aggregate at a uniform rate over the full lane width in 1 application. Apply to 1 lane at a time.
Sweep excess aggregate at joints before spreading adjacent aggregate.
Operate the spreader at speeds slow enough to prevent aggregate from rolling over after dropping.
If the spreader is not moving, aggregate must not drop. If you stop spreading and aggregate drops,
remove the excess aggregate before resuming activities.
37-2.01C(4)(c)(ii) Precoated Aggregate Application
During transit, cover precoated aggregate with tarpaulins if the ambient air temperature is below 65
degrees F or the haul time exceeds 30 minutes.
When applied, precoated aggregate must be from 225 to 325 degrees F.
37-2.01C(4)(d) Finishing
37-2.01 C(4)(d)(i) General
Remove piles, ridges, or unevenly distributed aggregate. Repair permanent ridges, bumps, streaks or
depressions in the finished surface. Spread additional aggregate and roll if aggregate is picked up by
rollers or vehicles.
Chip seal joints between adjacent applications of a chip seal must be smooth, straight, uniform, and
completely covered.
A coverage is 1 roller movement over the entire width of lane. A pass is 1 roller movement parallel to the
chip seal application in either direction. Overlapping passes are part of the coverage being made and are
not part of a subsequent coverage. Do not start a new coverage until completing the previous coverage.
Before opening to traffic, finish the chip seals in the following sequence:
1. Perform initial rolling consisting of 1 coverage with a pneumatic-tired roller
2. Perform final rolling consisting of 2 coverages with a pneumatic-tired roller
3. Sweep excess aggregate from the roadway and adjacent abutting areas
4. Apply a flush coat if specified
5. Remove covers from the facilities
37-2.01C(4)(d)(ii) Traffic Control With Pilot Car
For 2-lane 2-way roadways under 1-way traffic control, upon completion of final rolling, traffic must be
controlled with pilot cars and routed over the new chip seal for a period of 2 to 4 hours before opening the
lane to traffic not controlled with pilot cars.
For multilane roadways, when traffic is controlled with pilot cars, a maximum of 1 lane in the direction of
travel must be open to traffic. Traffic must be controlled with pilot cars and be routed on the new chip seal
surface of the lane for a minimum of 2 hours after completion of the initial sweeping and before opening
the lane to traffic not controlled with pilot cars. Once traffic controlled with pilot cars is routed over the chip
seal at a particular location, continuous control must be maintained at that location until the chip seal
placement and sweeping on adjacent lanes to receive a chip seal is completed.
Page 43 of 183
37-2.01C(4)(d)(iii) Sweeping
Sweeping must be performed after the chip seal has set and there is no damage or dislodging of
aggregate from the chip seal surface.As a minimum, sweeping is required at the following times:
1. On 2-lane 2-way roadways, from 2 to 4 hours after traffic, controlled with pilot cars, has been routed
on the chip seal
2. On multilane roadways, from 2 to 4 hours after aggregate have been placed
3. In addition to previous sweeping, perform final sweeping immediately before opening any lane to
public traffic, not controlled with pilot cars
37-2.01 C(4)(d)(iv) Excess Aggregate
Dispose of excess aggregate. If ordered, salvaging and stockpiling of excess aggregate is change order
work.
37-2.01C(4)(e) Chip Seal Maintenance
Perform sweeping on the morning following the application of aggregate on any lane that has been open
to traffic not controlled with pilot cars and before starting any other activities.
Chip seal surfaces must be maintained for 4 consecutive days from the day aggregate is applied.
Maintenance must include sweeping to maintain a surface free of loose aggregate and to prevent
formation of corrugations. Sweeping must not dislodge aggregate set in asphaltic emulsion or asphalt
binder.
After 4 consecutive days, excess aggregate must be removed from the paved areas.
37-2.01 D Payment
If there is no bid item for traffic control system, furnishing and using a pilot car is included in the various
items of the work involved in applying the chip seal.
The payment quantity for precoated aggregate is the weight measured after the aggregate is preheated
and precoated with asphalt binder.
If recorded batch weights are printed automatically,the payment quantity for aggregate is the weight
determined from the printed batch weights if:
1. Total weight for the precoated aggregate per batch is printed
2. Total asphalt binder weight per batch is printed
3. Zero tolerance weight is printed before weighing the first batch and after weighing the last batch for
each truckload
4. Time, date, mix number, load number, and truck identification are correlated with a load slip
5. Copy of the recorded batch weights is certified by a licensed weighmaster
37-2.02 ASPHALTIC EMULSION CHIP SEALS
37-2.02A General
37-2.02A(1) Summary
Section 37-2.02 includes specifications for applying asphaltic emulsion chip seals.An asphaltic emulsion
chip seal includes applying an asphaltic emulsion, followed by aggregate, and then a flush coat.
A double asphaltic emulsion chip seal is the application of an asphaltic emulsion followed by aggregate,
applied twice in sequence and then a flush coat.
37-2.02A(2) Definitions
Reserved
37-2.02A(3) Submittals
Immediately after sampling, submit two 1-quart plastic containers of asphaltic emulsion taken in the
presence of the Engineer. Samples must be submitted in insulated shipping container.
Page 44 of 183
37-2.02A(4) Quality Assurance
37-2.02A(4)(a) General
Reserved
37-2.02A(4)(b) Quality Control
37-2.02A(4)(b)(i) General
Reserved
37-2.02A(4)(b)(ii) Asphaltic Emulsions
Circulate asphaltic emulsion in the distributor truck before sampling.Take samples from the distributor
truck at mid load or from a sampling tap or thief. Before taking samples, draw and dispose of 1 gallon. In
the presence of the Engineer,take two 1-quart samples in a plastic container with lined sealed lid for
acceptance testing.
For asphaltic emulsion, the authorized laboratory must perform quality control sampling and testing at the
specified frequency and location for the following quality characteristics:
Asphaltic Emulsion
Quality characteristic Test method Minimum sampling and Sampling location
testing frequency
Saybolt Furol Viscosity, at 25°C
(Saybolt Furol seconds)
Sieve Test(%) AASHTO T 59 Minimum 1 per day per Distributor truck
deliver Storage stability, 1 day(%) delivery truck
Residue by distillation (%)
Particle chargea
Tests on Residue from Distillation Test:
Penetration, 25°C AASHTO T 49
Ductility AASHTO T 51 Minimum 1 per day per Distributor truck
Solubility in trichloroethylene AASHTO T 44 delivery truck
alf the result of the particle charge is inconclusive,the asphaltic emulsion must be tested for pH
under ASTM E70. Grade QS1 h asphaltic emulsion must have a minimum pH of 7.3. Grade CQS1 h
asphaltic emulsion must have a maximum pH of 6.7.
37-2.02A(4)(c) Department Acceptance
Aggregate acceptance is based on the Department's sampling and testing for compliance with the
requirements shown in the following table:
Aggregate Gradation Acceptance Criteria
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Gradation (% passing by weight) 3/8" 5/16" 1/4"
Sieve size:
3/4" -- -- --
1/2" 100 -- --
3/8" 85-100 100 100
No.4 California Test 202 0-15 0-50 60-85
No. 8 0-5 0-15 0-25
No. 16 -- 0-5 0-5
No. 30 -- 0-3 0-3
No. 200 0-2 0-2 0-2
37-2.02B Materials
37-2.02B(1) General
Reserved
Page 45 of 183
37-2.02B(2)Asphaltic Emulsions
Reserved
37-2.02B(3)Aggregate
Aggregate gradation for an asphaltic emulsion chip seal must comply with the requirements shown in the
following table:
Asphaltic Emulsion Chip Seal Aggregate Gradation
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Gradation (% passing by weight) 3/8" 5/16" 1/4"
Sieve size:
3/4" -- -- --
1/2" 100 -- --
3/8" California Test 85-100 100 100
No.4 202 0-15 0-50 60-85
No. 8 0-5 0-15 0-25
No. 16 -- 0-5 0-5
No. 30 -- 0-3 0-3
No. 200 0-2 0-2 0-2
37-2.02C Construction
37-2.02C(1) General
Reserved
37-2.02C(2) Asphaltic Emulsions
Asphaltic emulsions must be applied within the application rate ranges shown in the following table:
Asphaltic Emulsion Application Rates
Aggregate gradation Application rate range
(gal/sq yd)
3/8" 0.30-0.45
5/16" 0.25-0.35
1/4" 0.20-0.30
For double asphaltic emulsion chip seals,the asphaltic emulsions must be applied within the application
rates shown in the following table:
Asphaltic Emulsion Application Rates
Double chip seals Application rate range
(gal/sq yd)
1 st application 0.30-0.45
2nd application 0.20-0.30
When applied,the temperature of the asphaltic emulsions must be from 130 to 180 degrees F.
Apply asphaltic emulsions when the ambient air temperature is from 65 to 110 degrees F and the
pavement surface temperature is at least 80 degrees F.
Do not apply asphaltic emulsions when weather forecasts predict the ambient air temperature will fall
below 39 degrees F within 24 hours after application.
37-2.02C(3) Spreading Aggregates
Aggregate must be spread within the spread rate ranges shown in the following table:
Page 46 of 183
Aggregate Spread Rates
Aggregate gradation Spread rate range
(lb/sq yd)
3/8" 20-30
5/16" 16-25
1/4" 12-20
For double asphaltic emulsion chip seals, aggregate must be spread within the spread rate ranges shown
in the following table:
Aggregate Spread Rates
Double chip seal Spread rate range
(lb/sq yd)
1 st application 23-30
2nd application 12-20
Remove excess aggregate on the 1st application before the 2nd application of asphaltic emulsion.
You may stockpile aggregate for asphaltic emulsion chip seals if you prevent contamination.Aggregate
must have a damp surface at spreading. If water visibly separates from the aggregate, do not spread.
You may re-dampen aggregate in the delivery vehicle.
Spread aggregate before an asphaltic emulsion sets or breaks.
Do not spread aggregate more than 2,500 feet ahead of the completed initial rolling.
37-2.02D Payment
Not Used
37-2.03 POLYMER MODIFIED ASPHALTIC EMULSION CHIP SEALS
37-2.03A General
37-2.03A(1) Summary
Section 37-2.03 includes specifications for applying polymer modified asphaltic emulsion chip seals. A
polymer modified asphaltic emulsion chip seal includes applying a polymer modified asphaltic emulsion,
followed by aggregate, and then a flush coat.
A double polymer modified asphaltic emulsion chip seal is the application of a polymer modified asphaltic
emulsion followed by aggregate, applied twice in sequence and then a flush coat.
37-2.03A(2) Definitions
Reserved
37-2.03A(3) Submittals
Immediately after sampling, submit two 1-quart cans of polymer modified asphaltic emulsion taken in the
presence of the Engineer. A sample must be submitted in an insulated shipping container.
37-2.03A(4) Quality Assurance
37-2.03A(4)(a) General
Reserved
37-2.03A(4)(b) Quality Control
37-2.03A(4)(b)(i) General
Reserved
37-2.03A(4)(b)(ii) Polymer Modified Asphaltic Emulsions
Circulate polymer modified asphaltic emulsions in the distributor truck before sampling. Take samples
from the distributor truck at mid load or from a sampling tap or thief. Before taking samples, draw and
dispose of 1 gallon. In the presence of the Engineer, take two 1-quart samples for acceptance testing.
Page 47 of 183
For polymer modified asphaltic emulsions,the authorized laboratory must perform quality control
sampling and testing at the specified frequency and location for the following quality characteristics:
Polymer Modified Asphaltic Emulsion
Minimum
Quality characteristic Test method sampling and
testing Sampling
frequency location
Saybolt Furol Viscosity, at 50 °C (Saybolt Furol
seconds
Settlement, 5 days max,
Storage stability test, 1 day max, % AASHTO T 59 Minimum 1 Distributor
Sieve test max, % per day per
Demulsibilit min, % delivery truck truck
Particle charge
Ash content max, % ASTM D3723
Residue by evaporation min, % California Test 331
Tests on residue from evaporation test:
Penetration, 25°C AASHTO T 49
Penetration, 4 °C, 200g for 60 seconds AASHTO T 49 Minimum 1 Distributor
Ductility, 25 °C min, mm AASHTO T 51 per day per truck
Torsional recover min, % California Test 332 delivery truck
Ring and Ball Softening Point min, °F) AASHTO T 53
37-2.03A(4)(c) Department Acceptance
Aggregate acceptance is based on the Department's sampling and testing for compliance with the
requirements shown in the following table:
Aggregate Gradation Acceptance Criteria
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Gradation (% passing by weight) 3/8" 5/16" 1/4"
Sieve size:
3/4" -- -- --
1/2" 100 -- --
3/8" California Test 85-100 100 100
No.4 202 0-15 0-50 60-85
No. 8 0-5 0-15 0-25
No. 16 -- 0-5 0-5
No. 30 -- 0-3 0-3
No. 200 0-2 0-2 0-2
37-2.03B Materials
37-2.03B(1) General
Reserved
37-2.03B(2) Polymer Modified Asphaltic Emulsions
A polymer modified asphaltic emulsion must include elastomeric polymer.
A polymer modified asphaltic emulsion must be Grade PMRS2, PMRS2h, PMCRS2, or PMCRS2h.
Polymer content in percent by weight does not apply.
A polymer modified asphaltic emulsion must comply with section 94 and the quality characteristic
requirements in the following table:
Page 48 of 183
Polymeric Asphaltic Emulsion
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Penetration 4 °C 200q for 60 seconds min AASHTO T 49 6
Ring and Ball Softening Point(min, °F) AASHTO T 53 135
37-2.03B(3) Aggregate
The aggregate gradation for a polymer modified asphaltic emulsion chip seal must comply with the
requirements shown in the following table:
Asphaltic Emulsion Chip Seal Aggregate Gradation
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Gradation (% passing
by weight) 3/8" 5/16" 1/4"
Sieve Size
3/4" -- -- --
1/2" 100 -- --
California Test
3/8" 85-100 100 100
No.4 202 0-15 0-50 60-85
No. 8 0-5 0-15 0-25
No. 16 -- 0-5 0-5
No. 30 -- 0-3 0-3
No. 200 0-2 0-2 0-2
37-2.03C Construction
Polymer modified asphaltic emulsions must be applied within the application rate ranges shown in the
following table:
Polymer Modified Asphaltic Emulsion Application Rates
Aggregate gradation Application rate range
(gal/sq yd)
3/8" 0.30-0.45
5/16" 0.25-0.35
1/4" 0.20-0.30
For double polymer modified asphaltic emulsion chip seals, polymer modified asphaltic emulsions must
be applied within the application rates shown in the following table:
Polymer Modified Asphaltic Emulsion Application Rates
Double application Application rate range
(gal/sq yd)
1 st application 0.30-0.45
2nd application 0.20-0.30
Apply polymer modified asphaltic emulsions when the ambient air temperature is from 60 to 105 degrees
F and the pavement surface temperature is at least 80 degrees F.
Do not apply polymer modified asphaltic emulsions when weather forecasts predict the ambient air
temperature will fall below 39 degrees F within 24 hours after application.
Aggregate must be spread within the spread rate ranges shown in the following table:
Page 49 of 183
Aggregate Spread Rates
Chip seal type Spread rate range
(lb/sq yd)
3/8" 20-30
5/16" 16-25
1/4" 12-20
For double chip seals, aggregate must be spread within spread rate ranges shown in the following table:
Aggregate Spread Rates
Double application Spread rate range
(lb/sq yd)
1 st application 23-30
2nd application 12-20
Remove excess aggregate on the 1st application before the 2nd application of asphaltic emulsion.
You may stockpile aggregate for the polymer modified asphaltic emulsion chip seals if you prevent
contamination. Aggregate must have damp surfaces at spreading. If water visibly separates from the
aggregate, do not spread.You may redampen aggregate in the delivery vehicle.
Spread aggregate before the polymer modified asphaltic emulsion sets or breaks.
Do not spread aggregate more than 2,500 feet ahead of the completed initial rolling.
37-2.03D Payment
Not Used
37-2.04 ASPHALT RUBBER BINDER CHIP SEALS
37-2.04A General
37-2.04A(1) Summary
Section 37-2.04 includes specifications for applying asphalt rubber binder chip seals.
An asphalt rubber binder chip seal consists of applying asphalt rubber binder followed by heated
aggregate precoated with asphalt binder followed by a flush coat.
37-2.04A(2) Definitions
crumb rubber modifier: Combination of ground or granulated high natural scrap tire crumb rubber and
scrap tire crumb rubber derived from waste tires described in Pub Res Code§42703.
descending viscosity reading: Subsequent viscosity reading at least 5 percent lower than the previous
viscosity reading.
high natural scrap tire crumb rubber: Material containing 40 to 48 percent natural rubber.
scrap tire crumb rubber: Any combination of vehicle tires or tire buffing.
37-2.04A(3) Submittals
At least 5 business days before use, submit the permit issued by the local air district for asphalt rubber
binder field blending equipment and application equipment. If an air quality permit is not required by the
local air district for producing asphalt rubber binder, submit verification from the local air district that an air
quality permit is not required.
For each delivery of asphalt rubber binder ingredients to the job site, submit a certificate of compliance
with a copy of the specified test results.
Submit a certified volume or weight slip for each delivery of asphalt rubber binder ingredients and asphalt
rubber binder.
Submit a SDS for each asphalt rubber binder ingredient and the asphalt rubber binder.
Page 50 of 183
At least 15 days before use, submit:
1. Samples of each asphalt rubber binder ingredient:
1.1. 2 Ibs of scrap tire crumb rubber
1.2. 2 Ibs of high natural scrap tire crumb rubber
1.3. Two 1-quart cans of base asphalt binder
1.4. Two 1-quart cans of asphalt modifier
2. Asphalt rubber binder formulation and data as follows:
2.1. For asphalt modifier, include:
2.1.1. Source of asphalt modifier
2.1.2. Type of asphalt modifier
2.1.3. Percentage of asphalt modifier by weight of asphalt binder
2.1.4. Percentage of combined asphalt binder and asphalt modifier by weight of asphalt
rubber binder
2.1.5. Test results for the specified quality characteristics
2.2. For crumb rubber modifier, include:
2.2.1. Each source and type of scrap tire crumb rubber and high natural scrap tire crumb
rubber
2.2.2. Percentage of scrap tire crumb rubber and high natural scrap tire crumb rubber by
total weight of asphalt rubber binder
2.2.3. Test results for the specified quality characteristics
2.3. For asphalt rubber binder, include minimum reaction time and temperature
Immediately after sampling, submit five 1-quart cans of asphalt rubber binder taken in the presence of the
Engineer. Sample must be submitted in insulated shipping containers.
Submit notification 15 minutes before each viscosity test or submit a schedule of testing times.
Submit the log of asphalt rubber binder descending viscosity test results within 1 business day after
sampling.
Submit asphalt rubber binder quality control viscosity test results within 1 business day after sampling.
37-2.04A(4) Quality Assurance
37-2.04A(4)(a) General
The equipment used in producing asphalt rubber binder and the equipment used in spreading asphalt
rubber binder must be permitted for use or exempted by the local air district.
37-2.04A(4)(b) Quality Control
37-2.04A(4)(b)(i) General
Reserved
37-2.04A(4)(b)(ii) Asphalt Modifiers
For asphalt modifiers, the authorized laboratory must perform quality control sampling and testing at the
specified frequency for the following quality characteristics:
Asphalt Modifier for Asphalt Rubber Binder
Quality characteristic Test method Frequency
Viscosity ASTM D445 1 per shipment
Flash point ASTM D92
Molecular Analysis:
Asphaltenes ASTM D2007 1 per shipment
Aromatics ASTM D2007
37-2.04A(4)(b)(iii) Crumb Rubber Modifiers
Sample and test scrap tire crumb rubber and high natural scrap tire crumb rubber separately.
Perform quality control sampling and testing at the specified frequency for the following quality
characteristics:
Page 51 of 183
Crumb Rubber Modifier
Quality characteristic Test method Frequency
Scrap tire crumb rubber gradation California Test 385 1 per 10,000
High natural scrap tire crumb rubber gradation California Test 385 1 per 3,400 lb
Wire in CRM California Test 385
Fabric in CRM California Test 385
CRM particle length 1 per 10,000 lb
CRM specific gravity California Test 208
Natural rubber content in high natural scrap tire crumb ASTM D297 1 per 3,400 lb
rubber
37-2.04A(4)(b)(iv) Asphalt Rubber Binders
For asphalt rubber binders, the authorized laboratory must perform quality control sampling and testing at
the specified frequency and location for the following quality characteristics:
Asphalt Rubber Binder Quality Control Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Sampling location Frequency
Descending viscositya at 375°F (Pa-s ASTM D7741 Reaction vessel 1 per lot"
x10
Viscosity at 375'F (Pa-s x 10 ) ASTM D7741 Distribution truck 15 minutes before
use per lot
Cone penetration at 25'C (0.10 mm) ASTM D217
Resilience at 25 °C(% rebound) ASTM D5329 Distribution truck 1 per loth
Softening point('C) ASTM D36
aStart taking viscosity readings at least 45 minutes after adding crumb rubber modifier and continue
taking viscosity readings every 30 minutes until 2 consecutive descending viscosity readings have
been obtained and the final viscosity complies with the specification requirement.
bA lot is defined in the MPQP.
Retain samples from each lot.Test samples for cone penetration, resilience, and softening point for the
first 3 lots and if all 3 lots pass, the testing frequency may be reduced to once for every 3 lots.
If QC test results indicate that the asphalt rubber binder does not comply with the specifications,take
corrective action and notify the Engineer.
37-2.04A(4)(c) Department Acceptance
37-2.04A(4)(c)(i) General
Reserved
37-2.04A(4)(c)(ii) Asphalt Modifiers
The Department accepts asphalt modifier based on compliance with the requirements shown in the
following table:
Asphalt Modifier for Asphalt Rubber Binder
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Viscosity at 100 'C (m /s x 10 ) ASTM D445 X ±3a
Flash point(min, °C) ASTM D92 207
Molecular Analysis:
Asphaltenes(max, % by mass) ASTM D2007 0.1
Aromatics(min, % by mass) ASTM D2007 55
'The symbol "X" is the asphalt modifier viscosity.
37-2.04A(4)(c)(iii) Crumb Rubber Modifiers
Scrap tire CRM and high natural CRM are sampled and tested separately.
Page 52 of 183
The Department accepts scrap tire CRM and high natural CRM based on compliance with the
requirements shown in the following table:
Crumb Rubber Modifier for Asphalt Rubber Binder
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Wire in CRM max % California Test 385 0.01
Fabric in CRM max, % California Test 385 0.05
CRM particle length max, in -- 3/16
CRM specific gravity California Test 208 1.1-1.2
Natural rubber content in high natural CRM % ASTM D297 40.0-48.0
The Department accepts CRM gradation based on the requirements shown in the following table:
Crumb Rubber Modifier Gradation Requirements
Quality characteristic Test Requirement
method
Gradation (% passing by weight) Scrap tire crumb rubber High natural scrap tire
Sieve size: crumb rubber
Operating Contract Operating Contract
range compliance range compliance
No. 110 California 95-0 0 100 90-100 100 100
No. 16 Test 385 35-85 32-88 92-100 85-100
No. 30 2-25 1-30 25-95 20-98
No. 50 0-10 0-15 6-35 2-40
No. 100 0-5 0-10 0-7 0-10
No. 200 0-2 0-5 0-3 0-5
If a test result for CRM gradation does not comply with the specifications, the Department deducts the
corresponding amount for each gradation test as shown in the following table:
Material Gradation test resulta Deduction
Scrap tire crumb rubber Operating range <TR<Contract compliance $250
Scrap tire crumb rubber TR>Contract compliance $1,100
High natural scrap tire crumb rubber Operating range <TR<Contract compliance $250
High natural scrap tire crumb rubber TR>Contract compliance $600
aTest Result=TR
Each gradation test for scrap tire crumb rubber represents 10,000 lb or the quantity used in that day's
production, whichever is less.
Each gradation test for high natural scrap tire crumb rubber represents 3,400 lb or the quantity used in
that day's production, whichever is less.
37-2.04A(4)(c)(iv) Asphalt Rubber Binders
For Department acceptance testing,take a sample of asphalt rubber binder in the Engineer's presence
every 5 lots or once a day, whichever is greater. Each sample must be in five 1-quart cans with an open
top and friction lid.
For an asphalt rubber binder, acceptance is based on the Department's sampling and testing for
compliance with the requirements shown in the following table:
Page 53 of 183
Asphalt Rubber Binder
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Cone enetration at 25°C 0.10 mm ASTM D217 25-60
Resilience at 25°C % rebound ASTM D5329 18-50
Softeninq point(°C) ASTM D36 55-88
Viscosity at 375 °F Pa•s x 10-3 a ASTM D7741 1 500-2 500
aPrepare sample for viscosity test under California Test 388.
37-2.04A(4)(c)(v) Precoated Aggregate
The Department accepts precoated aggregate based on compliance with the requirements shown in the
following table:
Precoated Aggregate Gradation Acceptance Criteria
Quality Characteristic Test method Requirement
1/2"gradation (% passing by weight) California Test 202
Sieve size:
3/4" 100
1/2" 85-90
3/8" 0-30
No.4 0-5
No. 8 --
No. 200 0-1
3/8"gradation (% passing by weight) California Test 202
Sieve size:
3/4" 100
1/2" 95-100
3/8" 70-85
No.4 0-15
No. 8 0-5
No. 200 0-1
37-2.04B Materials
37-2.04B(1) General
Reserved
37-2.04B(2) Asphalt Binders
Asphalt binder used as the base binder for asphalt rubber binder must comply with the specifications for
asphalt binder. Do not modify asphalt binder with polymer.
37-2.04B(3) Asphalt Modifiers
An asphalt modifier must be a resinous, high flash point, and aromatic hydrocarbon.An asphalt modifier
must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Asphalt Modifier for Asphalt Rubber Binder
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Viscosity at 100 °C (m /s x 10 ) ASTM D445 X ±3a
Flash point min, CL.O.C., °C ASTM D92 207
Molecular analysis:
Asphaltenes by mass max, % ASTM D2007 0.1
Aromatics by mass (min, %) ASTM D2007 55
aXdenotes the proposed asphalt modifier viscosity from 19 to 36. A change in X requires a new
asphalt rubber binder submittal.
37-2.04B(4) Crumb Rubber Modifiers
The CRM to be used must be on the Authorized Materials List for crumb rubber modifier.
Page 54 of 183
The CRM must be ground or granulated at ambient temperature.
Scrap tire crumb rubber and high natural scrap tire crumb rubber must be delivered to the asphalt rubber
binder production site in separate bags.
Steel and fiber must be separated. If steel and fiber are cryogenically separated, it must occur before
grinding and granulating. Cryogenically-produced CRM particles must be large enough to be ground or
granulated.
The CRM must be dry,free-flowing particles that do not stick together.A maximum of 3 percent calcium
carbonate or talc by weight of CRM may be added. The CRM must not cause foaming when combined
with the asphalt binder and asphalt modifier.
The CRM must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Crumb Rubber Modifier for Asphalt Rubber Binder
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Wire in CRM max % California Test 385 0.01
Fabric in CRM (max, %) California Test 385 0.05
CRM particle length (max, in) -- 3/16
CRM specific gravity California Test 208 1.1-1.2
The CRM must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Crumb Rubber Modifier Requirements
Requirement
Quality characteristic Test method Scrap tire crumb rubber High natural scrap tire
crumb rubber
Acetone extract % 6.0-16.0 4.0-16.0
Rubber hydrocarbon min, % 42.0-65.0 50.0
Natural rubber content % ASTM D297 22.0-39.0 40.0-48.0
Carbon black content % 28.0-38.0 --
Ash content(max, %) 8.0 --
Scrap tire crumb rubber gradation must comply with the gradation requirements shown in the following
table:
Scrap Tire Crumb Rubber Gradation
Quality characteristic Test Requirement
method
Gradation (% passing by Gradation limit Operating range Contract
weight) compliance
Sieve size:
No. 8 100 100 100
No. 10 California 98-100 95-100 90-100
No. 16 Test 385 45-75 35-85 32-88
No. 30 2-20 2-25 1-30
No. 50 0-6 0-10 0-15
No. 100 0-2 0-5 0-10
No. 200 0 0-2 0-5
High natural scrap tire crumb rubber gradation must comply with the gradation requirements shown in the
following table:
Page 55 of 183
Hi h Natural Scrap Tire Crumb Rubber Gradation
Quality characteristic Test Requirement
method
Gradation (% passing by Gradation limit Operating range Contract
weight) compliance
Sieve size:
No. 10 100 100 100
No. 16 California 95-100 92-100 85-100
No. 30 Test385 35-85 25-95 20-98
No. 50 10-30 6-35 2-40
No. 100 0-4 0-7 0-10
No. 200 0-1 0-3 0-5
37-2.04B(5) Asphalt Rubber Binders
An asphalt rubber binder must be a combination of:
1. Asphalt binder
2. Asphalt modifier
3. Crumb rubber modifier
Asphalt rubber binder blending equipment must be authorized under the Department's MPQP.
The blending equipment must allow the determination of weight percentages of each asphalt rubber
binder ingredient.
An asphalt rubber binder must be 79± 1 percent by weight asphalt binder and 21 ± 1 percent by weight of
CRM. The minimum percentage of CRM must be 20.0 percent and lower values must not be rounded up.
The CRM must be 75±2 percent by weight scrap tire crumb rubber and 25±2 percent by weight high
natural scrap tire crumb rubber.
An asphalt modifier and asphalt binder must be blended at the production site.An asphalt modifier must
be from 2.5 to 6.0 percent by weight of the asphalt binder in the asphalt rubber binder. The asphalt rubber
binder supplier determines the exact percentage.
If blended before adding CRM,the asphalt binder must be from 375 to 440 degrees F when an asphalt
modifier is added and the mixture must circulate for at least 20 minutes. An asphalt binder, asphalt
modifier, and CRM may be proportioned and combined simultaneously.
The blend of an asphalt binder and an asphalt modifier must be combined with the CRM at the asphalt
rubber binder production site. The asphalt binder and asphalt modifier blend must be from 375 to 440
degrees F when the CRM is added. Combined ingredients must be allowed to react at least 45 minutes at
temperatures from 375 to 425 degrees F except the temperature must be at least 10 degrees F below the
flash point of the asphalt rubber binder.
After reacting, the asphalt rubber binder must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Asphalt Rubber Binder
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Cone penetration at 25°C 0.10 mm ASTM D217 25-60
Resilience at 25°C(% rebound) ASTM D5329 18-50
Softening point(°C) ASTM D36 55-88
Viscosity at 375 OF (Pa-s x 107)a ASTM D7741 1,500-2,500
aPrepare sample for viscosity test under California Test 388.
Maintain asphalt rubber binder at a temperature from 375 to 415 degrees F.
Page 56 of 183
Stop heating unused asphalt rubber binder 4 hours after the 45-minute reaction period. Reheating asphalt
rubber binder that cools below 375 degrees F is a reheat cycle. Do not exceed 2 reheat cycles. If
reheating,the asphalt rubber binder must be from 375 to 415 degrees F before use.
During reheating, you may add CRM. The CRM must not exceed 10 percent by weight of the asphalt
rubber binder. Allow added CRM to react for at least 45 minutes. Reheated asphalt rubber binder must
comply with the specifications for asphalt rubber binder.
37-2.04B(6) Precoated Aggregate
Before precoating with asphalt binder, aggregate for an asphalt rubber binder chip seal must comply with
the gradation requirements shown in the following table:
Asphalt Rubber Binder Chip Seal Aggregate Gradation
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Gradation (% passing by weight) 1/2" 3/8"
Sieve size:
3/4" 100 100
1/2" California Test 85-90 95-100
3/8" 202 0-30 70-85
No.4 0-5 0-15
No. 8 -- 0-5
No. 200 0-1 0-1
37-2.04C Construction
37-2.04C(1) General
Reserved
37-2.04C(2) Equipment
Distributor trucks must be equipped with:
1. Mixing and heating unit
2. Observation platform on the rear of the truck for an observer on the platform to see the nozzles and
unplug them if needed
37-2.04C(3) Asphalt Rubber Binder Application
Apply the asphalt rubber binder when the ambient temperature is from 60 to 105 degrees F and the
pavement surface temperature is at least 55 degrees F.
Do not apply the asphalt rubber binder unless enough aggregate is available at the job site to cover the
asphalt rubber binder within 2 minutes. Intersections, turn lanes, gore points, and irregular areas must be
covered within 15 minutes.
Do not apply asphalt rubber binder when pavement is damp or during high wind conditions. If authorized,
you may adjust the distributor bar height and distribution speed and use shielding equipment during high
wind conditions.
When applied,the temperature of the asphalt rubber binder must be from 385 to 415 degrees F.
Apply the asphalt rubber binder at a rate from 0.55 to 0.65 gal/sq yd. You may reduce the application rate
by 0.050 gal/sq yd in the wheel paths.
37-2.04C(4) Precoated Aggregate Spreading
Spread aggregate at a rate from 28 to 40 Ib/sq yd. Do not spread aggregate more than 200 feet ahead of
the completed initial rolling.
37-2.04C(5) Rolling and Sweeping
Perform initial rolling within 90 seconds of spreading aggregate. If authorized for final rolling, you may use
a steel-wheeled roller weighing from 8 to 10 tons in static mode only.
Page 57 of 183
Perform a final sweeping before Contract acceptance. The final sweeping must not dislodge aggregate.
37-2.04D Payment
Asphalt rubber binder is measured as specified for asphalt binder.
37-2.05 STRESS ABSORBING MEMBRANE INTERLAYERS
37-2.05A General
Section 37-2.05 includes specifications for placing stress absorbing membrane interlayers(SAMI).
Comply with section 37-2.04 except a flush coat is not required.
Traffic must not be allowed on a SAMI.
37-2.05B Materials
For a SAMI, aggregate must comply with the 3/8-inch gradation.
37-2.05C Construction
If a SAMI is overlaid in the same work shift, section 37-2.01 C(4)(e)does not apply.
Final sweeping is not required for a SAMI.
37-2.05D Payment
Not Used
37-2.06 MODIFIED ASPHALT BINDER CHIP SEALS
Reserved
37-2.07 SCRUB SEALS
Reserved
37-3 SLURRY SEALS AND MICRO-SURFACINGS
37-3.01 GENERAL
37-3.01A General
37-3.01A(1) Summary
Section 37-3.01 includes general specifications for applying slurry seals and micro-surfacings.
37-3.01A(2) Definitions
Reserved
37-3.01A(3) Submittals
At least 15 days before starting placement of a slurry seal or micro-surfacing, submit:
1. Samples for:
1.1. Asphaltic emulsion slurry seal, two 1-quart wide mouth plastic containers with screw top lid of
asphaltic emulsion
1.2 Polymer modified asphaltic emulsion slurry seal, two 1-quart wide mouth plastic containers with
screw top lid of polymer modified asphaltic emulsion
1.3. Micro-surfacing, two 1-quart wide mouth plastic containers with screw top lid of micro-surfacing
emulsion
2. Asphaltic emulsion, polymer modified asphaltic emulsion, or micro-surfacing emulsion data as
follows:
2.1. Supplier and Type/Grade of asphaltic emulsion
2.2. Type of modifier polymer for polymer modified asphaltic emulsion or micro-surfacing emulsion
2.3. Copy of the specified test results for asphaltic emulsion, polymer modified asphaltic emulsion,
or micro-surfacing emulsion
3. 50 lb of aggregate
4. Aggregate test results for the followings:
4.1. Gradation
4.2. Los Angeles Rattler
4.3. Percent of crushed particles
Page 58 of 183
4.4 Sand equivalent
4.5 Durability
At least 10 days before starting placement of a slurry seal or micro-surfacing, submit a laboratory report of
test results and the proposed mix design from an authorized laboratory. The authorized laboratory must
sign the laboratory report and mix design.
The report must include:
1. Test results used in the mix design compared with specification requirements
2. Proportions based on the dry weight of aggregate, including ranges,for:
2.1. Aggregate
2.2. Water
2.3. Additives
2.4. Mineral filler
2.5. Slurry seal emulsion or micro-surfacing emulsion residual asphalt content
3. Recommended changes to the proportions based on heating the mixture to 100 degrees F and
mixing for 60 seconds, if atmospheric temperatures during application will be 90 degrees F or above,
for:
3.1. Water
3.2. Additives
3.3. Mineral filler
4. Quantitative moisture effects on the aggregate's unit weight determined under ASTM C29M
If the mix design consists of the same materials covered by a previous laboratory report, you may submit
the previous laboratory report that must include material testing data performed within the previous 12
months for authorization.
If you change any of the materials in the mix design, submit a new mix design and laboratory report at
least 10 days before starting slurry seal or micro-surfacing work.
Submit a certificate of compliance as specified for asphaltic emulsion in section 94-1.01 C with each
shipment of asphaltic emulsion, polymer modified asphaltic emulsion or micro-surfacing emulsion.
Submit quality control test results for the quality characteristics within the reporting times allowance after
sampling shown in the following table:
Quality Control Test Reporting Requirements
Quality characteristic Maximum reporting time
allowance
Los Angeles Rattler loss max, % 2 business days
Percent of crushed particles min, % 2 business days
Durability min 2 business days
Resistance of fine aggregate to
degradation by abrasion in the Micro- 2 business days
Deval Apparatus % loss by weight)
Gradation % passing by weight) 48 hours
Sand equivalent min 48 hours
Moisture content % 48 hours
Within 3 days after taking asphaltic emulsion, polymer modified asphaltic emulsion or micro-surfacing
emulsion quality control samples, submit the authorized laboratory's test results.
37-3.01A(4) Quality Assurance
37-3.01A(4)(a) General
Your authorized laboratory must be able to perform International Slurry Surfacing Association tests and
mix design.
Page 59 of 183
37-3.01A(4)(b) Quality Control
37-3.01A(4)(b)(i) General
Reserved
37-3.01A(4)(b)(ii) Aggregate
For aggregate, the authorized laboratory must perform sampling and testing at the specified frequency
and location for the following quality characteristics:
Aggregate Quality Control
Quality characteristic Test method Minimum Location of
sampling and sampling
testing frequency
Los Angeles Rattler loss (max, %) California Test 211 1 st day of See California
At 500 revolutions roduction Test 125
Percent of crushed particles (min, %) AASHTO T 335 1 st day of See California
roduction Test 125
Sand equivalent(min) California Test 217 1 per working See California
stockpile per day Test 125
Resistance of fine aggregate to ASTM D7428
degradation by abrasion in 1 per working See California
the Micro-Deval Apparatus (% loss stockpile per day Test 125
by weight)
Gradation (% passing by weight) California Test 202 1 per working See California
stockpile per day Test 125
Moisture content,from field stockpile AASHTO T 255a 1 per working See California
(%) stockpile per day Test 125
aTest aggregate moisture at field stockpile every 2 hours if you are unable to maintain the moisture
content to within a maximum daily variation of±0.5 percent.
37-3.01A(4)(b)(iii) Slurry Seals and Micro-surfacings
Reserved
37-3.01A(4)(c) Department Acceptance
Slurry Seal and micro-surfacing acceptance is based on:
1. Visual inspection for the following:
1.1. Uniform surface texture throughout the work limits.
1.2. Marks in the surface:
1.2.1. Up to 4 marks in the completed slurry seal or micro-surfacing surface that are up to 1
inch wide and up to 6 inches long per 1000 square feet of slurry seal or micro-
surfacing placed.
1.2.2. No marks in the completed slurry seal or micro-surfacing surface that are over 1 inch
wide or 6 inches long.
1.3. Excessive raveling consisting of the separation of the aggregate from the asphaltic emulsion,
polymer modified asphaltic emulsion or micro-surfacing emulsion.
1.4. Bleeding consists of the occurrence of a film of asphaltic material on the surface of the slurry
seal or micro-surfacing.
1.5. Delaminating of slurry seal or micro-surfacing from the existing pavement.
1.6. Rutting or wash-boarding.
2. Department's sampling and testing for compliance with the requirements for aggregate shown in the
following table:
Page 60 of 183
Aggregate Gradation Acceptance Criteria
Quality characteristic Test method Requirements
Gradation (% passing by weight)
Sieve Size: Type I Type II Type III
3/8" -- 100 100
No.4 California Test 100 94-100 70-90
No. 8 202 90-100 65-90 45-70
No. 16 60-90 40-70 28-50
No. 30 40-65 25-50 19-34
No. 200 10-20 5-15 5-15
An aggregate gradation test represents 300 tons or 1 day's production, whichever is less.
If test results for aggregate gradation do not comply with the specifications, you may remove the slurry
seal or micro-surfacing represented by the test results or request it remain in place with a payment
deduction. If your request is authorized,the Department deducts:
1. $1.75 per ton of slurry seal for each noncompliant aggregate gradation
2. $2.00 per ton of micro-surfacing for each noncompliant aggregate gradation
37-3.01 B Materials
37-3.0113(1) General
Additional water must not cause separation of the asphaltic emulsion, polymer modified asphaltic
emulsion or micro-surfacing emulsion from the aggregate before placement.
You may use an additive that does not adversely affect the slurry seal or micro-surfacing.
37-3.01 B(2) Aggregate
Aggregate must be rock dust.Aggregate must be free from vegetable matter, deleterious substances,
caked or clay lumps, and oversized particles.
Aggregate for a slurry seal and micro-surfacing must comply with the gradations shown in the following
table:
Aggregate Gradation
Quality characteristic Test method Requirements
Gradation (% passing by weight) Type I Type II Type III
Sieve size:
3/8" -- 100 100
No. 4 California 100 94-100 70-90
No. 8 Test 202 90-100 65-90 45-70
No. 16 60-90 40-70 28-50
No. 30 40-65 25-50 19-34
No. 200 10-20 5-15 5-15
37-3.01C Construction
37-3.01C(1) General
Before applying slurry seals or micro-surfacings, cover manholes, valve and monument covers, grates,
and other exposed facilities located within the area of application using plastic or oil resistant construction
paper secured by tape or adhesive to the facility being covered. Reference the covered facilities with
enough control points to relocate the facilities after application of the slurry seals or micro-surfacings.
37-3.01C(2) Proportioning
Proportion slurry seal and micro-surfacing ingredients in compliance with the authorized mix design.
Page 61 of 183
37-3.01C(3) Mixing and Spreading Equipment
37-3.01C(3)(a) General
Mixing and spreading equipment for slurry seals and micro-surfacings must proportion the asphaltic
emulsions, water, aggregate, and any additives by volume and mix them in continuous pug mill mixers.
Introduce emulsions into the mixer with a positive displacement pump. If you use a variable-rate pump,
the adjusting unit must be sealed in its calibrated position.
Introduce water into the mixer through a meter that measures gallons.
Choose a truck mounted mixer-spreader or continuous self-loading mixer spreader.
37-3.01C(3)(b) Truck Mounted Mixer Spreaders
Truck mounted mixer spreaders must comply with:
1. Rotating and reciprocating equipment must be covered with metal guards.
2. Proportion aggregate using a belt feeder with an adjustable cutoff gate. The Engineer verifies the
height of the gate opening.
3. Belt feeder must have a depth monitor device.The depth monitor device must automatically shut
down power to the belt feeder when the aggregate depth is less than 70 percent of the target depth.
4. Separate monitor device must detect the revolutions of the belt feeder.This device must
automatically shut down power to the belt feeder if it detects no revolutions. If the belt feeder is an
integral part of the equipment's drive chain,the monitor device is not required.
5. Aggregate belt feeder must be connected directly to the drive on the emulsion pump. The aggregate
feeder drive shaft must have a revolution counter reading the nearest 0.10 revolution for micro-
surfacing, and nearest 1 revolution for slurry seal.
6. Emulsion storage must be equipped with a device that automatically shuts down power to the
emulsion pump and aggregate belt feeder when the level of stored emulsion is lowered.To allow for
normal fluctuations, there may be a delay of 3 seconds between detection of low emulsion storage
levels or low aggregate depths and automatic power shut down.
7. Emulsion storage must be located immediately before the emulsion pump.
8. Emulsion storage tank must have a temperature indicator at the pump suction level.The indicator
must be accurate to±5 degrees F.
9. No-flow and revolution warning devices must be in working condition. Low-flow indicators must be
visible while walking alongside the equipment.
37-3.01C(3)(c) Continuous Self-Loading Mixer Spreaders
Continuous self-loading mixer spreaders must be automatically sequenced and self-propelled.The mixing
machine must deliver each material to a double shafted mixer and discharge the mixed material on a
continuous flow basis. The mixing machines must have sufficient storage capacity to maintain a
continuous supply of material to the proportioning controls.The mixing machine operators must have full
control of forward and reverse speeds during placement.
37-3.01 C(3)(d) Spreader Boxes
The spreader boxes used to spread slurry seals and micro-surfacings must be:
1. Capable of spreading the slurry seal or micro-surfacing a minimum of 12 feet wide and preventing the
loss of slurry seal or micro-surfacing.
2. Equipped with flexible rubber belting on each side. The belting must contact the pavement to prevent
the loss of slurry seal or micro-surfacing from the box.
3. Equipped to uniformly apply the slurry seal or micro-surfacing on superelevated sections and
shoulder slopes. Micro-surfacing spreader box must be equipped with reversible motor driven augers.
4. Equipped with a series of strike-off devices at its rear.
4.1. The leading strike off device must be:
4.1.1. Fabricated of a suitable material such as steel or stiff rubber
4.1.2. Designed to maintain close contact with the pavement during spreading
4.1.3. Capable of obtaining the specified thickness
4.1.4. Capable of being adjusted to the various pavement cross sections
4.2. The final strike-off device must be:
4.2.1. Fabricated of flexible material that produces a uniform texture in the finished surface
Page 62 of 183
4.2.2. Cleaned daily and changed if longitudinal scouring occurs in the slurry seal of micro-
surfacing
5. Clean and free of slurry seal or micro-surfacing at the start of each work shift.
37-3.01C(3)(e) Shoulder Equipment
Spread the slurry seal or micro-surfacing on shoulders with a device such as an edge box that forms
clean and straightjoints and edges.
37-3.01C(3)(f) Equipment Calibration
Equipment calibration must comply with the MPQP. Notify the Engineer at least 5 business days before
calibrating.
If the Department authorizes a truck or continuous mixer spreader, its calibration is valid for 6 months
provided you:
1. Use the same truck or continuous mixer spreader verified with a unique identifying number
2. Use the same materials in compliance with the authorized mix design
3. Do not perform any repair or alteration to the proportioning systems
Calibrate the adjustable cut-off gate settings of each truck or continuous mixer spreader on the project to
achieve the correct delivery rate of aggregate and emulsion per revolution of the aggregate feeder under
the MPQP.
Checks must be performed for each aggregate source using an authorized vehicle scale.
Individual checks of the aggregate belt feeder's delivery rate to the pug mill mixer must not vary more
than 2 percent from the average of 3 runs of at least 3 tons each.
Before using a variable-rate emulsion pump,the pump must be calibrated and sealed in the calibrated
condition under the MPQP.
Individual checks of the emulsion pump's delivery rate to the pug mill mixer must not vary more than 2
percent from the average of 3 runs of at least 500 gal each.
37-3.01C(4) Surface Preparation
Immediately before applying slurry seals or micro-surfacings, clean the surface to receive slurry seals or
micro-surfacings by removing any extraneous material affecting adhesion of the slurry seal or micro-
surfacing with the existing surface. Use self-propelled power brooms or other methods such as flushing to
clean the existing pavement.
37-3.01C(5) Placement
37-3.01 C(5)(a) General
If truck-mounted mixer-spreaders are used, keep at least 2 operational spreaders at the job site during
placement.
Spread slurry seals and micro-surfacings uniformly and do not spot, rehandle, or shift the mixture.
However in areas inaccessible to spreading equipment,spread the slurry seal or micro-surfacing mixtures
with hand tools or other authorized methods. If placing with hand tools, lightly dampen the area first.
You may fog the roadway surface with water ahead of the spreader box. The fog spray must be adjusted
for pavement:
1. Temperature
2. Surface texture
3. Dryness
You determine the application rates for slurry seals or micro-surfacings and the Engineer authorizes the
application rates. Spread within 10 percent of authorized rate.
The mixtures must be uniform and homogeneous after spreading, and there must not be separation of the
emulsion and aggregate after setting.
Page 63 of 183
37-3.01C(5)(b) Weather Conditions
Only place slurry seals or micro-surfacings if both the pavement and air temperatures are at least 50
degrees F and rising.The expected high temperature must be at least 65 degrees F within 24 hours after
placement.
Do not place slurry seals or micro-surfacings if rain is imminent or the air temperature is expected to be
below 36 degrees F within 24 hours after placement.
37-3.01C(5)(c) Joints
Transverse and longitudinal joints must be:
1. Uniform
2. Straight
3. Neat in appearance
4. Without material buildup
5. Without uncovered areas
Transverse joints must be butt-type joints.
Prevent double placement at transverse joints over previously placed slurry seals or micro-surfacings.
Place longitudinal joints:
1. On centerlines, lane lines, edge lines, or shoulder lines
2. With overlaps not more than 4 inches
You may request other longitudinal joint patterns if they do not adversely affect the slurry seals or micro-
surfacings.
The maximum difference between the pavement surface and the bottom edge of a 12-foot straightedge
placed perpendicular to the longitudinal joint must be 0.04 foot.
37-3.01C(5)(d) Finished Surfaces
Finished slurry seals or micro-surfacings must be smooth and free of irregularities such as scratch or tear
marks.You may leave up to 4 marks that are up to 1 inch wide and 6 inches long per 75 linear feet of
slurry seal or micro-surfacing placed. Do not leave any marks that are over 1 inch wide or 6 inches long.
37-3.01C(5)(e) Maintenance Sweeping
Sweep the slurry seals or micro-surfacings 24 hours after placement without damaging the slurry seals or
micro-surfacings. For 4 days afterwards,sweep the slurry seals or micro-surfacings daily unless
determined otherwise by the Engineer.
37-3.01 C(5)(f) Repair of Early Distress
The slurry seals or micro-surfacings must not show bleeding, raveling, separation, or other distresses for
15 days after placing. If bleeding, raveling, delaminating, rutting, or wash-boarding occurs after placing
the slurry seals or micro-surfacings, make repairs using an authorized method.
37-3.01 D Payment
Not Used
37-3.02 SLURRY SEALS
37-3.02A General
37-3.02A(1) Summary
Section 37-3.02 includes specifications for applying slurry seals.
Applying a slurry seal consists of spreading a mixture of asphaltic emulsion or polymer modified asphaltic
emulsion, aggregate, additives, and water on a surface or pavement.
37-3.02A(2) Definitions
Reserved
Page 64 of 183
37-3.02A(3) Submittals
Immediately after sampling, submit two 1-quart wide mouth plastic containers of asphaltic emulsion or
polymer modified asphaltic emulsion taken in the presence of the Engineer. Samples must be submitted
in insulated shipping containers.
37-3.02A(4) Quality Assurance
37-3.02A(4)(a) General
Reserved
37-3.02A(4)(b) Quality Control
37-3.02A(4)(b)(i) General
Take samples of asphaltic emulsion and polymer modified asphaltic emulsion from the tank truck at mid
load or from a sampling tap or thief. Before taking samples, draw and dispose of 1 gallon. In the presence
of the Engineer take two 1-quart samples in wide mouth plastic containers with lined, sealed lids for
acceptance testing.
37-3.02A(4)(b)(ii) Asphaltic Emulsion
For asphaltic emulsions,the authorized laboratory must perform quality control sampling and testing at
the specified frequency and location for the following quality characteristics:
Asphaltic Emulsion
Quality characteristic Test method Minimum sampling and Sampling location
testing frequency
Saybolt Furol Viscosity, at 25
°C(Saybolt Furol seconds)
Sieve Test(%) Minimum 1 per day per
Storage stability, 1 day(%) AASHTO T 59 delivery truck Delivery truck
Residue by distillation (%)
Particle charges
Tests on Residue from Distillation Test:
Penetration, 25°C AASHTO T 49
Ductility AASHTO T 51 Minimum 1 per day per Delivery truck
Solubility in tricloroethylene AASHTO T 44 delivery truck
slf the result of the particle charge is inconclusive, the asphaltic emulsion must be tested for pH under
ASTM E70. Grade QS1 h asphaltic emulsion must have a minimum pH of 7.3. Grade CQS1 h asphaltic
emulsion must have a maximum pH of 6.7.
37-3.02A(4)(b)(iii) Polymer Modified Asphaltic Emulsion
For polymer modified asphaltic emulsions,the authorized laboratory must perform quality control
sampling and testing at the specified frequency and location for the following quality characteristics:
Page 65 of 183
Polymer Modified Asphaltic Emulsion
Minimum Sampling
Quality characteristic Test method sampling and Location
testing frequency
Tests on emulsion:
Saybolt Furol Viscosity at 25°C AASHTO T 59
Sa bolt Furol seconds
Sieve test % AASHTO T 59 Minimum 1 per
Storage stabilityafter 1 day % AASHTO T 59 day per delivery Delivery truck
truck
Residue by evaporation min, % California Test 3-'Al
Particle charge AASHTO T 59
Tests on residue by evaporation:
Penetration at 25°C AASHTO T 49
Ductility at 25 °C min, mm AASHTO T 51
Torsional recovery(min, %) California Test 332 Minimum 1 per
Or day per delivery Delivery truck
truck
Polymer content based on residual California Test 401
asphalt min,
37-3.02A(4)(c) Department Acceptance
For a slurry seal asphaltic emulsion and polymer modified asphaltic emulsion, acceptance is based on the
Department's sampling and testing for compliance with the requirements for the quality characteristics
specified.
Aggregate acceptance is based on the Department's sampling and testing for compliance with the
requirements shown in the following table:
Aggregate Acceptance Criteria
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Los Angeles Rattler loss (max, %) California Test 211 a
At 500 revolutions 35
Percent of crushed particles (min, %) California Test 205 95
Durability(min) California Test 229 55
Sand equivalent(min)
Type
45
Type II California Test 217 55
Twe 111 60
aCalifornia Test 211 must be performed on the source aggregate before
crushing.
A sand equivalent test represents 300 tons or 1 day's production, whichever is less.
If test results for sand equivalent do not comply with the specifications, you may remove the slurry seal
represented by the test results or request it remain in place with a payment deduction. If your request is
authorized, the Department deducts $1.75 per ton of slurry seal for each noncompliant sand equivalent
test.
37-3.0213 Materials
37-3.02B(1) General
Reserved
37-3.02B(2) Asphaltic Emulsions
An asphaltic emulsion must comply with the requirements in Section 94.The asphaltic emulsion must be
Grade CQS1 h.
Page 66 of 183
37-3.02B(3) Polymer Modified Asphaltic Emulsions
A polymer modified asphaltic emulsion must:
1. Consist of an elastomeric polymer mixed with an asphaltic material uniformly emulsified with water
and an emulsifying or stabilization agent.
2. Use either neoprene polymer or butadiene and styrene copolymer. The polymer must be
homogeneous and milled into the asphaltic emulsion at the colloid mill.
3. Be Grade PMCQS1 h and must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Polymer Modified Asphaltic Emulsion Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Tests on emulsion:
Saybolt Furol Viscosity at 25°C (Saybolt Furol AASHTO T 59 15-90
seconds
Sieve test(%) AASHTO T 59 0-0.3
Storage stability after 1 day(%) AASHTO T 59 0-1
Residue by evaporation (min, %) California Test 331 60
Particle charge AASHTO T 59 Positive
Tests on residue by evaporation:
Penetration at 25°C AASHTO T 49 40-90
Ductility at 25 °C(min, mm) AASHTO T 51 400
Torsional recovery(min, %) California Test 332 18
Or
Polymer content based on residual asphalt(min, %) California Test 401 2.5
37-3.02B(4) Aggregate
Aggregate must comply with the quality characteristic requirements shown in the following table:
Aggregate Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Los Angeles Rattler loss (max, %) California Test 211a
At 500 revolutions 35
Percent of crushed particles min, % California Test 205 95
Durability min California Test 229 55
Sand equivalent(min)
Typel
45
Te II California Test 217 55
Yp
Type III 60
aCalifornia Test 211 must be performed on the source aggregate before crushing. The
aggregate supplier must certify that the crushed aggregate being used on the project is
manufactured from the source aggregate complying with the LA rattler requirements.
37-3.02B(5) Slurry Seal Mix Design
The slurry seal mix design, using project source aggregate, an asphaltic emulsion, and set-control agents
if any, must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Page 67 of 183
Slurry Seal Mix Design Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method a Requirement
Consistency max mm Technical Bulletin 106 30
Wet stripping Technical Bulletin 114 Pass
Compatibility Technical Bulletin 115 Passb
Cohesion test,within 1 hour(min, kg-mm) Technical Bulletin 139 200
Wet track abrasion (max, g/m2) Technical Bulletin 100 810
Test methods are by the International Slurry Surfacing Association.
bMixing test must pass at the maximum expected air temperature at the job site during placement.
The mix design must have the percent of asphaltic residue, based on percentage by weight of the dry
aggregate,within the ranges shown in the following table:
Slurry seal type Residue range
Type 1 10-16
Type II 7.5-13.5
Type III 6.5-12.0
Determine the exact percentage based on the design asphalt binder content and the asphalt residual
content of the asphaltic emulsion furnished.
37-3.02C Construction
37-3.02C(1) General
Reserved
37-3.02C(2) Proportioning
After proportioning, slurry seal mixtures must be workable.
37-3.02C(3) Mixing and Spreading Equipment
Reserved
37-3.02C(4) Placement
The slurry seal spread rates must be within the ranges shown in the following table:
Slurry Seal Spread Rates
Slurry seal type Application range
(lb of dry aggregate/sq yd)
Type 1 8-12
Type II 10-18
T pe III 20-25
Within 4 hours after placement, slurry seals must be set enough to allow traffic without pilot cars. Protect
slurry seals from damage until it has set and will not adhere or be picked up by vehicle tires. Slurry seals
must not exhibit distress from traffic such as bleeding, raveling, separation or other distresses.
37-3.02D Payment
The payment quantity for slurry seal is the weight determined by combining the weights of the aggregate
and asphaltic emulsion or polymeric asphaltic emulsion.The payment quantity for slurry seal does not
include the weights of the added water and set-control additives.
37-3.03 MICRO-SURFACINGS
37-3.03A General
37-3.03A(1) Summary
Section 37-3.03 includes specifications for applying micro-surfacings.
Page 68 of 183
Applying a micro-surfacing consists of spreading a mixture of a micro-surfacing emulsion,water,
additives, mineral filler, and aggregate on the pavement.
37-3.03A(2) Definitions
Reserved
37-3.03A(3) Submittals
Immediately after sampling, submit two 1-quart wide mouth plastic containers of micro-surfacing emulsion
taken in the presence of the Engineer. Samples must be submitted in insulated shipping container.
37-3.03A(4) Quality Assurance
37-3.03A(4)(a) General
Reserved
37-3.03A(4)(b) Quality Control
37-3.03A(4)(b)(i) General
Reserved
37-3.03A(4)(b)(ii) Micro-surfacing Emulsions
Take samples from the truck tank at mid load from a sampling tap or thief. Before taking samples, draw
and dispose of 1 gallon. In the presence of the Engineer, take two 1-quart wide mouth plastic containers
for acceptance testing.
For a micro-surfacing emulsion, the authorized laboratory must perform quality control sampling and
testing at the specified frequency and location for the quality characteristics shown in the following table:
Micro-Surfacing Emulsion
Minimum sampling Sampling
Quality characteristic Test method and testing location
frequency
Tests on emulsion:
Saybolt Furol Viscosity, at 25°C
Sa bolt Furol seconds AASHTO T 59 Minimum 1 per day Delivery truck
Storage stability, 1 daymax, % a per delivery truck
Sieve test max,
Residue by evaporation (min, %) California Test Minimum 1 per day Delivery truck
331 per delivery truck
Tests on residue from evaporation test:
Penetration at 25°C AASHTO T 49d Minimum 1 per day Delivery truck
Softening point min, °C AASHTO T 53 per delivery truck
aStorage stability test will be run if the storage exceeds 48 hours
37-3.03A(4)(c) Department Acceptance
For micro-surfacing emulsions, acceptance is based on the Department's sampling and testing for
compliance with the requirements shown in the following table:
Page 69 of 183
Micro-surfacing Emulsion Acceptance Criteria
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Tests on emulsion:
Saybolt Furol Viscosity at 25'C AASHTO T 59 15-90
Sa bolt Furol seconds
Sieve test(%) AASHTO T 59 0.30
Storage stability, 1 day(max, %) AASHTO T 59 0-1
Settlement', 5 days (max, %) ASTM D244 5
Residue by evaporation (min, %) California Test 331 62
Tests on residue by evaporation:
Penetration at 25°C AASHTO T 49 40-90
Softening point(min,°C) AASHTO T 53 57
'Settlement test on emulsion is not required if used within 48 hours of shipment.
Acceptance of aggregate, except mineral filler, is based on the Department's sampling and testing for
compliance with the requirements shown in the following table:
Aggregate Acceptance Criteria
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Los Angeles Rattler loss (max, %) California Test 211'
At 500 revolutions 35
Percent of crushed particles min, % California Test 205 95
Durability min California Test 229 65
Sand equivalent(min) California Test 217
Type 11 65
Type III 1 1 65
'California Test 211 must be performed on the aggregate before crushing. The aggregate
supplier must certify that the crushed aggregate being used on the project is manufactured
from the source aggregate complying with the LA rattler requirements.
An aggregate sand equivalent test represents 300 tons or 1 day's production,whichever is less.
If the test results for aggregate sand equivalent do not comply with the specifications, you may remove
the micro-surfacing represented by the test results or request it remain in place with a payment deduction.
If your request is authorized, the Department deducts$2.00 per ton of micro-surfacing for each
noncompliant aggregate sand equivalent test.
37-3.0313 Materials
37-3.03B(1) General
Reserved
37-3.03B(2) Micro-surfacing Emulsions
A micro-surfacing emulsion must be a homogeneous mixture of asphalt, an elastomeric polymer and an
emulsifier solution.
Add an elastomeric polymer modifier to asphalt or emulsifier solution before emulsification.An
elastomeric polymer solid must be a minimum of 3 percent by weight of the micro-surfacing emulsion's
residual asphalt.
A micro-surfacing emulsion must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Page 70 of 183
Micro-surfacing Emulsion Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Tests on emulsion:
Saybolt Furol Viscosity at 25°C (Saybolt Furol AASHTO T 59 15-90
seconds
Sieve test(%) AASHTO T 59 0.30
Storage stability, 1 day(max, %) AASHTO T 59 0-1
Settlementa, 5 days (max, %) ASTM D244 5
Residue by evaporation (min, %) California Test 331 62
Tests on residue by evaporation:
Penetration at 25°C AASHTO T 49 40-90
Softening point(min, °C) AASHTO T 53 57
aSettlement test on emulsion is not required if used within 48 hours of shipment.
37-3.03B(3) Aggregate
Aggregate must comply with the quality characteristic requirements shown in the following table:
Aggregate Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Los Angeles Rattler loss (max, %) California Test 211a
At 500 revolutions 35
Percent of crushed particles (min, %) California Test 205 95
Durability(min) California Test 229 65
Sand equivalent(min) California Test 217
Type I I 65
Type III 1 1 65
aCalifornia Test 211 must be performed on the source aggregate before crushing. The
aggregate supplier must certify that the crushed aggregate being used on the project is
manufactured from the source aggregate complying with the LA rattler requirements.
37-3.03B(4) Mineral Fillers
If a mineral filler is used, it must be type I or type II Portland cement.A mineral filler used during mix
design must be used during production.
37-3.03B(5) Micro-Surfacing Mix Designs
The micro-surfacing mix design must have the material proportion limits shown in the following table:
Micro-surfacing Mix Design Proportion Limits
Material Proportion limits
Micro-surfacing emulsion asphalt residual content(% 5.5-10.5
of dry wei ht of aggregate)
Water and additives As Required
Mineral filler % of dry weight of aggregate) 0-3
The micro-surfacing mix design must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Page 71 of 183
Micro-surfacing Mix Design Requirements
Quality characteristics Test method Requirement
Wet cohesion
At 30 minutes (set) (min, kg-cm) Technical Bulletin 139 12
At 60 minutes traffic min, kg-cm) 20
Excess asphalt(max, g/m ) Technical Bulletin 109 540
Wet stripping (min, %) Technical Bulletin 114 90
Wet track abrasion loss
6-day soak(max, g/m2) Technical Bulletin 100 810
Displacement
Lateral (max, %) Technical Bulletin 147A 5
Specific gravity after 1000 cycles of 57 kg 2.10
max
Classification compatibility min, grade points Technical Bulletin 144 AAA, BAA 11
Mix time at 25 °C (min) Technical Bulletin 113 Controllable to 120
seconds
aTest methods are by the International Slurry Surfacing Association.
37-3.03B(6)Tack Coats
If there is a bid item for tack coat, you must coat the pavement surface with an asphaltic emulsion mixed
with additional water before applying a micro-surfacing.The maximum ratio of water to asphaltic emulsion
must be 2 to 1.Apply the tack coat at a rate from 0.08 to 0.15 gal/sq yd. The exact rate must be
authorized.
You determine the grade of slow-setting or quick setting asphaltic emulsion to be used.
37-3.03C Construction
37-3.03C(1) General
Reserved
37-3.03C(2) Proportioning
Field conditions may require adjustments to the proportions within the authorized mix design during
construction.
37-3.03C(3) Mixing and Spreading Equipment
37-3.03C(3)(a) General
Reserved
37-3.03C(3)(b) Scratch Course Boxes
Spread the scratch courses with the same type of spreader box used to spread micro-surfacings except
use an adjustable steel strike-off device instead of a final strike-off device.
37-3.03C(3)(c) Wheel Path Depression Boxes
Each wheel path depression box must have adjustable strike-off device between 5 and 6 feet wide to
regulate depth.The wheel path depression box must also have devices such as hydraulic augers capable
of:
1. Moving the mixed material from the rear to the front of the filling chamber
2. Guiding larger aggregate into the deeper section of the wheel path depression
3. Forcing the finer material towards the outer edges of the spreader box
37-3.03C(4) Test Strips
If micro-surfacing placement will require more than 1 day, you must construct a test strip. The test strip
must be:
1. From 300 to 450 feet long
2. The same as the full production micro-surfacing
3. On 1 of the application courses specified at an authorized location
Page 72 of 183
4. At the same time of day or night the full production micro-surfacing is to be applied
If multiple application courses are specified, you may construct test strips over 2 days or nights.
The Engineer evaluates the test strip after traffic has used it for 12 hours. If the Engineer determines the
mix design or placement procedure is unacceptable, make modifications and construct a new test strip for
the Engineer's evaluation.
37-3.03C(5) Placement
37-3.03C(5)(a) General
Reserved
37-3.03C(5)(b) Repair Wheel Path Depressions
If repairing wheel path depressions is shown in plans,fill wheel path depressions and irregularities with
micro-surfacing material before spreading micro-surfacing. If the depressions are less than 0.04 foot
deep,fill with a scratch course. If the depressions are 0.04 foot deep or more,fill the depressions using a
wheel path depression box.
Spread scratch courses by adjusting the steel strike-off of a scratch course box until it is directly in contact
with the pavement surface.
Spread micro-surfacings with a wheel path depression box leaving a slight crown at the surface. Use
multiple applications to fill depressions more than 0.12 foot deep. Do not apply more than 0.12 foot in a
single application.
Allow traffic to compact each filled wheel path depression for a minimum of 12 hours before placing
additional micro-surfacings.
37-3.03C(5)(c) Micro-surfacing Pavement Surfaces
The micro-surfacing spread rates must be within the ranges shown in the following table:
Micro-surfacing type Application range
(lb of dry aggregate/sq yd)
Tvoe II 10-20
Type Illa 20-32
Type Illb 30-32
Over asphalt concrete pavement
bOver concrete pavement and concrete bridge decks
Within 2 hours after placement, micro-surfacings must be set enough to allow traffic without pilot cars.
Protect the micro-surfacings from damage until it has set and will not adhere or be picked up by vehicle
tires. Micro-surfacings must not exhibit distress from traffic such as bleeding, raveling, separation or other
distresses.
37-3.03D Payment
The payment quantity for micro-surfacing is the weight determined by combining the weights of the
aggregate and micro-surfacing emulsion.The payment quantity for micro-surfacing does not include the
weights of added water, mineral filler, and additives.
37-3.04 RUBBERIZED AND MODIFIED SLURRY SEALS
Reserved
37-4 FOG SEALS AND FLUSH COATS
37-4.01 GENERAL
37-4.01A General
37-4.01A(1) Summary
Section 37-4.01 includes general specifications for applying fog seals and flush coats.
Page 73 of 183
37-4.01A(2) Definitions
Reserved
37-4.01A(3) Submittals
At least 15 days before use, submit:
1. Sample of asphaltic emulsion in two 1-quart plastic container with lined, sealed lid
2. Asphaltic emulsion information and test data as follows:
2.1. Supplier
2.2. Type/Grade of asphalt emulsion
2.3. Copy of the specified test results for asphaltic emulsion
37-4.01 B Materials
Not Used
37-4.01 C Construction
37-4.01C(1) General
Reserved
37-4.01C(2) Weather Conditions
Only place a fog seal or flush coat if both the pavement and ambient temperatures are at least 50
degrees F and rising. Do not place a fog seal or flush coat within 24 hours of rain or within 24 hours of
forecast rain or freezing temperatures.
37-4.01 D Payment
Not Used
37-4.02 FOG SEALS
37-4.02A General
37-4.02A(1) Summary
Section 37-4.02 includes specifications for applying fog seals.
Applying a fog seal includes applying a diluted slow-setting or quick setting asphaltic emulsion.
37-4.02A(2) Definitions
Reserved
37-4.02A(3) Submittals
Immediately after sampling, submit two 1-quart plastic container of asphaltic emulsion taken in the
presence of the Engineer. Samples must be submitted in insulated shipping container.
37-4.02A(4) Quality Assurance
37-4.02A(4)(a) General
Reserved
37-4.02A(4)(b) Quality Control
37-4.02A(4)(b)(i) General
Reserved
37-4.02A(4)(b)(ii) Asphaltic Emulsions
Circulate asphaltic emulsions in the distributor truck before sampling.Take samples from the distributor
truck at mid load or from a sampling tap or thief. Before taking samples, draw and dispose of 1 gallon. In
the presence of the Engineer, take asphalt emulsion sample in two 1-quart plastic container with lined,
sealed lid.
For asphaltic emulsions,the authorized laboratory must perform quality control sampling and testing at
the specified frequency and location for the following quality characteristics:
Page 74 of 183
Asphaltic Emulsion
Quality characteristic Test Method Minimum sampling and Sampling location
testing frequency
Saybolt Furol Viscosity, at
25°C Sa bolt Furl seconds
Sieve Test % AASHTO T 59 Minimum 1 per day per Distributor truck
Storage stability, 1 day % delivery truck
Residue by distillation
Particle charge a
Tests on Residue from Distillation Test:
Penetration, 25°C AASHTO T 49
DuctilityAASHTO T 51 Minimum 1 per day per Distributor truck
Solubilityin tricloroeth lene AASHTO T 44 delivery truck
'if the result of the particle charge is inconclusive,the asphaltic emulsion must be tested for pH under
ASTM E70. Grade QS1 h asphaltic emulsion must have a minimum pH of 7.3. Grade CQS1 h asphaltic
emulsion must have a maximum pH of 6.7.
37-4.02A(4)(b)(iii) Asphaltic Emulsion Spread Rates
For fog seals, the authorized laboratory must perform sampling and testing at the specified frequency and
location for the following quality characteristics:
Fog Seal Quality Control Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Minimum sampling Location of
and testing frequency sampling
Asphaltic emulsion spread rate California Test 339 2 per day Pavement
al/s d surface
37-4.02A(4)(c) Department Acceptance
Fog seal acceptance is based on:
1. Visual inspection for the following:
1.1. Uniform surface texture throughout the work limits
1.2. Flushing consisting of the occurrence of a film of asphaltic material on the surface
1.4 Streaking consisting of alternating longitudinal bands of asphaltic emulsion approximately
parallel with the lane line
2. The Department's sampling and testing for compliance with the requirements for the quality
characteristics specified in section 94 for asphaltic emulsion
3. Department's sampling and testing for compliance with the requirements for fog seal shown in the
following table:
Fog Seal Acceptance Criteria
Quality Characteristic Test Method Requirement
Asphaltic emulsions read rate al/s d California Test 339 TV± 10%
37-4.02B Materials
You determine the grade of slow-setting or quick setting asphaltic emulsion to be used.
37-4.02C Construction
Apply asphaltic emulsions for fog seals at a residual asphalt rate from 0.02 to 0.06 gal/sq yd.
If additional water is added to the asphaltic emulsions,the resultant mixture must not be more than 1 part
asphaltic emulsion to 1 part water. You determine the dilution rate.
If the fog seals become tacky, sprinkle water as required.
Page 75 of 183
If fog seals and chip seals are on the same project, the joint between the seal coats must be neat and
uniform.
37-4.02D Payment
The Department does not adjust the unit price for an increase or decrease in the asphaltic emulsion
quantity.
37-4.03 FLUSH COATS
37-4.03A General
37-4.03A(1) Summary
Section 37-4.03 includes specifications for applying flush coats.
Applying a flush coat includes applying a fog seal coat followed by sand.
37-4.03A(2) Definitions
Reserved
37-4.03A(3) Submittals
At least 15 days before use, submit:
1. Proposed target X values for sand gradation.
2. Gradation test results for sand
Submit quality control test results for sand gradation within 2 business days of sampling.
37-4.03A(4) Quality Assurance
37-4.03A(4)(a)General
Reserved
37-4.03A(4)(b) Quality Control
For sand,the authorized laboratory must perform sampling and testing at the specified frequency and
location for the following quality characteristics:
Sand Quality Control
Quality characteristic Test method Minimum sampling Location of
and testing frequency sampling
Gradation (% passing by weight) California Test 1 per day See California
202 Test125
37-4.03A(4)(c) Department Acceptance
Flush coat acceptance is based on fog seal acceptance and the following:
1. Visual inspection for uniform application of sand.
2. Sand acceptance is based on the Department's sampling and testing for compliance with the
requirements shown in the following table:
Page 76 of 183
Sand Gradation Acceptance Criteria
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Gradation (% passing by weight)
Sieve size:
3/8" 100
No.4 93-100
No. 8 California Test 202 61-99
No. 16 X ± 13
No. 30 X ± 12
No. 50 X ±9
No.100 1-15
No. 200 0-10
NOTE: "X"is the gradation that you propose to furnish for the specific sieve size.
37-4.03B Material
37-4.03B(1) General
Reserved
37-4.03B(2) Sand
Sand must be free from deleterious coatings, clay balls, roots, bark, sticks, rags, and other extraneous
material.
Sand for a flush coat must comply with the gradations shown in the following table:
Sand Gradation
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Gradation (% passing by weight)
Sieve size:
3/8" 100
No.4 93-100
No. 8 California Test 202 61-99
No. 16 X± 13
No. 30 X± 12
No. 50 X±9
No.100 1-15
No. 200 0-10
NOTE: "X"is the gradation that you propose to furnish for the specific sieve size.
Fine aggregate sizes must be distributed such that the difference between the total percentage passing
the No. 16 and No. 30 sieves is from 10 to 40, and the difference between the percentage passing the
No. 30 and No. 50 sieves is from 10 to 40.
37-4.03C Construction
37-4.03C(1) General
During flush coat activities, close adjacent lanes to traffic. Do not track asphaltic emulsion on existing
pavement surfaces.
Apply sand immediately after applying asphaltic emulsions.
Spread sand aggregate with a mechanical device that spreads sand at a uniform rate over the full width
of a traffic lane in a single application. Spread sand at a rate from 2 to 6 Ib/sq yd. You determine the
application rates for sand and the Engineer authorizes the application rate.
37-4.03C(2) Sweeping
Sweep loose sand material remaining on the surface 24 hours after application.
Page 77 of 183
37-4.03D Payment
The Department does not adjust the unit price for an increase or decrease in the sand cover(seal)
quantity.
37-5 PARKING AREA SEALS
37-5.01 GENERAL
37-5.01A Summary
Section 37-5 includes specifications for applying parking area seals. Sealing a parking area consists of
spreading a mixture of asphaltic emulsion, aggregate, polymer, and water.
37-5.0113 Definitions
Reserved
37-5.01C Submittals
At least 15 days before starting placement, submit a 20 lb sample of the aggregate to be used.
At least 10 days before starting placement, submit:
1. Name of the authorized laboratory to perform testing and mix design.
2. Laboratory report of test results and a proposed mix design. The report and mix design must include
the specific materials to be used and show a comparison of test results and specifications. The mix
design report must include the quantity of water allowed to be added at the job site. The authorized
laboratory performing the tests must sign the original laboratory report and mix design.
3. Manufacturer's data for oil seal primer and polymer.
If the mix design consists of the same materials covered by a previous laboratory report, you may submit
the previous laboratory report that must include material testing data performed within the previous 12
months for authorization.
If you request substitute materials, submit a new laboratory report and mix design at least 10 days before
starting placement.
Submit a certificate of compliance for the parking area seal material.
Immediately after sampling, submit two 1-quart plastic containers of parking area seal taken in the
presence of the Engineer. Samples must be submitted in insulated shipping containers.
37-5.01 D Quality Assurance
37-5.01D(1) General
Reserved
37-5.01 D(2) Quality Control
37-5.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
37-5.01D(2)(b) Asphaltic Emulsions
For an asphaltic emulsion, the authorized laboratory must perform quality control sampling and testing at
the specified frequency and location for the following quality characteristics:
Page 78 of 183
Asphaltic Emulsion
Quality characteristic Test Method Minimum sampling Sampling
and testing frequency location
Saybolt Furol Viscosity, at 25°C
Sa bolt Furol seconds
Sieve Test(%) AASHTO T 59 Minimum 1 per day Distributor truck
Storage stability, 1 day(%) per delivery truck
Residue by distillation (%)
Particle chargea
Tests on Residue from Distillation Test
Penetration, 25°C AASHTO T 49
Ductility AASHTO T 51 Minimum 1 per day Distributor truck
Solubility in trichloroethylene AASHTO T 44 per delivery truck
'if the result of the particle char is inconclusive, the asphaltic emulsion must be tested for pH under
ASTM E70. Grade QS1 h asphaltic emulsion must have a minimum pH of 7.3. Grade CQS1 h asphaltic
emulsion must have a maximum pH of 6.7.
37-5.01 D(2)(c) Sand
For sand,the authorized laboratory must perform sampling and testing at the specified frequency and
location for the following quality characteristics:
Sand Quality Control
Quality characteristic Test method Minimum sampling Location of
and testing frequency sampling
Gradation (% passing by weight) California Test 202 One per project See California Test
125
37-5.01 D(2)(d) Parking Area Seals
For a parking area seal, the authorized laboratory must perform quality control sampling and testing at the
specified frequency for the following quality characteristics:
Parking Area Seal Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Frequency
Mass per liter k ASTM D244
Cone penetration (mm) California Test 413
Nonvolatile % ASTM D2042a
Nonvolatile soluble in trichloroeth lene % One per project
Wet track abrasion /m ASTM D3910
Dried film color --
Viscosity KU ASTM D562
aWeigh 10 g of homogenous material into a previously tarred, small can. Place in a constant temperature
oven at 165 ± 5 °C for 90 ± 3 minutes. Cool, reweigh, and calculate nonvolatile components as a percent
of the original weight.
bKrebs units
37-5.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
Parking area seal acceptance is based on:
1. Visual inspection for:
1.1. Uniform surface texture throughout the work limits
1.2 Marks in the surface:
1.2.1. Up to 4 marks in the completed parking area seal that are up to 1 inch wide and up to
6 inches long per 1,000 square feet of parking area seal placed.
1.2.2. No marks in the completed parking area seal surface that are over 1 inch wide or 6
inches long.
Page 79 of 183
1.2. Raveling consisting of the separation of the aggregate from the asphaltic emulsion
1.3. Bleeding consisting of the occurrence of a film of asphaltic material on the surface of the
parking area seal
1.4 Delaminating of the parking area seal from the existing pavement
1.5 Rutting or wash-boarding
2. The Department's sampling and testing of aggregate for compliance with 100 percent passing no. 16
sieve under California Test 202
3. The Department's sampling and testing for compliance with the requirements shown in the following
table:
Parking Area Seal Acceptance Criteria
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Mass per liter min, k ASTM D244 1.1
Cone penetration (mm) California Test 413 340-700
Nonvolatile min % ASTM D2042a 50
Nonvolatile soluble in trichloroethylene(%) 10-35
Wet track abrasion (max, g/m2) ASTM D3910 380
Dried film color -- Black
Viscosity(min, KU)b ASTM D562 75
aWeigh 10 g of homogenous material into a previously tared, small ointment can. Place in a
constant temperature oven at 165±5 °C for 90±3 minutes. Cool, reweigh, and calculate
nonvolatile components as a percent of the original weight.
bKrebs units
37-5.02 MATERIALS
37-5.02A General
Aggregate must be clean, hard, durable, uncoated, and free from organic and deleterious substances.
One hundred percent of the aggregate must pass the no. 16 sieve.
Asphaltic emulsion must be either Grade SS1 h or CSS1 h, except the values for penetration at 25
degrees C for tests on residue from distillation must be from 20 to 60.
Polymer must be either neoprene, ethylene vinyl acetate, or a blend of butadiene and styrene.
Oil seal primer must be a quick-drying emulsion with admixtures. Oil seal primer must be manufactured to
isolate the parking area seal from pavement with residual oils, petroleum grease, and spilled gasoline.
Crack sealant must comply with section 37-6.
Water must be potable and not separate from the emulsion before the material is placed.
37-5.0213 Mix Design
The proposed mix design for a parking area seal must comply with the requirements shown in the
following table:
Page 80 of 183
Parking Area Seal Mix Design Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Mass per liter mink ASTM D244 1.1
Cone penetration (mm) California Test 413 340-700
Nonvolatile min % ASTM D2042a 50
Nonvolatile soluble in trichloroethylene(°/o) 10-35
Wet track abrasion (max, g/m2) ASTM D3910 380
Dried film color -- Black
Viscosity(min, KU)b ASTM D562 75
'Weigh 10 g of homogenous material into a previously tarred, small ointment can. Place in a
constant temperature oven at 165±5 °C for 90±3 minutes. Cool, reweigh, and calculate
nonvolatile components as a percent of the original weight.
bKrebs units
A parking area seal must contain a minimum of 2 percent polymer by volume of undiluted asphaltic
emulsion.
37-5.02C Proportioning
Parking area seal ingredients must be mixed at a central plant. The plant must include mechanical or
electronic controls that consistently proportion the ingredients. Mix an asphaltic emulsion with the other
ingredients mechanically.
Store the parking area seal in a tank equipped with mixing or agitation devices. Keep stored materials
thoroughly mixed. Protect stored materials from freezing conditions.
37-5.03 CONSTRUCTION
37-5.03A General
Request that the Engineer shut off the irrigation control system at least 5 days before placing the seal. Do
not water plants adjacent to the seal at least 24 hours before and after the seal coat placement.
37-5.0313 Surface Preparations
If cracks in the existing pavement are from 1/4 to 1 inch wide, treat the cracks under section 37-6. Do not
place the parking area seals until the Engineer determines that the crack treatments are cured.
If cracks in the existing pavement are greater than 1 inch wide, the Engineer orders the repair.This work
is change order work.
After any crack treatment and before placing parking area seals, clean the pavement surface, including
removal of oil and grease spots. Do not use solvents.
If cleaning the pavement with detergents,thoroughly rinse with water.Allow all water to dry before placing
parking area seals.
You must seal oil and grease spots that remain after cleaning. Use an oil seal primer and comply with the
manufacturer's instructions.
If the existing pavement has oil and grease spots that do not come clean and sealing is insufficient, the
Engineer orders the repair of the pavement.This work is change order work.
Before placing the parking area seals, dampen the pavement surface using a distributor truck. Place the
seal on the damp pavement but do not place it with standing water on the pavement.
37-5.03C Placement
If adding water at the job site based on the manufacturer's instructions for consistency and spreadability,
do not exceed 15 percent by volume of undiluted asphaltic emulsion.
Place the parking area seals in 1 or more application.The seals must be uniform and smooth,free of
ridges or uncoated areas.
Page 81 of 183
If placing in multiple applications, allow the last application to thoroughly dry before the subsequent
application.
Do not allow traffic on the parking area seals for at least 24 hours after placement.
Do not stripe over the parking area seals until it is dry.
37-5.04 PAYMENT
The payment quantity for parking area seal is the weight determined by combining the weights of the
aggregate and asphaltic emulsion. The payment quantity for parking area seal does not include the
added water and set-control additive.
37-6 CRACKTREATMENTS
37-6.01 GENERAL
37-6.01A Summary
Section 37-6 includes specifications for treating cracks in asphalt concrete pavement.
37-6.01 B Definitions
Reserved
37-6.01C Submittals
If your selected crack treatment material is on the Authorized Material List for flexible pavement crack
treatment material, submit a certificate of compliance including:
1. Manufacturer's name
2. Production location
3. Brand or trade name
4. Designation
5. Batch or lot number
6. Crack treatment material type
7. Contractor or subcontractor name
8. Contract number
9. Lot size
10. Shipment date
11. Manufacturer's signature
If your selected crack treatment material is not on the Authorized Material List for flexible pavement crack
treatment material, submit a sample and test results from each batch or lot 20 days before use. Testing
must be performed by an authorized laboratory and test results must show compliance with the
specifications.Test reports must include the information specified for the certificate of compliance
submittal. Each hot-applied crack treatment material sample must be a minimum of 3 lb and submitted in
a silicone release container. Each cold-applied crack treatment material sample must be a minimum of 2
quarts and submitted in a plastic container.
At least 10 days before the start of work, submit sand gradation test results under California Test 202.
Submit the following with each delivery of crack treatment material to the job site:
1. Manufacturer's heating and application instructions
2. Manufacturer's SIDS
3. Name of the manufacturer's recommended detackifying agent
37-6.01 D Quality Assurance
37-6.01D(1) General
Hot-applied crack treatment material must be sampled at least once per project in the Engineer's
presence. Collect two 3-pounds-minimum samples of crack treatment material from the dispensing wand
into silicone release boxes.
Page 82 of 183
Cold-applied crack treatment material must be sampled at least once per project in the Engineer's
presence. Collect 2 samples of crack treatment material from the dispensing wand into 1-quart
containers.
37-6.01D(2) Quality Control
Reserved
37-6.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
Crack treatment acceptance is based on:
1. Visual inspection for uniform filling of cracks throughout the work limits including:
1.2. Crack treatment is not more than a 1/4 inch below the specified level
1.3. Sealant failures
1.4. Crack re-opening
1.5. Crack overbanding is less than 3 inches wide
2. The Department's sampling and testing for compliance with the requirements shown in the following
table:
Crack Treatment Acceptance Criteria
Quality characteristica Test method b Requirement
Type 1 Type 2 Type 3 Type 4 Type 5
Softening point min, °C ASTM D36 102 96 90 84 84
Cone penetration at 77 °F (max) ASTM D5329 35 40 50 70 90
Resilience at 77°F, una ed % ASTM D5329 20-60 25-65 30-70 35-75 40-80
Flexibilit °C ° ASTM D3111 0 0 0 -11 -28
Tensile adhesion min, % ASTM D5329 300 400 400 500 500
Specific gravity(max) ASTM D70 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25
Asphalt compatibility ASTM D5329 Pass Pass Pass Pass Pass
Sieve test % passing) See note d 100 100 100 100 100
aCold-applied crack treatment material residue collected under ASTM D6943, Method B and sampled
under ASTM D140 must comply with the grade specified.
bExcept for viscosity, cure each specimen at a temperature of 23±2 °C and a relative humidity of 50±
10 percent for 24±2 hours before testing.
°For the flexibility test, the specimen size must be 6.4±0.2 mm thick by 25±0.2 mm wide by 150±0.5
mm long. The test mandrel diameter must be 6.4±0.2 mm.The bend arc must be 180 degrees. The
bend rate must be 2± 1 seconds.At least 4 of 5 test specimens must pass at the specified test
temperature without fracture, crazing, or cracking.
dFor hot-applied crack treatment, dilute with toluene and sieve through a no. 8 sieve. For cold-applied
crack treatment, sieve the material as-received through a no. 8 sieve. If the manufacturer provides a
statement that added components passed the no. 16 sieve before blending, this requirement is void.
37-6.02 MATERIALS
37-6.02A General
Reserved
37-6.02B Crack Treatment Material
A crack treatment material must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Page 83 of 183
Crack Treatment Material
Quality characteristic' Test method b Requirement
Type 1 Type 2 Type 3 Type 4 Type 5
Softening point min °C ASTM D36 102 96 90 84 84
Cone penetration at 77 °F (max) ASTM D5329 35 40 50 70 90
Resilience at 77°F, unaged (%) ASTM D5329 20-60 25-65 30-70 35-75 40-80
Flexibility(°C)° ASTM D3111 0 0 0 -11 -28
Tensile adhesion (min, %) ASTM D5329 300 400 400 500 500
Specific gravity(max) ASTM D70 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25
Asphalt compatibility ASTM D5329 Pass Pass Pass Pass Pass
Sieve test(% passing) See note d 100 100 100 100 100
'Cold-applied crack treatment material residue collected under ASTM D6943, Method B and sampled
under ASTM D140 must comply with the grade specifications.
bExcept for viscosity, cure each specimen at a temperature of 23±2 °C and a relative humidity of 50±
10 percent for 24±2 hours before testing.
°For the flexibility test, the specimen size must be 6.4±0.2 mm thick by 25±0.2 mm wide by 150±0.5
mm long.The test mandrel diameter must be 6.4±0.2 mm. The bend arc must be 180 degrees.The
bend rate must be 2 ± 1 seconds. At least 4 of 5 test specimens must pass at the specified test
temperature without fracture, crazing, or cracking.
dFor hot-applied crack treatment, dilute with toluene and sieve through a no. 8 sieve. For cold-applied
crack treatment, sieve the material as-received through a no. 8 sieve. If the manufacturer provides a
statement that added components passed the no. 16 sieve before blending, this requirement is void.
A crack treatment material must be delivered to the job site with the information listed below. If crack
treatment material is delivered to the job site in containers, each container must be marked with the
following information.
1. Manufacturer's name
2. Production location
3. Brand or trade name
4. Designation
5. Crack treatment trade name
6. Batch or lot number
7. Maximum heating temperature
8. Expiration date for cold application only
Hot-applied crack treatment must be delivered to the job site premixed in cardboard containers with
meltable inclusion liners or in a fully meltable package.
Cold-applied crack treatment must have a minimum shelf life of 3 months from the date of manufacture.
37-6.02C Sand
Sand applied to tacky crack treatment material must be clean,free of clay, and comply with the gradation
shown in the following table:
Sand Gradation
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Gradation (% passing by weight)
Sieve size:
No.4 California Test 202 100
No. 50 0-30
No. 200 0-5
37-6.03 CONSTRUCTION
Treat cracks from 1/4 to 1 inch in width for the entire length of the crack. Fill or repair cracks wider than 1
inch as ordered. Filling cracks wider than 1 inch is change order work.
Page 84 of 183
If treating cracks on a traffic lane adjacent to a shoulder, treat the cracks on the shoulder.
For hot-applied crack treatment material, rout cracks or saw cut to form a reservoir.
Cracks must be clean and dry before treating. Before treating, blast cracks with oil-free compressed air at
a pressure of at least 90 psi.
If the pavement temperature is below 40 degrees F or if there is evidence of moisture in the crack, use a
hot air lance immediately before applying crack treatment. The hot air lance must not apply flame directly
on the pavement.
Heat and apply hot-applied crack treatment material under with the manufacturer's instructions.
Apply cold-applied crack treatment material with a distributor kettle, a piston, or a diaphragm barrel pump
that can deliver from 50 to 75 psi. The application line must have a pressure gauge and a filter. The
pressure in the application line must not exceed 20 psi. The pressure gauge must have a regulator. Use a
high-pressure hose with a 1/2-inch NPT swivel connection and a dispensing wand.
Apply crack treatment with a nozzle inserted into the crack. Fill the crack flush. If after 2 days the crack
treatment is more than 1/4 inch below the specified level, the sealant fails, or the crack re-opens, re-treat
the crack.
Immediately remove crack treatment material that is spilled or deposited on the pavement surface.
Before opening to traffic, apply sand or the manufacturer's recommended detackifying agent to tacky
crack treatment material on the traveled way.
Sweep up excess sand before opening to traffic.
37-6.04 PAYMENT
The payment quantity for crack treatment is the length measured in lane miles along the edge of each
paved lane parallel to the pavement's centerline. The payment for a lane includes crack treatment of the
adjacent shoulder.
37-7-37-10 RESERVED
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
39 ASPHALT CONCRETE
07-15-16
Replace SP-2 at each occurrence in section 39 with:
01-15-16
MS-2
Replace the 3rd paragraph of section 39-2.01A(1)with:
07-15-16
WMA technologies must be on the Authorized Material List for WMA authorized technologies.
Add between the 3rd and 4th paragraphs of section 39-2.01A(1):
04-15-16
For HMA that uses asphalt binder containing crumb rubber modifier, submit a Crumb Rubber Usage
Report form monthly and at the end of the project.
Page 85 of 183
Add to the table in the 4th paragraph of section 39-2.01A(1):
01-15-16
Asphalt Institute MS-2 7th edition 2015
Add to item 8 in the 4th paragraph of section 39-2.01A(3)(b)(i):
07-15-16
except lime supplier and source
Replace the headings and paragraphs of section 39-2.01A(3)(i)with:
01-15-16
39-2.01A(3)(i) Reserved
Replace the 2nd sentence in the 3rd paragraph of section 39-2.01A(4)(b)with:
01-15-16
Submit 3 parts and keep 1 part.
Add between single and test in the 7th paragraph of section 39-2.01A(4)(i)(1):
07-15-16
aggregate or HMA
Replace the 1st paragraph of section 39-2.01 B(2)(b)with:
07-15-16
If the proposed JMF indicates that the aggregate is being treated with dry lime or lime slurry with
marination, or the HMA with liquid antistrip, then testing the untreated aggregate under AASHTO T 283
and AASHTO T 324 is not required.
If HMA treatment is required or being used by the Contractor, determine the plasticity index of the
aggregate blend under California Test 204.
Add between aggregate and with dry lime in the 3rd and 4th paragraphs of section 39-2.01 B(2)(b):
07-15-16
blend
Replace the 9th through 11th paragraphs of section 39-2.01 B(8)(a)with:
07-15-16
HMA must be produced at the temperatures shown in the following table:
HMA Production Temperatures
HMA compaction Temperature(°F)
HMA
Density based <-325
Method 305-325
HMA with W MA technology
Density based 240-325
Method 260-325
Page 86 of 183
04-15-16
Delete the 1st paragraph of section 39-2.01B(11).
Add after the 2nd paragraph of section 39-2.01 B(11):
04-15-16
For miscellaneous areas and dikes:
1. Choose the aggregate gradation from:
1.1. 3/8-inch Type A HMA aggregate gradation
1.2. 1/2-inch Type A HMA aggregate gradation
1.3. 1/2-inch dike mix aggregate gradation
2. Choose asphalt binder Grade PG 64-10, PG 64-16 or PG 70-10.
3. Minimum asphalt binder content must be:
3.1. 6.40 percent for 3/8-inch Type A HMA aggregate gradation
3.2. 5.70 percent for 1/2-inch Type A HMA aggregate gradation
3.3. 6.40 percent for 1/2-inch dike mix aggregate gradation
If you request and the Engineer authorizes, you may reduce the minimum asphalt binder content.
Aggregate gradation for 1/2-inch dike mix must be within the TV limits for the specified sieve size shown
in the following table:
Aggregate Gradation for 1/2-inch Dike Mix
(Percentage Passing)
Sieve size Target value limit Allowable tolerance
3/4" 100 --
1/2" 90-95 TV±5
No.4 70-75 TV±5
No. 8 23-25 TV±5
No. 50 15-35 TV±5
No. 200 7.0-13.0 TV±2.0
Replace item 4 in the 2nd paragraph of section 39-2.01C(1)with:
07-15-16
4. For method compaction:
4.1. The temperature of the HMA and the HMA produced with WMA water injection technology in
the windrow does not fall below 260 degrees F
4.2. The temperature of the HMA produced using WMA additive technology in the windrow does
not fall below 250 degrees F
07-15-16
Delete item 3 in the 8th paragraph of section 39-2.01C(1).
Replace 39-2.01A(3)(m)(iv)in the 6th paragraph of section 39-2.01 C(3)(e)with:
01-15-16
36-3.01 C(3)
Replace 2.06 in the 4th paragraph of section 39-2.01C(3)(f)with:
07-15-16
2.05
Page 87 of 183
Add to the end of section 39-2.01 C(15)(b):
07-15-16
The compacted lift thickness must not exceed 0.25 foot.
Add between rectangles and with in the 4th paragraph of section 39-2.01C(16):
04-15-16
half the lane width,
Add between to and the in item 1 of the 4th paragraph of section 39-2.01 C(16):
04-15-16
and along
07-15-16
Delete coat in the 5th paragraph of section 39-2.01C(16).
Replace 37 in the 5th paragraph of section 39-2.01 C(16)with:
07-15-16
37-4.02
Replace section 39-2.02A(3)(b)with:
01-15-16
The JMF must be based on the superpave HMA mix design as described in MS-2 Asphalt Mix Design
Methods by the Asphalt Institute.
Add between the 1st and 2nd paragraphs of section 39-2.02C:
07-15-16
If the ambient air temperature is below 60 degrees F, cover the loads in trucks with tarpaulins. If the time
for HMA discharge to truck at the HMA plant until transfer to paver's hopper is 90 minutes or greater and
if the ambient air temperature is below 70 degrees F, cover the loads in trucks with tarpaulins, unless the
time from discharging to the truck until transfer to the paver's hopper or the pavement surface is less than
30 minutes.The tarpaulins must completely cover the exposed load until you transfer the mixture to the
paver's hopper or the pavement surface.
Replace the table in the 2nd paragraph of section 39-2.02C with:
07-15-16
Minimum Ambient Air and Surface Temperatures
Lift thickness Ambient air(OF) Surface('IF)
(feet) Unmodified Modified asphalt Unmodified asphalt Modified asphalt
asphalt binder binder binder binder
Type A HMA and T e A HMA produced with WMA water in'ection technology
<0.15 55 50 60 55
>_0.15 45 45 50 50
Type A HMA produced with WMA additive technology
<0.15 45 45 50 45
>_0.15 40 40 40 40
Page 88 of 183
07-15-16
Delete the 3rd paragraph of section 39-2.02C.
Add between HMA and placed in the 1st sentence of the 4th paragraph of section 39-2.02C:
07-15-16
and Type A HMA produced with WMA water injection technology
Add between the 4th and the 5th paragraphs of section 39-2.02C:
07-15-16
For Type A HMA produced with WMA additive technology placed under method compaction, if the
asphalt binder is:
1. Unmodified,complete:
1.1 1 st coverage of breakdown compaction before the surface temperature drops below 240
degrees F
1.2. Breakdown and intermediate compaction before the surface temperature drops below 190
degrees F
1.3. Finish compaction before the surface temperature drops below 140 degrees F
1.4 You may continue static rolling below 140 degrees F to remove roller marks.
2. Modified,complete:
2.1. 1 st coverage of breakdown compaction before the surface temperature drops below 230
degrees F
2.2. Breakdown and intermediate compaction before the surface temperature drops below 170
degrees F
2.3. Finish compaction before the surface temperature drops below 130 degrees F
2.4. You may continue static rolling below 130 degrees F to remove roller marks.
Replace the 2nd paragraph of section 39-2.03A(3)(b)with:
01-15-16
The JMF must be based on the superpave HMA mix design as described in MS-2 Asphalt Mix Design
Methods by the Asphalt Institute.
Replace the requirement in the row for Voids in mineral aggregate on plant produced HMA in the
2nd table in section 39-2.03A(4)(e)(i)with:
01-15-16
18.0-23.0
Add before the 1st paragraph of section 39-2.03A(4)(e)(ii)(C):
04-15-16
CRM used must be on the Authorized Materials List for Crumb Rubber Modifier.
CRM must be a ground or granulated combination of scrap tire crumb rubber and high natural scrap tire
crumb rubber, CRM must be 75.0 ±2.0 percent scrap tire crumb rubber and 25.0 ±2.0 percent high
natural scrap tire crumb rubber by total weight of CRM. Scrap tire crumb rubber and high natural scrap
tire crumb rubber must be derived from waste tires described in Pub Res Code § 42703.
Page 89 of 183
Replace the row for Hamburg wheel track in the table in section 39-2.03B(2)with:
01-15-16
Hamburg wheel track(min, number of passes at the inflection AASHTO T 324
point) (Modified)d
Binder grade:
PG 58 10,000
PG 64 12,500
PG 70 15,000
Replace RHMA-G in the 3rd and 5th paragraphs of section 39-2.03C with:
07-15-16
RHMA-G and RHMA-G produced with WMA water injection technology
Add between the 5th and 6th paragraphs of section 39-2.03C:
07-15-16
For RHMA-G produced with WMA additive technology placed under method compaction:
1. Complete the 1 st coverage of breakdown compaction before the surface temperature drops below
260 degrees F
2. Complete breakdown and intermediate compaction before the surface temperature drops below 230
degrees F
3. Complete finish compaction before the surface temperature drops below 180 degrees F
4. You may continue static rolling below 140 degrees F to remove roller marks
Replace the 6th and 7th paragraphs of section 39-2.04C with:
07-15-16
For HMA-O and HMA-O produced with WMA water injection technology:
1. With unmodified asphalt binder:
1.1. Spread and compact only if the atmospheric temperature is at least 55 degrees F and the
surface temperature is at least 60 degrees F.
1.2. Complete the 1st coverage using 2 rollers before the surface temperature drops below 240
degrees F.
1.3. Complete all compaction before the surface temperature drops below 200 degrees F.
2. With modified asphalt binder, except asphalt rubber binder:
2.1. Spread and compact only if the atmospheric temperature is at least 50 degrees F and the
surface temperature is at least 50 degrees F.
2.2. Complete the 1 st coverage using 2 rollers before the surface temperature drops below 240
degrees F.
2.3. Complete all compaction before the surface temperature drops below 180 degrees F.
For HMA-O produced with WMA additive technology:
1. With unmodified asphalt binder:
1.1. Spread and compact only if the atmospheric temperature is at least 45 degrees F and the
surface temperature is at least 50 degrees F.
1.2. Complete the 1 st coverage using 2 rollers before the surface temperature drops below 230
degrees F.
1.3. Complete all compaction before the surface temperature drops below 190 degrees F.
2. With modified asphalt binder, except asphalt rubber binder:
2.1. Spread and compact only if the atmospheric temperature is at least 40 degrees F and the
surface temperature is at least 40 degrees F.
2.2. Complete the 1 st coverage using 2 rollers before the surface temperature drops below 230
degrees F.
Page 90 of 183
2.3. Complete all compaction before the surface temperature drops below 170 degrees F.
Replace RHMA-O and RHMA-O-HB in the 8th paragraph of section 39-2.04C with:
07-15-16
RHMA-O and RHMA-O produced with WMA water injection technology, and RHMA-O-HB and RHMA-O-
HB produced with WMA water injection technology
Add between the 8th and 9th paragraphs of section 39-2.04C:
07-15-16
For RHMA-O produced with WMA additive technology and RHMA-O-HB produced with WMA additives
technology:
1. Spread and compact if the ambient air temperature is at least 45 degrees F and the surface
temperature is at least 50 degrees F
2. Complete the 1st coverage using 2 rollers before the surface temperature drops below 270 degrees F
3. Complete all compaction before the surface temperature drops below 240 degrees F
Add to the 2nd paragraph of section 39-2.05A(3)(b):
01-15-16
The material transfer vehicle must receive HMA directly from the truck.
Replace Table 6.1 at each occurrence in the table in section 39-2.05B(2)with:
01-15-16
Table 8.1
Replace SP-2 Asphalt Mixture in the 1st footnote in the table in the 2nd paragraph of section 39-
2.05B(2)(b)with:
01-15-16
MS-2 Asphalt Mix Design Methods
Replace Manual Series No. 2(MS-2) in the 1st footnote in the table in the 2nd paragraph of section
39-2.05B(2)(b)with:
01-15-16
MS-2 Asphalt Mix Design Methods
Replace 39-3.05 in the 1st paragraph of section 39-3.04Awith:
01-15-16
39-3.04
Add to the end of section 39-3.04A:
07-15-16
Schedule cold planing activities such that the pavement is cold planed, the HMA is placed, and the area
is opened to traffic during the same work shift.
07-15-16
Delete the 2nd sentence of the 1st paragraph in section 39-3.04C(4).
Page 91 of 183
Replace 39-3.06 in the 1st paragraph of section 39-3.05Awith:
01-15-16
39-3.05
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
DIVISION VI STRUCTURES
47 EARTH RETAINING SYSTEMS
07-15-16
Replace the 6th paragraph in section 47-2.02A with:
07-15-16
Rock for rock slope protection at drain pipe outlets must be small-rock slope protection and must comply
with the gradation specified for 7-inch-thick layer in section 72-4.02.
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
49 PILING
07-15-16
04-15-16
Delete the 2nd paragraph of section 49-1.01 A.
Replace the 1st sentence in the 5th paragraph of section 49-1.01 D(3)with:
07-15-16
Load test and anchor piles must comply with the specifications for piling as described and Class N steel
pipe piling.
Add to the list in 7th paragraph of section 49-1.01 D(3):
07-15-16
5. Welds that connect the anchor pile and the anchor pile head must be tested under section 49-
2.02A(4)(b)(iii)(C)
Replace the 10th paragraph of section 49-1.01 D(3)with:
07-15-16
Furnish labor, materials,tools, equipment, and incidentals as required to assist the Department in the
transportation, installation, operation, and removal of Department-furnished steel load test beams,jacks,
bearing plates, drills, and other test equipment. This is change order work.
Replace the 7th paragraph of section 49-1.01 D(4)with:
07-15-16
Piles to be dynamically monitored must:
1. Have an additional length of 2 times the pile diameter plus 2 feet.
2. Be available to the Department at least 2 business days before driving.
3. Be safely supported at least 6 inches off the ground in a horizontal position on at least 2 support
blocks. If requested, rotate the piles on the blocks.
4. Be positioned such that the Department has safe access to the entire pile length and circumference
for the installation of anchorages and control marks for monitoring.
Page 92 of 183
07-15-16
Delete business in item 6 in the list in the 8th paragraph of section 49-1.01 D(4).
Add to the list in 9th paragraph of section 49-1.01D(4):
07-15-16
3. Cut pile to the specified cut-off elevation after bearing acceptance criteria is provided by the
Department
04-15-16
Delete the 3rd paragraph of section 49-1.03.
04-15-16
Delete the 2nd paragraph of section 49-1.04.
01-15-16
Delete the 4th paragraph of section 49-2.01C(5).
Replace item 3 in the list in the 2nd paragraph of section 49-3.01A with:
07-15-16
3. CISS concrete piles
Add between undisturbed material and in a dry in the 1st paragraph of section 49-3.01C:
07-15-16
casing, or steel shell
Replace the 2nd and 3rd paragraphs of section 49-3.01C with:
07-15-16
Place and secure reinforcement. Securely block the reinforcement to provide the minimum clearance
shown between the reinforcing steel cage and the sides of the drilled hole, casing, or steel shell.
Steel shells, casings, and drilled holes must be clean and free of debris before reinforcement and
concrete are placed.
Replace dewatered in the 4th paragraphs of section 49-3.01 C with:
07-15-16
drilled
Add to section 49-3.02A(1):
07-15-16
Permanent steel casing and driven steel shell must comply with section 49-2.02.
Replace the paragraph of section 49-3.02A(2)with:
07-15-16
dry hole: A drilled hole that requires no work to keep it free of water.
dewatered hole: A drilled hole that:
1. Accumulates no more than 12 inches of water at the bottom during a 1 hour period without any
pumping from the hole.
Page 93 of 183
2. Has no more than 3 inches of water at the bottom immediately before placing concrete.
3. Does not require temporary casing to control the groundwater.
Replace item 8 in the list in the 1st paragraph of section 49-3.02A(3)(b)with:
07-15-16
8. Drilling plan and sequence
9. Concrete sequence and placement plan
10. If inspection pipes are required, methods for ensuring the inspection pipes remain straight,
undamaged, and properly aligned during concrete placement
Replace 1 business day in the paragraph of section 49-3.02A(3)(d)with:
07-15-16
2 business days
Add to section 49-3.02A(3)(d):
07-15-16
The log must:
1. Show the pile location,tip elevation, cutoff elevation, dates of excavation and concrete placement,
total quantity of concrete placed, length and tip elevation of any casing, and details of any hole
stabilization method and materials used.
2. Include an 8-1/2 by 11 inch graph of concrete placed versus depth of hole filled as follows:
2.1. Plot the graph continuously throughout concrete placement. Plot the depth of drilled hole filled
vertically with the pile tip at the bottom and the quantity of concrete placed horizontally.
2.2. Take readings at each 5 feet of pile depth, and indicate the time of the reading on the graph.
Add after the sentence in the paragraph of section 49-3.02A(3)(e):
07-15-16
Allow 10 days for the review.
Replace the 3rd sentence in the paragraph of section 49-3.02A(3)(f)with:
07-15-16
Allow 10 days for the review and analysis of this report.
Add after rejected pile in the 1st sentence in the 1st paragraph of section 49-3.02A(3)(g):
07-15-16
to be mitigated
07-15-16
Delete the 2nd paragraph of section 49-3.02A(3)(g).
Replace item 3 in the list in the 3rd paragraph of section 49-3.02A(3)(g)with:
07-15-16
3. Step by step description of the mitigation work to be performed, including drawings if necessary. If the
ADSC Standard Mitigation Plan is an acceptable mitigation method, include the most recent version.
For the most recent version of the ADSC Standard Mitigation Plan, go to:
http://www.dot.ca.gov/hq/esc/geotech/ft/adscmitplan.htm
Page 94 of 183
Replace the 2nd sentence in the paragraph of section 49-3.02A(3)(i)with:
07-15-16
Allow 10 days for the review.
Add to section 49-3.02A(3):
07-15-16
49-3.02A(3)0) Certifications
If synthetic slurry is used, submit as an informational submittal the names and certifications of your
employees who are trained and certified by the synthetic slurry manufacturer.
Add after excavated hole in the 1st sentence in the 3rd paragraph of section 49-3.02A(4)(c):
07-15-16
lined with plastic
Replace the 1st paragraph of section 49-3.02A(4)(d)(i)with:
07-15-16
Section 49-3.02A(4)(d)applies to CIDH concrete piles except for piles(1) less than 24 inches in diameter
or(2)constructed in dry or dewatered holes.
Replace gamma-gamma logging in the 2nd paragraph of section 49-3.02A(4)(d)(i)with:
07-15-16
GGL
Replace the 1st sentence in the 3rd paragraph of section 49-3.02A(4)(d)(i)with:
07-15-16
After notification by the Engineer of pile acceptance,fill the inspection pipes and cored holes with grout.
Replace gamma-gamma logging in section 49-3.02A(4)(d)(ii)with:
07-15-16
GGL
Replace the 3rd and 4th paragraphs of section 49-3.02A(4)(d)(iii)with:
07-15-16
The Department may perform CSL to determine the extent of the anomalies identified by GGL and to
further evaluate a rejected pile for the presence of anomalies not identified by GGL. The pile acceptance
test report will indicate if the Department intends to perform CSL and when the testing will be performed.
Allow the Department 20 additional days for a total of 50 days to perform CSL and to provide
supplemental results.
If authorized, you may perform testing on the rejected pile.
07-15-16
Delete the 8th paragraph of section 49-3.02A(4)(d)(iii).
Add to the end of section 49-3.02A(4)(d)(iii):
07-15-16
If the Engineer determines it is not feasible to repair the rejected pile, submit a mitigation plan for
replacement or supplementation of the rejected pile.
Page 95 of 183
Add to section 49-3.02A(4):
07-15-16
49-3.02A(4)(e) Certifications
If synthetic slurry is used, your employees who will be providing technical assistance in the slurry
activities must be trained and certified by the synthetic slurry manufacturer to show their competency to
perform inspection of slurry operations.
Replace section 49-3.02B(4)with:
07-15-16
49-3.02B(4) Reserved
Replace near in the 3rd, 4th,and 5th paragraphs of section 49-3.02B(6)(b)with:
07-15-16
within 2 feet of
Replace twice per shift in item 2 in the 3rd paragraph of section 49-3.02B(6)(b)with:
07-15-16
every 4 hours
07-15-16
Delete the 7th and 8th paragraphs of section 49-3.02B(6)(b).
07-15-16
Delete the 3rd paragraph of section 49-3.02B(6)(c).
Replace near in item 2 in the 4th paragraph of section 49-3.02B(6)(c)with:
07-15-16
within 2 feet of
Replace item 5 in the 4th paragraph of section 49-3.02B(6)(c)with:
07-15-16
5. After final cleaning and immediately before placing concrete.
Replace section 49-3.02B(9)with:
07-15-16
49-3.02B(9) Inspection Pipes
Inspection pipes must be schedule 40 PVC pipe complying with ASTM D1785 with a nominal pipe size of
2 inches.
Watertight PVC couplers complying with ASTM D2466 are allowed to facilitate pipe lengths in excess of
those commercially available.
Add to the beginning of section 49-3.02C(1):
07-15-16
Unless otherwise authorized, drilling the hole and placing reinforcement and concrete in the hole must be
performed in a continuous operation.
Page 96 of 183
Replace the 5th paragraph of section 49-3.02C(2)with:
07-15-16
If slurry is used during excavation, maintain the slurry level at a height required to maintain a stable hole,
but not less than 10 feet above the piezometric head.
Replace the 1st sentence in the 9th paragraph of section 49-3.02C(2)with:
07-15-16
Remove water that has infiltrated the dewatered hole before placing concrete, as required for dewatered
hole.
Replace the 1st sentence in the 10th paragraph of section 49-3.02C(2)with:
07-15-16
If authorized,to control caving or water seepage, you may enlarge portions of the hole, backfill the hole
with slurry cement backfill, concrete, or other material, and redrill the hole to the diameter shown.
Replace the 4th paragraph of section 49-3.02C(3)with:
07-15-16
Remove the temporary casing during concrete placement. Maintain the concrete in the casing at a level
required to maintain a stable hole, but not less than 5 feet above the bottom of the casing, to prevent
displacement of the concrete by material from outside the casing.
Replace the 5th paragraph of section 49-3.02C(4)with:
07-15-16
For a single CIDH concrete pile supporting a column:
1. If the pile and the column share the same reinforcing cage diameter, this cage must be accurately
placed as shown
2. If the pile reinforcing cage is larger in diameter than the column cage:
2.1. Maintain a clear horizontal distance of at least 3.5 inches between the two cages, if the
concrete is placed under dry conditions
2.2. Maintain a clear horizontal distance of at least 5 inches between the two cages if the concrete
is placed under slurry
2.3. The offset between the centerlines of the two cages must not exceed 6 inches
Replace the paragraphs in section 49-3.02C(5)with:
07-15-16
For acceptance testing, install and test vertical inspection pipes as follows:
1. Log the location of the inspection pipe couplers with respect to the plane of pile cutoff.
2. Cap each inspection pipe at the bottom. Extend the pipe from 3 feet above the pile cutoff to the
bottom of the reinforcing cage. Provide a temporary top cap or similar means to keep the pipes clean
before testing. If pile cutoff is below the ground surface or working platform, extend inspection pipes
to 3 feet above the ground surface or working platform.
3. If any changes are made to the pile tip, extend the inspection pipes to the bottom of the reinforcing
cage.
4. Install inspection pipes in a straight alignment and parallel to the main reinforcement. Securely fasten
inspection pipes in place and provide protective measures to prevent misalignment or damage to the
inspection pipes during installation of the reinforcement and placement of concrete in the hole.
Construct CIDH concrete piles such that the relative distance of inspection pipes to vertical steel
reinforcement remains constant.
5. After concrete placement is complete,fill inspection pipes with water to prevent debonding of the
pipe.
6. Provide safe access to the tops of the inspection pipes.
Page 97 of 183
7. After placing concrete and before requesting acceptance testing, test each inspection pipe in the
Engineer's presence by passing a rigid cylinder through the length of pipe. The rigid cylinder must be
1-1/4-inch diameter by 4.5-foot long, weigh 12 pounds or less, and be able to freely pass down
through the entire length of the pipe under its own weight and without the application of force.
8. When performing acceptance testing, inspection pipes must provide a 2-inch-diameter clear opening
and be completely clean, unobstructed, and either dry or filled with water as authorized.
9. After acceptance testing is complete, completely fill the inspection pipes with water.
If the rigid cylinder fails to pass through the inspection pipe:
1. Completely fill the inspection pipes in the pile with water immediately.
2. Core a nominal 2-inch-diameter hole through the concrete for the entire length of the pile for each
inspection pipe that does not pass the rigid cylinder. Coring must not damage the pile reinforcement.
3. Locate cored holes as close as possible to the inspection pipes they are replacing and no more than
5 inches clear from the reinforcement.
Core holes using a double wall core barrel system with a split tube type inner barrel. Coring with a solid
type inner barrel is not allowed.
Coring methods and equipment must provide intact cores for the entire length of the pile.
Photograph and store concrete cores as specified for rock cores in section 49-1.01 D(5).
The coring operation must be logged by an engineering geologist or civil engineer licensed in the State
and experienced in core logging. Coring logs must comply with the Department's Soil and Rock Logging,
Classification, and Presentation Manual for rock cores. Coring logs must include core recovery, rock
quality designation of the concrete, locations of breaks, and complete descriptions of inclusions and voids
encountered during coring.
The Department evaluates the portion of the pile represented by the cored hole based on the submitted
coring logs and concrete cores. If the Department determines a pile is anomalous based on the coring
logs and concrete cores, the pile is rejected.
Replace item 2 in the list in the 2nd paragraph of section 49-3.02C(7)with:
07-15-16
2. Extend at least 5 feet below the construction joint. If placing casing into rock or a dry hole, the casing
must extend at least 2 feet below the construction joint.
Add to the beginning of section 49-3.02C(9):
07-15-16
49-3.02C(9)(a) General
Replace the 2nd sentence of the 3rd paragraph of section 49-3.02C(9)with:
04-15-16
Do not vibrate the concrete.
Add after concrete pump in the 8th paragraph of section 49-3.02C(9):
07-15-16
and slurry pump
Replace item 3 in the list in the 11th paragraph of section 49-3.02C(9)with:
07-15-16
3. Maintain the slurry level at a height required to maintain a stable hole, but not less than 10 feet above
the piezometric head.
Page 98 of 183
Replace the 13th paragraph of section 49-3.02C(9)with:
07-15-16
Maintain a log of concrete placement for each drilled hole.
Replace 14th and 15th paragraphs of section 49-3.02C(9)with:
07-15-16
If a temporary casing is used, maintain concrete placed under slurry at a level required to maintain a
stable hole, but not less than 5 feet above the bottom of the casing.The withdrawal of the casing must
not cause contamination of the concrete with slurry.
The equivalent hydrostatic pressure inside the casing must be greater than the hydrostatic pressure on
the outside of the casing to prevent intrusion of water, slurry, or soil into the column of freshly placed
concrete.
Remove scum, Iaitance, and slurry-contaminated concrete from the top of the pile.
Add to section 49-3.02C(9):
07-15-16
49-3.02C(9)(b) Mineral Slurry
Remove any caked slurry on the sides or bottom of hole before placing reinforcement.
If concrete is not placed immediately after placing reinforcement, the reinforcement must be removed and
cleaned of slurry, the sides of the drilled hole must be cleaned of caked slurry, and the reinforcement
again placed in the hole for concrete placement.
49-3.02C(9)(c) Synthetic Slurry
A manufacturer's representative must:
1. Provide technical assistance for the use of their material
2. Be at the job site before introduction of the synthetic slurry into the drilled hole
3. Remain at the job site until released by the Engineer
After the manufacturer's representative has been released by the Engineer, your employee certified by
the manufacturer must be present during the construction of the pile under slurry.
Replace the heading of section 49-3.03 with:
07-15-16
CAST-IN-STEEL SHELL CONCRETE PILING
Replace the 1st paragraph of section 49-3.03A(1)with:
07-15-16
Section 49-3.03 includes specifications for constructing CISS concrete piles consisting of driven open-
ended or closed-ended steel shells filled with reinforcement and concrete.
Add to the end of section 49-3.03A(1):
07-15-16
CISS concrete piles include Class 90 Alternative V and Class 140 Alternative V piles.
Add to section 49-3.03A(3):
01-15-16
Submit a Pile and Driving Data Form under section 49-2.01 A(3)(a) if specified in the special provisions.
Page 99 of 183
Replace the paragraph of section 49-3.03D with:
07-15-16
Furnish piling is measured along the longest side of the pile from the specified tip elevation shown to the
plane of pile cutoff.
Replace section 49-4.03 with:
01-15-16
49-4.03 CONSTRUCTION
49-4.03A General
Reserved
49-4.03B Drilled Holes
Drill holes for steel soldier piles into natural foundation material. Drilled holes must be accurately located,
straight, and true.
Furnish and place temporary casings or tremie seals where necessary to control water or to prevent
caving of the hole.
Before placing the steel soldier pile, remove loose materials existing at the bottom of the hole after drilling
operations have been completed.
Do not allow surface water to enter the hole. Remove all water in the hole before placing concrete.
If temporary casings are used, they must comply with section 49-3.02C(3).
49-4.03C Steel Soldier Piles
Plumb and align the pile before placing concrete backfill and lean concrete backfill. The pile must be at
least 2 inches clear of the sides of the hole for the full length of the hole to be filled with concrete backfill
and lean concrete backfill. Ream or enlarge holes that do not provide the clearance around steel piles.
Maintain alignment of the pile in the hole while placing backfill material.
Clean and prepare piles in anticipated heat affected areas before splicing steel piles or welding concrete
anchors.
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
50 PRESTRESSING CONCRETE
07-15-16
Add to the end of section 50-1.01 C:
07-15-16
50-1.01C(8) Post-tensioning Jack Calibration Chart
Submit the post-tensioning jack calibration plot.
50-1.01C(9) Pretensioning Jack Calibration Chart
For any pretensioning jack calibrated by an authorized laboratory, submit a certified calibration plot.
Replace section 50-1.01 D(2)(b)with:
07-15-16
50-1.01 D(2)(b) Equipment and Calibration
50-1.01 D(2)(b)(i) General
Each jack body must be permanently marked with the ram area.
Each pressure gauge must be fully functional and have an accurately reading, clearly visible dial or
display. The dial must be at least 6 inches in diameter and graduated in 100 psi increments or less.
Page 100 of 183
Each load cell must be calibrated and have an indicator that can be used to determine the force in the
prestressing steel.
The range of each load cell must be such that the lower 10 percent of the manufacturer's rated capacity is
not used in determining the jacking force.
Each jack must be calibrated equipped with its gauges.
Mechanically calibrate the gauges with a dead weight tester or other authorized means before calibration
of the jacking equipment.
50-1.01D(2)(b)(ii) Post-tensioning
Equip each hydraulic jack used to tension prestressing steel with 2 pressure gauges or 1 pressure gauge
and a load cell. Only 1 pressure gauge must be connected to the jack during stressing.
Each jack used to tension prestressing steel permanently anchored at 25 percent or more of its specified
minimum ultimate tensile strength must be calibrated by METS within 1 year of use and after each repair.
You must:
1. Schedule the calibration of the jacking equipment with METS.
2. Verify that the jack and supporting systems are complete, with proper components, and are in good
operating condition.
3. Provide labor, equipment, and material to(1) install and support the jacking and calibration equipment
and (2)remove the equipment after the calibration is complete.
4. Plot the calibration results.
Each jack used to tension prestressing steel permanently anchored at less than 25 percent of its specified
minimum ultimate tensile strength must be calibrated by an authorized laboratory within 180 days of use
and after each repair.
50-1.01 D(2)(b)(iii) Pretensioning
Each jack used to pretension prestressing steel must be calibrated, equipped with its gauges, by a
laboratory on the Authorized Laboratory List within 1 year of use and after each repair.
Calibrate pretensioning jacks:
1. Under ASTM E4 using an authorized laboratory. Certification that the calibration is performed to
ASTM accuracy is not required.
2. In the presence of the Engineer. Notify the Engineer at least 2 business days before calibrating the
jack.
3. Using 3 test cycles. Average the forces from each test cycle at each increment.
4. To cover the load range used in the work.
Gauges for pretensioning jacks may:
1. Be electronic pressure indicators that display either:
1.1. Pressure in 100 psi increments or less
1.2. Load to 1 percent of the maximum sensor/indicator capacity or 2 percent of the maximum load
applied,whichever is smaller
2. Have a dial less than 6 inches in diameter
Gauges displaying pressure must have been calibrated within 1 year of the jack calibration.
Each hydraulic jack used for pretensioning must be equipped with either 2 gauges or 1 gauge and a load
cell or you must have a calibrated standby jack with its gauge present on site during stressing.
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
Page 101 of 183
51 CONCRETE STRUCTURES
07-15-16
Add to the list in the 2nd paragraph of section 51-1.01A:
04-15-16
8. Pile extensions
07-15-16
9. Drainage inlets
Add to the list in the 6th paragraph of section 51-1.01A:
07-15-16
7. Drainage inlets
Add to section 51-1.021:
07-15-16
Metal frames, covers, grates, and other miscellaneous iron and steel used with drainage inlets must
comply with section 75-2.
Add to section 51-1.03B:
07-15-16
You may use PC drainage inlets as an alternative to CIP drainage inlets.
Add between the 10th and 11th paragraphs of section 51-1.03C(2)(a):
07-15-16
For drainage inlets, extend the outside forms at least 12 inches below the top of the inlet. You may place
concrete against excavated earth below this depth except:
1. You must use full-depth outside forms or other protection when work activities or unstable earth may
cause hazardous conditions or contamination of the concrete.
2. You must increase the wall thickness 2 inches if placing concrete against the excavated surface.The
interior dimensions must be as shown.
Add to section 51-1.03C(2)(b):
07-15-16
For drainage inlets, remove exterior forms to at least 12 inches below the final ground surface. Exterior
forms below this depth may remain if their total thickness is not more than 1 inch.
Add to the list in the 2nd paragraph of section 51-1.03F(2):
07-15-16
4. Interior and top surfaces of drainage inlets
Add to section 51-1.04:
07-15-16
The payment quantity for structural concrete, drainage inlet is the volume determined from the
dimensions shown for CIP drainage inlets.
Add to section 51-4.01 C(1):
07-15-16
For PC drainage inlets, submit field repair procedures and a patching material test sample before repairs
are made.Allow 10 days for the Engineer's review.
Page 102 of 183
Add to section 51-4.01C(2)(a):
07-15-16
For drainage inlets with oval or circular cross sections, submit shop drawings with calculations. Shop
drawings and calculations must be sealed and signed by an engineer who is registered as a civil engineer
in the State.Allow 15 days for the Engineer's review.
Add to section 51-4.01 D(3):
07-15-16
The Engineer may reject PC drainage inlets exhibiting any of the following:
1. Cracks more than 1/32 inch wide
2. Nonrepairable honeycombed or spalled areas of more than 6 square inches
3. Noncompliance with reinforcement tolerances or cross sectional area shown
4. Wall, inlet floor, or lid less than minimum thickness
5. Internal dimensions less than dimensions shown by 1 percent or 1/2 inch, whichever is greater
6. Defects affecting performance or structural integrity
Add to section 51-4.02C:
07-15-16
Materials for PC drainage inlets must comply with the following:
1. Preformed flexible joint sealant must be butyl-rubber complying with ASTM C990
2. Resilient connectors must comply with ASTM C923
3. Sand bedding must comply with section 19-3.02F(2)
4. Bonding agents must comply with ASTM C1059/C1059,Type II
Add to section 51-4.02D:
07-15-16
51-4.02D(8) Drainage Inlets
PC units for drainage inlets must be rectangular, round, or oval in cross section, or any combination.
Transitions from a rectangular grate opening to a round or oval basin must be made in not less than 8
inches. Provide means for field adjustment to meet final grade, paving, or surfacing.
If oval or circular shape cross-sections are furnished,they must comply with AASHTO LRFD Bridge
Design Specifications, Sixth Edition with California Amendments.
Wall and slab thicknesses may be less than the dimensions shown by at most 5 percent or 3/16 inch,
whichever is greater.
Reinforcement placement must not vary more than 1/2 inch from the positions shown.
Add to section 51-4.03:
07-15-16
51-4.03H Drainage Inlets
Repair PC drainage inlet sections to correct damage from handling or manufacturing imperfections before
installation.
Center pipes in openings to provide a uniform gap. Seal gaps between the pipe and the inlet opening with
nonshrink grout under the grout manufacturer's instructions. For systems designated as watertight, seal
these gaps with resilient connectors.
Match fit keyed joints to ensure uniform alignment of walls and lids. Keys are not required at the inlet floor
level if the floor is precast integrally with the inlet wall. Seal keyed joint locations with preformed butyl
rubber joint sealant. You may seal the upper lid and wall joint with nonshrink grout.
Page 103 of 183
Clean keyed joint surfaces before installing sealant. Joint surfaces must be free of imperfections that may
affect the joint. Use a primer if surface moisture is present. Use a sealant size recommended by the
sealant manufacturer. Set joints using sealant to create a uniform bearing surface.
Flat drainage inlet floors must have a field-cast topping layer at least 2 inches thick with a slope of 4:1
(horizontal:vertical)toward the outlet. Use a bonding agent when placing the topping layer.Apply the
bonding agent under the manufacturer's instructions.
Replace the 2nd paragraph of section 51-7.01Awith:
07-15-16
Minor structures include structures described as minor structures.
07-15-16
Delete the 4th paragraph of section 51-7.01 B.
07-15-16
Delete the 1st and 3rd paragraphs of section 51-7.01C.
07-15-16
Delete the heading and paragraph of section 51-7.02.
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
52 REINFORCEMENT
01-15-16
Replace the 3rd paragraph of section 52-6.03B with:
01-15-16
For uncoated and galvanized reinforcing bars complying with ASTM A615/A615M, Grade 60,ASTM
A706/A706M, or ASTM A767/A767M, Class 1, the length of lap splices must be at least:
1. 45 diameters of the smaller bar spliced for reinforcing bars no. 8 or smaller
2. 60 diameters of the smaller bar spliced for reinforcing bars nos. 9, 10, and 11
For epoxy-coated reinforcing bars and alternatives to epoxy-coated reinforcing bars complying with ASTM
A775/A775M,ASTM A934/A934M,ASTM Al 035/A1035M, or ASTM Al 055/A1055M, the length of lap
splices must be at least:
1. 65 diameters of the smaller bar spliced for reinforcing bars no. 8 or smaller
2. 85 diameters of the smaller bar spliced for reinforcing bars nos. 9, 10, and 11
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
53 SHOTCRETE
01-15-16
Replace 632 in item 1 in the list in the 3rd paragraph of section 53-1.02 with:
01-15-16
675
Page 104 of 183
Replace item 2 in the list in the 3rd paragraph of section 53-1.02 with:
01-15-16
2. You may substitute a maximum of 30 percent coarse aggregate for the fine aggregate. Coarse
aggregate must comply with section 90-1, except section 90-1.02C(4)(d)does not apply. The
gradation for the coarse aggregate must comply with the gradation specified in section 90-1.02C(4)(b)
for the 1/2 inch x No.4 or the 3/8 inch x No. 8 primary aggregate nominal size.
Replace shotcrete in the 2nd sentence of the 4th paragraph of section 53-1.02 with:
01-15-16
concrete
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
56 OVERHEAD SIGN STRUCTURES, STANDARDS, AND POLES
07-15-16
Replace section 56-1.01 with:
07-15-16
56-1.01 GENERAL
56-1.01A Summary
Section 56-1 includes general specifications for constructing overhead sign structures, standards, and
poles.
56-1.01B Definitions
Reserved
56-1.01C Submittals
Reserved
56-1.01D Quality Assurance
56-1.01D(1) General
Reserved
56-1.01 D(2) Quality Control
56-1.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
56-1.01 D(2)(b) Nondestructive Testing
56-1.01 D(2)(b)(i) General
Perform NDT of steel members under AWS D1.1 and the requirements shown in the following table:
Page 105 of 183
Nondestructive Testing for Steel Standards and Poles
Weld location Weld type Minimum required NDT
Circumferential splices
around the perimeter of CJP groove weld with 100% UT or RT
tubular sections, poles, backing ring
and arms
Longitudinal seam CJP or PJP groove Random 25% MT
weld
Longitudinal seam within 6
inches of a circumferential CJP groove weld 100% UT or RT
splice
CJP groove weld with t>_ 5/16 inch: 100% UT and 100% MT
Welds attaching base backing ring and t< 5/16 inch: 100% MT after root weld
plates,flange plates, pole reinforcing fillet pass and final weld pass
plates, or mast arm plates External (top)fillet
to poles or arm tubes weld for socket-type 100% MT
connections
Hand holes and other Fillet and PJP welds MT full length on random 25% of all
appurtenances standards and poles
NOTE: t= pole or arm thickness
Page 106 of 183
Nondestructive Testing for Overhead Sign Structures
Weld location Weld type Minimum required NDT
CJP groove weld
Base plate to post with backing ring 100% UT and 100% MT
and reinforcing fillet
Base plate to gusset plate CJP groove weld 100% UT
Circumferential splices of pipe CJP groove weld 100% UT or RT
or tubular sections with backing ring
Split post filler plate welds CJP groove weld 100% UT or RT
with backing bar
Longitudinal seam weld for CJP groove weld t< 1/4 inch: 100% MT
pipe posts t>_ 1/4 inch: 100% UT or RT
PJP groove weld Random 25% RT
Chord angle splice weld CJP groove weld 100% UT or RT
with backing bar
Truss vertical,diagonal, and Fillet weld Random 25% MT
wind angles to chord angles
Upperjunction plate to chord Fillet weld Random 25% MT
cantilever type truss
Bolted field splice plates CJP groove weld 100% UT and 100% MT
(tubular frame type)
Cross beam connection plates
(lightweight extinguishable Fillet weld Random 25% MT
message sign)
Arm connection angles
(lightweight extinguishable Fillet weld 100% MT
message sign)
Mast arm to arm plate CJP groove weld t>_5/16 inch: 100% UT and 100% MT
(lightweight extinguishable with backing ring t<5/16 inch: 100% MT after root
message sin) weld pass and final weld pass
Post angle to post(lightweight Fillet weld 100% MT
extinguishable message sign)
Hand holes and other Fillet and PJP MT full length on random 25% of all
appurtenances welds -sign structures
NOTE: t= pole or arm thickness
56-1.011D(2)(b)(ii) Ultrasonic Testing
For UT of welded joints with any members less than 5/16 inch thick or tubular sections less than 13
inches in diameter,the acceptance and repair criteria must comply with Clause 6.13.3.1 of AWS D1.1.
For UT of other welded joints, the acceptance and repair criteria must comply with Table 6.3 of AWS D1.1
for cyclically loaded nontubular connections.
After galvanization, perform additional inspection for toe cracks along the full length of all CJP groove
welds at tube-to-transverse plate connections using UT.
When performing UT, use an authorized procedure under AWS D1.1,Annex S.
56-1.01 D(2)(b)(iii) Radiographic Testing
The acceptance criteria for radiographic or real time image testing must comply with AWS D1.1 for tensile
stress welds.
56-1.01 D(2)(b)(iv) Longitudinal Seam Welds
The Engineer selects the random locations for NDT.
Grind the cover pass smooth at the locations to be tested.
Page 107 of 183
If repairs are required in a portion of a tested weld, perform NDT on the repaired portion and on 25
percent of the untested portions of the weld. If more repairs are required, perform NDT on the entire weld.
56-1.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
Reserved
Replace section 56-2.01 D(2)(b)with:
07-15-16
Reserved
Replace the 2nd sentence of the 1st paragraph of section 56-2.02F with:
07-15-16
Manufactured pipe posts must comply with one of the following:
Add to the list in the 1st paragraph of section 56-2.02F:
07-15-16
4. ASTM A1085, Grade A
Replace the 2nd paragraph of section 56-2.02F with:
07-15-16
You may fabricate pipe posts from structural steel complying with ASTM A36/A36M,ASTM A709/A709M,
Grade 36, or ASTM A572/A572M, Grades 42 or 50.
07-15-16
Delete the last sentence in the 1st paragraph of section 56-2.02K(2).
07-15-16
Delete the 3rd paragraph of section 56-2.02K(2).
Replace the 2nd paragraph of section 56-2.02K(4)with:
07-15-16
Safety cable at walkways must not be kinked, knotted, deformed, frayed, or spliced.
Replace the 1st sentence of the paragraph in section 56-2.02K(5)with:
07-15-16
The edges of handholes and other large post and arm openings must be ground smooth.
Replace the heading of section 56-3 with:
07-15-16
56-3 STANDARDS, POLES, PEDESTALS, AND POSTS
Replace the paragraph in section 56-3.01Awith:
07-15-16
Section 56-3 includes general specifications for fabricating and installing standards, poles, pedestals, and
posts.
Page 108 of 183
Replace section 56-3.01 B(2)(b)with:
07-15-16
Standards with handholes must comply with the following:
1. Include a UL-listed lug and 3/16-inch or larger brass or bronze bolt for attaching the bonding jumper
for non-slip-base standards.
2. Attach a UL-listed lug to the bottom slip base plate with a 3/16-inch or larger brass or bronze bolt for
attaching the bonding jumper for slip-base standards.
Replace the 1 st sentence of the 3rd paragraph of section 56-3.01 C(2)(a)with:
07-15-16
After each standard, pole, pedestal, and post is properly positioned, place mortar under the base plate.
Replace the 2nd sentence of the 4th paragraph of section 56-3.01 C(2)(a)with:
07-15-16
The top of the foundation at curbs or sidewalks must be finished to curb or sidewalk grade.
Replace the 10th paragraph of section 56-3.01 C(2)(a)with:
07-15-16
Except when located on a structure,construct foundations monolithically.
Replace the 13th paragraph of section 56-3.01 C(2)(a)with:
07-15-16
Do not erect standards, poles, pedestals, or posts until the concrete foundation has cured for at least 7
days.
Replace the 14th paragraph in section 56-3.01C(2)(a)with:
07-15-16
The Engineer selects either the plumbing or raking technique for standards, poles, pedestals, and posts.
Plumb or rake by adjusting the leveling nuts before tightening nuts. Do not use shims or similar devices.
After final adjustments of both top nuts and leveling nuts on anchorage assemblies have been made and
each standard, pole, pedestal, and post on the structure is properly positioned, tighten nuts as follows:
1. Tighten leveling nuts and top nuts,following a crisscross pattern, until bearing surfaces of all nuts,
washers, and base plates are in firm contact.
2. Use an indelible marker to mark the top nuts and base plate with lines showing relative alignment of
the nut to the base plate.
3. Tighten top nuts following a crisscross pattern:
3.1. Additional 1/6 turn for anchor bolts greater than 1-1/2 inches in diameter.
3.2. Additional 1/3 turn for other anchor bolts.
3.3. Tightening tolerance for all top nuts is± 1/8 turn.
Replace the 1 st sentence of the 4th paragraph of section 56-3.01 C(2)(b)with:
07-15-16
If shown, use sleeve nuts on Type 1 standards.
Add to section 56-3.01 C(2)(b):
07-15-16
Spiral reinforcement must be continuous above the bottom of the anchor bolts.The top termination must
be either:
Page 109 of 183
1. V-6" lap beyond the end of pitch with a 90-degree hook extending to the opposite side of the cage, or
2. V-6" lap beyond the end of pitch with 2 evenly spaced authorized mechanical couplers
Replace the 1st sentence of the paragraph in section 56-3.02A(4)(b)with:
07-15-16
For cast slip bases for standards and poles with shaft lengths of 15 feet or more, perform RT on 1 casting
from each lot of a maximum of 50 castings under ASTM E94.
Replace the 2nd paragraph of section 56-3.02B(1)with:
07-15-16
Material for push button posts, pedestrian barricades, and guard posts must comply with ASTM
A53/A53M or ASTM A500/A500M.
Add to section 56-3.02B(1):
07-15-16
Steel pipe standards and mast arms must be hot dip galvanized after manufacturing. Remove spikes from
galvanized surfaces.
Replace the 2nd paragraph of section 56-3.02B(2)with:
07-15-16
HS anchor bolts, nuts, and washers must comply with section 55-1.02D(1)and the following:
1. Bolt threads must be rolled
2. Hardness of HS anchor bolts must not exceed 34 HRC when tested under ASTM F606
3. Galvanization must be by mechanical deposition
4. Nuts must be heavy-hex type
5. Each lot of nuts must be proof load tested
Replace the 2nd sentence of the 9th paragraph of section 56-3.02B(2)with:
07-15-16
During manufacturing, properly locate the position of the luminaire arm on the arm plate to avoid
interference with the cap screw heads.
Add to section 56-3.02B(3)(a):
07-15-16
Steel having a nominal thickness greater than 2 inches that is used for tube-to-transverse plate
connections must have a minimum CVN impact value of 20 ft-lb at 20 degrees F when tested under
ASTM E23.
Add to section 56-3.02B(3)(c):
07-15-16
The length of telescopic slip-fit splices must be at least 1.5 times the inside diameter of the exposed end
of the female section.
For welds connecting reinforced handholes or box-type pole plate connections to a tubular member, the
start and stop points must be at points located on a longitudinal axis of symmetry of the tube coinciding
with the axis of symmetry of the hand hole or pole plate.
Page 110 of 183
Replace the table in the 1st paragraph of section 56-3.02C with:
07-15-16
Slip Base Bolt Tightening Requirements
Standard type Torque(ft-lb)
15-S B 150
15-SBF 150
30 150
31 200
Replace the 1st sentence of the 2nd paragraph of section 56-3.02C with:
07-15-16
Bolted connections attaching signal or luminaire arms to standards, poles, and posts are considered slip
critical.
Add to section 56-3.06B:
07-15-16
Manufacture the mast arm from standard pipe,free from burrs. Each mast arm must have an insulated
wire inlet and wood pole mounting brackets for the mast arm and tie-rod cross arm. Manufacture tie rod
from structural steel and pipe.
07-15-16
Delete the 2nd paragraph of section 56-3.06C.
Replace the 1st sentence of the 3rd paragraph of section 56-3.06C with:
07-15-16
Mount the mast arm for luminaires to provide a 34-foot mounting height for a 165 W LED luminaire and a
40-foot mounting height for a 235 W LED luminaire.
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
59 STRUCTURAL STEEL COATINGS
07-15-16
Replace Type S in the 2nd paragraph of section 59-1.02A with:
01-15-16
Type M or Type S
Add to the list in the 2nd paragraph of section 59-1.0213:
07-15-16
5. Manufactured abrasives.
Replace Mineral and slag in the 3rd paragraph of section 59-1.0213 with:
07-15-16
Mineral, manufactured, and slag
Page 111 of 183
07-15-16
Delete the 4th paragraph of section 59-2.01 C(1).
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
60 EXISTING STRUCTURES
07-15-16
07-15-16
Delete the 2nd sentence in the 11th paragraph of section 60-3.04B(3)(c).
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
64 PLASTIC PIPE
07-15-16
Replace Reserved in section 64-3 with:
07-15-16
64-3.01 GENERAL
64-3.01A Summary
Section 64-3 includes specifications for constructing slotted plastic pipe.
Slotted plastic pipe includes structure excavation, concrete backfill, connecting new pipe to new or
existing facilities, concrete collars, reinforcement, and other connecting devices.
64-3.0113 Definitions
Reserved
64-3.01C Submittals
If an or equal slotted plastic pipe is being considered, it must be submitted 30 days before installation for
approval.
If RSC is used for concrete backfill for slotted plastic pipe, submit the concrete mix design and test data
from an authorized laboratory 10 days before excavating the pipe trench. The laboratory must specify the
cure time required for the concrete mix to attain 2,000 psi compressive strength when tested under
California Test 521.
Heel-resistant grates if specified must be submitted 30 days before installation for approval. Anchorage
details must be included in the submittal.
64-3.01 D Quality Assurance
Reserved
64-3.02 MATERIALS
64-3.02A General
Not Used
64-3.02B Slotted Plastic Pipes
Slotted plastic pipe must be one of the following or equal:
Slotted Plastic Pipe
12"diameter 18"diameter
Zurn Z888-12 Zurn Z888-18
ACO Qmax 350 ACO Qmax 365
ADS Duraslot-12 ADS Duraslot-18
Page 112 of 183
64-3.02C Concrete Backfill
Concrete for concrete backfill for slotted plastic pipe must comply with the specifications for minor
concrete. You may use RSC instead of minor concrete for concrete backfill.
If RSC is used for concrete backfill, the RSC must:
1. Contain at least 590 pounds of cementitious material per cubic yard
2. Comply with section 90-3.02A, except section 90-1 does not apply
3. Comply with section 90-2
64-3.02D Heel-Resistant Grates
Heel-resistant grate must:
1. Be designed to carry traffic loadings
2. Comply with ADA requirements
3. Be constructed of steel or cast iron
4. Be provided by the same manufacturer of the slotted plastic pipe
5. Comply with the manufacturer's instructions
64-3.02E Bar Reinforcement
Bar reinforcement must comply with ASTM A615/A615M, Grade 60 or ASTM A706/A706M, Grade 60.
64-3.02F Miscellaneous Metal
Ductile iron, nuts, bolts, and washers must comply with section 75.
64-3.02G Grout
Grout must be non-shrink grout complying with ASTM C1107/C1107M.
64-3.02H Curing Compound
Non-pigmented curing compound must comply with ASTM C309, Type 1, Class B.
64-3.021 End Caps
End cap must:
1. Be provided by the same manufacturer of the slotted plastic pipe
2. Prevent concrete backfill from entering the pipe
64-3.03 CONSTRUCTION
64-3.03A General
Cover the grate slots with heavy-duty tape or other authorized covering during paving and concrete
backfilling activities to prevent material from entering the slots.
64-3.03B Preparation
Pave adjacent traffic lanes before installing slotted plastic pipes.
Excavation must comply with section 19-3.
64-3.03C Installation
Lay and join slotted plastic pipes under the pipe manufacturer's instructions.
Lay pipes to line and grade with sections closelyjointed and adequately secured to prevent separation
during placement of the concrete backfill. If the pipes do not have a positive interlocking mechanism like a
slot and tongue connection, secure the sections together with nuts, bolts, and washers before backfilling.
The top of slotted plastic pipes must not extend above the completed surface. Position the pipes so that
the concrete backfill is flush with the surrounding grade and above the top of the grate from 1/8 to 1/4
inch.
Place channels with the male and female ends facing each other.
Page 113 of 183
Place lateral support bar reinforcement on both sides of the grate slots. The support bar reinforcement
must run the full length of the slots.
Anchor heel-resistant grates to the concrete backfill under the manufacturer's instructions.
64-3.03D Concrete Backfill
Wherever minor concrete is used for concrete backfill for slotted plastic pipe, do not allow traffic on top of
the backfill within 7 days of placement.
Wherever RSC is used for concrete backfill for slotted plastic pipe, do not allow traffic on top of the backfill
before the required cure time of 2,000 psi is achieved.
Place concrete backfill where shown.
Consolidate the concrete backfill with high-frequency internal vibrators.
Texture the concrete backfill surface with a broom or burlap drag to produce a durable skid-resistant
surface.
Apply a non-pigmented curing compound to the exposed concrete backfill surface whenever the
atmospheric temperature is 90 degrees F or greater after placement.
64-3.03E Transition Fittings
Use transition fittings to connect slotted plastic pipes to drainage inlets.The transition fittings must be
supplied by the same pipe manufacturer.
Where welds are required in transition fittings, welds must comply with the pipe manufacturer's
instructions.The completed welds must not have visible pinholes.Fill the gaps around the pipes in the
inlet structure wall with non-shrink grout where the pipes connect to an existing drainage structure. Install
the grout under the pipe manufacturer's instructions.
Cut the pipes as shown after the grout used to seal the transition fitting has cured for at least 24 hours.
64-3.04 PAYMENT
Slotted plastic pipe is measured along the centerline of the pipe and parallel with the slope line. If the pipe
is cut to fit a structure or slope,the payment quantity is the length of pipe necessary to be placed before
cutting, measured in 2-foot increments.
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
DIVISION VII DRAINAGE FACILITIES
71 EXISTING DRAINAGE FACILITIES
01-15-16
Replace items 5 and 6 in the list in the 1st paragraph of section 71-3.01D with:
01-15-16
5. Performing postrehabilitation inspection
Add after the 4th paragraph of section 71-3.01 D:
01-15-16
Record the quantity of grout that is installed and submit this quantity.The Department does not pay for
grout that leaks through to the inside of the culvert. The Department does not pay for grout material that is
wasted, disposed of, or remaining on hand after the completion of the work.
Page 114 of 183
Replace the 2nd heading in section 71-5.03 with:
01-15-16
71-5.0313 Frames, Covers, Grates,and Manholes
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
DIVISION VIII MISCELLANEOUS CONSTRUCTION
72 SLOPE PROTECTION
07-15-16
Replace the 1st and 2nd paragraphs of section 72-2.0213 with:
07-15-16
For method A and B placement and the class of RSP described, comply with the rock gradation shown in
the following table:
Rock Gradation
Nominal RSP class Nominal
by median particle median d15°(inches) d50°(inches) dloo° Placement
diameter particle (inches)
Diameter weight
Classy inches W 50
c,d Min Max Min Max Max Method
1 6 201b 3.7 5.2 5.7 6.9 12.0 B
11 9 601b 5.5 7.8 8.5 10.5 18.0 B
111 12 150 1 b 7.3 10.5 11.5 14.0 24.0 B
IV 15 3001b 9.2 13.0 14.5 17.5 30.0 B
V 18 1/4 ton 11.0 15.5 17.0 20.5 36.0 B
VI 21 3/8 ton 13.0 18.5 20.0 24.0 42.0 A or B
VII 24 1/2 ton 14.5 21.0 23.0 27.5 48.0 A or B
Vill 30 1 ton 18.5 26.0 28.5 34.5 48.0 A or B
IX 36 2 ton 22.0 31.5 34.0 41.5 52.8 A
X 42 3 ton 25.5 36.5 40.0 48.5 60.5 A
XI 46 4 ton 28.0 39.4 43.7 53.1 66.6 A
a For RSP Classes I-VIII, use Class 8 RSP fabric. For RSP Classes IX-XI, use Class 10 RSP fabric.
bIntermediate or B dimension (i.e., width) where A dimension is length and C dimension is thickness.
'd%,where % denotes the percentage of the total weight of the graded material.
dValues shown are based on the minimum and maximum particle diameters shown and an average
specific gravity of 2.65.Weight will vary based on specific gravity of rock available for the project.
Replace the table in section 72-2.02C with:
07-15-16
Fabric Class
Class Largest rock gradation class used in slope protection
8 Classes I-VIII
10 Classes IX-XI
Page 115 of 183
Replace the table in the 1st paragraph of section 72-3.02C with:
07-15-16
Concreted-Rock Gradation
Nominal RSP class by Nominal
median particle median d15° d5o° dloo°
diameter particle
weight
Class (inchze es)es) W50cd Min Max Min Max Max
Wei hta
1 6 20lb 3.7 5.2 5.7 6.9 12.0
11 9 60lb 5.5 7.8 8.5 10.5 18.0
111 12 150lb 7.3 10.5 11.5 14.0 24.0
V 18 1/4 ton 11.0 15.5 17.0 20.5 36.0
VII 24 1/2 ton 14.5 21.0 23.0 27.5 48.0
Use Class 8 RSP fabric.
bIntermediate or B dimension (i.e.,width)where A dimension is length and C dimension is thickness.
°d%, where% denotes the percentage of the total weight of the graded material.
dValues shown are based on the minimum and maximum particle diameters shown and an assumed
specific gravity of 2.65.Weight will vary based on specific gravity of rock available for the project.
Replace the table in section 72-3.03E with:
07-15-16
Minimum Concrete Penetration
Rock class
VII V 111 11 1
Penetration 18 14 10 8 6
inches
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
73 CONCRETE CURBS AND SIDEWALKS
07-15-16
Replace section 73-3.01 A with:
07-15-16
Section 73-3 includes specifications for constructing sidewalks, gutter depressions, island paving, curb
ramps,and driveways.
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
74 PUMPING EQUIPMENT AND CONTROLS
04-15-16
Replace 87-1.03K in the 4th paragraph of section 74-3.03B(2)with:
04-15-16
87
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
Page 116 of 183
80 FENCES
07-15-16
Replace section 80-4 with:
07-15-16
80-4 WILDLIFE EXCLUSION FENCES
80-4.01 GENERAL
80-4.01A General
Section 80-4 includes specifications for constructing wildlife exclusion fences.
Constructing a wildlife exclusion fence includes the installation of any signs specified in the special
provisions.
80-4.01 B Materials
Each T post must:
1. Comply with ASTM A702
2. Be metal and have an anchor plate
3. Be painted black or galvanized
80-4.01 C Construction
Not Used
80-4.01 D Payment
Not Used
80-4.02 DESERT TORTOISE FENCES
80-4.02A General
Section 80-4.02 includes specifications for constructing desert tortoise fences.
80-4.0213 Materials
80-4.0213(1) Permanent Desert Tortoise Fences
80-4.0213(1)(a) General
Each wire tie and hog ring for a permanent desert tortoise fence must comply with section 80-2.02F.
Each hold down pin must:
1. Be U-shaped,with 2 minimum 6-inch long legs
2. Have pointed ends
3. Be at least 11-gauge wire
4 Be galvanized
5. Be commercial quality
80-4.0213(1)(b) Hardware Cloth
The hardware cloth must:
1. Comply with ASTM A740
2. Be welded or woven galvanized steel wire fabric
3. Be made of at least 14-gauge wire
4. Be 36 inches wide
80-4.0213(1)(c) Barbless Wire
The barbless wire must:
1. Comply with ASTM A641/A641 M
2. Be at least 14-gauge wire
3. Have a Class 1 zinc coating
Page 117 of 183
80-4.02B(1)(d) Posts
Each post must:
1. Comply with ASTM F1083
2. Be standard weight, schedule 40 steel pipe with a nominal pipe size of 1 inch
3. Be galvanized steel fence post conforming to ASTM A702
80-4.02B(2) Temporary Desert Tortoise Fences
The materials for a temporary desert tortoise fence must comply with section 80-4.02B(1), except the
hardware cloth must be made of at least 16-gauge wire.
80-4.02C Construction
80-4.02C(1) General
Extend the hardware cloth a minimum of 24 inches above the ground.
Plumb the posts and pull the hardware cloth taut. Correct any alignment issues.
80-4.02C(2) Permanent Desert Tortoise Fences
Excavate the ground to form a trench before installing the posts and hardware cloth. Embed the posts at
maximum 5-foot intervals into the ground. If T posts are used, use 5-foot lengths and embed the posts to
match the above-ground height shown for the posts.
Securely fasten the hardware cloth to the posts with wire ties and to barbless wire with hog rings as
shown. Pass the wire ties through the hardware cloth. Encircle the posts and barbless wire with the ties
and tie them by twisting a minimum of 3 complete turns.
Bend the twisted ends of the ties down to prevent possible snagging. Close hog rings with their ends
overlapping.
Bury the hardware cloth a minimum of 12 inches into the ground. Install the cloth in 1 continuous piece.
You may cut the cloth into shorter segments if authorized.
Overlap the hardware cloth segments at posts,with a minimum overlap of 6 inches centered at a post.
Wire tie the overlapped cloth to posts as shown. Prevent fraying by threading barbless wire along the
vertical edges of the hardware cloth on either side of the post or use 3 equally spaced hog rings (6 hog
rings per location)along each wire cloth edge.
Where bedrock or caliche substrate is encountered, use the bent hardware cloth detail if authorized.
Transitions from buried-to-bent or bent-to-buried configuration must occur at a post location with a
minimum 6-inch overlap of the hardware cloth as shown. The maximum spacing for hold down pins is 24
inches on center.Anchor in place with hold down pins the beginning and end corners of the hardware
cloth placed on the ground.
Backfill the removed earth material into the trench created to install the hardware cloth and posts. Use an
8 lb or heavier hand tamper to compact the backfill around the posts and hardware cloth. Install a post at
each corner of the cloth segments.
If a gate must be installed, attach the hardware cloth to the gate frame such that there is contact along
the entire length of the gate between the finished ground surface and the lower edge of the cloth. Install
the gate under section 80-10.
80-4.02C(3) Temporary Desert Tortoise Fences
Fold the horizontal edge of the hardware cloth at a 90° angle toward the tortoise habitat area. Ensure the
clearance to the ground at the bend is from 0 to 2 inches.
Where the hardware cloth overlaps, secure the bend piece with one of the following:
1. Barbless wire threaded along the width of the cloth
2. Minimum of 4 hog rings equally spaced along the edge
Fasten the bent piece to the ground with hold down pins pushed completely into the ground.
Page 118 of 183
When the temporary fence is no longer needed, compact soil into post holes with an 8 lb or heavier hand
tamper.
80-4.02D Payment
Not Used
80-4.03-80-4.09 RESERVED
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
DIVISION IX TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES
83 RAILINGS AND BARRIERS
04-15-16
04-15-16
Delete to in the 4th paragraph of section 83-1.02B.
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
84 MARKINGS
07-15-16
Add to the beginning of section 84-8.03A:
07-15-16
Select the method and equipment for constructing ground-in indentations.
Replace the 1st paragraph of section 84-8.03Awith:
07-15-16
Do not construct rumble strips:
1. On structures, approach slabs, or concrete weigh-in-motion slabs
2. At intersections
3. Bordering two-way left turn lanes, driveways, or other high-volume turning areas
4. Within 6 inches of any concrete pavement joint
Add between the 2nd and 3rd paragraphs of section 84-8.03A:
07-15-16
Modify rumble strip spacing to avoid locating a groove on a concrete pavement joint.
Replace the 3rd paragraph of section 84-8.03A with:
07-15-16
Indentations must comply with the dimensions shown and not vary more than:
1. 10 percent in length
2. 0.06 inch in depth
3. 10 percent in width
4. 1 inch in center-to-center spacing between rumble strips
Page 119 of 183
Add to the end of section 84-8.03A:
07-15-16
The noise level created by the combined grinding activities must not exceed 86 dBA when measured at a
distance of 50 feet at right angles to the direction of travel.
Break rumble strips before and after intersections, driveways, railroad crossings,freeway gore areas, and
freeway ramps. Place breaks and break distances as shown. You may adjust breaks and the break
distances as needed at low-volume driveways or other locations if authorized.
07-15-16
Delete new in the 1st paragraph of section 84-8.03B.
07-15-16
Add to the end of section 84-8.0313:
Remove grinding residue under section 13-4.03E(7).
Replace the 1st paragraph of section 84-8.03C with:
07-15-16
Construct rumble strips in the top layer of HMA and asphalt concrete surfacing by the ground-in method.
Add between the 2nd and 3rd paragraphs of section 84-8.03C:
07-15-16
Dispose of the removed material.
07-15-16
Delete the 2nd paragraph of section 84-8.03C.
Replace 37-2 in the 3rd paragraph of section 84-8.03C with:
07-15-16
37-4.02
Replace section 84-8.04 with:
07-15-16
The payment quantity for any type of rumble strip is the length measured by the station along the length
of the rumble strip without deductions for gaps between indentations.
Replace the 2nd paragraph of section 84-9.03B with:
04-15-16
Completely remove traffic stripes and pavement markings, including any paint in the gaps, by methods
that do not remove pavement to a depth of more than 1/8 inch.
Add between the 2nd and 3rd paragraphs of section 84-9.03B:
04-15-16
Submit your proposed method for removing traffic stripes and pavement markings at least 7 days before
starting the removal work.Allow 2 business days for the review.
Remove pavement marking such that the old message cannot be identified. Make any area removed by
grinding rectangular.Water must not puddle in the ground areas. Fog seal ground areas on asphalt
concrete pavement.
Page 120 of 183
04-15-16
Delete materially in the 1st paragraph of section 84-9.03D.
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
DIVISION X ELECTRICAL WORK
Replace section 86 with:
04-15-16
86 GENERAL
04-15-16
86-1.01 GENERAL
86-1.01A Summary
Section 86 includes general specifications for furnishing electrical equipment and materials.
Electrical equipment and materials must comply with part 4 of the California MUTCD and 8 CA Code of
Regs,chapter 4, subchapter 5, "Electrical Safety Orders."
Galvanized equipment and materials must comply with section 75-1.02B.
86-1.0113 Definitions
accessible pedestrian signal: Accessible pedestrian signal as defined in the California MUTCD.
accessible walk indication: Activated audible and vibrotactile action during the walk interval.
actuation: Actuation as defined in the California MUTCD.
ambient sound level: Background sound level in dB at a given location.
ambient sound sensing microphone: Microphone that measures the ambient sound level in dB and
automatically adjusts the accessible pedestrian signal speaker's volume.
audible speech walk message: Audible prerecorded message that communicates to pedestrians which
street has the walk interval.
channel: Discrete information path.
CALIPER: Commercially Available LED Product Evaluation and Reporting.A U.S. Department of Energy
program that individually tests and provides unbiased information on the performance of commercially
available LED luminaires and lights.
controller assembly: Assembly for controlling a system's operations, consisting of a controller unit and
auxiliary equipment housed in a waterproof cabinet.
controller unit: Part of the controller assembly performing the basic timing and logic functions.
correlated color temperature: Absolute temperature in kelvin of a blackbody whose chromaticity most
nearly resembles that of the light source.
detector: Detector as defined in the California MUTCD.
electrolier: Assembly of a lighting standard and luminaire.
flasher: Device for opening and closing signal circuits at a repetitive rate.
flashing beacon control assembly: Assembly of switches, circuit breakers,terminal blocks,flasher,
wiring, and other necessary electrical components housed in a single enclosure for operating a
beacon.
Page 121 of 183
house side lumens: Lumens from a luminaire directed to light up areas between the fixture and the pole,
such as sidewalks at intersection or areas off the shoulders on freeways.
illuminance gradient: Ratio of the minimum illuminance on a 1-foot square of sign panel to that on an
adjacent 1-foot square of sign panel.
inductive loop detector: Detector capable of being actuated by an inductance change caused by a
vehicle passing or standing over the loop. An inductive loop detector includes a loop or group of loops
installed in the roadway and a lead-in cable installed and connected inside a controller cabinet.
junction temperature: Temperature of the electronic junction of the LED device. The junction
temperature is critical in determining photometric performance, estimating operational life, and
preventing catastrophic failure of the LED.
L70: Extrapolated life in hours of the luminaire when the luminous output depreciates 30 percent from the
initial values.
lighting standard: Pole and mast arm supporting the luminaire.
LM-79: Test method from the Illumination Engineering Society of North America specifying the test
conditions, measurements, and report format for testing solid state lighting devices, including LED
luminaires.
LM-80: Test method from the Illumination Engineering Society of North America specifying the test
conditions, measurements, and report format for testing and estimating the long-term performance of
LEDs for general lighting purposes.
luminaire:Assembly that houses the light source and controls the light emitted from the light source.
National Voluntary Laboratory Accreditation Program: U.S. Department of Energy program that
accredits independent testing laboratories.
powder coating: Coating applied electrostatically using exterior-grade, UV-stable, polymer powder.
power factor: Ratio of the real power component to the complex power component.
pretimed controller assembly:Assembly operating traffic signals under a predetermined cycle length.
programming mechanism: Device to program the accessible pedestrian signal operation.
pull box: Box with a cover that is installed in an accessible place in a conduit run to facilitate the pulling
in of wires or cables.
push button information message: Push button information message as defined in the California
MUTCD.
push button locator tone: Push button locator tone as defined in the California MUTCD.
signal face: Signal face as defined in the California MUTCD.
signal head: Signal head as defined in the California MUTCD.
signal indication: Signal indication as defined in the California MUTCD.
signal section: Signal section as defined in the California MUTCD.
signal standard: Pole with or without mast arms carrying 1 or more signal faces.
street side lumens: Lumens from a luminaire directed to light up areas between the fixture and the
roadway, such as traveled ways and freeway lanes.
surge protection device: Subsystem or component that protects equipment against short-duration
voltage transients in power line.
total harmonic distortion: Ratio of the rms value of the sum of the squared individual harmonic
amplitudes to the rms value of the fundamental frequency of a complex waveform.
Page 122 of 183
traffic-actuated controller assembly: Assembly for operating traffic signals under the varying demands
of traffic as registered by detector actuation.
traffic phase: Traffic phase as defined in the California MUTCD.
vehicle: Vehicle as defined in the California Vehicle Code.
vibrotactile pedestrian device: Vibrotactile pedestrian device as defined in the California MUTCD.
86-1.01C Submittals
86-1.01C(1) General
Within 15 days after Contract approval, submit a list of equipment and materials you propose to install.
Submit the list before shipping equipment and materials to the job site. The list must include:
1. Manufacturer's name
2. Make and model number
3. Month and year of manufacture
4. Lot and serial numbers
5. Contract number
6. Your contact information
Submit confirmation of the vendor's acceptance of the order for the electrical equipment and materials as
an informational submittal.
Submit 3 sets of computer-generated, schematic wiring diagrams for each cabinet.
Diagrams, plans, and drawings must be prepared using graphic symbols in IEEE 315, "Graphic Symbols
for Electrical and Electronic Diagrams."
Submit a schedule of values within 15 days after Contract approval.
Do not include costs for the traffic control system in the schedule of values.
Submit a manufacturer's maintenance manual or combined maintenance and operation manual as an
informational submittal. The manual must have a master item index that includes:
1. Specifications
2. Design characteristics
3. General operation theory
4. Function of all controls
5. Troubleshooting procedure
6. Parts list, descriptions, stock numbers, and settings
7. Block circuit diagram
8. Layout of components
9. Schematic diagrams
86-1.01C(2) Pull Boxes
Submit the manufacturer's installation instructions for pull boxes, including:
1. Quantity and size of entries that can be made without degrading the strength of the pull box below the
load rating
2. Locations where side entries can be made
3. Acceptable method for creating the entry
Submit load-rating test reports for pull boxes from a NRTL.
86-1.01C(3) LED Luminaires
Submit for an LED luminaire:
1. Maximum power in watts
2. Maximum designed junction temperature
3. Heat sink area in square inches
Page 123 of 183
4. Designed junction-to-ambient thermal resistance calculation with thermal resistance components
clearly defined
5. L70 in hours when extrapolated for the average nighttime operating temperature
6. Life expectancy based on the junction temperature
7. Manufacturer's data sheet for the power supply, including the rated life
Submit the manufacturer's QC test data for LED luminaires as an informational submittal.
86-1.01C(4) Low-Pressure Sodium Luminaires
Submit the manufacturer's QC test data for low-pressure sodium luminaires as an informational submittal.
86-1.01C(5) Service Equipment Enclosures
Submit shop drawings for a service equipment enclosure to METS.
86-1.01C(6) Signal Heads
Submit a certificate of compliance and the manufacturer's QC test data for signal heads as an
informational submittal.
86-1.01C(7) LED Signal Modules
Submit the manufacturer's QC test data for LED signal modules as an informational submittal.
86-1.01C(8) Visors
Submit a certificate of compliance and the manufacturer's QC test data for visors as an informational
submittal.
86-1.01C(9) LED Countdown Pedestrian Signal Face Modules
Submit the manufacturer's QC test data for LED countdown pedestrian signal face modules as an
informational submittal.
86-1.01C(10) Accessible Pedestrian Signals
Submit the manufacturer's QC test data for accessible pedestrian signals as an informational submittal.
86-1.01D Quality Assurance
86-1.01D(1) General
Electrical equipment must comply with one or more of the following standards:
1. ANSI
2. ASTM
3. EIA/ECIA
4. NEMA
5. NETA
6. UL/NRTL
7. TIA
Materials must comply with:
1. FCC rules
2. ITE standards
3. NEC
4. California Electrical Code
86-1.01D(2) Source Quality Control
Service equipment enclosures and cabinets must be inspected and tested at the source.
86-1.01 D(3) Department Acceptance
Deliver material and equipment for testing to METS.
Allow 30 days for testing. The Department notifies you when testing is complete.
Page 124 of 183
If the Department accepts the material or equipment, you must pick it up from the test site and deliver it to
the job site.
If the Department rejects material or equipment, remove it within 5 business days after you are notified it
is rejected. If it is not removed within that period,the Department may remove it and ship it to you and
deduct the costs of labor, material and shipping.
Resubmit a new sample and allow 30 days for retesting.The retesting period starts when the
replacement material or equipment is delivered to METS.
86-1.02 MATERIALS
86-1.02A General
Anchor bolts, anchor bars or studs, and nuts and washers must comply with section 75-1.02.
Bolt threads must accept galvanized standard nuts without requiring tools or causing removal of
protective coatings.
86-1.02B Conduit and Accessories
86-1.02B(1) General
Conduit and fittings must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Conduit and Fitting Requirements
Type Requirement
1 Must be hot-dip galvanized rigid steel complying with UL 6 and ANSI C80.1. The zinc coating
must comply with copper sulfate test requirements in UL 6. Fittings must be electrogalvanized
and certified under UL 514B.
2 Must comply with requirements for Type 1 conduit and be coated with PVC or polyethylene.
The exterior thermoplastic coating must have a minimum thickness of 35 mils. The internal
coating must have a minimum thickness of 2 mils. Coated conduit must comply with NEMA RN
1, or NRTL PVC-001.
3 Must be Type A, extruded, rigid PVC conduit complying with UL 651 or must be HDPE conduit
complying with U L 651 A.
4 Must have an inner,flexible metal core covered by a waterproof, nonmetallic, sunlight-resistant
jacket, and must be UL listed for use as a grounding conductor. Fittings must be certified under
UL 514B.
5 Must be intermediate steel complying with UL 1242 and ANSI C80.6. The zinc coating must
comply with copper sulfate test requirements specified in UL 1242. Fittings must be
electrog a Ivan ized and certified under UL 514B.
Bonding bushings installed on metal conduit must be insulated and either a galvanized or zinc-alloy type.
86-1.02B(2) Structures Accessories
Steel hangers, steel brackets, and other fittings used to support conduit in or on a wall or bridge
superstructure must comply with section 75-3.
Precast concrete cradles for conduit must be made of minor concrete and commercial-quality welded wire
fabric. The minor concrete must contain a minimum of 590 lb of cementitious material per cubic yard. The
cradles must be moist cured for a minimum of 3 days.
86-1.02C Pull Boxes
86-1.02C(1) General
Pull box cover must have a marking on the top that is:
1. Clearly defined
2. Uniform in depth
3. Parallel to either side
4. 1 to 3 inches in height
Cover marking must be:
Page 125 of 183
1. SERVICE for service circuits between a service point and service disconnect
2. SERVICE IRRIGATION for circuits from a service equipment enclosure to an irrigation controller
3. SERVICE BOOSTER PUMP for circuits from a service equipment enclosure to the booster pump
4. TDC POWER for circuits from a service equipment enclosure to telephone demarcation cabinet
5. LIGHTING for a lighting system
6. SIGN ILLUMINATION for a sign illumination system
7. SIGNAL AND LIGHTING for a signal and lighting system
8. RAMP METER for a ramp metering system
9. TMS for a traffic monitoring station
10. FLASHING BEACON for a flashing beacon system
11. CMS for a changeable message sign system
12. INTERCONNECT for an interconnect conduit and cable system
The load rating must be stenciled on the inside and outside of the pull box and the cover.
If a transformer or other device must be placed in the pull box, include recesses for a hanger.
The hardware must be stainless steel with 18 percent chromium and 8 percent nickel content.
86-1.02C(2) Nontraffic Pull Boxes
A nontraffic pull box and cover must comply with ANSI/SCTE 77, "Specification for Underground
Enclosure Integrity,"for Tier 22 load rating and must be gray or brown.
Each new pull box must have a cover with an electronic marker cast inside.
A pull box extension must be made of the same material as the pull box. The extension may be another
pull box if the bottom edge of the pull box fits into the opening for the cover.
The bolts, nuts, and washers must be a captive design and galvanized. Captive bolts for securing the
cover of nontraffic pull boxes must be capable of withstanding a torque from 55 to 60 ft-lb and a minimum
pull-out strength of 750 lb.
86-1.02C(3) Traffic Pull Boxes
A traffic pull box and cover must comply with ASTM C857 for HS20-44 loading.
The frame must be anchored to the box with 2-1/4-inch-long concrete anchors with a 1/4 inch diameter. A
no. 3-1/2(T) pull box must have 4 concrete anchors, one placed in each corner. No. 5(T)and no. 6(T) pull
boxes must have 6 concrete anchors, one placed in each corner and one near the middle of each of the
longer sides.
Nuts must be vibration-resistant, zinc-plated, carbon steel and have a wedge ramp at the root of the
thread.
Before galvanizing a steel or cast iron cover, the manufacturer must apply the cover marking by one of
the following methods:
1. Use a cast iron strip at least 1/4 inch thick with letters raised a minimum of 1/16 inch. Fasten the strip
to the cover with 1/4-inch,flathead, stainless steel machine bolts and nuts. Peen the bolts after
tightening.
2. Use a sheet steel strip at least 0.027 inch thick with letters raised a minimum of 1/16 inch. Fasten the
strip to the cover by spot welding, tack welding, or brazing with 1/4-inch stainless steel rivets or 1/4-
inch, roundhead, stainless steel machine bolts and nuts. Peen the bolts after tightening.
The steel cover must be countersunk approximately 1/4 inch to accommodate the bolt head.When
tightened,the bolt head must be no more than 1/8 inch above the top of the cover.
86-1.02C(4) Reserved
86-1.02D Tapes
86-1.02D(1) General
Reserved
Page 126 of 183
86-1.02D(2) Pull Tape
Pull tape must be a flat,woven, lubricated, soft-fiber, polyester tape with a minimum tensile strength of
1,800 lb. The tape must have sequential measurement markings every 3 feet.
86-1.02D(3) Reserved
86-1.02E Reserved
86-1.02F Conductors and Cables
86-1.02F(1) Conductors
86-1.02F(1)(a) General
Reserved
86-1.02F(1)(b) Reserved
86-1.02F(1)(c) Copper Conductors
86-1.02F(1)(c)(i) General
Copper wire must comply with ASTM B3 and B8.
Conductor must be clearly and permanently marked the entire length of its outer surface with:
1. Manufacturer's name or trademark
2. Insulation-type letter designation
3. Conductor size
4. Voltage
5. Temperature rating
6. Number of conductors for a cable
The minimum insulation thickness and color code requirements must comply with NEC.
A conductor must be UL listed or NRTL certified and rated for 600 V(ac).
Insulation for no. 14 to no. 4 conductors must be one of the following:
1. Type TW PVC under ASTM D2219
2. Type THW PVC
3. Type USE, RHH, or RHW cross-linked polyethylene
The insulation for no. 2 and larger conductors must be one of the above or THWN.
Conductors must be identified as shown in the following table:
Page 127 of 183
Conductor Identification
Identification
Insulation color
Circuit Signal phase or function Base Stripe Band symbols Size
2, 6 Red, yel, brn Blk 2, 6 14
4, 8 Red, yel, brn Ora 4, 8 14
Signals 1, 5 Red, yel, brn None 1, 5 14
(vehicle)a,b 3, 7 Red, yel, brn Pur 3, 7 14
Ramp meter 1 Red, yel, brn None NBR 14
Ramp meter 2 Red, yel, brn Blk NBR 14
2p, 6p Red, brn Blk 2p, 6p 14
Pedestrian 4p, 8p Red, brn Ora 4p, 8p 14
signals 1 p, 5p Red, brn None 1 p, 5p 14
3p, 7p Red, brn Pur 3p, 7p 14
2p, 6p Blu Blk P-2, P-6 14
Pedestrian 4p, 8p Blu Ora P-4, P-8 14
push buttons 1 p, 5p Blu None P-1, P-5 14
3p, 7p Blu Pur P-3, P-7 14
Traffic signal Ungrounded circuit
controller conductor Blk None CON-1 6
cabinet Grounded circuit
conductor Wht None CON-2 6
Highway Ungrounded- line 1 Blk None NBR 14
lighting pull box Ungrounded- line 2 Red None NBR 14
to luminaire Grounded Wht None NBR 14
Multiple Ungrounded- line 1 Blk None ML1 10
highway
lighting Ungrounded- line 2 Red None ML2 10
Ungrounded-PEU Blk None C1 14
Lighting control Switching leg from PEU
unit or SM transformer Red None C2 14
Ungrounded -line 1
Service (signals) Blk None NBR 6
Ungrounded -line 2
(lighting) Red None NBR 8
Sign lighting Ungrounded- line 1 Blk None SL-1 10
Ungrounded- line 2 Red None SL-2 10
Flashing Ungrounded between
beacons flasher and beacons Red or yel None F-Loc.° 14
Pedestrian push buttons Wht Blk NBR 14
Signals and multiple
Grounded lighting Wht None NBR 10
circuit Flashing beacons and
conductor sign lighting Wht None NBR 12
Lighting control Wht None C-3 14
Service Wht None NBR 14
Railroad
preemption Blk None R 14
Spares Blk None NBR 14
NBR= No band required PEU=Photoelectric unit
aOn overlaps,the insulation is striped for the 1 st phase in the designation, e.g., phase (2+3)conductor is
striped as for phase 2.
bBand for overlap and special phases as required
°Flashing beacons having separate service do not require banding.
dColor Code:Yel-Yellow, Brn-Brown, Blu-Blue, Blk-Black,Wht-White, Ora-Orange, Pur-Purple
Page 128 of 183
The insulation color must be homogeneous throughout the full depth of the insulation.The identification
stripe must be continuous throughout the length of the conductor.
86-1.02F(1)(c)(ii) Bonding Jumpers and Equipment Grounding Conductors
A bonding jumper must be copper wire or copper braid of the same cross-sectional area as a no. 8
conductor or larger.
An equipment grounding conductor may be bare or insulated.
86-1.02F(1)(c)(iii) Inductive Loop Conductors
Inductive loop conductor must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Conductor Requirements for Inductive Loop Detectors
Loop wire Requirement
Type 1 Type RHW-USE neoprene-jacketed or Type USE cross-linked polyethylene, insulated, no.
12 stranded copper wire with a minimum 40-mils insulation thickness at anV point.
Type THWN or Type XHHW, no. 14, stranded copper wire in a plastic tubing.The plastic
Type 2 tubing must be polyethylene or vinyl rated for use at 105 °C and resistant to oil and
gasoline.The outside diameter of the tubing must be at most 0.27 inch with a wall
thickness of at least 0.028 inch.
86-1.02F(1)(d) Reserved
Reserved
86-1.02F(2) Cables
86-1.02F(2)(a) General
Reserved
86-1.02F(2)(b) Reserved
Reserved
86-1.02F(2)(c) Reserved
86-1.02F(2)(d) Copper Cables
86-1.02F(2)(d)(i) General
The conductor wire size for a detector lead-in cable must comply with the requirements of ASTM 13286.
Cable, except a detector lead-in cable, must be clearly and permanently marked the entire length of its
outer surface with:
1. Manufacturer's name or trademark
2. Insulation-type letter designation
3. Conductorsize
4. Voltage
5. Temperature rating
6. Number of conductors for a cable
86-1.02F(2)(d)(ii) Conductors Signal Cables
A conductors signal cable must have a black polyethylene jacket with an inner polyester binder sheath.
The cable jacket must be rated for 600 V(ac)and 75 degrees C. Filler material, if used, must be
polyethylene.
The individual conductors in the cable must be solid copper complying with ASTM B286 with Type THWN
insulation.The minimum thickness of insulation must comply with NEC for conductor sizes no. 14 to
no.10. The minimum thickness of the nylon jacket must be 4 mils.
Cable must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Page 129 of 183
Cable Conductor Cable jacket thickness Maximum Conductor color code
type' quantity and mils nominal
type Average Minimum outside
diameter
(inch)
3CSC 3 no. 14 44 36 0.40 Blue/black,blue/orange,
white/black stripe
5CSC 5 no. 14 44 36 0.50 Red, yellow, brown, black,
white
9CSC 8 no. 14 60 48 0.65 No. 12-white,
1 no. 12 no. 14- red, yellow,
brown, black, and
red/black,yellow/black,
brown/black,white/black
stripe
12CSC 11 no. 14 60 48 0.80 No. 12-white,
1 no. 12 no. 14- red, yellow,
brown, red/black stripe,
yellow/black stripe,
brown/black stripe,
black/red stripe,
black/white stripe, black,
red/white stripe,
brown/white stripe
28CSC 27 no. 14 80 64 0.90 No. 10-white
1 no. 10 no. 14-red/black stripe,
yellow/black stripe,
brown/black stripe,
red/orange stripe,
yellow/orange stripe,
brown/orange stripe,
red/silver stripe,
yellow/silver stripe,
brown/silver stripe,
red/purple stripe,
yellow/purple stripe,
brown/purple stripe, red/2
black stripes, brown/2
black stripes, red/2
orange stripes, brown/2
orange stripes, red/2
silver stripes, brown/2
silver stripes, red/2 purple
stripes, brown/2 purple
stripes, blue/black stripe,
blue/orange stripe,
blue/silver stripe,
blue/purple stripe,
white/black stripe,
black/red stripe, black
86-1.02F(2)(d)(iii) Detector Lead-in Cables
Conductors for a loop detector lead-in cable must be two no. 16, 19-by-29, stranded,tinned copper wires
with calculated cross-sectional areas complying with ASTM B286, table 1 and must comply with the
requirements shown in the following table:
Page 130 of 183
Conductor Requirements for Loop Detector Lead-In Cables
Lead-in cable Requirement
Type B Insulated with 20 mils of high-density polyethylene. Conductors must be twisted
together with at least 2 turns per foot, and the twisted pair must be protected with a
copper or aluminum polyester shield. A minimum no. 20 copper drain wire must be
connected to the equipment ground within the cabinet. Cable must have a high-density
polyethylene or high-density polypropylene outer jacket with a nominal thickness of 32
mils. Include an amorphous, interior, moisture penetration barrier of nonhydroscopic
polyethylene or polypropylene fillers.
Type C Comply with International Municipal Signal Association Specification no. 50-2.A
minimum no. 20 copper drain wire must be connected to the equipment ground within
the cabinet.
86-1.02F(2)(d)(iv) Reserved
86-1.02F(2)(d)(v) Signal Interconnect Cables
A signal interconnect cable must be a 6-pair type with stranded,tinned, copper no. 20 conductors.The
insulation for each conductor must be color-coded polypropylene with a minimum 13-mils nominal
thickness. The conductors must be in color-coded,twisted pairs. Each pair must be wrapped with an
aluminum polyester shield and have a no. 22 or larger, stranded, tinned, copper drain wire inside the
shielded pair.
The cable jacket must be black HDPE rated for a minimum of 300 V(ac)and 60 degrees C. The jacket
must have a minimum nominal wall thickness of 40 mils.
86-1.02F(2)(e) Reserved
86-1.02G Equipment Identification Characters
Equipment identification characters must be 2-1/2 inch, series D lettering, except on wood poles,they
must be 3-inch lettering.
The characters must be self-adhesive reflective labels or paint, except on wood poles,they must be
embossed on aluminum.
86-1.02H Splicing Materials
Splicing materials include:
1. Connectors
2. Electrical insulating coating
3. PVC electrical tape
4. Butyl rubber stretchable tape
5. PVC pressure-sensitive adhesive tape
6. Heat shrink tubing
Connectors must be C-shaped compression or butt type.
Electrical insulating coating must be a fast drying sealant with low nontoxic fumes.
PVC electrical tape must have a minimum thickness of 80 mils.
Butyl rubber stretchable tape with liner must have a minimum thickness of 120 mils.
PVC pressure-sensitive adhesive electrical tape must have a minimum thickness of 6 mils.
Electrical tapes must be self-fusing, oil-and flame-resistant, synthetic rubber and be UL listed or NRTL
certified.
Heat-shrink tubing must be made of irradiated polyolefin tubing with a minimum wall thickness of 40 mils
before contraction and an adhesive mastic inner wall. When heated, the inner wall must melt and fill the
crevices and interstices of the covered splice area and the outer wall must shrink to form a waterproof
insulation.
Page 131 of 183
Heat-shrink tubing must comply with the requirements for extruded, insulating tubing at 600 V(ac)
specified in UL Standard 468D and ANSI C119.1 and the requirements shown in the following table:
Heat-Shrink Tubing Requirements
Quality characteristic Requirement
Shrinkage ratio of supplied diameters(max, %) 33
Dielectric strength (min, kV/in) 350
Resistivity(min, 0/in) 25 x 1013
Tensile strength min, psi 2,000
Operating temperature °C -40-90 135 °C in emergency)
Water absorption (max, %) 0.5
aWhen heated to 125°C and allowed to cool to 25 °C
86-1.021 Connectors and Terminals
A connector and terminal must comply with SAE-AS7928 and be a crimp type, rated for 600 V(ac)and
either UL listed or NRTL certified.
86-1.02J Standards, Poles, Pedestals,and Posts
Standards for signals, lighting, and flashing beacons, poles for closed circuit television, pedestals for
cabinets, posts for extinguishable message sign and posts for pedestrian push button assemblies must
comply with section 56-3.
86-1.02K Luminaires
86-1.02K(1) General
Luminaire must be either LED or low-pressure-sodium type.
86-1.02K(2) LED Luminaires
LED luminaire must be on the Authorized Material List for LED luminaires and must:
1. Be self-contained, not requiring assembly.
2. Comply with UL 1598 for luminaires in wet locations.
3. Have a power supply with:
3.1. ANSI/IEC rating of at least IP65.
3.2. 2 leads to accept standard 0-10 V(dc).
3.3. Dimming control compatible with IEC 60929,Annex E. If the control leads are open or the
analog control signal is lost, the circuit must default to 100-percent power.
3.4. Case temperature self rise of 77 degrees F or less above ambient temperature in free air with
no additional heat sinks.
4. Weigh no more than 35 lb.
5. Have a minimum operating life of 63,000 hours when operated for an average time of 11.5 hours at
an average temperature of 70 degrees F.
6. Be designed to operate over a temperature range from -40 to 130 degrees F.
7. Be operationally compatible with photoelectric controls.
8. Have a correlated color temperature range from 3,500 to 6,500 K and a color rendering index of 65 or
greater.
9. Have a maximum-effective projected area of 1.4 sq ft when viewed from either side or end.
10. Have a housing color that matches a color no. 26152 to 26440, 36231 to 36375, or 36440 of FED-
STD-595.
11. Have an ANSI C1 36.41-compliant, locking-type, photocontrol receptacle with dimming connections
and a watertight shorting cap.
12. Comply with LM-79, LM-80 and California Test 611.
The individual LEDs must be connected such that a catastrophic loss or a failure of 1 LED does not result
in the loss of more than 20 percent of the luminous output of the luminaire.
The luminaire must be permanently marked inside the unit and outside of its packaging box. Marking
consists of:
1. Manufacturer's name or trademark
Page 132 of 183
2. Month and year of manufacture
3. Model, serial, and lot numbers
4. Rated voltage,wattage, and power in VA
An LED luminaire's onboard circuitry must include a surge protection device to withstand high-repetition
noise transients caused by utility line switching, nearby lightning strikes, and other interferences.The
device must protect the luminaire from damage and failure due to transient voltages and currents as
defined in Tables 1 and 4 of ANSI/IEEE C64.41.2 for location category C-High. The surge protection
device must comply with UL 1449 and ANSI/IEEE C62.45 based on ANSI/IEEE C62.41.2 definitions for
standard and optional waveforms for location category C-High.
An LED luminaire and its associated onboard circuitry must comply with the Class A emission limits under
47 CFR 15(B)for the emission of electronic noise.
The fluctuations of line voltage must have no visible effect on the luminous output.
The operating voltage may range from 120 to 480 V(ac), 60±3 Hz. Luminaire must operate over the
entire voltage range or the voltage range must be selected from one of the following:
1. Luminaire must operate over a voltage range from 95 to 277 V(ac).The operating voltages for this
option are 120 V(ac)and 240 V(ac).
2. Luminaire must operate over a voltage range from 347 to 480 V(ac).The operating voltage for this
option is 480 V(ac).
LED luminaire must have a power factor of 0.90 or greater.The total harmonic distortion, current, and
voltage induced into a power line by a luminaire must not exceed 20 percent. The L70 of the luminaire
must be the minimum operating life or greater. Illuminance measurements must be calibrated to standard
photopic calibrations.
The maximum power consumption and maintained illuminance of the LED luminaires must comply with
the isofootcandle curves as shown.
LED luminaire must not allow more than 10 percent of the rated lumens to project above 80 degrees from
vertical and 2.5 percent of the rated lumens to project above 90 degrees from vertical.
Luminaire must have passive thermal management with enough capacity to ensure proper heat
dissipation and functioning of the luminaire over its minimum operating life. The maximum junction
temperature for the minimum operating life must not exceed 221 degrees F.
The junction-to-ambient thermal resistance must be 95 degrees F per watt or less. The use of fans or
other mechanical devices is not allowed for cooling the luminaire. The heat sink must be made of
aluminum or other material of equal or lower thermal resistance.The luminaire must contain circuitry that
automatically reduces the power to the LEDs so the maximum junction temperature is not exceeded
when the ambient temperature is 100 degrees F or greater.
The luminaire's housing must be fabricated from materials designed to withstand a 3,000-hour salt spray
test under ASTM B117.All aluminum used in housings and brackets must be made of a marine-grade
alloy with less than 0.2 percent copper.All exposed aluminum must be anodized. A chromate conversion
undercoating must be used underneath a thermoplastic polyester powder coat.
The housing must be designed to prevent the buildup of water on its top surface. Exposed heat sink fins
must be oriented to allow water to run off the luminaire and carry dust and other accumulated debris away
from the unit.The optical assembly of the luminaire must be protected against dust and moisture intrusion
to at least an UL 60529 rating of IP66. The power supply enclosure must be protected to at least an UL
60529 rating of IP43.
The housing must have a slip fitter capable of being mounted on a 2-inch-diameter pipe tenon. Slip fitter
must:
1. Fit on mast arms with outside diameters from 1-5/8 to 2-3/8 inches
2. Be adjustable to a minimum of±5 degrees from the axis of the tenon in a minimum of 5 steps: +5,
+2.5, 0, -2.5, -5
3. Have clamping brackets that:
Page 133 of 183
3.1. Are made of corrosion-resistant materials or treated to prevent galvanic reactions
3.2. Do not bottom out on the housing bosses when adjusted within the designed angular range
3.3. Do not permanently set in excess of 1/32 inch when tightened
Each refractor or lens must be made of UV-inhibiting high-impact plastic, such as acrylic or
polycarbonate, or heat-and impact-resistant glass.The refractor or lens must be resistant to scratching.
Polymeric materials, except for the lenses of enclosures containing either the power supply or electronic
components of the luminaire, must be made of UL94 V-0 flame-retardant materials.
An LED luminaire and its internal components must be able to withstand mechanical shock and vibration.
If the components are mounted on a down-opening door, the door must be hinged and secured to the
luminaire's housing separately from the refractor or flat lens frame.The door must be secured to the
housing to prevent accidental opening. A safety cable must mechanically connect the door to the housing.
An LED luminaire must have a barrier-type terminal block secured to the housing to connect field wires.
The terminal screws must be captive and equipped with wire grips for conductors up to no. 6.
The conductors and terminals must be identified and marked.
86-1.02K(3) Low-Pressure Sodium Luminaires
A low-pressure sodium luminaire must be an enclosed cutoff or semi-cutoff type and be self-contained,
not requiring assembly.
The housing must be either(1)a minimum 1/1 6-inch-thick, corrosion-resistant, die-cast aluminum sheet
and plate with concealed continuous welds or(2)a minimum 3/32-inch-thick, acrylonitrile-butadiene-
styrene sheet material on a cast aluminum frame. The housing must provide mounting for all electrical
components and a slip fitter. The housing must be divided into optical and power compartments that are
individually accessible for service and maintenance.
The painted exterior surface of the luminaire must be finished with a fused coating of electrostatically
applied polyester powder paint or other UV-inhibiting film.The color must be aluminum gray.
A sealing ring must be installed in the pipe tenon opening to prevent the entry of water and insects into
the power and optical compartments. The ring must be made of high-temperature neoprene or equal
material.
The power unit assembly must be accessible through a weather-tight, hinged cover secured to the
housing with spring latches or captive screws.
The luminaire's hardware must be stainless steel or cadmium plated. Removable components must be
secured with machine screws or bolts instead of sheet metal screws.
A semi-cutoff luminaire or a molded refractor-style cutoff luminaire must include a refractor. Other cutoff
luminaires must include a flat lens. The refractor assembly and flat lens assembly must be designed to
rigidly maintain their shape and be hinged and secured to the housing with spring latches.
The refractor must be either a 1-piece injection-molded polycarbonate with a minimum thickness of 3/32
inch or a 1-piece injection-molded acrylic with a minimum thickness of 1/8 inch. Alternate methods of
manufacturing the refractor may be authorized provided minimum specified thicknesses are maintained.
The flat lens must be a 1-piece polycarbonate with a minimum thickness of 3/32 inch, mounted to a metal
frame.
The lamp socket must be made of high-temperature,flame-retardant, thermoset material with self-wiping
contacts or an equal. The socket must be rated for 660 W and 1,000 V(ac). The position of the socket and
support must maintain the lamp in the correct relationship with the reflector and refractor for the designed
light distribution pattern.The reflector may be an integral part of the housing.
The luminaire must comply with the isofootcandle curves as shown.
Low-pressure sodium lamp must:
1. Bea 180 W, single-ended, bayonet-base,tubular, gas-discharge lamp
Page 134 of 183
2. Maintain a minimum of 93 percent of its initial lumens over its rated life
3. Reach 80 percent of its light output within 10 minutes
4. Restrike within 1 minute after a power outage or voltage drop at the lamp socket
5. Have ANSI L74/E designation
The lamp operating position must be at±20 degrees from the horizontal.
Lamp must comply with the minimum performance requirements shown in the following table:
Minimum Performance Requirements
Quality characteristic Requirement
Initial lumens Im 33,000
Rated average life at 10 h/start(h) 18,000
The low-pressure sodium lamp ballast must be an autotransformer or high-reactance type.The power
factor must be not less than 90 percent when the ballast is operated at the nominal line voltage with a
nominally-rated reference lamp.The lamp wattage regulation spread must not vary by more than ±6
percent for±10 percent input voltage variation from nominal through life.
At the line voltage, the ballast must have a lamp current crest factor not exceeding 1.8 and ballast loss
not exceeding 24 percent for a 180 W ballast.
The ballast must include a multi-circuit connector for quick disconnection.
86-1.02K(4) Reserved
86-1.021L Reserved
86-1.02M Photoelectric Controls
Photoelectric control types are as shown in the following table:
Photoelectric Control Types
Control type Description
I Pole-mounted photoelectric unit.Test switch housed in an enclosure.
II Pole-mounted photoelectric unit. Contactor and test switch located in a service
equipment enclosure.
III Pole-mounted photoelectric unit. Contactor and a test switch housed in an enclosure.
IV A photoelectric unit that plugs into a NEMA twist-lock receptacle, integral with the
luminaire.
V A photoelectric unit, contactor, and test switch located in a service equipment
enclosure.
The pole-mounted adaptor for Type I, II, and III photoelectric controls must include a terminal block and
cable supports or clamps to support the wires.
The enclosure for Type I and III photoelectric controls must be a NEMA 3R type. The enclosure must
have a factory-applied, rust-resistant prime coat and finish coat. The enclosure must be hot-dip
galvanized or painted to match the color of the lighting standard.
Photoelectric unit must:
1. Have a screen to prevent artificial light from causing cycling.
2. Have a rating of 60 Hz, 105-130 V(ac), 210-240 V(ac), or 105-240 V(ac).
3. Operate at a temperature range from -20 to 55 degrees C.
4. Consume less than 10 W.
5. Be a 3-prong,twist-lock type with a NEMA IP 65 rating,ANSI C1 36.1 0-compliant
6. Have a fail-on state
7. Fit into a NEMA-type receptacle
8. Turn on from 1 to 5 footcandles and turn off from 1.5 to 5 times the turn-on level. Measurements must
be made by procedures in EEI-NEMA Standards for Physical and Electrical Interchangeability of
Light-Sensitive Control Devices Used in the Control of Roadway Lighting.
Page 135 of 183
Type I, II, III, and V photoelectric controls must have a test switch to allow manual operation of the lighting
circuit. Switch must be:
1. Single-hole mounting,toggle type
2. Single pole and single throw
3. Labeled Auto-Test on a nameplate
Photoelectric control's contactor must be:
1. Normallyopen
2. Mechanical-armature type with contacts of fine silver, silver alloy, or equal or better material
3. Installed to provide a minimum space of 2-1/2 inches between the contactor terminals and the
enclosure's sides
The terminal blocks must be rated at 25 A, 600 V(ac), molded from phenolic or nylon material, and be the
barrier type with plated-brass screw terminals and integral marking strips.
86-1.02N Fused Splice Connectors
The fused splice connector for 240 and 480 V(ac)circuits must simultaneously disconnect both
ungrounded conductors. The connector must not have exposed metal parts except for the head of the
stainless steel assembly screw. The head of the assembly screw must be recessed a minimum of 1/32
inch below the top of the plastic boss that surrounds the head.
The connector must protect the fuse from water or weather damage. Contact between the fuse and fuse
holder must be spring loaded.
Fuses must:
1. Be standard, midget,ferrule type
2. Have a nontime-delay feature
3. Be 3/32 by 1-1/2 inches
86-1.020 Grounding Electrodes
Grounding electrode must be:
1. 1 piece
2. Minimum 10-foot length of one of the following:
2.1. Galvanized steel rod or pipe not less than 3/4 inch in diameter
2.2. Copper clad steel rod not less than 5/8 inch in diameter
86-1.02P Enclosures
86-1.02P(1) General
The enclosures must be rated NEMA 3R and include a dead front panel and a hasp with a 7/16-inch-
diameter hole for a padlock.
The enclosure's machine screws and bolts must not protrude outside the cabinet wall.
The fasteners on the exterior of an enclosure must be vandal resistant and not be removable. The
exterior screws, nuts, bolts, and washers must be stainless steel.
86-1.02P(2) Service Equipment Enclosures
A service equipment enclosure must be factory wired and manufactured from steel and galvanized or
have factory-applied, rust-resistant prime and finish coats, except Types 11 and III.
Type II and III service equipment enclosures must:
1. Be made of 0.125-inch minimum thickness 5052-H32 aluminum sheet complying with ASTM B209.
2. Be manufactured using gas metal arc welding with bare aluminum welding electrodes. The electrodes
must comply with AWS A5.10 Class ER5356.
Page 136 of 183
3. Be manufactured using welding procedures, welders, and welding operators that comply with the
requirements for welding procedures,welders, and welding operators in in AWS B2.1, "Specification
for Welding Procedure and Performance Qualification."
4. Have full-seal weld exterior seams.
5. Exterior welds must be ground smooth and edges filed to a radius of at least 0.03 inch.
6. Have a surface finish that complies with MIL-A-8625 for a Type 11, Class I coating, except the anodic
coating must have a minimum thickness of 0.0007 inch and a minimum coating weight of 0.001 oz/sq
in.
If a Type III enclosure houses a transformer of more than 1 kVA, the enclosure must have effective
screened ventilation louvers of no less than 50 sq. in for each louver.The framed screen must be
stainless no. 304 with a no. 10 size mesh and secured with at least 4 bolts.
The dead front panel on a Type III service equipment enclosure must have a continuous stainless steel or
aluminum piano hinge. The panel must be secured with a latch or captive screws. No live part must be
mounted on the panel.
The enclosure must be watertight and marked as specified in NEC to warn of potential electric-arc flash
hazards.
Internal conductors for the photoelectric control unit must be 600 V(ac), 14 AWG (THHN)stranded
machine tool wire.Where subject to flexing, 19 stranded wire must be used.
The meter area must be have a sealable, lockable, weather-tight cover that can be removed without the
use of tools.
For Type III-A, III-B, and III-C enclosures,the meter socket must be a 5-clip type, and the landing lug
must be suitable for multiple conductors.
For a Type III-D enclosure, the meter socket must be a 7-clip type, and the landing lug must be suitable
for multiple conductors. The pedestal must comply with the Electric Utility Service Equipment
Requirements Committee drawing no. 308 or 309.
Landing lugs must be(1)sized for the incoming service utility conductors, (2)compatible with either
copper or aluminum conductors, and (3)made of copper or tin-plated aluminum. Live parts of the
electrical equipment must be guarded against accidental contact.
The main and neutral busses of the enclosure must be made of tin-plated copper, be rated for 125 A, and
be suitable for copper or aluminum conductors.
Each service equipment enclosure must have up to 2 main circuit breakers that will simultaneously
disconnect ungrounded service-entrance conductors.
Circuit breaker for a service equipment enclosure must:
1. Be quick-break on either automatic or manual operation
2. Be trip indicating
3. Be internal-trip type
4. Be UL listed or NRTL certified and comply with UL 489 or equal
5. Be clearly marked with the frame size
6. Have an operating mechanism that is enclosed and trip-free from the operating handle on overload
7. Have the trip rating clearly marked on the operating handle
8. Have an interior made of copper
Circuit breakers used as disconnects must have a minimum interrupting capacity of 10,000 A, rms.
The interior of the enclosure must accept plug-in circuit breakers.A minimum of 6 standard single-pole
circuit breakers, 3/4" nominal, must be provided for branch circuits.
Identify each circuit breaker and component by description using an engraved phenolic nameplate
attached with stainless steel rivets or screws.
Nameplate must be installed:
Page 137 of 183
1. Adjacent to the breaker on the dead front panel. The characters must be a minimum of 1/8 inch high.
2. Adjacent to the component on the back panel.The characters must be a minimum of 1/8 inch high.
3. At the top exterior of the door panel. The nameplate must include the system number, voltage, and
number of phases engraved in minimum 3/16-inch-high characters.
A plastic-laminated wiring diagram must be attached inside the enclosure with brass eyelets by a UL-
listed or NRTL-certified method.
86-1.02P(3) Lighting and Sign Illumination Enclosures
A lighting and sign illumination enclosure must be manufactured from steel and either galvanized,
cadmium plated, or powder coated.
86-1.02Q Cabinets
86-1.02Q(1) General
Cabinets must be factory wired except for battery backup system cabinets.
The fasteners on the exterior of a cabinet, except for battery backup system cabinets, must be removable
and vandal resistant.The exterior screws, nuts, bolts, and washers must be stainless steel.
Terminal blocks, circuit breakers, and a power supply must be UL approved.
86-1.02Q(2) Department-Furnished Controller Cabinets
A Department-furnished controller assembly consists of a Model 170E or 2070E controller unit, a wired
controller cabinet, and all auxiliary equipment required to operate the system. The Department does not
furnish anchor bolts.
86-1.02Q(3) Controller Cabinets
The controller cabinet must be a Model 334L, comply with TEES, and be on the Authorized Material List
for traffic signal control equipment. The cabinet must have 3 drawer shelves. Each shelf must be attached
to the tops of 2 supporting angles with 4 screws.
86-1.02Q(4) Telephone Demarcation Cabinets
86-1.02Q(4)(a) General
The doors of a telephone demarcation cabinet must be attached using continuous stainless steel piano
hinges.
86-1.02Q(4)(b) Type ATelephone Demarcation Cabinets
Reserved
86-1.02Q(4)(c) Type B Telephone Demarcation Cabinets
A Type B telephone demarcation cabinet consists of a mounting panel, outlets, circuit breaker,fan, dead
front plates, and fuse.
The mounting panel must be made of 3/4-inch-thick ACX-grade plywood.
The mounting panel must be fastened to the cabinet with nuts, lock washers, and flat washers to 10
welded studs.
The cabinet must be made of 0.125-inch-thick anodized aluminum.
The cabinet door must be hung and secured with drawn latches, lockable with a padlock.The padlock
latches must each have a minimum 7/16-inch-diameter hole.
Ventilation louvers must be located on the door.
The fan must be located in a ventilator housing and be controlled thermostatically. The thermostat control
must have a range from 80 to 130 degrees F.
The thermostat and fan circuit must be protected with a fuse rated for 175 percent of the motor capacity.
The fan capacity must be a minimum 25 cfm.
Page 138 of 183
86-1.02Q(4)(d) Type C Telephone Demarcation Cabinets
Reserved
86-1.02Q(5) Battery Backup System Cabinets
The cabinet for a battery backup system must comply with TEES and be on the Authorized Material List
for traffic signal control equipment.
86-1.02R Signal Heads
86-1.02R(1) General
A signal head consists of a signal mounting assembly, backplate, and signal face.
The head must have a terminal block attached to the back of one housing. The terminal block must have
enough positions to accommodate all indications. Each position must be permanently labeled for the
indications used.
The metal signal heads must not fracture or deflect more than half the lens diameter when tested under
California Test 666.
The plastic signal heads must not fracture or deflect when tested under California Test 605.
The deflection must not be more than 10 degrees in either the vertical or horizontal plane after the wind
load has been removed from the front of the signal face or more than 6 degrees in either the vertical or
horizontal plane after the wind load has been removed from the back of the signal face.
86-1.02R(2) Signal Mounting Assemblies
Signal mounting assembly must include:
1. 1-1/2-inch-diameter steel pipe or galvanized conduit
2. Pipe fitting made of ductile iron, galvanized steel, bronze, or aluminum alloy,Type AC-8413, no. 380
3. Mast arm and post-top slip fitters and terminal compartments made of cast bronze or hot-dip
galvanized ductile iron
The horizontal distance between the vertical centerlines of the terminal compartment or slip fitter and of
each signal face must not exceed 11 inches except where required for proper signal face alignment or to
allow programming of programmed visibility signal sections.
The mounting assembly must be watertight and free of sharp edges or protrusions that might damage
conductor insulation.The assembly must have positive-locking serrated fittings that prevent signal faces
from rotating when the fittings are mated with similar fittings on the faces.
Each terminal compartment must be fitted with a terminal block having a minimum of 12 positions, each
with 2 screw-type terminals. Each terminal must accommodate at least five no. 14 conductors.The
terminal compartment must have a cover for easy access to the terminal block.
86-1.02R(3) Backplates
The backplate material must be a homogeneous black color with a lusterless finish.
A metal backplate must be made of a minimum 1/16-inch-thick 3001-14 aluminum.
A plastic backplate must have a minimum thickness of 1/16 inch and be formed from sheet plastic or
assembled from extruded, molded, or cast plastic sections. Sections must be factory joined using one of
the following:
1. Appropriate solvent cement.
2. Aluminum rivets and washers painted or permanently colored to match the backplate.
3. No. 10 machine screws with flat washers, lock washers, and nuts painted to match the backplate.
Each plastic backplate must be secured to the plastic signal face such that it resists removal or
permanent deformation.
86-1.02R(4) Signal Faces
Signal face consists of signal sections with signal housings, LED modules, and visors.
Page 139 of 183
Signal face must:
1. Be adjustable and allow for 360-degree rotation about the vertical axis
2. Comply with ITE publications ST-052-E, Vehicle Traffic Control Signal Heads: Light Emitting Diode
(LED) Circular Signal Supplement and ST-054, Vehicle Traffic Control Signal Heads:Light Emitting
Diode(LED) Vehicle Arrow Traffic Signal Supplement
3. Be sealed with a neoprene gasket at the top opening
A metal signal face must have a metal backplate and visor.
A plastic signal face must have a plastic backplate and visor.
If a signal face is supported by a Type MAS slip fitter, spacers are required between the 2 sections. The
spacers must be made of the same material as the housing. The vertical dimension of the spacers must
allow proper seating of the serrations between the slip fitter and the 2 sections.The 2 sections must be
joined with at least two no. 10 minimum machine screws through holes near the front of the housing and
the spacers and matching holes in a reinforcing plate installed in the housing.
86-1.02R(4)(a) Signal Sections
86-1.02R(4)(a)(i) General
Signal section must have:
1 Opening at the top and bottom for a 1-1/2-inch pipe
2. Maximum height of 10-1/4 inches for an 8-inch section and 14-3/4 inches for a 12-inch section
3. Hinge pins, door-latching devices, and other exposed hardware manufactured of Type 304/304L or
305 stainless steel
4. Interior screws and fittings manufactured of stainless steel or steel with a corrosion-resistant plating
or coating
5. Gaskets made of a material that is not degraded if installed in a section with metal or plastic housing
Sections must be capable of being joined together to form a signal face in any combination.This
interchangeability is not required between metal and plastic sections.
Each section must be joined to an adjacent section by one of the following:
1. Minimum of 3 machine screws for 8-inch sections and 4 machine screws for 12-inch sections,
installed through holes near the front and back of the housing. Each screw must be a no. 10 and have
a nut,flat washer, and lock washer.
2. 2 machine screws, each with a nut, flat washer, and lock washer, installed through holes near the
front of the housing and a fastener through the 1-1/2-inch pipe opening.The fastener must have 2
large,flat washers to distribute the load around the pipe's opening and 3 carriage bolts, each with a
nut and lock washer. The minimum screw size must be no. 10, and the carriage bolt size must be 1/4
inch.
The holes for the machine screws must be either cast or drilled during signal section fabrication. Each
hole must be surrounded by a minimum 1/8-inch-wide boss to allow contact between signal sections
about the axis of the hole.
A serrated nylon washer must be inserted between each plastic signal section and the metal mounting
assembly. Each serrated nylon washer must be from 3/16 to 1/4 inch thick. The serrations must match
those on the signal section and the mounting assembly.
86-1.02R(4)(a)(ii) Programmed Visibility Signal Sections
Programmed visibility signal section must have:
1. Nominal 12-inch-diameter circular or arrow indication
2. Cap visor
3. Adjustable connection that:
3.1. Provides incremental tilting from 0 to 10 degrees above or below the horizontal
3.2. Maintains a common vertical axis through couplers and mountings
Page 140 of 183
The terminal connection must allow external adjustment about the mounting axis in 5-degree increments.
The visibility of each signal section must be capable of adjustment or programming within the section.
The adjustment for the section must be preset at 4 degrees below the horizontal.
86-1.02R(4)(a)(iii) Signal Housings
The signal housing must:
1. Be die-cast aluminum, permanent mold-cast aluminum, or if specified, structural plastic
2. Comply with ITE publications ST-052-E, Vehicle Traffic Control Signal Heads:Light Emitting Diode
(LED) Circular Signal Supplement and ST-054, Vehicle Traffic Control Signal Heads:Light Emitting
Diode (LED) Vehicle Arrow Traffic Signal Supplement if made of die-cast or permanent mold-cast
aluminum
3. Have a 1-piece, hinged, square-shaped door that is:
3.1. Designed to allow access for replacement of modules without the use of tools
3.2. Secured such that it remains closed during loading tests
4. Have a watertight module or lens mounted in the door
5. Have a terminal block attached to the back,with the terminals permanently labeled for conductors to
facilitate field wiring
Each housing must have reinforcement plates. Reinforcement plates must be either sheet aluminum,
galvanized steel, or cast aluminum. Each plate must have a minimum thickness of 0.11 inch and a hole
concentric with a 1-1/2-inch pipe-mounting hole in the housing. Reinforcement plates must be placed as
specified in the following table:
Reinforcement Plate Placement
Material Placement
Sheet aluminum Inside and outside of housing
Galvanized steel Inside of housing
Cast aluminum Outside of housing
Reinforcement plates placed outside of the housing must be finished to match the signal housing color
and be designed to allow a proper serrated coupling between the signal face and the mounting hardware.
A minimum of three no. 10 machine screws must be installed through holes in each plate and matching
holes in the housing. Each screw must have a round or binder head, a nut, and a lock washer.
A metal housing must have a metal visor.
Plastic housing must:
1. Be molded in a single piece or fabricated from 2 or more pieces joined into a single piece
2. Be a black color throughout, including the door, matching color no. 17038, 27038, or 37038 of FED-
STD-595
3. Have UV stability
4. Be self-extinguishing
If reinforcing webs are used to connect the back of the housing to the top, bottom, and sides of the
adjacent housing, reinforcement plates are not required.
The exterior of the housing must be painted as specified in sections 78-4.08 and 59.
86-1.02R(4)(b) LED Signal Modules
An LED signal module must be on the Authorized Material List for LED traffic signal modules.
An LED signal module must comply with ITE publications ST-052-E, Vehicle Traffic Control Signal Heads:
Light Emitting Diode (LED) Circular Signal Supplement and ST-054, Vehicle Traffic Control Signal Heads:
Light Emitting Diode (LED) Vehicle Arrow Traffic Signal Supplement, except:
1. Maximum module weight must be 4 lb
2. Module must be a sealed unit with:
Page 141 of 183
2.1. 2 color-coded conductors for the power connection except lane control modules must use 3
color-coded conductors
2.2. Printed circuit board that complies with TEES, chapter 1, section 6
2.3. Lens that is:
2.3.1. Convex or flat with a smooth outer surface
2.3.2. Made of UV-stabilized plastic or glass
2.4. 1-piece EPDM gasket
3. Module must include 3-foot-long conductors with attached quick-disconnect terminals
4. Identification must include:
4.1. Month and year of manufacture
4.2. 1-inch-diameter symbol of the module type with the module color written adjacent to the
symbol in 0.50-inch-high letters
5 LED must be the ultra-bright type rated for 100,000 hours of continuous operation
6. Module must have an integral power supply
Individual LEDs must be wired such that a loss or failure of 1 LED will not result in a loss of more than 5
percent of the module's light output. Failure of an individual LED in a string must not result in a loss of an
entire string or other indication.
The symbol for a 12-inch U-turn section must be a 15/16-inch-wide inverted U with an arrow on the left
end.
A lane control section must be a combination module with a red Xand green arrow. The conductor
function and color code must be as shown in the following table:
Conductor Function and Color Code
Function Color
Neutral White
Red X Red
Green arrow Brown
The minimum power consumption for an LED signal module must be 5 W.
The maximum power consumption for an LED signal module must be as shown in the following table:
Maximum Power Consumption
LED signal module Power consumption W
Red Yellow Green
type 25°C 74 °C 25 °C 74 °C 25°C 74 °C
8-inch circular 8 13 13 16 12 12
12-inch circular 11 17 22 25 15 15
12-inch arrow 9 12 10 12 11 11
12-inch U-turn 9 12 10 12 11 11
Bicycle 11 17 22 25 15 15
Programmed visibility 11 17 22 25 15 15
Lane control (X) 9 12 -- -- -- --
Lane control (Arrow) -- -- -- -- 11 11
Red and green LED signal modules operating over a temperature range from -40 to 74 degrees C and
yellow LED signal modules operating at 25 degrees C must maintain the minimum illumination values for
48 months as shown in the following tables:
Page 142 of 183
Minimum Maintained Intensities for Circular Indications
Intensities cd
8-inch 12-inch
Angle(v,h) Red Yellow Green Red Yellow Green
2.5 ±2.5 133 267 267 339 678 678
2.5, ±7.5 97 194 194 251 501 501
2.5, ±12.5 57 113 113 141 283 283
2.5, ±17.5 25 48 48 77 154 154
7.5, ±2.5 101 202 202 226 452 452
7.5, ±7.5 89 178 178 202 404 404
7.5, ±12.5 65 129 129 145 291 291
7.5, ±17.5 41 81 81 89 178 178
7.5, ±22.5 18 37 37 38 77 77
7.5, ±27.5 10 20 20 16 32 32
12.5, ±2.5 37 73 73 50 101 101
12.5, ±7.5 32 65 65 48 97 97
12.5, ±12.5 28 57 57 44 89 89
12.5, ±17.5 20 41 41 34 69 69
12.5, ±22.5 12 25 25 22 44 44
12.5, ±27.5 9 16 16 16 32 32
17.5, ±2.5 16 32 32 22 44 44
17.5, ±7.5 14 28 28 22 44 44
17.5, ±12.5 10 20 20 22 44 44
17.5, ±17.5 9 16 16 22 44 44
17.5, ±22.5 6 12 12 20 41 41
17.5, ±27.5 4 9 9 16 32 32
Minimum Maintained Luminance for Indications
Indication type Luminance(fL)
Red Yellow Green
Arrow 1,610 3,210 3,210
U-turn 1,610 3,210 3,210
Bicycle 1,610 1,610 1,610
Lane control (X) 1,610 -- --
Lane control (Arrow) -- -- 1,610
Minimum Maintained Luminance for Programmed Visibility Indications
Luminance cd
Indication type Red Yellow Green
PV at angle v=2.5, h=±2.5 314 314 314
Conductors must be prewired to the terminal block.
86-1.02R(4)(c) Visors and Directional Louvers
The visor must be a tunnel type.
The visor must have a downward tilt from 3 to 7 degrees with a minimum length of 9-1/2 inches for
nominal 12-inch round lenses and 7 inches for nominal 8-inch round lenses.
A metal visor must be formed from minimum 0.050-inch-thick aluminum alloy sheet.
A plastic visor must be either formed from sheet plastic or blow-molded. The plastic must be a black
homogeneous color with a lusterless finish. A visor must withstand a wind load applied to its side for 24
Page 143 of 183
hours without permanent deformation or removal from its door when tested under California Test 605 for
plastic visors and California Test 666 for metal visors.
If directional louvers are used, the louvers must fit into full-circular signal visors. Louvers must consist of
one of the following:
1. Outside cylinder constructed of sheet steel with a minimum nominal thickness of 0.030 inch and
vanes constructed of sheet steel with a minimum nominal thickness of 0.016 inch.
2. Outside cylinder and vanes constructed of 5052-1-132 aluminum alloy of equal thickness.
86-1.02S Pedestrian Signal Heads
86-1.02S(1) General
A pedestrian signal head consists of a pedestrian signal mounting assembly and a pedestrian signal face
comprising of a pedestrian signal housing, an LED countdown pedestrian signal face module, and a front
screen.
86-1.02S(2) Pedestrian Signal Mounting Assemblies
A pedestrian signal mounting assembly must comply with the specifications for a signal mounting
assembly in section 86-1.02R, except mast arm slip fitters are not required.
86-1.02S(3) Pedestrian Signal Faces
86-1.02S(3)(a) General
Each pedestrian signal face must include a light-duty terminal block rated at 5 A and have 12 positions
with no. 6-by-1/8-inch binder head screws. Each position must have 1 screw-type terminal.
The wiring and terminal block must comply with ITE publication ST-055-E, Pedestrian Traffic Control
Signal Indicators:Light Emitting Diode (LED) Signal Modules.
86-1.02S(3)(b) Pedestrian Signal Housings
Pedestrian signal housing must comply with the specifications for a signal housing in 86-1.02R(4)(a)(iii),
except the maximum overall dimensions must be 18-1/2 inches wide, 19 inches high, and 11-1/2 inches
deep and without:
1. Visor
2. Watertight module or lens mounted in the door
3. Reinforcement plates
The housing must have a terminal block attached to the back. The terminal block must have enough
positions to accommodate all indications. Each position must be permanently labeled for the indications
used.
86-1.02S(3)(c) LED Countdown Pedestrian Signal Face Modules
An LED countdown PSF module must comply with ITE publication ST-055-E, Pedestrian Traffic Control
Signal Indicators:Light Emitting Diode (LED) Signal Modules, except the material must comply with
ASTM D3935 and the module must have:
1. Ultra-bright-type LED rated for 100,000 hours of continuous operation.
2. Lot number and month and year of manufacture permanently marked on the back of the module
3. Prominent and permanent vertical markings for accurate indexing and orientation within the
pedestrian signal housing if a specific mounting orientation is required. Markings must be a minimum
of 1 inch in height and include an up arrow and the word up or top.
4. Circuit board complying with TEES, chapter 1, section 6.
Individual LEDs must be wired such that a loss or failure of 1 LED will not result in a loss of more than 5
percent of the module's light output. Failure of an individual LED in a string must not result in a loss of an
entire string or other indication.
Each symbol must be at least 9 inches high and 5-1/4 inches wide. The 2-digit countdown timer, Upraised
Hand, and Walking Person indications must be electronically isolated from each other.The 3 indications
must not share a power supply or interconnect circuitry.
Page 144 of 183
The module must operate over the specified ambient temperature and voltage range and be readable
both day and night at distances up to the full width of the area to be crossed. Upon initial testing at 25
degrees C,the module must have at least the luminance values shown in the following table:
Luminance Values
PSF module symbol Luminance
Upraised hand and 2- 1,094
digit countdown timer fL
Walking person fL 1,547
The module must not exceed the power consumption requirements shown in the following table:
Maximum Power Consumption Requirements
PSF module display At 24°C At 74°C
Upraised Hand 10.0 W 12.0 W
Walking Person 9.0 W 12.0 W
2-digit countdown timer 6.0 W 8.0 W
86-1.02S(3)(d) Front Screen
Pedestrian signal face must have a front screen that is one of the following types:
1. 3/8-inch-thick aluminum honeycomb screen with 0.2-inch-wide cells or a 1/2-inch-thick plastic screen
with 3/8-inch-wide squares with 1/1 6-inch wall thickness that:
1.1. Is installed so it tilts downward at an angle of 15±2 degrees from the top and completely
covers the message plate.
1.2. Includes a clear front cover made of either a minimum 1/8-inch-thick acrylic plastic sheet or a
minimum 1/1 6-inch-thick polycarbonate plastic.
1.3. Is held firmly in place, including the cover, with stainless steel or aluminum clips or stainless
steel metal screws.
2. Polycarbonate screen that:
2.1. Has a nominal thickness of 1/32 inch.
2.2. Is a 1-1/2-inch-deep eggcrate or Z-crate type.
2.3. Is mounted in a frame constructed of aluminum alloy or polycarbonate with a minimum
thickness of 0.040 inch.
2.4. Is held in place with stainless steel screws.
The screen and frame of a pedestrian signal face must be made of either(1) plastic that is a flat black
color or(2)anodized aluminum that is a flat black color or finished with lusterless, black, exterior-grade
latex paint formulated for application to metal surfaces.
86-1.02T Accessible Pedestrian Signals
Accessible pedestrian signal must comply with the California MUTCD, chapter 4E, and have:
1. Audible speech message that plays when the push button is actuated. The message must include the
name of the street to be crossed. The accessible pedestrian signal must have at least 5 audible
message options.
2. Push button locator tone that clicks or beeps.
3. Feature that activates the pedestrian phase during a failure of the audible message, locator tone, or
vibrotactile device.
An accessible pedestrian signal must function with the Department-furnished Model 170E/2070E
controller assembly.
No part of the accessible pedestrian signal must be installed inside the controller cabinet.
Power for the accessible pedestrian signal must be from the pedestrian signal housing terminal block.
The housing for the signal assembly must be made of corrosion-resistant material. Theft-proof bolts used
for mounting the housing to the standard must be stainless steel with a content of 17 percent chromium
and 8 percent nickel.The housing must be shaped to fit the pole's curvature.
Page 145 of 183
The color of a metallic housing must match color no. 33538 of FED-STD-595.
The color of a plastic housing must match color no. 17038, 27038, or 37038 of FED-STD-595.
Accessible pedestrian signal must:
1. Have electronic switches, a potentiometer, or an access port for a device for controlling and
programming the volume level and messaging
2. Be weatherproof and shockproof
Enclosure for the accessible pedestrian signal must:
1. Weigh less than 7 lb
2. Measure less than 16 by 6 by 5 inches
3. Have a wiring hole with a diameter not exceeding 1-1/8 inches
5. Have a switch for a push button
6. Have a vibrotactile device on the push button or on the arrow
7. Have an internal weatherproof speaker and microphone that senses the ambient sound level
The separation between adjacent holes used for conductors and mounting must be at least twice the
diameter of the larger hole.
The speaker grills must be located on the surface of the enclosure. The speakers must not interfere with
the housing or its mounting hardware.
The conductor cable between the accessible pedestrian signal assembly and the pedestrian signal head
must be a 9 no. 20 conductor cable complying with MIL-W-16878D.
86-1.02U Push Button Assemblies
The housing for a push button assembly must be made of die-cast aluminum, permanent mold-cast
aluminum, or UV-stabilized self-extinguishing structural plastic.The plastic housing must have a color
throughout that matches color no. 17038, 27038, or 37038 of FED-STD-595.
If the push button is to be attached to a pole,the housing must be shaped to fit the pole's curvature.
The assembly must be waterproof and shockproof.
The push button's switch must be a single-pole, double-throw switching unit with screw-type terminals
rated 15 A at 125 V(ac).
Switch for the push button must have:
1. Plunger actuator and a U frame to allow recessed mounting in the push button housing
2. Operating force of 3.5 lb
3. Maximum pretravel of 5/64 inch
4. Minimum overtravel of 1/32 inch
5. Differential travel from 0.002 to 0.04 inch
6. Minimum 2-inch diameter actuator
86-1.02V Reserved
86-1.02W Loop Detector Sealants
86-1.02W(1) General
Sealant for filling loop detector slots must be one of the following:
1. Asphaltic emulsion
2. Elastomeric sealant
3. Epoxy sealant for inductive loops
4. Hot-melt rubberized asphalt
86-1.02W(2) Asphaltic Emulsion Sealant
Asphaltic emulsion sealant must comply with the State Specification 8040-41A-15.
Page 146 of 183
86-1.02W(3) Elastomeric Sealant
Elastomeric sealant must be a polyurethane material that cures only in the presence of moisture if used
within the stated shelf life. The sealant must be suitable for use in both asphalt concrete and concrete
pavement.
The cured elastomeric sealant must comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Cured Elastomeric Sealant Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Hardness ASTM D22403 65-85
Tensile strength (min, MPa) ASTM D412b 3.45
Elongation (min, %) 400
Flex at-40 °C° -- No cracks
Weathering resistance ASTM D822 Slight chalking
Salt spray resistance:
Tensile strength (min, MPa) ASTM B117e 3.45
Elongation (min, %) 400
Dielectric constant(%) ASTM D150 <25
Indentation at 25°C and 50% relative humidity(Rex. Type A, Model 1700 only)
bDie C pulled at 508 mm/minute
°0.6-mm free film bend (180°)over 13-mm mandrel
dWeatherometer 350 h, cured 7 days at 25 °C and 50% relative humidity
e28 days at 38 °C with 5% NaCl, Die C, and pulled at 508 mm/minute)
(Change over a temperature range from -30 to 50 °C
86-1.02W(4) Hot-Melt Rubberized Asphalt Sealant
Hot-melt rubberized asphalt sealant must:
1. Be in solid form at room temperature and fluid at an application temperature range from 190 to 205
degrees C
2. Not produce toxic fumes
3. Be suitable for use in both asphalt concrete and concrete pavement
4. Be packaged in containers clearly marked Detector Loop Sealant with the manufacturer's batch and
lot number.
The cured hot-melt rubberized asphalt sealant must comply with the requirements shown in the following
table:
Cured Hot-Melt Rubberized Asphalt Sealant Requirements
Quality characteristic Test method Requirement
Cone penetration (max, 1/10 mm) ASTM D5329, sec. 6a 35
Flow(max, mm) ASTM D5329, sec. 8b 5
Resilience (min, %) ASTM D5329, sec. 12° 25
Softening point(min, °C) ASTM D36 82
Ductility(min, cm) ASTM D113d 30
Flash point, Cleveland Open Cup (min, °C) ASTM D92 288
Viscosity(Pa-s) ASTM D4402e 2.5-3.5
aAt 25 °C, 150 g, 5 s
')At 60 °C
°At 25 °C
dAt 25°C, 5 cm/minute
eBrookfield Thermosel, no. 27 spindle, 20 rpm, 190°C
86-1.02X Reserved
86-1.02Y Transformers
A transformer must be single-phase and may be a nonsubmersible or submersible type.
Page 147 of 183
A transformer must be a dry type designed for operation on a 60 Hz supply. The transformer must have a
decal showing a connection diagram. The diagram must show either color coding or wire tagging with
primary(H 1, H2)or secondary(X1,X2)markers and the primary and secondary voltage and volt-ampere
rating.A transformer must comply with the electrical requirements shown in the following table:
Transformer Electrical Requirements
Quality characteristic Requirement
Rating(V(ac)) 120/480, 120/240,240/480, or
480/120
Efficiency % >95
Secondary voltage regulation and tolerance from half load to full ±3
load
Secondary 240 and 480 V(ac)windings must be center tapped.
The transformer must withstand the application of 2,200 V(ac)from core to coils and from coil to coil for a
1-minute period when tested immediately after operation of the transformer at full load for 24 hours.
The external leads for the secondary connections must be no. 10 Type USE rated for 600 V(ac).
The transformer's leads must extend a minimum of 12 inches from the case.
The transformer's insulation must be NEMA 185 C or better.
Each transformer must:
1. Include metal half-shell coil protection.
2. Have moisture-resistant,synthetic-varnish-impregnated windings.
3. Be waterproof and suitable for outdoor operation.
Each submersible transformer must:
1. Include a handle and a hanger.
2. Be securely encased in a rugged, corrosion-resistant,watertight case.
3. Have leads that extend out through 1 or more sealed hubs.
4. Be manufactured to withstand a 5-day test with 12-hour on and off periods submerged in 2 feet of salt
water that is 2 percent salt by weight. The operating periods must be at full load.
86-1.02Z Batteries
Battery must:
1. Be deep-cycle,sealed, prismatic, lead-calcium-based,absorbed-glass-mat,valve-regulated, lead-
acid type
2. Be rated for 12 V
3. Be rated for a temperature range from -25 to 60 degrees C
4. Be group size 24
5. Be commercially available and stocked locally
6. Be marked with a date code, maximum recharge data, and recharge cycles
7. Be new and fully charged when furnished
8. Be free from damage or deformities
9. Have a carrying handle
10. Have 2 top-mounted, threaded-stud posts that include all washers and nuts
11. Include insulating rubber covers for protecting the lugs, posts, and wiring: red for the positive terminal
and black for the negative terminal
If a battery is used for a battery backup system, it must accommodate 3/8-inch ring lugs of a Department-
furnished battery harness.
86-1.03 CONSTRUCTION
Not Used
Page 148 of 183
86-1.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
Replace section 87 with:
04-15-16
87 ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS
04-15-16
87-1 GENERAL
87-1.01 GENERAL
87-1.01A Summary
Section 87 includes general specifications for constructing and installing electrical systems.
The Department deducts the cost for maintenance performed by the Department on new or portions of
existing systems modified under the Contract.
87-1.0113 Definitions
Reserved
87-1.01C Submittals
Reserved
87-1.01 D Quality Assurance
87-1.01D(1) General
Reserved
87-1.01 D(2) Quality Control
Before shipping the material to the job site, submit to METS test samples of:
1. Accessible pedestrian signals
2. LED countdown pedestrian signal face modules
3. LED signal modules
4. LED luminaires
Submit a sample size as shown in the following table:
Electrical Material Sampling
Contract quantity Test sample size
1-8 1
9-15 2
16-25 3
26-90 5
91-150 8
151-280 13
281-500 20
501-1200 32
Before starting operation of an electrical system, perform a conductor test in the presence of the
Engineer.
Conductor test consists of testing each conductor and the conductors in cables for:
Page 149 of 183
1. Continuity.
2. Grounds.
3. Insulation resistance at 500 V(dc) between the circuit and ground. The insulation resistance must be
a minimum of 10 M0 on circuits, except it must be a minimum of 100 Mn for inductive loop detector
circuits.
Start the operational test of the system on any day except Friday or the day before a holiday. The
operational test for signals must start from 9:00 a.m.to 2:00 p.m. Notify the Engineer 48 hours before
starting the test.
An operational test consists of a minimum of 5 business days of continuous, satisfactory operation of the
system. If the system fails, correct the problem and retest the system.A shutdown of the system caused
by traffic, a power interruption, or unsatisfactory performance of Department-furnished materials does not
constitute discontinuity of the test.
87-1.02 MATERIALS
Not Used
87-1.03 CONSTRUCTION
87-1.03A General
The Engineer determines the final locations of electrical systems.
Verify the locations of electrical systems and the depths of existing detectors, conduits, and pull boxes.
Notify the Engineer before performing work on the existing system.
You may shut down the system for alteration or removal.
Where an existing Department underground facility is shown within 10 feet of any excavation, locate and
field mark the facility before performing work that could damage or interfere with the existing facility.
If an existing facility is within 2 feet of an excavation, determine the exact location of the facility by
excavating with hand tools before using any power-operated or power-driven excavating or boring
equipment.A vacuum excavator may be used if authorized.
Notify the Engineer immediately if an existing facility is damaged by your activities.
If existing underground conduit is to be incorporated into a new system, clean it with a mandrel or
cylindrical wire brush and blow it clean with compressed air.
Limit the shutdown of traffic signal systems to normal working hours. Notify the local traffic enforcement
agency before shutting down the signal.
Place temporary W3-1 and R1-1 signs in each direction to direct traffic through the intersection during
shutdown of the signal. Place two R1-1 signs for 2-lane approaches.The signs must comply with part 2 of
the California MUTCD.
Cover signal faces when the system is shut down overnight. Cover temporary W3-1 and R1-1 signs when
the system is turned on.
If you work on an existing lighting system and the roadway is to remain open to traffic, ensure the system
is in operation by nightfall.
Replace detectors you damage within 72 hours, or the Department replaces them and deducts the cost.
Work performed on an existing system not described is change order work.
Do not use electrical power from existing highway facilities unless authorized.
Maintain a minimum 48-inch clearance for a pedestrian pathway when placing equipment.
Except for service installation or work on service equipment enclosures, do not work above ground until
all materials are on hand to complete the electrical work at each location.
Page 150 of 183
Bond all metal components to form a continuous grounded system as specified in NEC.
Ground metallic equipment mounted less than 8 feet above the ground surface on a wood pole.
If you damage any portion of a concrete curb, sidewalk, curb ramp, driveway, or gutter depression,
replace the entire section between contraction or expansion joints under section 73.
Apply equipment identification characters.
Orient louvers, visors, and signal faces such that they are clearly visible to approaching traffic from the
direction being controlled.
Test loops and the detector lead-in cable circuit for continuity, ground, and insulation resistance at the
controller cabinet before connecting detector lead-in cable to the terminal block.
Perform an operational test of the systems.
Before starting the operational test for systems that impact traffic,the system must be ready for operation,
and all signs, pavement delineation, and pavement markings must be in place at that location.
87-1.03113 Conduit Installation
87-1.0313(1) General
The installation of conduit includes installing caps, bushings, and pull tape and terminating the conduit in
pull boxes,foundations, poles, or a structure.
Limit the number of bends in a conduit run to no more than 360 degrees between pull points.
Use conduit to enclose conductors except where they are installed overhead or inside standards or posts.
You may use a larger size conduit than specified for the entire length between termination points. Do not
use a reducing coupling.
Extend an existing conduit using the same material.Terminate conduits of different materials in a pull
box.
Install 2 conduits between a controller cabinet and the adjacent pull box.
Use a minimum trade size of conduit of:
1. 1-1/2 inches from an electrolier to the adjacent pull box
2. 1 inch from a pedestrian push button post to the adjacent pull box
3. 2 inches from a signal standard to the adjacent pull box
4. 3 inches from a controller cabinet to the adjacent pull box
5. 2 inches from an overhead sign to the adjacent pull box
6. 2 inches from a service equipment enclosure to the adjacent pull box
7. 1-1/2 inches if unspecified
Use Type 1 conduit:
1. On all exposed surfaces
2. In concrete structures
3. Between a structure and the nearest pull box
Ream the ends of shop-cut and field-cut conduit to remove burrs and rough edges. Make the cuts square
and true. Do not use slip joints and running threads to couple conduit. If a standard coupling cannot be
used for metal-type conduit, use a threaded union coupling.Tighten the couplings for metal conduit to
maintain a good electrical connection.
Cap the ends of conduit to prevent debris from entering before installing the conductors or cables. Use a
plastic cap for Type 1, 2, and 5 conduits and a standard pipe cap for all other types of conduit.
For Type 1, 2, and 5 conduits, use threaded bushings and bond them using a jumper. For other types of
conduit, use nonmetallic bushings.
Page 151 of 183
Do not install new conduit through foundations.
Cut Type 2 conduit with pipe cutters; do not use hacksaws. Use standard conduit-threading dies for
threading conduit. Tighten conduit into couplings or fittings using strap wrenches or approved groove joint
pliers.
Cut Type 3 conduit with tools that do not deform the conduit. Use a solvent weld for connections.
Protect shop-cut threads from corrosion under the standards shown in the following table:
Shop-Cut Thread Corrosion Protection
Conduit Standard
Types 1 and 2 ANSI C80.1
Type 5 ANSI C80.6
Apply 2 coats of unthinned, organic zinc-rich primer to metal conduit before painting. Use a primer on the
Authorized Material List for organic zinc-rich primers. Do not use aerosol cans. Do not remove shop-
installed conduit couplings.
For conduits, paint:
1. All exposed threads
2. Field-cut threads, before installing conduit couplings to metal conduit
3. Damaged surfaces on metal conduit
If a Type 2 conduit or conduit coupling coating is damaged:
1. Clean the conduit or fitting and paint it with 1 coat of rubber-resin-based adhesive under the
manufacturer's instructions
2. Wrap the damaged coating with at least 1 layer of 2-inch-wide, 20 mils-minimum-thickness, PVC tape
under ASTM D1000 with a minimum tape overlap of 1/2 inch
You may repair damaged spots of 1/4 inch or less in diameter in the thermoplastic coating by painting
with a brushing-type compound supplied by the conduit manufacturer.
If factory bends are not used, bend the conduit to a radius no less than 6 times its inside diameter without
crimping or flattening it. Comply with the bending requirements shown in the following table:
Conduit-Bending Requirements
Type Requirement
1 Use equipment and methods under the conduit manufacturer's instructions.
2 Use a standard bending tool designed for use on thermoplastic-coated conduit.The
conduit must be free of burrs and pits.
3 Use equipment and methods under the conduit manufacturer's instructions. Do not
expose the conduit to a direct flame.
5 Use equipment and methods under the conduit manufacturer's instructions.
Install pull tape with at least 2 feet of slack in each end of the conduit that will remain empty. Attach the
tape's ends to the conduit.
Install conduit terminating in a standard or pedestal from 2 to 3 inches above the foundation. Slope the
conduit toward the handhole opening.
Terminate conduit installed through the bottom of a nonmetallic pull box 2 inches above the bottom and 2
inches from the wall closest to the direction of the run.
87-1.03B(2) Conduit Installation for Structures
87-1.03B(2)(a) General
Paint exposed Type 1 conduit the same color as the structure.
Page 152 of 183
Install galvanized steel hangers, steel brackets, and other fittings to support conduit in or on a wall or
bridge.
87-1.03B(2)(b) New Structures
Seal and make watertight the conduits which lead to soffits,wall-mounted luminaires, other lights, and
fixtures located below the pull box grade.
If you place a conduit through the side of a nonmetallic pull box, terminate the conduit 2 inches from the
wall and 2 inches above the bottom. Slope the conduit toward the top of the box to facilitate pulling
conductors.
For ease of installation and if authorized, you may use Type 4 conduit instead of Type 1 conduit for the
final 2 feet of conduit entering a pull box in a reinforced concrete structure.
Install an expansion fitting where a conduit crosses an expansion joint in a structure. Each expansion
fitting for metal conduit must include a copper bonding jumper having the ampacity as specified in NEC.
Install an expansion-deflection fitting for an expansion joint with a 1-1/2-inch movement rating.The fitting
must be watertight and include a molded neoprene sleeve, a bonding jumper, and 2 silicon bronze or
zinc-plated iron hubs.
For an expansion joint with a movement rating greater than 1-1/2 inches, install the expansion-deflection
fitting as shown.
For conduit installed inside of bridge structures, you must:
1. Install precast concrete cradles made of minor concrete and commercial-quality welded wire fabric.
The minor concrete must contain a minimum of 590 lb of cementitious material per cubic yard. The
cradles must be moist cured for a minimum of 3 days.
2. Bond precast concrete cradles to a wall or bridge superstructure with one of the following:
2.1. Epoxy adhesive for bonding freshly-mixed concrete to hardened concrete.
2.2. Rapid-set epoxy adhesive for pavement markers.
2.3. Standard-set epoxy adhesive for pavement markers.
3. Use a pipe sleeve or form an opening for a conduit through a bridge superstructure.The sleeve or
opening through a prestressed member or conventionally reinforced precast member must be:
3.1. Oriented transverse to the member.
3.2. Located through the web.
3.3. No more than 4 inches in size.
4. Wrap the conduit with 2 layers of asphalt felt building paper and securely tape or wire the paper in
place for a conduit passing through a bridge abutment wall. Fill the space around the conduit with
mortar under section 51-1, except the proportion of cementitious material to sand must be 1 to 3. Fill
the space around the conduits after prestressing is completed.
Thread and cap a conduit installed for future use in structures. Mark the location of the conduit's end in a
structure, curb, or wall directly above the conduit with a Ythat is 3 inches tall.
87-1.03B(2)(c) Existing Structures
Run surface-mounted conduit straight and true, horizontal or vertical on the wall, and parallel to walls on
ceilings or similar surfaces. Support the conduit at a maximum of 5-foot intervals where needed to
prevent vibration or deflection. Support the conduit using galvanized, malleable-iron, conduit clamps, and
clamp backs secured with expansion anchorage devices complying with section 75-3.02C. Use the
largest diameter of galvanized,threaded studs that will pass through the mounting hole in the conduit
clamp.
87-1.03B(3) Conduit Installation Underground
87-1.03B(3)(a) General
Install conduit to a depth of:
1. 14 inches for the trench-in-pavement method
2. 18 inches, minimum, under sidewalk and curbed paved median areas
3. 42 inches, minimum, below the bottom of the rail of railroad tracks
Page 153 of 183
4. 30 inches, minimum, everywhere else below grade
Place conduit couplings at a minimum of 6 inches from the face of a foundation.
Place a minimum of 2 inches of sand bedding in a trench before installing Type 2 or Type 3 conduit and 4
inches of sand bedding over the conduit before placing additional backfill material.
If installing conduit within the limits of hazardous locations as specified in NEC for Class I, division 1,
install and seal Type 1 or Type 2 conduit with explosion-proof sealing fittings.
87-1.03B(3)(b) Conduit Installation under Paved Surfaces
You may lay conduit on existing pavement within a new curbed median constructed on top.
Install conduit under existing pavement by the jacking or drilling methods. You may use the trench-in-
pavement method for either of the following conditions:
1. If conduit is to be installed behind the curb under the sidewalk
2. If the delay to vehicles will be less than 5 minutes
Do not use the trench-in-pavement method for conduit installations under freeway lanes or freeway-to-
freeway connector ramps.
87-1.03B(3)(c) Reserved
87-1.03B(3)(d) Conduit Installation under Railroad Tracks
Install Type 1 or Type 2 conduit with a minimum diameter of 1-1/2 inches under railroad tracks. If you use
the jacking or drilling method to install the conduit, construct the jacking pit a minimum of 13 feet from the
tracks'centerline at the near side of the pit. Cover the jacking pit with planking if left overnight.
87-1.03B(4) Reserved
87-1.03B(5) Conduit Installation by the Jacking or Drilling Method
Keep the jacking or drilling pit 2 feet away from the pavement's edge. Do not weaken the pavement or
soften the subgrade with excessive use of water.
If an obstruction is encountered, obtain authorization to cut small holes in the pavement to locate or
remove the obstruction.
You may install Type 2 or Type 3 conduit under the pavement if a hole larger than the conduit's diameter
is predrilled.The predrilled hole must be less than one and half the conduit's diameter.
Remove the conduit used for drilling or jacking and install new conduit for the completed work.
87-1.03B(6) Conduit Installation by the Trenching-In-Pavement Method
Install conduit by the trenching-in-pavement method using a trench approximately 2 inches wider than the
conduit's outside diameter but not exceeding 6 inches in width.
Where additional pavement is to be placed, you must complete the trenching before the final pavement
layer is applied.
If the conduit shown is to be installed under the sidewalk, you may install it in the street within 3 feet of
and parallel to the face of the curb. Install pull boxes behind the curb.
Cut the trench using a rock-cutting excavator. Minimize the shatter outside the removal area of the trench.
Dig the trench by hand to the required depth at pull boxes.
Place conduit in the trench.
Backfill the trench with minor concrete to the pavement's surface by the end of each work day. If the
trench is in asphalt concrete pavement and no additional pavement is to be placed, backfill the top 0.10
foot of the trench with minor HMA within 3 days after trenching.
Page 154 of 183
87-1.03C Installation of Pull Boxes
87-1.03C(1) General
Install pull boxes no more than 200 feet apart.
You may install larger pull boxes than specified or shown and additional pull boxes to facilitate the work
except in structures.
Install a pull box on a bed of crushed rock and grout it before installing conductors. The grout must be
from 0.5 to 1 inch thick and sloped toward the drain hole. Place a layer of roofing paper between the grout
and the crushed rock sump. Make a 1-inch drain hole through the grout at the center of the pull box.
Set the pull box such that the top is 1-1/4 inches above the surrounding grade in unpaved areas and
leveled with the finished grade in sidewalks and other paved areas.
Place the cover on the box when not working in it.
Grout around conduits that are installed through the sides of the pull box.
Bond and ground the metallic conduit before installing conductors and cables in the conduit.
Bond metallic conduits in a nonmetallic pull box using bonding bushings and bonding jumpers.
Do not install pull boxes in concrete pads, curb ramps, or driveways.
Reconstruct the sump of a pull box if disturbed by your activities. If the sump was grouted, remove and
replace the grout.
87-1.03C(2) Nontraffic Pull Boxes
If you bury a nontraffic pull box, set the box such that the top is 6 to 8 inches below the surrounding
grade. Place a 20-mil-thick plastic sheet made of HDPE or PVC virgin compounds to prevent water from
entering the box.
Place mortar between a nontraffic pull box and a pull box extension.
Where a nontraffic pull box is in the vicinity of curb in an unpaved area, place the box adjacent to the
back of the curb if practical.
Where a nontraffic pull box is adjacent to a post or standard, place the box within 5 feet upstream from
traffic if practical.
If you replace the cover on a nontraffic pull box, anchor it to the box.
87-1.03C(3) Traffic Pull Boxes
Place minor concrete around and under a traffic pull box.
Bolt the steel cover to the box when not working in it.
Bond the steel cover to the conduit with a jumper and bolt it down after installing the conductors and
cables.
87-1.03C(4) Structure Pull Boxes
Bond metallic conduit in a metal pull box in a structure using locknuts, inside and outside of the box,
bonding bushings, and bonding jumpers connected to bonding wire running in the conduit system.
87-1.03D Reserved
87-1.03E Excavating and Backfilling for Electrical Systems
87-1.03E(1) General
Notify the Engineer at least 72 hours before starting excavation activities.
Dispose of surplus excavated material.
Restrict closures for excavation on a street or highway to 1 lane at a time unless otherwise specified.
Page 155 of 183
87-1.03E(2) Trenching
Dig a trench for the electrical conduits or direct burial cables. Do not excavate until the conduit or direct
burial cable will be installed.
Place excavated material in a location that will not interfere with traffic or surface drainage.
After placing the conduit or direct burial cable, backfill the trench with the excavated material. Compact
the backfill placed outside the hinge point of slopes and not under pavement to a minimum relative
compaction of 90 percent.
Compact the backfill placed within the hinge points and in areas where pavement is to be constructed to a
minimum relative compaction of 95 percent.
Restore the sidewalks, pavement, and landscaping at a location before starting excavation at another
location.
87-1.03E(3) Concrete Pads, Foundations,and Pedestals
Construct foundations for standards, poles, metal pedestals, and posts under section 56-3.
Construct concrete pads,foundations,and pedestals for controller cabinets,telephone demarcation
cabinets, and service equipment enclosures on firm ground.
Install anchor bolts using a template to provide proper spacing and alignment. Moisten the forms and
ground before placing the concrete. Keep the forms in place until the concrete sets for at least 24 hours to
prevent damage to the surface.
Use minor concrete for pads,foundations, and pedestals.
In unpaved areas, place the top of the foundation 6 inches above the surrounding grade, except place the
top:
1. 1 foot 6 inches above the grade for Type M and 336L cabinets
2. 1 foot 8 inches above the grade for Type C telephone demarcation cabinets
3. 2 inches above the grade for Type G and Type A cabinets and Type III service equipment enclosures
The pad must be 2 inches above the surrounding grade.
In and adjacent to the sidewalk and other paved areas, place the top of the foundation 4 inches above the
surrounding grade, except place the top:
1. 1 foot 6 inches above the grade for Type M and 336L cabinets
2. 1 foot 8 inches above the grade for Type C telephone demarcation cabinets
3. Level with the finished grade for Type G and Type A cabinets and Type III service equipment
enclosures
The pad must be level with the finished grade.
Apply an ordinary surface finish under section 51-1.03F.
Allow the foundation to cure for at least 7 days before installing any equipment.
87-1.03F Conductors and Cable Installations
87-1.03F(1) General
The installation of conductors and cables includes splicing conductors and attaching the terminals and
connectors to the conductors.
Clean the conduit and pull all conductors and cables as a unit.
If new conductors or cables are to be added in an existing conduit:
1 Remove the content
2. Clean the conduit
3. Pull both old and new conductors and cables as a unit
Page 156 of 183
Wrap conductors and secure cables to the end of the conduit in a pull box.
Seal the ends of conduits with a sealing compound after installing conductors or cables.
Neatly arrange conductors and cables inside pull boxes and cabinets. Tie the conductors and cables
together with self-clinching nylon cable ties or enclose them in a plastic tubing or raceway.
Identify conductors and cables by direct labeling, tags, or bands fastened in such a way that they will not
move. Use mechanical methods for labeling.
Provide band symbol identification on each conductor or each group of conductors comprising a signal
phase in each pull box and near the end of terminated conductors.
Tape the ends of unused conductors and cables in pull boxes to form a watertight seal.
Do not connect the push-button or accessible pedestrian signal neutral conductor to the signal neutral
conductor.
87-1.03F(2) Cables
87-1.03F(2)(a) General
Reserved
87-1.03F(2)(b) Reserved
87-1.03F(2)(c) Copper Cables
87-1.03F(2)(c)(i) General
Reserved
87-1.03F(2)(c)(11) Detector Lead-in Cables
Install a Type B or C detector lead-in cable in conduit.
Waterproof the ends of the lead-in cable before installing it in the conduit to prevent moisture from
entering the cable.
Splice loop conductors for each direction of travel for the same phase, terminating in the same pull box, to
a separate lead-in cable running from the pull box adjacent to the loop detector to a sensor unit mounted
in the controller cabinet. Install the lead-in cable without splices except at the pull box.
Verify in the presence of the Engineer that the loops are operational before making the final splices
between loop conductors and the lead-in cable.
Identify and tag each lead-in cable with the detector designation at the cabinet and pull box adjacent to
the loops.
87-1.03F(2)(c)(iii) Conductors Signal Cables
Do not splice signal cables except for a 28-conductor cable.
Provide identification at the ends of terminated conductors in a cable as shown.
Provide identification for each cable in each pull box showing the signal standard to which it is connected
except for the 28-conductor cable.
Connect conductors in a 12-conductor cable as shown in the following table:
Page 157 of 183
12CSC Color Code and Functional Connection
Color code Termination Phase
Red Red signal 2 4 6 or 8
Yellow Yellow signal 2, 4, 6, or 8
Brown Green signal 2, 4, 6, or 8
Red/black stripe Red signal 1, 3, 5, or 7
Yellow/black stripe Yellow signal 1, 3, 5, or 7
Brown/black stripe Green signal 1, 3, 5, or 7
Black/red stripe Spare or as required for red or DONT --
WALK
Black/white stripe Spare or as required for yellow --
Black Spare or as required for green or WALK --
Red/white stripe Pedestrian signal DONT WALK --
Brown/white stripe Pedestrian signal WALK --
White Terminal block I Neutral
Provide identification for each 28-conductor cable C1 or C2 in each pull box. The cable labeled C1 must
be used for signal phases 1, 2, 3, and 4. The cable labeled C2 must be used for signal phases 5, 6, 7,
and 8.
Connect conductors in a 28-conductor cable as shown in the following table:
Page 158 of 183
28CSC Color Code and Functional Connection
Color code Termination Phase
Red/black stripe Red signal 2 or 6
Yellow/black stripe Yellow signal 2 or 6
Brown/black stripe Green signal 2 or 6
Red/orange stripe Red signal 4 or 8
Yellow/orange stripe Yellow signal 4 or 8
Brown/orange stripe Green signal 4 or 8
Red/silver stripe Red signal 1 or 5
Yellow/silver stripe Yellow signal 1 or 5
Brown/silver stripe Green signal 1 or 5
Red/purple stripe Red signal 3 or 7
Yellow/purple stripe Yellow signal 3 or 7
Brown/purple stripe Green signal 3 or 7
Red/2 black stripes Pedestrian signal DONT WALK 2 or 6
Brown/2 black stripes Pedestrian signal WALK 2 or 6
Red/2 orange stripes Pedestrian signal DONT WALK 4 or 8
Brown/2 orange stripes Pedestrian signal WALK 4 or 8
Red/2 silver stripes Overlap A, C OLAa,
OLCa
Brown/2 silver stripes Overlap A, C OLA°, OLC°
Red/2 purple stripes Overlap B, D OLBa,
OLD
Brown/2 purple stripes Overlap B, D OLB°, OLD°
Blue/black stripe Pedestrian push button 2 or 6
Blue/orange stripe Pedestrian push button 4 or 8
Blue/silver stripe Overlap A, C OLAb,
OLCb
Blue/purple stripe Overlap B, D OLBb,
OLDb
White/black stripe Pedestrian push button common --
Black/red stripe Railroad preemption --
Black Spare --
White Terminal block Neutral
OL= Overlap;A, B, C, and D =Overlapping phase designation
a For red phase designation
bFor yellow phase designation
°For green phase designation
Use the neutral conductor only with the phases associated with that cable. Do not intermix neutral
conductors from different cables except at the signal controller.
87-1.03F(2)(c)(iv) Signal Interconnect Cable
For a signal interconnect cable, provide a minimum of 6 feet of slack inside each controller cabinet.
Do not splice the cable unless authorized.
If splices are authorized, insulate the conductor splices with heat-shrink tubing and overlap the insulation
at least 0.6 inch. Cover the splice area of the cable with heat-shrink tubing and overlap the cable jacket at
least 1-1/2 inches. Provide a minimum of 3 feet of slack at each splice.
87-1.03F(3) Conductors
87-1.03F(3)(a) General
Do not run conductors to a terminal block on a standard unless they are to be connected to a signal head
mounted on that standard.
Provide 3 spare conductors in all conduits containing ramp metering and traffic signal conductors.
Page 159 of 183
Install a separate conductor for each terminal of a push button assembly and accessible pedestrian
signal.
Provide conductor slack to comply with the requirements shown in the following table:
Conductor Slack Requirements
Location Slack(feet)
Signal standard 1
Lighting standard 1
Signal and lighting standard 1
Pull box 3
Splice 3
Standards with slip base 0
87-1.03F(3)(b) Reserved
87-1.03F(3)(c) Copper Conductors
87-1.03F(3)(c)(i) General
Install a minimum no. 8, insulated, grounding copper conductor in conduit and connect it to all-metal
components.
Where conductors from different service points occupy the same conduit or standard, enclose the
conductors from one of the services in flexible or rigid metal conduit.
87-1.03F(3)(c)(ii) Inductive Loop Conductors
Install a Type 1 or 2 inductive loop conductor except use Type 2 for Type E loop detectors.
Install the conductor without splices except at the pull box.
87-1.03F(4) Manual Installation Method
Use an inert lubricant for placing conductors and cables in conduit.
Pull the conductors and cables into the conduit by hand using pull tape.
87-1.03G Equipment Identification Characters
The Engineer provides you with a list of the equipment identification characters.
Stencil the characters or apply the reflective self-adhesive labels to a clean surface.
Treat the edges of self-adhesive characters with an edge sealant.
Place the characters on the side facing traffic on:
1. Front doors of cabinets and service equipment enclosures.
2. Wood poles,fastened with 1-1/4-inch aluminum nails,for pole mounted enclosures
3. Adjacent bent or abutment at approximately the same station as an illuminated sign or soffit luminaire
4. Underside of the structure adjacent to the illuminated sign or soffit luminaire if no bent or abutment
exists nearby
5. Posts of overhead signs
6. Standards
Before placing new characters on existing or relocated equipment, remove the existing characters.
87-1.03H Conductor and Cables Splices
87-1.03H(1) General
You may splice:
1. Grounded conductors in a pull box
2. Accessible pedestrian signal and push bottom conductors in a pull box
3. Ungrounded signal conductors in a pull box if signals are modified
Page 160 of 183
4. Ungrounded signal conductors to a terminal compartment or a signal head on a standard with
conductors of the same phase in the pull box adjacent to the standard
5. Ungrounded lighting circuit conductors in a pull box if lighting circuits are modified
Solder all splices using the hot iron, pouring, or dipping method. Do not perform open-flame soldering.
87-1.03H(2) Splice Insulation Methods
Insulate splices in a multiconductor cable to form a watertight joint and to prevent moisture absorption by
the cable.
Use heat-shrink tubing or Method B to insulate a splice.
Use heat-shrink tubing as follows:
1. Cover the splice area completely with an electrical insulating coating and allow it to dry.
2. Place mastic around each conductor before placing them inside the tubing. Use the type of mastic
specified in the tubing manufacturer's instructions.
3. Heat the area under the manufacturer's instructions. Do not perform open-flame heating.After
contraction, each end of the heat-shrink tubing or the open end of the tubing's end cap must overlap
the conductor insulation at least 1-1/2 inches.
4. Cover the entire splice with an electrical insulating coating and allow it to dry.
Use Method B as follows:
1. Cover the splice area completely with an electrical insulating coating and allow it to dry.
2. Apply 3 layers of half-lapped, 80-mils, PVC tape.
3. Apply 2 layers of 120-mils, butyl-rubber, stretchable tape with liner.
4. Apply 3 layers of half-lapped, 6-mils, PVC, pressure-sensitive, adhesive tape.
5. Cover the entire splice with an electrical insulating coating and allow it to dry.
87-1.031 Connectors and Terminals
Apply connectors and terminals to cables and conductors using a crimping compression tool under the
manufacturer's instructions.The tool must prevent opening of the handles until the crimp is completed.
Install crimp-style terminal lugs on stranded conductors smaller than no. 14.
Solder no. 8 and smaller conductors to connectors and terminal lugs.
87-1.03J Standards, Poles, Pedestals,and Posts
Install standards, poles, pedestals, and posts under section 56-3.
Ground standards with a handhole by attaching a bonding jumper from the bolt or lug inside the standard
to a metal conduit or to the grounding wire in the adjacent pull box. The bonding jumper must be visible
when the handhole cover is removed.
Ground standards without a handhole or standards with a slip base by attaching a bonding jumper to all
anchor bolts using ground clamps and connecting it to a metal conduit or to the grounding wire in the
adjacent pull box. The bonding jumper must be visible after mortar has been placed on the foundation.
87-1.03K Reserved
87-1.03L Utility Service
87-1.03L(1) General
Install the service equipment early enough to allow the utility to complete its work before completion of the
electrical work.
At least 15 days before permanent electrical and telecommunication service is required, request the
service connections for permanent installations.The Department arranges with the utilities for completion
of the connections and pays all costs and fees required by the utilities.
Page 161 of 183
87-1.03L(2) Electric Service
87-1.03L(2)(a) General
If service equipment is to be installed on a utility-owned pole,furnish and install the conduit, conductors,
pull boxes, and other necessary material to complete the service installation.The service utility decides
the position of the riser and equipment on the pole.
87-1.03L(2)(b) Electric Service for Irrigation
Establishing electric service for irrigation includes installing conduit, conductors, and pull boxes and
making connections from the service point to the irrigation controllers.
87-1.03L(2)(c) Electric Service for Booster Pumps
Establishing electric service for a booster pump includes installing conduit, conductors, and pull boxes
and making connections from the service point to the booster pump enclosure.
87-1.03L(3) Telecommunications Service
Establishing telecommunication service includes installing conduit, conductors, and pull boxes and
making connections from the service point to the telephone demarcation cabinet.
87-1.03M Photoelectric Controls
Mount the photoelectric unit on the top of the pole for Type I, II, and III photoelectric controls. Use
mounting brackets where pole-top mounting is not possible. Orient the photoelectric unit to face north.
Mount the enclosure at a height of 6 feet above finished grade on the same standard as the photoelectric
unit.
Install a minimum 100 VA, 480/120 V(ac)transformer in the contactor enclosure to provide 120 V(ac)for
the photoelectric control unit when switching 480 V(ac), 60 Hz circuits.
87-1.03N Fused Splice Connectors
Install a fuse splice connector in each ungrounded conductor for luminaires mounted on standards.The
connector must be located in the pull box adjacent to the standard.
Crimp the connector terminals onto the ungrounded conductors using a tool under the manufacturer's
instructions. Insulate the terminals and make them watertight.
87-1.030 Grounding Electrodes
Install a grounding electrode for each cabinet, service equipment enclosure, and transformer.
Attach a grounding conductor from the electrode using either a ground clamp or exothermic weld.
Connect the other end of the conductor to the cabinet, service equipment enclosure, and transformer.
87-1.03P Service Equipment Enclosures
Installing a service equipment enclosure includes constructing the foundation and pad and installing
conduit, adjacent pull boxes, and grounding electrode.
Locate the foundation such that the minimum clearance around the front and back of the enclosure
complies with NEC, article 110.26, "Spaces About Electrical Equipment, (600 V, nominal or less)."
Bond and ground metal conduit as specified in NEC and by the service utility except the grounding
electrode conductor must be no. 6 or larger.
If circuit breakers and components do not have a description on engraved phenolic nameplates, install
them using stainless steel rivets or screws under section 86-1.02P(2).
87-1.03Q Cabinets
87-1.03Q(1) General
Installing a cabinet includes constructing the foundation and pad and installing conduit, adjacent pull
boxes, and grounding electrode.
Apply a mastic or caulking compound before installing the cabinet on the foundation to seal the openings.
Page 162 of 183
Connect the field wiring to the terminal blocks in the cabinet. Neatly arrange and lace or enclose the
conductors in plastic tubing or raceway. Terminate the conductors with properly sized captive or spring
spade terminals.Apply a crimp-style connector and solder them.
Install and solder a spade-type terminal on no. 12 and smaller field conductors and a spade-type or ring-
type terminal on conductors larger than no. 12.
87-1.03Q(2) Department-Furnished Controller Cabinets
Arrange for the delivery of Department-furnished controller cabinets.
87-1.03Q(3) Reserved
87-1.03Q(4) Telephone Demarcation Cabinets
Installing a telephone demarcation cabinet includes installing conduit, cable, and pull boxes to the
controller cabinet.
Install the cabinet with the back toward the nearest lane of traffic.
87-1.03R Signal Heads
87-1.03R(1) General
Installing a signal head includes mounting the heads on standards and mast arms, installing backplates
and visors, and wiring conductors to the terminal blocks.
Keep the heads covered or direct them away from traffic until the system is ready for operation.
87-1.03R(2) Signal Faces
Use the same brand and material for the signal faces at each location.
Program the programmable visibility signal faces under the manufacturer's instructions.The indication
must be visible only in those areas or lanes to be controlled.
87-1.03R(3) Backplates
Install backplates using at least six 10-24 or 10-32 self-tapping and locking stainless steel machine
screws and flat washers.
If a plastic backplate requires field assembly, attach each joint using at least four no.10 machine screws.
Each machine screw must have an integral or captive flat washer, a hexagonal head slotted for a
standard screwdriver, and either a locking nut with an integral or captive flat washer or a nut,flat washer,
and lock washer. Machine screws, nuts, and washers must be stainless steel or steel with a zinc or black
oxide finish.
If a metal backplate has 2 or more sections,fasten the sections with rivets or aluminum bolts peened after
assembly to avoid loosening.
Install the backplate such that the background light is not visible between the backplate and the signal
face or between sections.
87-1.03R(4) Signal Mounting Assemblies
Install a signal mounting assembly such that its members are arranged symmetrically and plumb or level.
Orient each mounting assembly to allow maximum horizontal clearance to the adjacent roadway.
For a bracket-mounted assembly, bolt the terminal compartment or pole plate to the pole or standard.
In addition to the terminal compartment mounting, attach the upper pipe fitting of Type SV-1-T with 5
sections or a SV-2-TD to the standard or pole using the mounting detail for signal heads without a
terminal compartment.
Use a 4-1/2-inch slip fitter and set screws to mount an assembly on a post top.
After installing the assembly, clean and paint the exposed threads of the galvanized conduit brackets and
bracket areas damaged by the wrench or vise jaws. Use a wire brush to clean and apply 2 coats of
unthinned, organic zinc-rich primer. Do not use an aerosol can to apply the primer.
Page 163 of 183
Install the conductors in the terminal compartment and secure the cover.
87-1.03S Pedestrian Signal Heads
Installing a pedestrian signal head includes mounting the heads on standards and wiring conductors to
the terminal blocks.
Install the pedestrian signal mounting assembly under section 87-1.03R(4).
Use the same brand and material for the pedestrian signal faces at each location.
Install a pedestrian signal face such that its members are arranged symmetrically and plumb or level.
87-1.03T Accessible Pedestrian Signals
Use the same brand for the accessible pedestrian signals at each location.
Install an accessible pedestrian signal and the R10 series sign on the crosswalk side of the standard.
Attach the accessible pedestrian signal to the standard with self-tapping screws.
Attach the sign to the standard using 2 straps and saddle brackets.
Point the arrow on the accessible pedestrian signal in the same direction as the corresponding crosswalk.
Furnish the equipment and hardware to set up and calibrate the accessible pedestrian signal.
Arrange to have a manufacturer's representative at the job site to program the accessible pedestrian
signal with an audible message or tone.
87-1.03U Push Button Assemblies
Install the push button assembly and the R10 series sign on the crosswalk side of the standard.
Attach the sign to the assembly for Type B assemblies.
Attach the sign to the standard using 2 straps and saddle brackets for Type C assemblies.
You may use straps and saddle brackets to secure the push button to the standard.
Use a slip fitter to secure the assembly on top of a 2-1/2-inch-diameter post.
87-1.03V Detectors
87-1.03V(1) General
Installing a detector includes installing inductive loop conductors, sealant, conduit, and pull boxes.
Center the detectors in the traffic lanes.
Do not splice the detector conductor.
87-1.03V(2) Inductive Loop Detectors
Mark the location of the inductive loop detectors such that the distance between the side of the loop and a
lead-in saw cut from an adjacent detector is at least 2 feet.The distance between lead-in saw cuts must
be at least 6 inches.
Saw cut the slots under section 13-4.03E(7).The bottoms of the slots must be smooth with no sharp
edges. For Type E detector loops, saw the slots such that the sides are vertical.
Wash the slots clean using water and blow dry them with compressed air to remove all moisture and
debris.
Identify the start of the conductor.
Waterproof the ends of a Type 2 loop conductor before installing it in the conduit to prevent moisture from
entering the cable.
Install the loop conductor in the slots and lead-in saw cuts using a 3/16-to 1/4-inch-thick wood paddle.
Hold the conductors in place at the bottom of the slot with wood paddles during placement of the sealant.
Page 164 of 183
Wind adjacent loops on the same sensor unit channel in opposite directions.
Twist the conductors for each loop into a pair consisting of a minimum of 2 turns per foot before placing
them in the lead-in saw cut and the conduit leading to the pull box. Do not install more than 2 twisted
pairs of conductors per lead-in saw cut.
Provide 5 feet of slack in the pull box.
Test each loop for continuity, circuit resistance, and insulation resistance before filling the slots with
sealant.
Remove excess sealant from the adjacent road surface before it sets. Do not use solvents to remove the
excess.
Identify the loop conductor pair in the pull box, marking the start with the letter S and the end with the
letter F. Band conductors in pairs by lane in the pull box adjacent to the loops and in the cabinet. Identify
each pair with the detector designation and loop number.
Install the conductors in a compacted layer of HMA immediately below the uppermost layer if more than
one layer will be placed. Install the loop conductors before placing the uppermost layer of HMA. Fill the
slot with a sealant flush to the surface.
Install the conductors in the existing pavement if one layer of HMA is to be placed. Install the loop
conductors before placing the layer of HMA. Fill the slot with a sealant flush to the surface.
87-1.03V(3) Preformed Inductive Loop Detectors
Construct a preformed inductive loop detector consisting of 4 turns in the loop and a lead-in conductor
pair twisted at least 2 turns per foot all encased in conduit and sealed to prevent water penetration. The
detector must be 6-foot square unless shown otherwise.
Construct the loop detector using a minimum 3/8-inch Schedule 40 or Schedule 80 PVC or polypropylene
conduit and no. 16 or larger conductor with Type THWN or TFFN insulation.
In new roadways, place the detector in the base course with the top of the conduit flush with the top of the
base. Cover with HMA or concrete pavement. Protect the detector from damage before and during
pavement placement.
In new reinforced concrete bridge decks, secure the detector to the top of the uppermost layer of
reinforcing steel using nylon wire ties. Hold the detector parallel to the bridge deck using PVC or
polypropylene spacers where necessary. Place conduit for lead-in conductors between the uppermost 2
layers of reinforcing steel.
Do not install detectors in existing bridge decks unless authorized.
Install a detector in existing pavement before placement of concrete or HMA as follows:
1. Saw cut slots at least 1-1/4 inches wide into the existing pavement.
2. Place the detector in the slots. The top of the conduit must be at least 2 inches below the top of the
pavement.
3. Test each loop circuit for continuity, circuit resistance, and insulation resistance.
4. Fill saw cuts with elastomeric or hot melt rubberized asphalt sealant for asphalt concrete pavement
and with epoxy sealant or hot melt rubberized asphalt sealant for concrete pavement.
87-1.03W Sealants
87-1.03W(1) General
Reserved
87-1.03W(2) Elastomeric Sealant
Apply an elastomeric sealant with a pressure feed applicator.
87-1.03W(3) Asphaltic Emulsion Sealant
Asphaltic emulsion sealant must:
Page 165 of 183
1. Be used for filling slots in asphalt concrete pavement of a maximum width of 5/8 inch
2. Not be used on concrete pavement or where the slope causes the material to run from the slot
3. Be thinned under the manufacturer's instructions
4. Be placed when the air temperature is at least 45 degrees F
87-1.03W(4) Hot-Melt Rubberized Asphalt Sealant
Melt the sealant in a jacketed, double-boiler-type, melting unit. The temperature of the heat transfer
medium must not exceed 475 degrees F.
Apply the sealant with a pressure feed applicator or a pour pot when the surface temperature of the
pavement is greater than 40 degrees F.
87-1.03X Reserved
87-1.03Y Transformers
Installing a transformer includes placing the transformer inside a pull box, a cabinet, or an enclosure.
Wire the transformer for the appropriate voltage.
Ground the secondary circuit of the transformer as specified in the NEC.
87-1.03Z Reserved
87-1.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
87-2 LIGHTING SYSTEMS
87-2.01 GENERAL
87-2.01A Summary
Section 87-2 includes specifications for constructing lighting systems.
Lighting system includes:
1. Foundations
2. Pull boxes
3. Conduit
4. Conductors
5. Standards
6. Luminaires
7. Service equipment enclosure
8. Photoelectric control
9. Fuse splice connectors
10. High mast lighting assemblies
The components of a lighting system are shown on the project plans.
87-2.0113 Definitions
Reserved
87-2.01C Submittals
Submit a certificate of compliance and test data for the high mast lighting luminaires.
87-2.01D Quality Assurance
Reserved
87-2.02 MATERIALS
87-2.02A General
Reserved
Page 166 of 183
87-2.0213 High Mast Lighting Assemblies
A high mast lighting assembly includes the foundation, pole, lowering device system, luminaires, and
control pedestal.
Each luminaire in a high mast lighting assembly must include a housing, an optical system, and a ballast.
The housing must be made of aluminum.
A painted or powder-coated housing for a high mast lighting luminaire must be able to withstand a 1,000-
hour salt spray test as specified in ASTM B117.
The optical system, consisting of the reflector, refractor or lens, lamp socket, and lamp, must be in a
sealed chamber. The chamber must be sealed by a gasket between the reflector and refractor or lens
and a gasket between the reflector and lamp socket. The chamber must have a separate filter or filtering
gasket for flow of air.
An asymmetrical luminaire must have a refractor or reflector that is rotatable 360 degrees around a
vertical axis to orient the distribution of light.
The luminaire must have a slip fitter for mounting on a 2-inch horizontal pipe tenon and must be
adjustable±3 degrees from the axis of the tenon.
The reflector must have a specular surface made of silvered glass or aluminum protected by either an
anodized finish or a silicate film.The reflector must be shaped such that a minimum of light is reflected
through the arc tube of the lamp.
The refractor and lens must be made of heat-resistant glass.
The lamp socket must be a porcelain-enclosed, mogul-multiple type. The shell must contain integral lamp
grips to ensure electrical contact under conditions of normal vibrations.The socket must be rated for
1,500 W, 600 V(ac)and 4,000 V(ac)pulse for a 400 W lamp and 5,000 V(ac) pulse for a 1,000 W lamp.
The luminaire must have a dual fuse holder for 2 fuses rated at 5 A, 480 V(ac).The fuses must be 13/32
inch by 1-1/2 inches, standard midget ferrule type with a nontime-delay feature.
The lamps must be vertical burning, protected from undue vibration, and prevented from backing out of
the socket by a stainless steel clamp attached to the luminaire.
A 1,000 W metal halide lamp must have an initial output of 100,000 lumens and an average rated life of
12,000 hours based on 10 hours per start.
A 400 W high-pressure sodium lamp must have an initial output of 50,000 lumens.A 1,000 W high-
pressure sodium lamp must have an initial output of 140,000 lumens.
The ballast for the luminaire must be a regulator type and have a core and coils, capacitors, and starting
aid.
Ballast must be:
1. Mounted within a weatherproof housing that integrally attaches to the top of a luminaire support
bracket and lamp support assembly
2. Readily removable without removing the luminaire from the bracket arm
3. Electrically connected to the optical assembly by a prewired quick disconnect
The ballast for a metal halide luminaire must comply with luminaire manufacturer's specifications.
The wattage regulation spread at any lamp voltage,from nominal through the life of the lamp, must vary
no more than 22 percent for a 1,000 W lamp and a±10 percent input voltage variation. The ballast's
starting line current must be less than its operating current.
87-2.02C Soffit and Wall-Mounted Luminaires
87-2.02C(1) General
Soffit and wall-mounted luminaires must be weatherproof and corrosion resistant.
Page 167 of 183
Each luminaire must include a 70 W high-pressure sodium lamp with a minimum average rated life of
24,000 hours. The lamp socket must be positioned such that the light center of the lamp is located within
1/2 inch of the designed light center of the luminaire.
Luminaire wiring must be SFF-2.
Flush-mounted soffit luminaire must have:
1. Metal body with two 1-inch-minimum conduit hubs and a means of anchoring the body into the
concrete
2. Prismatic refractor made of heat-resistant polycarbonate:
2.1. Mounted in a door frame
2.2. With the street side identified
3. Aluminum reflector with a specular anodized finish
4. Ballast located either within the housing or in a ceiling pull box if shown
5. Lamp socket
The door frame assembly must be hinged, gasketed, and secured to the luminaire body with at least 3
machine screws.
A pendant soffit luminaire must be enclosed and gasketed and have an aluminum finish. Luminaire must
have:
1. Aluminum reflector with a specular anodized finish
2. Refractor made of heat-resistant polycarbonate
3. Optical assembly that is hinged and latched for lamp access and a device to prevent dropping
4. Ballast designed for operation in a raintight enclosure
5. Galvanized metal box with a gasketed cover, 2 captive screws, and 2 chains to prevent dropping and
for luminaire mounting
Wall-mounted luminaire must have:
1. Cast metal body
2. Prismatic refractor:
2.1. Made of glass
2.2. Mounted in a door frame
3. Aluminum reflector with a specular anodized finish
4. Integral ballast
5. Lamp socket
6. Gasket between the refractor and the body
7. At least 2 mounting bolts of minimum 5/16-inch diameter
A cast aluminum body of a luminaire to be cast into or mounted against concrete must have a thick coat
of alkali-resistant bituminous paint on all surfaces to be in contact with the concrete.
87-2.02C(2) High-Pressure Sodium Lamp Ballasts
87-2.02C(2)(a) General
A high-pressure sodium lamp ballast must operate the lamp for its rated wattage.
Starting aids for a ballast must be interchangeable between ballasts of the same wattage and
manufacturer without adjustment.
The ballast must be provided with a heat-generating component to serve as a heat sink.The capacitor
must be placed at the maximum practicable distance from the heat-generating components or thermally
shielded to limit the case temperature to 75 degrees C.
The transformer and inductor must be resin impregnated for protection against moisture. Capacitors,
except for those in starting aids, must be metal cased and hermetically sealed.
The ballast must have a power factor of 90 percent or greater.
Page 168 of 183
For the nominal input voltage and lamp voltage,the ballast design center must not vary more than 7.5
percent from the rated lamp wattage.
87-2.02C(2)(b) Regulator-Type Ballasts
A regulator-type ballast must be designed such that a capacitance variance of±6 percent does not cause
more than±8 percent variation in the lamp wattage regulation.
The ballast must have a current crest factor not exceeding 1.8 for an input voltage variation of±10
percent.
The lamp wattage regulation spread for a lag-type ballast must not vary by more than 18 percent for±10
percent input voltage variations.The primary and secondary windings must be electrically isolated.
The lamp wattage regulation spread for a constant-wattage, autoregulator, lead-type ballast must not vary
by more than 30 percent for±10 percent input voltage variations.
87-2.02C(2)(c) Nonregulator-Type Ballasts
A nonregulator-type ballast must have a current crest factor not exceeding 1.8 for an input voltage
variation of±5 percent.
The lamp wattage regulation spread for an autotransformer or high reactance type ballast must not vary
by more than 25 percent for±5 percent input voltage variations.
87-2.03 CONSTRUCTION
87-2.03A General
Set the foundations for standards such that the mast arm is perpendicular to the centerline of the
roadway.
Tighten the cap screws of the luminaire's clamping bracket to 10 ft-lb for LED and low-pressure
luminaires.
Label the month and year of the installation inside the luminaire housing's door.
Perform the conductor and operational tests for the system.
87-2.03B High Mast Lighting Assemblies
Mount and connect the luminaires to the accessory support ring. Aim the asymmetrical luminaire to orient
the distribution of light.
87-2.03C Soffit and Wall-Mounted Luminaires
For a flush-mounted soffit luminaire:
1. Prevent concrete from getting into the housing during pouring of the concrete for the structure
2. Install the luminaire with the axis vertical and the street side of the refractor oriented as indicated
3. Locate the luminaire to provide a minimum 2-foot clearance from the inside surface of the girders and
1-foot clearance from the near face of the diaphragm
4. Install the bridge soffit and ceiling pull box over the same lane
For a pendant soffit luminaire:
1. Cast in place the inserts for the no. 8 pull box during concrete placement for a new structure
2. Drill holes for expansion anchors to support the no. 8 pull box on existing structures
3. Bond the suspension conduit and luminaire to the pull box
For a wall-mounted luminaire, provide:
1. Extension junction box or ring on a new structure
2. 4 external mounting taps on an existing structure
Place the soffits or wall-mounted luminaires in operation as soon as practicable after the falsework has
been removed from the structure.
Page 169 of 183
If the Engineer orders soffit or wall-mounted luminaires to be activated before permanent power service is
available, installing and removing the temporary power service is change order work.
87-2.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
87-3 SIGN ILLUMINATION SYSTEMS
87-3.01 GENERAL
87-3.01A Summary
Section 87-3 includes specifications for constructing sign illumination systems.
Sign illumination system includes:
1. Foundations
2. Pull boxes
3. Conduit
4. Conductors
5. Sign lighting fixtures
6. Enclosure for the disconnect circuit breaker
7. Service equipment enclosure
8. Photoelectric control
The components of a sign illumination system are shown on the project plans.
87-3.0113 Definitions
Reserved
87-3.01C Submittals
Submit the manufacturer's test data for the induction sign-lighting fixtures.
87-3.01D Quality Assurance
Reserved
87-3.02 MATERIALS
An induction sign-lighting fixture must include a housing with a door, reflector, refractor or lens, lamp,
socket assembly, power coupler, high-frequency generator,fuse block, and fuses.
The fixture must comply with the isofootcandle curves as shown.
Fixture must weigh no more than 44 lb, be rated for 87 W at 120/240 V(ac), and have a mounting
assembly made of one of the following materials:
1. Cast aluminum
2. Hot-dip galvanized steel plate
3. Galvanized steel plate finished with one of the following:
3.1. Polymeric coating
3.2. Same finish used for the housing
Housing must:
1. Be corrosion resistant and suitable for wet locations
2. Be above the top of the mounting rails at a maximum height of 12 inches
3. Have weep holes
Door must:
1. Hold a refractor or lens
2. Open without the use of special tools
3. Have a locking position at 50 degrees minimum from the plane of the door opening
4. Be hinged to the housing on the side of the fixture away from the sign panel
5. Have 2 captive latch bolts or other latching device
Page 170 of 183
When the door is opened, it must lock in the 50 degrees position when an 85 mph, 3-second wind-gust
load strikes the door from either side.
The housing and door must be manufactured of sheet or cast aluminum and have a gray powder coat or
polyester paint finish. The sheet aluminum must comply with ASTM B209 or B209M for 5052-H32
aluminum sheet. External bolts, screws, hinges, hinge pins, and door closure devices must be corrosion
resistant.
The housing and door must be gasketed. The thickness of the gasket must be a minimum of 1/4 inch.
Reflector must not be attached to the outside of the housing and must be:
1. Made of a single piece of aluminum with a specular finish
2. Protected with an electrochemically applied anodized finish or a chemically applied silicate film
3. Designed to drain condensation away from it
4. Secured to the housing with a minimum of 2 screws
5. Removable without removing any fixture parts
Refractor or lens must have a smooth exterior and must be manufactured from the materials shown in the
following table:
Refractor and Lens Material Requirements
Component Material
Flat lens Heat-resistant glass
Convex lens Heat-resistant,high-impact-resistant tempered glass
Refractor Borosilicate heat-resistant glass
The refractor and convex lens must be designed or shielded such that no luminance is visible if the fixture
is approached directly from the rear and viewed from below. If a shield is used, it must be an integral part
of the door casting.
Lamp must:
1. Be an 85 W induction type with a fluorescent, phosphor-coated, interior wall
2. Have a minimum 70 percent light output of its original lumen output after 60,000 hours of operation
3. Have a minimum color-rendering index of 80
4. Be rated at a color temperature of 4,000K
5. Be removable with common hand tools
The lamp socket must be rated for 1,500 W and 600 V(ac)and be a porcelain-enclosed mogul type with a
shell that contains integral lamp grips to ensure electrical contact under normal vibration conditions. The
shell and center contact must be made of nickel-plated brass.The center contact must be spring loaded.
The power coupler must be removable with common hand tools.
High-frequency generator must:
1. Start and operate lamps at an ambient temperature of-25 degrees C or greater for the rated life of
the lamp
2. Operate continuously at ambient air temperatures from -25 to 55 degrees C without a reduction in the
generator life
3. Have a design life of at least 100,000 hours at 55 degrees C
4. Have an output frequency of 2.65 MHz± 10 percent
5. Have radio frequency interference that complies with 47 CFR 18 regulations regarding harmful
interference
6. Have a power factor greater than 90 percent and total harmonic distortion less than 10 percent
The high frequency generator must be mounted such that the fixture can be used as a heat sink and be
replaceable with common hand tools.
Page 171 of 183
Each fixture must include a barrier-type fuse block for terminating field connections. Fuse block must:
1. Be rated 600 V(ac)
2. Have box terminals
3. Be secured to the housing and accessible without removal of any fixture parts
4. Be mounted to leave a minimum of 1/2 inch of air space from the sidewalls of the housing
5. Be designed for easy removal of fuses with a fuse puller
The fixture's fuses must be 13/32-inch-diameter, 1-1/2-inch-long ferrule type and UL listed or NRTL
certified. For a 120 V(ac)fixture, only the ungrounded conductor must be fused and a solid connection
must be provided between the grounded conductor and the high frequency generator.
The fixture must be permanently marked with the manufacturer's brand name,trademark, model number,
serial number, and date of manufacture on the inside and outside on the housing. The same information
must be marked on the package.
If a wire guard is used, it must be made of a minimum 1/4-inch-diameter galvanized steel wire. The wires
must be spaced to prevent rocks larger than 1-1/2-inch diameter from passing through the guard.The
guard must be either hot-dip galvanized or electroplated zinc-coated as specified in ASTM B633, service
condition SC4, with a clear chromate dip treatment.
87-3.03 CONSTRUCTION
Perform the conductor and operational tests for the system.
87-3.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
87-4 SIGNAL AND LIGHTING SYSTEMS
87-4.01 GENERAL
87-4.01A Summary
Section 87-4 includes specifications for constructing signal and lighting systems.
Signal and lighting system includes:
1. Foundations
2. Pull boxes
3. Conduit
4. Conductors
5. Cables
6. Standards
7. Signal heads
8. Internally illuminated street name signs
9. Service equipment enclosure
10. Department-furnished controller assembly
11. Detectors
12. Telephone demarcation cabinet
13. Accessible pedestrian signals
14. Push button assemblies
15. Pedestrian signal heads
16. Luminaires
17. Photoelectric control
18. Fuse splice connectors
19. Battery backup system
20. Flashing beacons
21. Flashing beacon control assembly
The components of a signal and lighting system are shown on the project plans.
87-4.01 B Definitions
Reserved
Page 172 of 183
87-4.01C Submittals
Submit shop drawings showing the message for each internally illuminated street sign, including the size
of letters, symbols, and arrows.
87-4.01 D Quality Assurance
87-4.011)(1) General
Reserved
87-4.01 D(2) Quality Control
87-4.01 D(2)(a) General
Reserved
87-4.011)(2)(b) Battery Backup System
Notify the Engineer 48 hours before testing the battery backup system.
Test the system in the presence of the Engineer by turning off the power to the signal system at the
service equipment enclosure.The signal system must run continuously for 30 minutes. If the battery
backup system fails, correct the problem and retest the system for another 30 minutes.After successful
completion of the test,turn the power on for the signal system.
87-4.02 MATERIALS
87-4.02A General
Reserved
87-4.02B Battery Backup System
A battery backup system includes the cabinet, batteries, and the Department-furnished electronics
assembly.
The electronics assembly includes the inverter/charger unit, power transfer relay, and the battery
harness.
87-4.02C Internally Illuminated Street Name Signs
An internally illuminated street name sign includes housing, brackets, sign panels, gaskets, ballast,
Iampholder,terminal blocks,conductors, and fuses.
An internally illuminated street sign must be designed and constructed to prevent deformation or failure
when subjected to an 85 mph, 3-second wind-gust load as specified in the AASHTO publication,
"Standard Specifications for Structural Supports of Highway Signs, Luminaires and Traffic Signals."
Sign must:
1. Be Types A or B
2. Have galvanized or cadmium-plated ferrous parts
3. Have screened weep holes
4. Have fasteners, screws, and hardware made of passive stainless steel,Type 302 or 304, or
aluminum Type 6060-T6
5. Operate at a temperature from -20 to 74 degrees C
Photoelectric unit sockets are not allowed.
The housing must be constructed to resist torsional twist and warp. The housing must be designed such
that opening or removing the panels provides access to the interior of the sign for lamp, ballast, and fuse
replacement.
The top and bottom of the sign must be manufactured from formed or extruded aluminum and attached to
formed or cast aluminum end fittings.The top, bottom, and end fittings must form a sealed housing.
For a Type A sign, both sides of the sign must be hinged at the top to allow installation or removal of the
sign panel.
For a Type B sign,the sign panel must be slide mounted into the housing.
Page 173 of 183
The top of the housing must have 2 free-swinging mounting brackets. Each bracket must be vertically
adjustable for leveling the sign to either a straight or curved mast arm.The bracket assembly must allow
the lighting fixture to swing perpendicular to the sign panel.
The reflectors must be formed aluminum and have an acrylic, baked-white-enamel surface with a
minimum reflectance of 0.85.
Sign panel must be translucent, high-impact-resistant, and made of one of the following plastic materials:
1. Glass-fiber-reinforced,acrylated resin
2. Polycarbonate resin
3. Cellulose acetate butyrate
The sign panel must be designed not to crack or shatter if a 1-inch-diameter steel ball weighing 2.4
ounces is dropped from a height of 8.5 feet above the sign panel to any point on the panel. For this test,
the sign panel must be lying in a horizontal position and supported within its frame.
The sign panel's surface must be evenly illuminated.The brightness measurements for the letters must
be a minimum of 150 foot-lamberts, average.The letter-to-background brightness ratio must be from 10:1
to 20:1. The background luminance must not vary by more than 40 percent from the average background
brightness measurement. The luminance of letters, symbols, and arrows must not vary by more than 20
percent from their average brightness measurement.
The sign panel's white or green color must not fade or darken if exposed to an accelerated test of UV light
equivalent to 2 years of outdoor exposure.
The sign panel's legend, symbols, arrows, and border on each face must be white on a green
background.The background must comply with color no. 14109 of FED-STD-595.
The message must appear on both sides of the sign and be protected from UV radiation. The letters must
be 8-inch upper case and 6-inch lower case, series E.
A Type A sign must have a closed-cell, sponge-neoprene gasket installed between the sign panel frame
to prevent the entry of water. The gasket must be uniform and even textured.
The sign ballast must be a high-power-factor type for outdoor operation from 110 to 125 V(ac)and 60 Hz
and must comply with ANSI C82.1 and C82.2.
The ballast for a Type A sign must be rated at 200 mA. The ballast for a Type B sign must be rated at 430
mA.
Sign lampholder must:
1. Be the spring-loaded type
2. Have silver-coated contacts and waterproofed entrance leads
3. Have a heat-resistant, circular cross section with a partially recessed neoprene ring
Removal of the lamp from the socket must de-energize the primary of the ballast.
The springs for the lampholders must not be a part of the current-carrying circuit.
The sign's wiring connections must terminate on a molded, phenolic, barrier-type, terminal block rated at
15 A, 1,000 V(ac). The connections must have a white, integral, waterproof marking strip. The terminal
screws must not be smaller than a no. 10.
The terminal block must be insulated from the fixture to provide protection from the line-to-ground
flashover voltage.
A sectionalized terminal block must have an integral barrier on each side and must allow rigid mounting
and alignment.
Fixture's conductors must:
1. Be stranded copper wire with a minimum thermoplastic insulation of 28 mils
Page 174 of 183
2. Be rated at 1,000 V(ac)and for use up to 90 degrees C
3. Be a minimum of no. 16
4. Match the color coding of the ballast leads
5. Be secured with spring cross straps, installed 12 inches apart or less in the chassis or fixture
Stranded copper conductors connected to screw-type terminals must terminate in crimp-type ring
connectors.
No splicing is allowed within the fixture.
The sign's fuse must be the Type 3AG, miniature, slow-blow type.
The fuse holder must be a panel-mounting type with a threaded or bayonet knob that grips the fuse tightly
for extraction. Each ballast must have a separate fuse.
87-4.03 CONSTRUCTION
87-4.03A General
Set the foundations for standards such that the mast arm is perpendicular to the centerline of the
roadway.
Tighten the cap screws of the luminaire's clamping bracket to 10 ft-lb for LED and low-pressure
luminaires.
Label the month and year of the installation inside the luminaire housing's door.
Perform the conductor and operational tests for the system.
87-4.0313 Battery Backup System Cabinets
Install the battery backup system cabinet to the right of the Model 332L cabinet.
If installation on the right side is not feasible, obtain authorization for installation on the left side.
Provide access for power conductors between the cabinets using:
1. 2"nylon-insulated, steel chase nipple
2. 2"steel sealing locknut
3. 2"nylon-insulated, steel bushing
Remove the jumper between the terminals labeled BBS-1 and BBS-2 in the 5 position terminal block in
the controller cabinet before connecting the Department-furnished electronics assembly.
87-4.03C Internally Illuminated Street Name Signs
Mount the internally illuminated street name sign to the signal mast arm using the adjustable brackets.
Connect the conductors to the terminal blocks in the signal head mounting terminal block.
87-4.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
87-5 RAMP METERING SYSTEMS
87-5.01 GENERAL
Section 87-5 includes specifications for constructing ramp metering systems.
Ramp metering system includes:
1. Foundations
2. Pull boxes
3. Conduit
4. Conductors
5. Standards
6. Signal heads
7. Service equipment enclosure
8. Department-furnished controller assembly
Page 175 of 183
9. Detectors
10. Telephone demarcation cabinet
The components of a ramp metering system are shown on the project plans.
87-5.02 MATERIALS
Not Used
87-5.03 CONSTRUCTION
Connect the field wiring to the terminal blocks in the controller cabinet.The Engineer provides you a list of
field conductor terminations for each controller cabinet.
Perform the conductor and operational tests for the system.
87-5.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
87-6 TRAFFIC MONITORING STATION SYSTEMS
87-6.01 GENERAL
Section 87-6 includes specifications for constructing traffic monitoring station systems.
Traffic monitoring station system includes:
1. Foundations
2. Pull boxes
3. Conduit
4. Cables
5. Conductors
6. Service equipment enclosure
7. Controller cabinet
8. Detectors
9. Telephone demarcation cabinet
The components of a traffic monitoring station system are shown on the project plans.
87-6.02 MATERIALS
Not Used
87-6.03 CONSTRUCTION
Connect the field wiring to the terminal blocks in the controller cabinet.The Engineer provides you a list of
field conductor terminations for the controller cabinet.
Perform the conductor and operational tests for the system.
87-6.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
87-7 FLASHING BEACON SYSTEMS
87-7.01 GENERAL
Section 87-7 includes specifications for constructing flashing beacon systems.
Flashing beacon system includes:
1. Foundations
2. Pull boxes
3. Conduit
4. Conductors
5. Standards
6. Service equipment enclosure
7. Signal heads
8. Flashing beacon control assembly
Page 176 of 183
The components of a flashing beacon system are shown on the project plans.
The flash rate for the flashing beacon must comply with chapter 4L, "Flashing Beacons,"of the California
MUTCD.
The flashing beacon must allow alternating flashing wig-wag operation.
The flashing beacon must have a separate flasher unit installed in the flashing beacon control assembly.
87-7.02 MATERIALS
Flashing beacon control assembly must:
1. Have a NEMA 3R enclosure with a dead front panel and a hasp with a 7/16-inch hole for a padlock.
The enclosure must have one of the following finishes:
1.1. Powder coating.
1.2. Hot-dip galvanized coating.
1.3. Factory-applied, rust-resistant prime coat and finish coat.
2. Have barrier-type terminal blocks rated for 25 A, 600 V(ac), made of molded phenolic or nylon
material and have plated-brass screw terminals and integral marking strips.
3. Include a solid state flasher complying with section 8 of NEMA standards publication no. TS 1 for 10
A, dual circuits.
87-7.03 CONSTRUCTION
Perform the conductor and operational tests for the system.
87-7.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
87-8-87-11 RESERVED
87-12 CHANGEABLE MESSAGE SIGN SYSTEMS
87-12.01 GENERAL
Section 87-12 includes specifications for constructing changeable message sign systems.
Changeable message sign system includes:
1. Foundations
2. Pull boxes
3. Conduit
4. Conductors
5. Service equipment enclosure
6. Department-furnished controller cabinet
7. Department-furnished changeable message sign
8. Department-furnished wiring harness
9. Service equipment enclosure
10. Sign disconnect
The components of a changeable message sign system are shown on the project plans.
87-12.02 MATERIALS
Not Used
87-12.03 CONSTRUCTION
Install the changeable message sign.
Connect the field wiring to the terminal blocks in the sign assembly and controller cabinet.
The Engineer provides you a list of field conductor terminations for each sign cabinet and controller
cabinet.
The Department maintains the sign assemblies.
Page 177 of 183
87-12.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
87-13-87-17 RESERVED
87-18 INTERCONNECTION CONDUIT AND CABLE
87-18.01 GENERAL
Section 87-18 includes specifications for constructing interconnection conduit and cable.
Interconnection conduit and cable includes:
1. Pull boxes
2. Conduit
3. Signal interconnect cables
The components of an interconnection conduit and cable are shown.
87-18.02 MATERIALS
Not Used
87-18.03 CONSTRUCTION
Test the signal interconnect cable.
Connect the signal interconnect cable to the terminal block in the controller cabinets.The Engineer
provides you a list of terminations for each controller cabinet.
87-18.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
87-19 RESERVED
87-20 TEMPORARY ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS
87-20.01 GENERAL
Section 87-20 includes specifications for providing temporary electrical systems.
Obtain the Department's authorization for the type of temporary electrical system and its installation
method.
A temporary system must operate on a continuous, 24-hour basis.
87-20.02 MATERIALS
87-20.02A General
Material and equipment may be new or used.
The components of a temporary system are shown on the project plans.
If you use Type OF-B cable, the minimum conductor size must be no. 12.
87-20.0213 Temporary Flashing Beacon Systems
A temporary flashing beacon system consists of a flashing beacon system,wood post, generator, and
photovoltaic system.
The system must comply with the specifications for a flashing beacon system in section 87-7, except it
may be mounted on a wood post or a trailer.
87-20.02C Temporary Lighting Systems
A temporary lighting system consists of a lighting system, generator, and wood poles.
The system must comply with the specifications for a lighting system in section 87-2, except it may be
mounted on a wood pole or a trailer.
Page 178 of 183
87-20.02D Temporary Signal Systems
A temporary signal system consists of a signal and lighting system,wood poles and posts, and a
generator.
System must comply with the specifications for a signal and lighting system in section 87-4, except:
1. Signal heads may be mounted on a wood pole, mast arm,tether wire, or a trailer
2. Flashing beacons may be mounted on a wood post, or a trailer
87-20.03 CONSTRUCTION
87-20.03A General
Provide electrical and telecommunication services for temporary systems. Do not use existing services
unless authorized.
Provide power for the temporary electrical systems under section 12-3.33, except you may use a
photovoltaic system for the temporary flashing beacon system.
Install conductors and cables in a conduit, suspended from wood poles at least 25 feet above the
roadway, or use direct burial conductors and cables.
You may saw slots across paved areas for burial conductors and cables.
Install conduit outside the paved area at a minimum of 12 inches below grade for Type 1 and 2 conduit
and at a minimum of 18 inches below grade for Type 3 conduit.
Install direct burial conductors and cables outside the paved area at a minimum depth of 24 inches below
grade.
Place the portions of the conductors installed on the face of wood poles in either Type 1, 2, or 3 conduit
between the point 10 feet above grade at the pole and the pull box. The conduit between the pole and the
pull box must be buried at a depth of at least 18 inches below grade.
Place conductors across structures in a Type 1, 2, or 3 conduit. Attach the conduit to the outside face of
the railing.
Mount the photoelectric unit at the top of the standard or wood post.
You may abandon in place conductors and cables in sawed slots or in conduit installed below the ground
surface.
87-20.03B Temporary Flashing Beacon Systems
Install a fused-splice connector in the pull box adjacent to each flashing beacon. Wherever conductors
are run overhead, install the splice connector in the line side outside of the control assembly.
87-20.03C Temporary Lighting Systems
Wherever conductors are run overhead, install the fuse splice connectors in the line side before entering
the mast arm.
87-20.031) Temporary Signal Systems
You may splice conductors that run to a terminal compartment or a signal head on a pole to the through
conductors of the same phase in a pull box adjacent to the pole. Do not splice conductors or cables
except in a pull box or in a NEMA 3R enclosure.
The Department provides the timing for the temporary signal.
Maintain the temporary signal except for the Department-furnished controller assembly.
87-20.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
Page 179 of 183
87-21 EXISTING ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS
87-21.01 GENERAL
Section 87-21 includes general specifications for performing work on existing electrical systems.
87-21.02 MATERIALS
Not Used
87-21.03 CONSTRUCTION
87-21.03A General
You may abandon unused underground conduit after pulling out all conductors and removing conduit
terminations from the pull boxes.
If standards are to be salvaged, remove:
1. All components
2. Mast arms from the standards
3. Luminaires, signal heads, and signal mounting assemblies from the standards and mast arms
If the existing material is unsatisfactory for reuse and the Engineer orders you to replace it with new
material, replacing the existing material with new material is change order work.
If the removed electrical equipment is to be reinstalled, supply all materials and equipment, including
signal mounting assemblies, anchor bolts, nuts, washers, and concrete, needed to complete the new
installation.
87-21.0313 Maintaining Existing Electrical Systems
87-21.03B(1) General
Maintain the existing electrical system in working order during the progress of the work. Conduct your
operations to avoid damage to the elements of the systems.
87-21.03B(2) Maintaining Existing Traffic Management System Elements During Construction
Section 87-21.02B(2)applies if a bid item for maintaining existing traffic management system elements
during construction is shown on the Bid Item List.
Traffic management system elements include:
1. Ramp metering system
2. Traffic monitoring stations
3. Microwave vehicle detection system
4. Changeable message sign system
5. Extinguishable message sign system
6. Highway advisory radio system
7. Closed circuit television camera system
8. Roadway weather information system
Obtain authorization at least 72 hours before interrupting communication between an existing system and
the traffic management center.
If the Engineer notifies you that an existing system is not fully operational due to your activities, repair or
replace the system within 72 hours. If the system cannot be fixed within 72 hours or it is located on a
structure, provide a temporary system within 24 hours until the system can be fixed. Perform a functional
test of the system in the presence of the Engineer. If you fail to perform the necessary repair or
replacement work,the Department may perform the repair or replacement work and deduct the cost.
If you damage an existing fiber optic cable, install a new cable such that the length of cable slack is the
same as before the damage, measured from an original splice point or termination. All splices must be
made using the fusion method.
You may interrupt the operation of traffic monitoring stations:
1. For 60 days if another operational traffic monitoring station is located within 3 miles
Page 180 of 183
2. For 15 days if another operational traffic monitoring station is located more than 3 miles away
If a traffic monitoring station must be interrupted for longer periods than specified, provide a temporary
detection system. Obtain the Department's authorization for the type of temporary system and its
installation method.
87-21.03C Modifying Existing Electrical Systems
Modify electrical systems as shown.
87-21.03D Removing Existing Electrical Systems
The components to be removed are shown on the project plans.
87-21.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
DIVISION XI MATERIALS
90 CONCRETE
07-15-16
Replace Method 1 in the 4th paragraph of section 90-1.01 D(5)(a)with:
07-15-16
Method 2
Replace section 90-9 with:
07-15-16
90-9 RETURNED PLASTIC CONCRETE
90-9.01 GENERAL
90-9.01A Summary
Section 90-9 includes specifications for incorporating returned plastic concrete(RPC) into concrete.
RPC must be used only where the specifications allow its use. Do not use RPC in pavement or structural
concrete.
90-9.01 B Definitions
returned plastic concrete(RPC): Excess concrete that is returned to a concrete plant in a plastic state
and that has not attained initial set.
hydration stabilizing admixture(HSA): Extended set retarding admixture that controls and predictably
reduces the hydration rate of the cementitious material.
90-9.01C Submittals
Submit the following with the weighmaster certificate:
1. Weight or volume of RPC
2. Type, brand, and dosage of HSA
3. Time of adding HSA
4. Copy of the original weighmaster certificate for the RPC
5. Temperature of RPC
When requested, submit the HSA manufacturer's instructions, including dosage tables.
90-9.01D Quality Assurance
The material plant producing concrete containing RPC must be authorized under the MPQP.
Page 181 of 183
For volumetric proportioning of RPC:
1. The volumetric container must be imprinted with manufacturer's name, model number, serial number,
the as-calibrated volume and date of the last calibration. Cross sectional dimensions of the container
must remain the same as those during its calibration.
2. The device must be re-calibrated monthly and at any time when the container shape has been
deformed from its original condition or there is evidence of material build-up on the inside of the
device.
3. The device must be held in a level condition during filling. Fill the device to the measure or strike-off
line. Each measurement must be filled to within 1.0% of the device as-calibrated volume.
4. The device interior must be cleaned after each measurement to maintain a zero condition.
For weight proportioning, proportion RPC with a weigh hopper attached to the plant at a position which
allows the addition of the RPC to the mixer truck with the conventional PCC ingredients. The plant
process controller must control the proportioning of RPC to within 1.0% of its target weight.
90-9.02 MATERIALS
90-9.02A General
The quantity of RPC added to the concrete must not exceed 15 percent.
The cementitious material content of the RPC must be at least that specified for the concrete that allows
the use of RPC.
Water must not be added to the RPC after batching, including in the truck mixer.
Use HSA for controlling and reducing the hydration rate of RPC.
Incorporate RPC by mixing into the concrete before arriving at the jobsite.
90-9.0213 Returned Plastic Concrete
The RPC must not exceed 100 degrees F at anytime.
If HSA is not used, RPC must be incorporated into the concrete before attaining initial set or within 4
hours after batching of RPC,whichever is earlier.
If HSA is used:
1. Add HSA to RPC within 4 hours after original batching.
2. Measure and record the time, dosage of HSA, and temperature of RPC when HSA is added.
3. Mix the RPC under the HSA manufacturer's instructions after adding HSA or at least 30 revolutions,
whichever is greater.
4. Incorporate RPC into the concrete within 4 hours after adding HSA.
RPC must not contain:
1. Accelerating admixture
2. Fiber
3. Pigment
4. Lightweight aggregate
5. Previously returned RPC
6. Any ingredient incompatible with the resultant concrete
90-9.02C Hydration Stabilizing Admixture
HSA must comply with ASTM C494 admixture Type B or Type D.
HSA must have a proven history of specifically maintaining and extending both plasticity and set.
HSA dosage must comply with the manufacturer's instructions.
90-9.02D Production
Proportion concrete containing RPC under section 90-2.02E.
Page 182 of 183
Proportion RPC by weight or by volume.
90-9.03 CONSTRUCTION
Not Used
90-9.04 PAYMENT
Not Used
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
92 ASPHALT BINDERS
04-15-16
04-15-16
Replace the 4th paragraph of section 92-1.0213 with:
Crumb rubber modifier used must be on the Authorized Materials List for crumb rubber modifier.
Production equipment for PG modified asphalt binder with crumb rubber modifier must be authorized
under the Department's MPQP.
Crumb rubber must be derived from waste tires described in Pub Res Code§42703 and must be free
from contaminants including fabric, metal, minerals, and other nonrubber substances.
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
96 GEOSYNTHETICS
01-15-16
Replace product name,manufacturing source, and date of manufacture in the 2nd sentence of the
1 st paragraph of section 96-1.01 D with:
01-15-16
manufacturing source code
Page 183 of 183
ID OOK
JUVENILE JUSTICE CAMPUS GROUNDWATER MONITORING
WELL REPLACEMENTS
3333 E. AMERICAN AVENUE
BUDGET / ACCOUNT: 8935 / 7431
co
FRESH Department of Public Works and Planning
CONTRACT NUMBER 23-06-C
BID BOOK TABLE OF CONTENTS
JUVENILE JUSTICE CAMPUS GROUNDWATER MONITORING WELL REPLACEMENTS
CONTRACT NUMBER 23-06-C
PROPOSAL TITLE
NUMBER(S)
NOT APPLICABLE INSTRUCTIONS FOR COMPLETING THE BID BOOK
1 PROPOSAL TO THE COUNTY OF FRESNO
2 BID ITEM LIST
3 EVALUATION OF BID ITEM LIST
4 BID SECURITY
5 NON-COLLUSION DECLARATION
6 PUBLIC CONTRACT CODE SECTION 10285.1 STATEMENT
7 PUBLIC CONTRACT CODE SECTION 10162 QUESTIONNAIRE AND PUBLIC
CONTRACT CODE 10232 STATEMENT
8(A)-8(C) SUBCONTRACTORS
9 - 16 NOT USED
17 GUARANTY
INSTRUCTIONS FOR COMPLETING THE BID BOOK FOR NON-FEDERAL AID
PROJECTS
General
Complete forms in the Bid book.
Submit an electronic bid online at http://www.BidExpress.com (Section 2-1.33D)or submit a hardcopy bid:
1. Under sealed cover addressed to the Department and labeled with the name of the bidder, the name of the
project and the statement'Do Not Open Until The Time Of Bid Opening.'
2. Marked as a bid
3. Identifying the contract number and the bid opening date
Certain bid forms must be submitted with the bid and properly executed.
Certain other forms and information must be submitted either with the bid or within the prescribed period after bid
opening as specified elsewhere in these special provisions.
Failure to submit the forms and information as specified results in a nonresponsive bid.
If an agent other than the authorized corporation officer or a partnership member signs the bid, file a Power of
Attorney with the Department either before opening bids or with the bid. Otherwise, the bid may be
nonresponsive.
Bid Item List and Bid Comparison
Submit a bid based on the bid item quantities the Department shows on the Bid Item List. Bids will be evaluated
and the low bidder determined as indicated in the Notice to Bidders.
Bid Document Completion
Proposal items are identified by title and by the word "Proposal"followed by the number assigned to the proposal
item in question. Proposal items are included in the Bid Book.
Proposal to the County of Fresno— Proposal 1
Provided for information.
Bid Item List— Proposal 2
One or more sheet(s) or list(s) upon which the bidder completes the bid.
Fill out completely including a unit price and total for each unit price-based item and a total for each lump sum
item.
Do not make any additions such as"plus tax", "plus freight", or conditions such as "less 2% if paid by 15th".
Use ink or typewriter for paper bids.
Evaluation of Bid Item List—Proposal 3
Describes how inconsistences and irregularities are evaluated and corrected when Design Services reviews the
Bid Item List.
Bid Security and Signature— Proposal 4
Submit one of the following forms of bidder's security equal to at least 10 percent of the bid:
• Cash
• Cashier's check
• Certified check
INSTRUCTIONS FOR COMPLETING THE BID BOOK FOR NON-FEDERAL AID PROJECTS: Page 2 of 4
• Signed bidder's bond by an admitted surety insurer
Indicate type of bid security provided.
• Cash—Acceptable but not recommended. Cash is deposited in a clearing account and is returned to
bidders by County warrant. This process may take several weeks.
• Cashier's or Certified Checks. This type of security is held until the bid is no longer under consideration.
If submitted by a potential awardee, they will be returned when the contract is fully executed by the
bidder and bonds and insurance have been approved.
• Bid Bonds - Must be signed by the bidder and by the attorney-in-fact for the bonding company. Provide
notarized signature of attorney-in-fact accompanied by bonding company's affidavit authorizing attorney-
in-fact to execute bonds. An unsigned bid bond will be cause for rejection.
Acknowledge Addenda
Provide contractor's license information.
State business name and if business is a:
• Corporation - list officers
• Partnership - list partners
• Joint Venture- list members; if members are corporations or partnerships, list their officers or partners.
• Individual - list Owner's name and firm name style
Signature of Bidder-the following lists types of companies and corresponding authorized signers.
• Corporation - by an officer
• Partnership - by a partner
• Joint Venture- by a member
• Individual - by the Owner
If signature is by a Branch Manager, Estimator, Agent, etc., the bid must be accompanied by a power of attorney
authorizing the individual to sign the bid in question or to sign bids more generally, otherwise the bid may be
rejected.
• Business Address- Firm's Street Address
• Mailing Address- P.O. Box or Street Address
• Complete, sign, and return with bid.
INSTRUCTIONS FOR COMPLETING THE BID BOOK FOR NON-FEDERAL AID PROJECTS: Page 3 of 4
Noncollusion Declaration —Proposal 5
Must be completed, signed, and returned with bid.
Public Contract Code Section 10285.1 Statement— Proposal 6
Select"has" or"has not" in accordance with instructions on form, return completed form with bid. Note that
signing the bid constitutes signing this statement.
Public Contract Code Section 10162 Questionnaire And Public Contract Code 10232 Statement—
Proposal 7
Select"yes" or"no" accordance with instructions on form, include explanation if"yes" is selected. Return
completed form with bid. Note that signing the bid constitutes signing this questionnaire and statement.
Subcontractors— Proposal 8(a)through Proposal 8(c)
Sheet(s)or spaces where bidders list subcontractors. List each subcontractor to perform work in an amount in
excess of 1/2 of 1 percent of the total bid (Pub Cont Code §4100 et seq.).
The Subcontractor List submitted with the bid must show the name, location of business, work portions to be
performed, the contractor's license number and the public works contractor registration number issued pursuant
to Labor Code Section 1725.5, for each listed subcontractor.
• Use subcontractor's business name style as registered with the License Board.
• Specify the city in which the subcontractor's business is located and the state if other than California.
• Description of the work to be performed by the subcontractor. Indicate with bid item numbers from the
bid item list and/or work descriptions similar to those on bid item list.
• List license number for each subcontractor.
Upon request from Design Services, provide the following additional information within 24 hours of bid opening if
not included on the Subcontractor List submitted with the bid:
• Complete physical address for each subcontractor listed.
• Percentage of the total bid or dollar amount associated with each subcontractor listed.
• Department of Industrial Relations registration number.
Proposal 9 - Proposal 16 —Not Used
Guaranty- Proposal 17
This document may, but does not need to be, submitted with the bid. It is part of the contract documents and
must be separately signed and submitted by the contractor to whom the award is made, together with the
executed Agreement.
INSTRUCTIONS FOR COMPLETING THE BID BOOK FOR NON-FEDERAL AID PROJECTS: Page 4 of 4
PROPOSAL TO THE COUNTY OF FRESNO
hereinafter called the Owner
JUVENILE JUSTICE CAMPUS GROUNDWATER MONITORING WELL
REPLACEMENTS
3333 E. AMERICAN AVENUE
The work embraced herein shall be done in accordance with the 2015 Standard Specifications
and with the 2015 Standard Plans, of the State of California, Department of Transportation
insofar as the same may apply and in accordance with these special provisions.
Except to the extent that they may conflict with these special provisions, revised Standard
Specifications apply to the extent included in the section entitled "Project Details" of the book
entitled "Specifications."
The work to be done is shown on a set of Plans, Department File No.11321, entitled: "Juvenile
Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Well Replacements".
The undersigned, as bidder, declares that the only persons, or parties interested in this proposal
as principals are those named herein, that this proposal is made without collusion with any other
person, firm or corporation; that they have carefully examined the location of the proposed work,
the annexed proposed form of contract, and the plans therein referred to; and they propose and
agrees if this proposal is accepted, that they will contract with the Owner to provide all necessary
machinery, tools, apparatus and other means of construction, and to do all the work and furnish
all the materials specified in the contract in the manner and time therein prescribed, and
according to the requirements of the Engineer as therein set forth, and that they will take in full
payment therefor the following unit prices, to-wit:
Proposal 1
Contract Number 23-06-C
General Info
Total:
$271,029.00
Number Description
23-06-C Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater Monitoring Wells Replacement
Deadline
The work to be done consists, in general, installing three new groundwater monitoring
09/07/2023 02:00 PM PDT wells, including submersible pumps, to monitor first encountered groundwater quality to
comply with Waste Discharge Requirements Order No. R5-2007-0150, issued by the
Vendor Central Valley Regional Water Quality Control Board. The existing seven monitoring
ABC Liovin Drilling, Inc. wells, installed in 2007 and shortly after, will remain in place and existing pumps in these
wells will be removed and salvaged.
Submitted
09/07/2023 09:19 AM PDT Allows zero unit prices and labor
Yes
Signed by
Allows negative unit prices and labor
Eric Miklas Account Holder
Eric Miklas Yes
Opened
09/07/2023 02:01 PM PDT By
jwongsing@fresnocountyca.gov
Page 1 of 20 09/07/2023
Attachment List
Project Website
RFC form, bid opening details, any Supplemental Information
including RFC responses, prebid conference information, etc.
Plans (1 MB)
Plans (1 MB)
Specifications (7 MB)
Specifications (7 MB)
Page 2 of 20 09/07/2023
Proposal to the County of Fresno - Proposal 1
The work embraced herein shall be done in accordance with the 2015 Standard Specifications and with the 2015 Standard Plans,
of the State of California, Department of Transportation insofar as the same may apply and in accordance with these special
provisions.
Except to the extent that they may conflict with these special provisions, revised Standard Specifications apply to the extent
included in the section entitled "Project Details" of the book entitled "Specifications."
The work to be done is shown on a set of Plans, Department File No. 11321, entitled: "Juvenile Justice Campus Groundwater
Monitoring Well Replacements".
The undersigned, as bidder, declares that the only persons, or parties interested in this proposal as principals are those named
herein, that this proposal is made without collusion with any other person, firm or corporation; that they have carefully examined
the location of the proposed work,
the annexed proposed form of contract, and the plans therein referred to; and they propose and agree if this proposal is accepted,
that they will contract with the Owner to provide all necessary machinery, tools, apparatus and other means of construction, and to
do all the work and furnish all the materials specified in the contract in the manner and time therein prescribed, and according to
the requirements of the Engineer as therein set forth, and that they will take in full payment therefor the following unit prices, to-
wit:
Page 3 of 20 09/07/2023
Bid Item List - Proposal 2
$271,029.00
Item No. Quantity Unit Item Description Item Price Extension
1 1 LS Mobilization, Insurance, and Bonds $50,000.00 $50,000.00
2 1 LS Worker Protection $5,000.00 $5,000.00
3 1 LS Traffic Control $4,500.00 $4,500.00
4 1 LS Job Site Management $7,500.00 $7,500.00
5 1 LS Prepare and Implement Water Pollution Control Plan $2,500.00 $2,500.00
6 1 LS Miscellaneous Facilities, Operations, and USA $6,000.00 $6,000.00
7 390 LF Drill 10-inch Diameter Borehole $120.00 $46,800.00
8 240 LF Furnish and Install 4-inch (nominal) Diameter Blank Casing $42.00 $10,080.00
9 150 LF Furnish and Install 4-inch (nominal) Diameter Perforated Casing $45.00 $6,750.00
10 168 LF Furnish and Install Filter Pack $38.00 $6,384.00
11 12 LF Construct Bentonite Seal $150.00 $1,800.00
12 225 LF Construct Cement Grout Seal $26.00 $5,850.00
13 16 HR Well Development by Bailing, Surging, and Pumping $450.00 $7,200.00
14 3 EA Construct Wellhead Facilities $3,000.00 $9,000.00
15 405 LF Video Survey Well Casing $15.00 $6,075.00
16 3 EA Furnish and Install Submersible Well Pump $4,250.00 $12,750.00
17 345 LF Furnish and Install 3/4" (nominal) Access Tube $12.00 $4,140.00
18 360 LF Furnish and Install 1 1/4-inch (nominal) Drop Pipe $20.00 $7,200.00
19 1 EA Well MW-2U Inspection $9,500.00 $9,500.00
20 1 EA Well 2 Vault Box Replacement $3,000.00 $3,000.00
21 1 LS Well 2 Abandonment $7,500.00 $7,500.00
22 1 LS PMW-2 Fence Removal and Replacement $1,500.00 $1,500.00
Total: $271,029.00
Page 4 of 20 09/07/2023
Item No. Quantity Unit Item Description Item Price Extension
23 50,000 $ Supplemental Work $1.00 $50,000.00
Total: $271,029.00
Page 5 of 20 09/07/2023
Evaluation of Bid Item List - Proposal 3
Abbreviations used in the bid proposal sheet are identified in Section 1-1.06, "Abbreviations," of these special provisions.
Bids are required for the entire work. Bids will be compared on the basis indicated in the Notice to Bidders. The bidder shall set
forth for each unit basis item of work a unit price and a total for the item, and for each lump sum item a total for the item, all in
clearly legible figures in the respective spaces provided for that purpose. In the case of unit basis items, the amount set forth
under the "Item Total" column shall be the product of the unit price bid and the estimated quantity for the item.
In case of discrepancy between the unit price and the total set forth for a unit basis item, the unit price shall prevail, except as
provided in (a) or (b), as follows:
(a) If the amount set forth as a unit price is unreadable or otherwise unclear, or is omitted, or is the same as the amount as
the entry in the item total column, then the amount set forth in the item total column for the item shall prevail and shall be
divided by the estimated quantity for the item and the price thus obtained shall be the unit price;
(b) (Decimal Errors) If the product of the entered unit price and the estimated quantity is exactly off by a factor of ten, one
hundred, etc., or one-tenth, or one-hundredth, etc. from the entered total, the discrepancy will be resolved by using the
entered unit price or item total, whichever most closely approximates percentage-wise the unit price or item total in the
Owner's Final Estimate of cost.
If both the unit price and the item total are unreadable or otherwise unclear, or are omitted, the bid may be deemed irregular.
Likewise, if the item total for a lump sum item is unreadable or otherwise unclear, or is omitted, the bid may be deemed irregular
unless the project being bid has only a single item and a clear, readable total bid is provided.
Symbols such as commas and dollar signs will be ignored and have no mathematical significance in establishing any unit price or
item total or lump sums. Written unit prices, item totals and lump sums will be interpreted according to the number of digits and, if
applicable, decimal placement. Cents symbols also have no significance in establishing any unit price or item total since all figures
are assumed to be expressed in dollars and/or decimal fractions of a dollar. Bids on lump sum items shall be item totals only; if
any unit price for a lump sum item is included in a bid and it differs from the item total, the items total shall prevail.
The foregoing provisions for the resolution of specific irregularities cannot be so comprehensive as to cover every omission,
inconsistency, error or other irregularity which may occur in a bid. Any situation not specifically provided for will be determined in
the discretion of the Owner, and that discretion will be exercised in the manner deemed by the Owner to best protect the public
interest in the prompt and economical completion of the work. The decision of the Owner respecting the amount of a bid, or the
existence or treatment of an irregularity in a bid, shall be final.
If this proposal shall be accepted and the undersigned shall fail to contract, as aforesaid, and to give the two bonds in the sums to
be determined as aforesaid, with surety satisfactory to the Owner, within eight (8) days not including Saturdays, Sundays and legal
holidays, after the bidder has received notice of award of the contract, the Owner, at its option, may determine that the bidder has
abandoned the contract, and thereupon this proposal and the acceptance thereof shall be null and void, and the forfeiture of such
security accompanying this proposal shall operate and the same shall be the property of the Owner.
Page 6 of 20 09/07/2023
Bid Security - Proposal 4
Bond Percentage
10.00%
Guarantee Method
Cash, Cashier's Check,
Certified Check, Paper Bid
Bond
Cash, Cashier's Check, Certified Check, Paper Bid Bond
Confirmation *
I have provided a Paper Bid Bond for the Bid Security Amount above prior to the solicitation
deadline.
You must either attach an electronic bid bond here or provide an original bid bond (or other form of bid security authorized by
Public Contract Code Section 20129(a)) to the office location according to the instructions in the Notice to Bidders prior to the bid
opening.
Page 7 of 20 09/07/2023
Addendum Acknowledgement - Proposal 4
Bidders must acknowledge all addenda. The Bidder acknowledges receipt of the following ADDENDA:
(Enter the number the Designer has assigned to each of the addenda that the Bidder is acknowledging)
Type N/A if no addenda were issued. Click "+" to add additional fields.
Addendum No. *
N/A
Dated
9/6/2023
Page 8 of 20 09/07/2023
Bidder Signature - Proposal 4
Business Name *
ABC Liovin Drilling, Inc.
Note: If bidder or other interested person is a corporation, state legal name of corporation. If bidder is a co-partnership, state true
name of firm.
Type of Business
Corporation - list Officers
Business Owners and Officers Names
Ivan Liovin (president, secretary, treasurer and manager)
Note: If bidder or other interested person is:
• a corporation, list names of the president, secretary, treasurer and manager thereof
• a partnership, list names of all individual co-partners composing firm.
• an individual, state first and last name in full.
Names of Owners and Key Employees *
Ivan Liovin (president, secretary, treasurer and manager)
Note: List majority owners of your firm. If multiple owners, list all. Also include anyone, including key employees, who are actively
promoting the contract. (SB1439)
Licensed in accordance with an act providing for the registration of Contractors:
Class
C-57
Contractor License No. * Expires
422904 9/30/2024
Page 9 of 20 09/07/2023
DIR Registration Number
1000002851
Business Address
1180 East Burnett Street, Signal Hill, CA
Zip Code
90755
Mailing Address
1180 East Burnett Street, Signal Hill, CA
Zip Code
90755
Business Phone * Fax Number
(562) 981-8575 (562) 981-9594
E-mail Address *
info@abcdrilling.com
Signature of Bidder
Ivan Liovin
Dated *
9/6/2023
NOTE: If bidder is a corporation, the legal name of the corporation shall be set forth above together with the signature of the
officer or officers authorized to sign contracts on behalf of the corporation; if bidder is a co-partnership, the true name of the firm
shall be set forth above together with the signature of the partner or partners authorized to sign contracts on behalf of the co-
partnership; and if bidder is an individual, his signature shall be placed above. If signature is by an agent, other than an officer of
a corporation or a member of a partnership, a Power of Attorney must be on file with the Owner prior to opening bids or submitted
with the bid; otherwise, the bid will be disregarded as irregular and unauthorized.
Page 10 of 20 09/07/2023
Noncollusion Declaration - Proposal 5
TO BE EXECUTED BY BIDDER AND SUBMITTED WITH BID*
The undersigned declares:
I am the (Choose one of the following options):
Corporate Officer
If Corporate Officer please list Title:
of (Business Name):
ABC Liovin Drilling, Inc
the party making the foregoing bid.
The bid is not made in the interest of, or on behalf of, any undisclosed person, partnership, company, association, organization, or
corporation. The bid is genuine and not collusive or sham. The bidder has not directly or indirectly induced or solicited any other
bidder to put in a false or sham bid. The bidder has not directly or indirectly colluded, conspired, connived, or agreed with any
bidder or anyone else to put in a sham bid, or refrain from bidding. The bidder has not in any manner, directly or indirectly, sought
by agreement, communication, or conference with anyone to fix the bid price of the bidder or any other bidder, or to fix any
overhead, profit, or cost element of the bid price, or of that of any other bidder. All statements contained in the bid are true. The
bidder has not, directly or indirectly, submitted his or her bid price or any breakdown thereof, or the contents thereof, or divulged
information or data relative thereto, to any corporation, partnership, company, association, organization, bid depository, or to any
member or agent thereof, and has not paid, and will not pay, any person or entity for that purpose.
Any person executing this declaration on behalf of a bidder that is a corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability
company, limited liability partnership, or any other entity, hereby represents that he or she has full power to execute, and does
execute, this declaration on behalf of the bidder.
I declare under penalty of perjury under the laws of the State of California that the foregoing is true and correct and that this
declaration is executed on 2023,
Date:
9/6/23
at City, State: "
Signal HIII, CA
Signature:
Ivan Liovin
(See Title 23 United States Code Section 112; Calif Public Contract Code Section 7106)
Page 11 of 20 09/07/2023
*NOTE: Completing, signing, and returning the Non-Collusion Declaration is a required part of the Proposal. Bidders are cautioned
that making a false certification may subject the certifier to criminal prosecution.
Page 12 of 20 09/07/2023
Public Contract Code - Proposal 6-7
Public Contract Code Section 10285.1 Statement - Proposal 6
In conformance with Public Contract Code Section 10285.1 (Chapter 376, Stats. 1985), the bidder hereby declares under penalty
of perjury under the laws of the State of California that the bidder
Choose an option: *
Has not been convicted
within the preceding three years of any offenses referred to in that section, including any charge of fraud, bribery, collusion,
conspiracy, or any other act in violation of any state or Federal antitrust law in connection with the bidding upon, award of, or
performance of, any public works contract, as defined in Public Contract Code Section 1101, with any public entity, as defined in
Public Contract Code Section 1100, including the Regents of the University of California or the Trustees of the California State
University. The term "bidder" is understood to include any partner, member, officer, director, responsible managing officer, or
responsible managing employee thereof, as referred to in Section 10285.1.
The above Statement is part of the Bid. Signing this Bid on the signature portion thereof shall also constitute signature of this
Statement. Bidders are cautioned that making a false certification may subject the certifier to criminal prosecution.
Public Contract Code Section 10162 Questionnaire - Proposal 7
In conformance with Public Contract Code Section 10162, the Bidder shall complete, under penalty of perjury, the following
questionnaire:
Has the bidder, any officer of the bidder, or any employee of the bidder who has a proprietary interest in the bidder, ever been
disqualified, removed, or otherwise prevented from bidding on, or completing a federal, state, or local government project because
of a violation of law or a safety regulation?
Choose an option:
No
If the answer is No, please type N/A. If the answer is Yes, explain the circumstances in the following space.
N/A
Public Contract Code Section 10232 Statement - Proposal 7
Page 13 of 20 09/07/2023
In conformance with Public Contract Code Section 10232, the Contractor hereby states under penalty of perjury, that no more than
one final unappealable finding of contempt of court by a federal court has been issued against the Contractor within the
immediately preceding two-years period because of the Contractor's failure to comply with an order of the National Labor Relations
Board.
Note: The above Statement and Questionnaire are part of the Bid. Signing this Bid on the signature portion thereof shall also
constitute signature of this Statement and Questionnaire. Bidders are cautioned that making a false certification may subject the
certifier to criminal prosecution.
Page 14 of 20 09/07/2023
Subcontractors - Proposal 8
The following named subcontractor(s) will perform with labor, or otherwise render services to the general contractor in or about the
construction of the work or improvement in an amount in excess of one-half of one percent of the total bid presented herewith.
Please fill out as completely as possible when submitting your bid. Use subcontractor's business name style as registered with the
License Board. Submission of subcontractor's name, location of business and description of work, California contractor's license
number and public works contractor registration number issued pursuant to Section 1725.5 of the Labor Code, all are REQUIRED,
by Section 4104 of the California Public Contract Code, to be submitted prior to bid opening. (The "location of business" must
specify the city in which the subcontractor's business is located, and the state if other than California.) All other requested
information shall be submitted, either with the bid or within 24 hours after bid opening.
Please fill out as completely as possible when submitting your bid. Use subcontractor's business name style as registered with the
License Board.
FAILURE TO LIST SUBCONTRACTORS AS DIRECTED MAY RENDER THE BID NON-RESPONSIVE, OR MAY RESULT IN
ASSESSMENT OF A PENALTY AGAINST THE BIDDER IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 4110 OF THE CALIFORNIA
PUBLIC CONTRACT CODE.
Subcontractor: To add more subcontractor listings, click the "+" to add additional fields.
Subcontractor:
Pacific Surveys
Business Address
1785 W Arrow Route, Bldf. D, Suite 3 & 4. Upland, CA 91786
Class
License No. "
N/A
DIR Registration No.
1000014306
Item No. or Description of Work
Geophysical Survey
Dollar Amount: OR Percentage of Total Bid:
$6,000.00
Email Address:
shop@pacificsurveys.com
Page 15 of 20 09/07/2023
Page 16 of 20 09/07/2023
Proposal 9 - 16
NOT USED
Page 17 of 20 09/07/2023
Guaranty - Proposal 17
Optional: Vendor is not required to complete.
(This guaranty shall be executed by the successful bidder in accordance with instructions in the special provisions. The bidder may
execute the guaranty on this page at the time of submitting their bid.)
GUARANTY
To the Owner: County of Fresno
CONTRACT NUMBER
The undersigned guarantees the construction and installation of the following work included in this project: 23-06-C
ALL WORK
Should any of the materials or equipment prove defective or should the work as a whole prove defective, due to faulty
workmanship, material furnished or methods of installation, or should the work or any part thereof fail to operate properly as
originally intended and in accordance with the plans and specifications, due to any of the above causes, all within twelve (12)
months after date on which this contract is accepted by the Owner, the undersigned agrees to reimburse the Owner, upon
demand, for its expenses incurred in restoring said work to the condition contemplated in said project, including the cost of any
such equipment or materials replaced and the cost of removing and replacing any other work necessary to make such replacement
or repairs, or, upon demand by the Owner, to replace any such material and to repair said work completely without cost to the
Owner so that said work will function successfully as originally contemplated.
The Owner shall have the unqualified option to make any needed replacement or repairs itself or to have such replacements or
repairs done by the undersigned. In the event the Owner elects to have said work performed by the undersigned, the undersigned
agrees that the repairs shall be made and such materials as are necessary shall be furnished and installed within a reasonable
time after the receipt of demand from the Owner.
Date:
9/6/23
Name (Printed):
Ivan Liovin
Signature:
Ivan Liovin
Title: *
President
Contractor:
Page 18 of 20 09/07/2023
ABC Liovin Drilling, Inc
Page 19 of 20 09/07/2023
Additional Documents (Use if needed)
Name Omission Terms Submitted
File
Optional: Vendor is not required to complete.
Not Required Extra space not needed ABC Bid
Extra Space if needed Proposal.pdf
I am not
enclosing this
Not Required document
Extra Space if needed Extra space not needed because the
omission terms
have been
met.
I am not
enclosing this
Not Required document
Extra Space if needed Extra space not needed because the
omission terms
have been
met.
3 Required Documents
Page 20 of 20 09/07/2023
AGREEMENT
THIS AGREEMENT made at Fresno, in Fresno County, California, by and between ABC Liovin Drilling,
Inc. hereinafter called the Contractor, and the County of Fresno hereinafter called the Owner.
WITNESSETH: That the Contractor and the Owner, for the consideration hereinafter named, agree as
follows:
ARTICLE I. The Contractor agrees to furnish all labor and materials, including tools, implements, and
appliances required, but excluding such materials as are mentioned in the specifications to be furnished
by the Owner, and to perform all the work in a good and workmanlike manner, free from any and all liens
and claims of mechanics, materialmen, teamsters, subcontractors, artisans, machinists, and laborers
required for:
JUVENILE JUSTICE CAMPUS GROUNDWATER MONITORING WELL REPLACEMENTS
3333 E. AMERICAN AVENUE, FRESNO, CA
CONTRACT NUMBER: 23-06-C
All in strict compliance with the plans, drawings and specifications therefor prepared by the Owner, and
other contract documents relating thereto.
ARTICLE II. The Contractor and the Owner agree that the Notice to Bidders and Special Provisions,
the Wage Scale (Prevailing Wages), the Plans and Drawings, Addenda and Bulletins thereto, and the
Proposal (Bid Book) hereto attached, together with this Agreement, form the contract, and they are as
fully a part of the contract as if hereto attached or herein repeated.
All portions of the Standard Specifications of the State of California, Department of Transportation, dated
2015, which are not in conflict with this contract shall be deemed a part of the specifications as though
fully therein set forth; provided, however, that revisions to the said Standard Specifications shall apply
only to the extent, if any, included in the Project Details of these specifications or as otherwise
incorporated directly herein. No part of said specifications which is in conflict with any portion of this
agreement, or which is not actually descriptive of the work to be done thereunder, or of the manner in
which said work is to be executed, shall be considered as any part of this agreement, but shall be utterly
null and void.
ARTICLE III. The Owner agrees to pay the Contractor in current funds for the performance of the
contract the sum of TWO HUNDRED SEVENTY ONE THOUSAND TWENTY NINE DOLLARS AND
00/100 ($271,029.00) it being understood that said price is based upon the estimated quantities of
materials to be used as set forth in the Proposal, except where provisions are made in the contract
documents whereby the estimated quantities shall constitute the final quantity; that upon completion of
the project the final contract prices shall be revised by change order, if necessary, to reflect the true
quantities used at the stated unit price thereof as contained in the Contractor's Proposal hereto attached.
Payments on account thereof will be made as set forth in the special provisions.
ARTICLE IV. If the Contractor should be adjudged a bankrupt, or if he should make a general
assignment for the benefit of his creditors, or if a receiver should be appointed on account of his
insolvency, or if he or any of his subcontractors should persistently violate any of the provisions of the
contract, or if he should persistently or repeatedly refuse or should fail, except in cases for which
extension of time is provided, to supply enough properly skilled workmen or proper materials, or if he
should fail to make prompt payment to subcontractors or for material or labor, or persistently disregard
Contract Number 23-06-C
laws, ordinances or the instructions of the Engineer, then the Owner may, upon certificate of the
Engineer when sufficient cause exists to justify such action, serve written notice upon the Contractor
and his surety of its intention to terminate the contract, and unless within five days after the serving of
such notice, such violations shall cease and satisfactory arrangements for correction thereof be made,
the contract shall, upon the expiration of said five days, cease and terminate.
In the event of any such termination, the Owner shall immediately serve written notice thereof upon the
surety and the Contractor, and the surety shall have the right to take over and perform the contract,
provided, however, that if the surety within ten (10) days after the serving upon it of notice of termination
does not give the Owner written notice of its intention to take over and perform the contract or does not
commence performance thereof within the ten (10) days stated above from the date of the serving of
such notice, the Owner may take over the work and prosecute the same to completion by contract or by
any other method it may deem advisable, for the account and at the expense of the Contractor, and the
Contractor and his surety shall be liable to the Owner for any excess cost occasioned the Owner thereby,
and in such event the Owner may without liability for so doing, take possession of and utilize in
completing the work such materials, appliances, plant and other property belonging to the Contractor as
may be on the site of the work and necessary therefor. In such case the Contractor shall not be entitled
to receive any further payment until the work is finished. If the unpaid balance of the contract price shall
exceed the expenses of finishing the work, including compensation for additional managerial and
administrative services, such excess shall be paid to the Contractor. If such expense shall exceed such
unpaid balance, the Contractor shall pay the difference to the Owner. The expense incurred by the
Owner, as herein provided and damage incurred through the Contractor's default, shall be certified by
the Engineer.
ARTICLE V. To the fullest extent permitted by law with respect to any work required to be done under
this contract, the Contractor will indemnify and hold harmless the COUNTY OF FRESNO, STATE OF
CALIFORNIA, CONSULTANTS and all other participating public agencies, whether or not said agencies
are named herein, who have jurisdiction within the areas in which the work is to be performed, and all
officers and employees of the Owner, the County, the State, the United States and said other
participating agencies, from any and all costs and expenses, attorney fees and court costs, damages,
liabilities, claims and losses occurring or resulting to COUNTY in connection with the performance, or
failure to perform, by CONTRACTOR, its officers, agents or employees under this Agreement, and from
any and all costs and expenses, attorney fees and court costs, damages, liabilities, claims and losses
occurring or resulting to any person, firm or corporation who may be injured or damaged by the
performance, or failure to perform, of CONTRACTOR, its officers, agents or employees under this
Agreement. In addition, CONTRACTOR agrees to indemnify COUNTY for Federal, State of California
and/or local audit exceptions resulting from non-compliance herein on the part of CONTRACTOR.
CONTRACTOR agrees to indemnify, save, hold harmless, and at COUNTY'S request, defend the
COUNTY, its officers, agents, and employees from any and all costs and expenses, damages, liabilities,
claims, and losses occurring or resulting to COUNTY in connection with the performance, or failure to
perform, by CONTRACTOR, its officers, agents, or employees under this Agreement, and from any and
all costs and expenses, damages, liabilities, claims, and losses occurring or resulting to any person,
firm, or corporation who may be injured or damaged by the performance, or failure to perform, of
CONTRACTOR, its officers, agents, or employees under this Agreement.
The Certificate of Insurance shall be issued in duplicate, to the COUNTY OF FRESNO, and all other
participating agencies, whether or not said agencies are named herein, who contribute to the cost of the
work or have jurisdiction over areas in which the work is to be performed and all officers and employees
of said agencies while acting within the course and scope of their duties and responsibilities.
In the event CONTRACTOR fails to keep in effect at all times insurance coverage as herein provided,
the COUNTY may, in addition to other remedies it may have, suspend or terminate this Agreement upon
the occurrence of such event.
Contract Number 23-06-C
All policies shall be with admitted insurers licensed to do business in the State of California. Insurance
purchased shall be purchased from companies possessing a current AM Best Company rating of A FSC
VII or better.
Without limiting the COUNTY'S right to obtain indemnification from CONTRACTOR or any third parties,
CONTRACTOR, at its sole expense, shall maintain in full force and effect, the following insurance
policies or a program of self-insurance, including but not limited to, an insurance pooling arrangement
or Joint Powers Agreement (JPA) throughout the term of the Agreement:
A. Commercial General Liability
Commercial General Liability Insurance with limits not less than those shown in the following table:
Liability Insurance Requirements
Total bid For each Aggregate for products/completed General b Umbrella or
occurrencea operation aggregate excess liabilityc
<_ $500,000 $1,000,000 $2,000,000 $2,000,000 $2,000,000
> $500,000
15 $1,000,000 $1,000,000 $2,000,000 $2,000,000 $5,000,000
> $1,000,000
5 $10,000,000 $1,000,000 $2,000,000 $2,000,000 $10,000,000
> $10,000,000
15 $25,000,000 $2,000,000 $2,000,000 $4,000,000 $15,000,000
> $25,000,000 $2,000,000 $2,000,000 $4,000,000 $25,000,000
'Combined single limit for bodily injury and property damage.
bThis limit must apply separately to your work under this Contract.
'The umbrella or excess policy must contain a clause stating that it takes effect (drops down) in the
event the primary limits are impaired or exhausted.
This policy shall be issued on a per occurrence basis. COUNTY may require specific coverages including
completed operations, products liability, contractual liability, Explosion-Collapse-Underground, fire legal
liability, or any other liability insurance deemed necessary because of the of the nature of this contract.
Such Commercial General Liability insurance shall name the County of Fresno, its officers, agents, and
employees, individually and collectively, as additional insured, but only insofar as the operations under
this Agreement are concerned. Such coverage for additional insured shall apply as primary insurance
and any other insurance, or self-insurance, maintained by COUNTY, its officers, agents and employees
shall be excess only and not contributing with insurance provided under CONTRACTOR's policies
herein. This insurance shall not be cancelled or changed without a minimum of thirty (30)days advance
written notice given to COUNTY. CONTRACTOR shall obtain endorsements to the Commercial General
Liability insurance policy naming COUNTY as an additional insured and providing for a thirty (30) day
prior written notice of cancellation or change in terms or coverage.
Within eight (8) days from date CONTRACTOR executes this Agreement, CONTRACTOR shall provide
certificates of insurance and endorsement as stated above for all of the foregoing policies, as required
herein, to the County of Fresno, or to designservices(d�fresnocountyca.gov, stating that such insurance
coverages have been obtained and are in full force; that the County of Fresno, its officers, agents and
employees will not be responsible for an premiums on the policies; that such Commercial General
Contract Number 23-06-C
Liability insurance names the County of Fresno, its officers, agents, and employees, individually and
collectively, as additional insured, but only insofar as the operations under this Agreement are
concerned; that such coverage for additional insured shall apply as primary insurance an any other
insurance, or self- insurance shall not be cancelled or changed without a minimum of thirty (30) days
advance, written notice given to COUNTY.
CONTRACTOR shall obtain endorsements to the Commercial General Liability insurance naming the
County of Fresno, its officers, agents, and employees, individually and collectively, as additional insured,
but only insofar as the operations under this Agreement are concerned. Such coverage for additional
insured shall apply as primary insurance and any other insurance, or self-insurance, maintained by
COUNTY, its officers, agents, and employees shall be excess only and not contributing with insurance
provided under CONTRACTOR'S policies herein. This insurance shall not be cancelled or changed
without a minimum or thirty (30) days advance written notice given to COUNTY.
B. Automobile Liability
Comprehensive Automobile Liability Insurance with limits of not less than One Million Dollars
($1,000,000) per accident for bodily injury and property damage. Coverage should include owned and
non-owned vehicles used in connection with this Agreement and all applicable endorsements.
C. Professional Liability
If CONTRACTOR is a licensed professional or employs professional staff, (e.g., Architect, Engineer,
Surveyor, etc.) in providing services, Professional Liability Insurance with limits of not less than One
Million Dollars ($1,000,000.00) per occurrence, Three Million Dollars ($3,000,000.00) annual aggregate
with a provision for 3 year tail coverage.
D. Worker's Compensation
A policy of Worker's Compensation insurance as may be required by the California Labor Code.
ARTICLE VI. Contractor represents that he has secured the payment of Worker's Compensation in
compliance with the provisions of the Labor Code of the State of California and during the performance
of the work contemplated herein will continue so to comply with said provisions of said Code. Contractor
shall supply the Owner with certificates of insurance, in duplicate, evidencing that Worker's
Compensation Insurance is in effect and providing that the Owner will receive ten days notice of
cancellation. If Contractor self-insures Worker's Compensation, Certificate of Consent to Self-insure
should be provided the Owner.
ARTICLE VII. The Contractor shall forthwith furnish in duplicate, a faithful performance bond in an
amount equal to 100% of the contract price and a payment bond in an amount equal to 100% of the
contract price, both bonds to be written by a surety company acceptable to the Owner and in the form
prescribed by law.
The payment bond shall contain provisions such that if the Contractor or his subcontractors shall fail to
pay (a) amounts due under the Unemployment Insurance Code with respect to work performed under
the contract, or (b) any amounts required to be deducted, withheld and paid over to the Employment
Development Department and to the Franchise Tax Board from the wages of the employees of the
Contractor and subcontractors pursuant to Section 13020 of the Unemployment Insurance Code with
respect to such work and labor, then the surety will pay these amounts. In case suit is brought upon the
payment bond, the surety will pay a reasonable attorney's fee to be fixed by the court.
ARTICLE VIII. This project is subject to compliance monitoring and enforcement by the Department of
Industrial Relations.
Contract Number 23-06-C
Except as provided in Labor Code section 1725.5(f), no contractor or subcontractor may be listed on a
bid proposal for a public works project unless registered with the Department of Industrial Relations
pursuant to Labor Code section 1725.5 [with limited exceptions from this requirement for bid purposes
only under Labor Code section 1771.1(a)].
Except as provided in Labor Code section 1725.5(f), no contractor or subcontractor may be awarded a
contract for public work on a public works project or engage in the performance of work on any public
works project unless registered with the Department of Industrial Relations pursuant to Labor Code
section 1725.5.
Contractor shall comply with all applicable laws and regulations relating to wages and employment,
including all requirements imposed by the California Department of Industrial Relations (DIR).
Contractor shall cooperate with County to furnish timely all information necessary for County's
completion of the form required to be submitted by County when registering the Project on the DIR
website; and County thereafter shall provide to Contractor the "Project ID Number' assigned by DIR in
order to facilitate Contactor's submission to DIR of its certified payrolls for the Project, in the manner
required and using such form as may be prescribed by DIR, in accordance with the provisions of Labor
Code section 1771.4(a)(3).
ARTICLE IX: Governing Law—Venue for any action arising out of or relating to this Agreement shall be
in Fresno County, California. This Agreement shall be governed by the laws of the State of California.
This Contract, 23-06-C, was awarded by the County of Fresno on October 24, 2023. It has
been reviewed by the Department of Public Works and Planning and is in proper order for signature
of the Chairman of the Board of Supervisors/ Director of Public Works and Planning.
IN WITNESS WHEREOF, they have executed this Agreement this 12th day of
December , 2023
ABC Liovin Drilling, Inc COUNTY OF FRESNO
(CONTRACTOR) (OWNER)
Ivan Liovin
By By
al ntero; Chairman
of., . Board of Supervisors of the
President County of Fresno
Title
ATTEST:
Bernice E. Seidel
Clerk of the Board of Supervisors
County of Fresno, State of California
By
Deputy
Contract Number 23-06-C